Provided by: gcc-4.6_4.6.4-6ubuntu2_amd64 bug

NAME

       gcc - GNU project C and C++ compiler

SYNOPSIS

       gcc [-c|-S|-E] [-std=standard]
           [-g] [-pg] [-Olevel]
           [-Wwarn...] [-pedantic]
           [-Idir...] [-Ldir...]
           [-Dmacro[=defn]...] [-Umacro]
           [-foption...] [-mmachine-option...]
           [-o outfile] [@file] infile...

       Only the most useful options are listed here; see below for the remainder.  g++ accepts mostly the same
       options as gcc.

DESCRIPTION

       When you invoke GCC, it normally does preprocessing, compilation, assembly and linking.  The "overall
       options" allow you to stop this process at an intermediate stage.  For example, the -c option says not to
       run the linker.  Then the output consists of object files output by the assembler.

       Other options are passed on to one stage of processing.  Some options control the preprocessor and others
       the compiler itself.  Yet other options control the assembler and linker; most of these are not
       documented here, since you rarely need to use any of them.

       Most of the command line options that you can use with GCC are useful for C programs; when an option is
       only useful with another language (usually C++), the explanation says so explicitly.  If the description
       for a particular option does not mention a source language, you can use that option with all supported
       languages.

       The gcc program accepts options and file names as operands.  Many options have multi-letter names;
       therefore multiple single-letter options may not be grouped: -dv is very different from -d -v.

       You can mix options and other arguments.  For the most part, the order you use doesn't matter.  Order
       does matter when you use several options of the same kind; for example, if you specify -L more than once,
       the directories are searched in the order specified.  Also, the placement of the -l option is
       significant.

       Many options have long names starting with -f or with -W---for example, -fmove-loop-invariants, -Wformat
       and so on.  Most of these have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of -ffoo would be
       -fno-foo.  This manual documents only one of these two forms, whichever one is not the default.

OPTIONS

   Option Summary
       Here is a summary of all the options, grouped by type.  Explanations are in the following sections.

       Overall Options
           -c    -S   -E   -o  file   -no-canonical-prefixes  -pipe   -pass-exit-codes  -x  language   -v   -###
           --help[=class[,...]]  --target-help  --version  -wrapper  @file  -fplugin=file  -fplugin-arg-name=arg
           -fdump-ada-spec[-slim] -fdump-go-spec=file

       C Language Options
           -ansi  -std=standard  -fgnu89-inline -aux-info filename -fno-asm  -fno-builtin  -fno-builtin-function
           -fhosted   -ffreestanding  -fopenmp -fms-extensions -fplan9-extensions -trigraphs  -no-integrated-cpp
           -traditional   -traditional-cpp  -fallow-single-precision   -fcond-mismatch  -flax-vector-conversions
           -fsigned-bitfields  -fsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields  -funsigned-char

       C++ Language Options
           -fabi-version=n      -fno-access-control      -fcheck-new    -fconserve-space     -fconstexpr-depth=n
           -ffriend-injection   -fno-elide-constructors   -fno-enforce-eh-specs   -ffor-scope     -fno-for-scope
           -fno-gnu-keywords   -fno-implicit-templates   -fno-implicit-inline-templates   -fno-implement-inlines
           -fms-extensions   -fno-nonansi-builtins    -fnothrow-opt    -fno-operator-names   -fno-optional-diags
           -fpermissive     -fno-pretty-templates     -frepo      -fno-rtti      -fstats      -ftemplate-depth=n
           -fno-threadsafe-statics     -fuse-cxa-atexit      -fno-weak      -nostdinc++      -fno-default-inline
           -fvisibility-inlines-hidden   -fvisibility-ms-compat  -Wabi   -Wconversion-null   -Wctor-dtor-privacy
           -Wnoexcept -Wnon-virtual-dtor  -Wreorder  -Weffc++   -Wstrict-null-sentinel  -Wno-non-template-friend
           -Wold-style-cast -Woverloaded-virtual  -Wno-pmf-conversions -Wsign-promo

       Objective-C and Objective-C++ Language Options
           -fconstant-string-class=class-name       -fgnu-runtime        -fnext-runtime       -fno-nil-receivers
           -fobjc-abi-version=n  -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors   -fobjc-direct-dispatch   -fobjc-exceptions   -fobjc-gc
           -fobjc-nilcheck  -fobjc-std=objc1  -freplace-objc-classes  -fzero-link  -gen-decls -Wassign-intercept
           -Wno-protocol  -Wselector -Wstrict-selector-match -Wundeclared-selector

       Language Independent Options
           -fmessage-length=n -fdiagnostics-show-location=[once|every-line] -fno-diagnostics-show-option

       Warning Options
           -fsyntax-only    -fmax-errors=n    -pedantic   -pedantic-errors   -w    -Wextra    -Wall    -Waddress
           -Waggregate-return     -Warray-bounds   -Wno-attributes   -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined   -Wc++-compat
           -Wc++0x-compat  -Wcast-align   -Wcast-qual  -Wchar-subscripts  -Wclobbered   -Wcomment   -Wconversion
           -Wcoverage-mismatch   -Wno-cpp   -Wno-deprecated -Wno-deprecated-declarations -Wdisabled-optimization
           -Wno-div-by-zero -Wdouble-promotion -Wempty-body  -Wenum-compare -Wno-endif-labels -Werror  -Werror=*
           -Wfatal-errors  -Wfloat-equal  -Wformat  -Wformat=2  -Wno-format-contains-nul  -Wno-format-extra-args
           -Wformat-nonliteral   -Wformat-security    -Wformat-y2k   -Wframe-larger-than=len  -Wjump-misses-init
           -Wignored-qualifiers   -Wimplicit    -Wimplicit-function-declaration    -Wimplicit-int    -Winit-self
           -Winline     -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast     -Wno-invalid-offsetof    -Winvalid-pch    -Wlarger-than=len
           -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations       -Wlogical-op       -Wlong-long       -Wmain        -Wmissing-braces
           -Wmissing-field-initializers    -Wmissing-format-attribute     -Wmissing-include-dirs    -Wno-mudflap
           -Wno-multichar  -Wnonnull   -Wno-overflow  -Woverlength-strings   -Wpacked   -Wpacked-bitfield-compat
           -Wpadded      -Wparentheses      -Wpedantic-ms-format     -Wno-pedantic-ms-format     -Wpointer-arith
           -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast -Wredundant-decls -Wreturn-type  -Wsequence-point   -Wshadow  -Wsign-compare
           -Wsign-conversion     -Wstack-protector   -Wstrict-aliasing   -Wstrict-aliasing=n   -Wstrict-overflow
           -Wstrict-overflow=n     -Wsuggest-attribute=[pure|const|noreturn]     -Wswitch       -Wswitch-default
           -Wswitch-enum   -Wsync-nand  -Wsystem-headers   -Wtrampolines   -Wtrigraphs   -Wtype-limits   -Wundef
           -Wuninitialized     -Wunknown-pragmas     -Wno-pragmas     -Wunsuffixed-float-constants      -Wunused
           -Wunused-function     -Wunused-label      -Wunused-parameter     -Wno-unused-result    -Wunused-value
           -Wunused-variable  -Wunused-but-set-parameter   -Wunused-but-set-variable   -Wvariadic-macros   -Wvla
           -Wvolatile-register-var  -Wwrite-strings

       C and Objective-C-only Warning Options
           -Wbad-function-cast      -Wmissing-declarations     -Wmissing-parameter-type     -Wmissing-prototypes
           -Wnested-externs -Wold-style-declaration  -Wold-style-definition  -Wstrict-prototypes   -Wtraditional
           -Wtraditional-conversion -Wdeclaration-after-statement -Wpointer-sign

       Debugging Options
           -dletters    -dumpspecs    -dumpmachine    -dumpversion  -fdbg-cnt-list  -fdbg-cnt=counter-value-list
           -fdump-noaddr       -fdump-unnumbered       -fdump-unnumbered-links       -fdump-translation-unit[-n]
           -fdump-class-hierarchy[-n]   -fdump-ipa-all   -fdump-ipa-cgraph  -fdump-ipa-inline  -fdump-statistics
           -fdump-tree-all -fdump-tree-original[-n]  -fdump-tree-optimized[-n]  -fdump-tree-cfg  -fdump-tree-vcg
           -fdump-tree-alias    -fdump-tree-ch   -fdump-tree-ssa[-n]   -fdump-tree-pre[-n]   -fdump-tree-ccp[-n]
           -fdump-tree-dce[-n]     -fdump-tree-gimple[-raw]     -fdump-tree-mudflap[-n]      -fdump-tree-dom[-n]
           -fdump-tree-dse[-n]     -fdump-tree-phiprop[-n]    -fdump-tree-phiopt[-n]    -fdump-tree-forwprop[-n]
           -fdump-tree-copyrename[-n]  -fdump-tree-nrv  -fdump-tree-vect  -fdump-tree-sink   -fdump-tree-sra[-n]
           -fdump-tree-forwprop[-n]    -fdump-tree-fre[-n]    -fdump-tree-vrp[-n]    -ftree-vectorizer-verbose=n
           -fdump-tree-storeccp[-n]   -fdump-final-insns=file   -fcompare-debug[=opts]    -fcompare-debug-second
           -feliminate-dwarf2-dups        -feliminate-unused-debug-types        -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
           -femit-class-debug-always -fenable-icf-debug -fmem-report -fpre-ipa-mem-report  -fpost-ipa-mem-report
           -fprofile-arcs   -frandom-seed=string   -fsched-verbose=n   -fsel-sched-verbose  -fsel-sched-dump-cfg
           -fsel-sched-pipelining-verbose   -fstack-usage    -ftest-coverage     -ftime-report    -fvar-tracking
           -fvar-tracking-assignments    -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle   -g    -glevel    -gtoggle    -gcoff
           -gdwarf-version -ggdb  -gstabs  -gstabs+  -gstrict-dwarf  -gno-strict-dwarf -gvms  -gxcoff   -gxcoff+
           -fno-merge-debug-strings  -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm -fdebug-prefix-map=old=new -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
           -femit-struct-debug-reduced         -femit-struct-debug-detailed[=spec-list]         -p           -pg
           -print-file-name=library      -print-libgcc-file-name     -print-multi-directory     -print-multi-lib
           -print-multi-os-directory    -print-prog-name=program     -print-search-dirs     -Q    -print-sysroot
           -print-sysroot-headers-suffix -save-temps -save-temps=cwd -save-temps=obj -time[=file]

       Optimization Options
           -falign-functions[=n]   -falign-jumps[=n]   -falign-labels[=n]  -falign-loops[=n]  -fassociative-math
           -fauto-inc-dec  -fbranch-probabilities  -fbranch-target-load-optimize  -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
           -fbtr-bb-exclusive   -fcaller-saves  -fcheck-data-deps  -fcombine-stack-adjustments  -fconserve-stack
           -fcompare-elim     -fcprop-registers     -fcrossjumping     -fcse-follow-jumps      -fcse-skip-blocks
           -fcx-fortran-rules     -fcx-limited-range     -fdata-sections     -fdce     -fdce    -fdelayed-branch
           -fdelete-null-pointer-checks    -fdse     -fdevirtualize     -fdse     -fearly-inlining     -fipa-sra
           -fexpensive-optimizations   -ffast-math   -ffinite-math-only  -ffloat-store  -fexcess-precision=style
           -fforward-propagate -ffp-contract=style  -ffunction-sections  -fgcse  -fgcse-after-reload  -fgcse-las
           -fgcse-lm   -fgraphite-identity   -fgcse-sm   -fif-conversion   -fif-conversion2  -findirect-inlining
           -finline-functions -finline-functions-called-once -finline-limit=n -finline-small-functions  -fipa-cp
           -fipa-cp-clone    -fipa-matrix-reorg   -fipa-pta   -fipa-profile   -fipa-pure-const   -fipa-reference
           -fipa-struct-reorg      -fira-algorithm=algorithm       -fira-region=region       -fira-loop-pressure
           -fno-ira-share-save-slots -fno-ira-share-spill-slots -fira-verbose=n -fivopts -fkeep-inline-functions
           -fkeep-static-consts     -floop-block     -floop-flatten     -floop-interchange     -floop-strip-mine
           -floop-parallelize-all     -flto     -flto-compression-level     -flto-partition=alg     -flto-report
           -fmerge-all-constants       -fmerge-constants       -fmodulo-sched      -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
           -fmove-loop-invariants fmudflap  -fmudflapir  -fmudflapth  -fno-branch-count-reg  -fno-default-inline
           -fno-defer-pop    -fno-function-cse    -fno-guess-branch-probability    -fno-inline   -fno-math-errno
           -fno-peephole     -fno-peephole2     -fno-sched-interblock     -fno-sched-spec      -fno-signed-zeros
           -fno-toplevel-reorder     -fno-trapping-math     -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss    -fomit-frame-pointer
           -foptimize-register-move       -foptimize-sibling-calls        -fpartial-inlining        -fpeel-loops
           -fpredictive-commoning       -fprefetch-loop-arrays      -fprofile-correction      -fprofile-dir=path
           -fprofile-generate   -fprofile-generate=path   -fprofile-use   -fprofile-use=path    -fprofile-values
           -freciprocal-math   -fregmove   -frename-registers   -freorder-blocks  -freorder-blocks-and-partition
           -freorder-functions   -frerun-cse-after-loop   -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops    -frounding-math
           -fsched2-use-superblocks      -fsched-pressure      -fsched-spec-load     -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
           -fsched-stalled-insns-dep[=n]            -fsched-stalled-insns[=n]            -fsched-group-heuristic
           -fsched-critical-path-heuristic           -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic          -fsched-rank-heuristic
           -fsched-last-insn-heuristic    -fsched-dep-count-heuristic     -fschedule-insns     -fschedule-insns2
           -fsection-anchors      -fselective-scheduling      -fselective-scheduling2     -fsel-sched-pipelining
           -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops            -fsignaling-nans            -fsingle-precision-constant
           -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller  -fsplit-wide-types -fstack-protector -fstack-protector-all -fstrict-aliasing
           -fstrict-overflow -fthread-jumps -ftracer -ftree-bit-ccp -ftree-builtin-call-dce -ftree-ccp -ftree-ch
           -ftree-copy-prop  -ftree-copyrename  -ftree-dce  -ftree-dominator-opts   -ftree-dse   -ftree-forwprop
           -ftree-fre   -ftree-loop-if-convert   -ftree-loop-if-convert-stores   -ftree-loop-im   -ftree-phiprop
           -ftree-loop-distribution   -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns   -ftree-loop-ivcanon   -ftree-loop-linear
           -ftree-loop-optimize  -ftree-parallelize-loops=n  -ftree-pre  -ftree-pta  -ftree-reassoc  -ftree-sink
           -ftree-sra -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-ter -ftree-vect-loop-version  -ftree-vectorize  -ftree-vrp
           -funit-at-a-time         -funroll-all-loops         -funroll-loops        -funsafe-loop-optimizations
           -funsafe-math-optimizations -funswitch-loops -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller -fvect-cost-model -fvpt
           -fweb -fwhole-program -fwpa -fuse-linker-plugin --param name=value -O  -O0  -O1  -O2  -O3  -Os -Ofast

       Preprocessor Options
           -Aquestion=answer -A-question[=answer] -C  -dD  -dI  -dM  -dN -Dmacro[=defn]  -E  -H  -idirafter  dir
           -include  file   -imacros  file  -iprefix file  -iwithprefix dir -iwithprefixbefore dir  -isystem dir
           -imultilib dir -isysroot dir -M  -MM  -MF  -MG  -MP   -MQ   -MT   -nostdinc  -P   -fworking-directory
           -remap -trigraphs  -undef  -Umacro  -Wp,option -Xpreprocessor option

       Assembler Option
           -Wa,option  -Xassembler option

       Linker Options
           object-file-name   -llibrary  -nostartfiles   -nodefaultlibs   -nostdlib  -pie  -rdynamic -s  -static
           -static-libgcc  -static-libstdc++ -shared -shared-libgcc  -symbolic -T script   -Wl,option   -Xlinker
           option -u symbol

       Directory Options
           -Bprefix -Idir -iplugindir=dir -iquotedir -Ldir -specs=file -I- --sysroot=dir

       Machine Dependent Options
           ARC    Options    -EB    -EL   -mmangle-cpu    -mcpu=cpu    -mtext=text-section   -mdata=data-section
           -mrodata=readonly-data-section

           ARM  Options  -mapcs-frame   -mno-apcs-frame  -mabi=name  -mapcs-stack-check    -mno-apcs-stack-check
           -mapcs-float  -mno-apcs-float -mapcs-reentrant  -mno-apcs-reentrant -msched-prolog  -mno-sched-prolog
           -mlittle-endian   -mbig-endian   -mwords-little-endian  -mfloat-abi=name   -msoft-float  -mhard-float
           -mfpe -mfp16-format=name -mthumb-interwork  -mno-thumb-interwork -mcpu=name  -march=name   -mfpu=name
           -mstructure-size-boundary=n   -mabort-on-noreturn   -mlong-calls   -mno-long-calls  -msingle-pic-base
           -mno-single-pic-base      -mpic-register=reg      -mnop-fun-dllimport      -mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
           -mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns  -mpoke-function-name  -mthumb   -marm  -mtpcs-frame  -mtpcs-leaf-frame
           -mcaller-super-interworking       -mcallee-super-interworking      -mtp=name       -mword-relocations
           -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd

           AVR Options -mmcu=mcu  -mno-interrupts -mcall-prologues  -mtiny-stack  -mint8

           Blackfin Options -mcpu=cpu[-sirevision] -msim -momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer
           -mspecld-anomaly   -mno-specld-anomaly   -mcsync-anomaly   -mno-csync-anomaly  -mlow-64k  -mno-low64k
           -mstack-check-l1        -mid-shared-library       -mno-id-shared-library        -mshared-library-id=n
           -mleaf-id-shared-library    -mno-leaf-id-shared-library   -msep-data    -mno-sep-data    -mlong-calls
           -mno-long-calls -mfast-fp -minline-plt -mmulticore  -mcorea  -mcoreb  -msdram -micplb

           CRIS Options -mcpu=cpu  -march=cpu   -mtune=cpu  -mmax-stack-frame=n   -melinux-stacksize=n  -metrax4
           -metrax100    -mpdebug    -mcc-init   -mno-side-effects  -mstack-align   -mdata-align   -mconst-align
           -m32-bit  -m16-bit  -m8-bit  -mno-prologue-epilogue  -mno-gotplt  -melf   -maout   -melinux   -mlinux
           -sim  -sim2 -mmul-bug-workaround  -mno-mul-bug-workaround

           CRX Options -mmac -mpush-args

           Darwin  Options  -all_load   -allowable_client   -arch   -arch_errors_fatal -arch_only  -bind_at_load
           -bundle    -bundle_loader   -client_name    -compatibility_version    -current_version    -dead_strip
           -dependency-file   -dylib_file   -dylinker_install_name -dynamic  -dynamiclib  -exported_symbols_list
           -filelist  -flat_namespace  -force_cpusubtype_ALL -force_flat_namespace  -headerpad_max_install_names
           -iframework -image_base  -init  -install_name  -keep_private_externs -multi_module  -multiply_defined
           -multiply_defined_unused -noall_load   -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms  -nofixprebinding  -nomultidefs
           -noprebind   -noseglinkedit  -pagezero_size   -prebind  -prebind_all_twolevel_modules -private_bundle
           -read_only_relocs  -sectalign -sectobjectsymbols  -whyload  -seg1addr -sectcreate  -sectobjectsymbols
           -sectorder      -segaddr       -segs_read_only_addr       -segs_read_write_addr       -seg_addr_table
           -seg_addr_table_filename     -seglinkedit   -segprot    -segs_read_only_addr    -segs_read_write_addr
           -single_module   -static   -sub_library   -sub_umbrella  -twolevel_namespace   -umbrella   -undefined
           -unexported_symbols_list      -weak_reference_mismatches     -whatsloaded     -F     -gused    -gfull
           -mmacosx-version-min=version -mkernel -mone-byte-bool

           DEC  Alpha  Options  -mno-fp-regs   -msoft-float   -malpha-as   -mgas   -mieee    -mieee-with-inexact
           -mieee-conformant       -mfp-trap-mode=mode        -mfp-rounding-mode=mode      -mtrap-precision=mode
           -mbuild-constants  -mcpu=cpu-type    -mtune=cpu-type   -mbwx    -mmax    -mfix    -mcix   -mfloat-vax
           -mfloat-ieee     -mexplicit-relocs     -msmall-data     -mlarge-data    -msmall-text     -mlarge-text
           -mmemory-latency=time

           DEC Alpha/VMS Options -mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=prefix -mmalloc64

           FR30 Options -msmall-model -mno-lsim

           FRV Options -mgpr-32  -mgpr-64  -mfpr-32  -mfpr-64 -mhard-float  -msoft-float -malloc-cc   -mfixed-cc
           -mdword    -mno-dword  -mdouble   -mno-double  -mmedia   -mno-media   -mmuladd   -mno-muladd  -mfdpic
           -minline-plt   -mgprel-ro    -multilib-library-pic    -mlinked-fp     -mlong-calls     -malign-labels
           -mlibrary-pic    -macc-4    -macc-8   -mpack   -mno-pack   -mno-eflags   -mcond-move   -mno-cond-move
           -moptimize-membar -mno-optimize-membar -mscc   -mno-scc   -mcond-exec   -mno-cond-exec  -mvliw-branch
           -mno-vliw-branch  -mmulti-cond-exec   -mno-multi-cond-exec   -mnested-cond-exec -mno-nested-cond-exec
           -mtomcat-stats -mTLS -mtls -mcpu=cpu

           GNU/Linux Options -mglibc -muclibc -mbionic -mandroid -tno-android-cc -tno-android-ld

           H8/300 Options -mrelax  -mh  -ms  -mn  -mint32  -malign-300

           HPPA   Options   -march=architecture-type    -mbig-switch     -mdisable-fpregs     -mdisable-indexing
           -mfast-indirect-calls    -mgas    -mgnu-ld     -mhp-ld  -mfixed-range=register-range  -mjump-in-delay
           -mlinker-opt      -mlong-calls      -mlong-load-store       -mno-big-switch       -mno-disable-fpregs
           -mno-disable-indexing   -mno-fast-indirect-calls   -mno-gas  -mno-jump-in-delay  -mno-long-load-store
           -mno-portable-runtime  -mno-soft-float  -mno-space-regs   -msoft-float   -mpa-risc-1-0  -mpa-risc-1-1
           -mpa-risc-2-0   -mportable-runtime  -mschedule=cpu-type   -mspace-regs  -msio  -mwsio -munix=unix-std
           -nolibdld  -static  -threads

           i386   and   x86-64   Options   -mtune=cpu-type     -march=cpu-type    -mfpmath=unit    -masm=dialect
           -mno-fancy-math-387   -mno-fp-ret-in-387    -msoft-float  -mno-wide-multiply   -mrtd   -malign-double
           -mpreferred-stack-boundary=num -mincoming-stack-boundary=num  -mcld  -mcx16  -msahf  -mmovbe  -mcrc32
           -mrecip  -mvzeroupper  -mprefer-avx128  -mmmx   -msse  -msse2 -msse3 -mssse3 -msse4.1 -msse4.2 -msse4
           -mavx -maes -mpclmul -mfsgsbase -mrdrnd -mf16c -mfused-madd  -msse4a  -m3dnow  -mpopcnt  -mabm  -mbmi
           -mtbm     -mfma4     -mxop     -mlwp    -mthreads     -mno-align-stringops     -minline-all-stringops
           -minline-stringops-dynamically   -mstringop-strategy=alg   -mpush-args     -maccumulate-outgoing-args
           -m128bit-long-double     -m96bit-long-double      -mregparm=num      -msseregparm    -mveclibabi=type
           -mvect8-ret-in-mem  -mpc32  -mpc64  -mpc80  -mstackrealign  -momit-leaf-frame-pointer   -mno-red-zone
           -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs   -mcmodel=code-model   -mabi=name   -m32   -m64  -mlarge-data-threshold=num
           -msse2avx -mfentry -m8bit-idiv -mavx256-split-unaligned-load -mavx256-split-unaligned-store

           i386 and x86-64 Windows Options -mconsole -mcygwin  -mno-cygwin  -mdll  -mnop-fun-dllimport  -mthread
           -municode -mwin32 -mwindows -fno-set-stack-executable

           IA-64   Options  -mbig-endian   -mlittle-endian   -mgnu-as   -mgnu-ld   -mno-pic  -mvolatile-asm-stop
           -mregister-names       -msdata      -mno-sdata      -mconstant-gp       -mauto-pic       -mfused-madd
           -minline-float-divide-min-latency    -minline-float-divide-max-throughput    -mno-inline-float-divide
           -minline-int-divide-min-latency       -minline-int-divide-max-throughput       -mno-inline-int-divide
           -minline-sqrt-min-latency       -minline-sqrt-max-throughput       -mno-inline-sqrt      -mdwarf2-asm
           -mearly-stop-bits -mfixed-range=register-range  -mtls-size=tls-size  -mtune=cpu-type  -milp32  -mlp64
           -msched-br-data-spec      -msched-ar-data-spec      -msched-control-spec      -msched-br-in-data-spec
           -msched-ar-in-data-spec     -msched-in-control-spec     -msched-spec-ldc     -msched-spec-control-ldc
           -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns                              -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
           -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle                               -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
           -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
           -msched-max-memory-insns=max-insns

           IA-64/VMS Options -mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=prefix -mmalloc64

           LM32   Options   -mbarrel-shift-enabled   -mdivide-enabled  -mmultiply-enabled  -msign-extend-enabled
           -muser-enabled

           M32R/D  Options  -m32r2  -m32rx  -m32r  -mdebug  -malign-loops  -mno-align-loops  -missue-rate=number
           -mbranch-cost=number       -mmodel=code-size-model-type       -msdata=sdata-type      -mno-flush-func
           -mflush-func=name -mno-flush-trap -mflush-trap=number -G num

           M32C Options -mcpu=cpu -msim -memregs=number

           M680x0 Options -march=arch  -mcpu=cpu  -mtune=tune -m68000  -m68020  -m68020-40  -m68020-60   -m68030
           -m68040  -m68060  -mcpu32  -m5200  -m5206e  -m528x  -m5307  -m5407 -mcfv4e  -mbitfield  -mno-bitfield
           -mc68000  -mc68020 -mnobitfield  -mrtd  -mno-rtd  -mdiv  -mno-div  -mshort  -mno-short   -mhard-float
           -m68881     -msoft-float     -mpcrel    -malign-int     -mstrict-align    -msep-data    -mno-sep-data
           -mshared-library-id=n  -mid-shared-library  -mno-id-shared-library -mxgot -mno-xgot

           M68hc1x Options -m6811  -m6812  -m68hc11  -m68hc12   -m68hcs12 -mauto-incdec   -minmax   -mlong-calls
           -mshort -msoft-reg-count=count

           MCore  Options  -mhardlit   -mno-hardlit   -mdiv   -mno-div  -mrelax-immediates -mno-relax-immediates
           -mwide-bitfields   -mno-wide-bitfields  -m4byte-functions    -mno-4byte-functions    -mcallgraph-data
           -mno-callgraph-data   -mslow-bytes   -mno-slow-bytes   -mno-lsim -mlittle-endian  -mbig-endian  -m210
           -m340  -mstack-increment

           MeP Options -mabsdiff -mall-opts  -maverage  -mbased=n  -mbitops  -mc=n  -mclip  -mconfig=name  -mcop
           -mcop32  -mcop64  -mivc2 -mdc -mdiv -meb -mel -mio-volatile -ml -mleadz -mm -mminmax -mmult -mno-opts
           -mrepeat -ms -msatur -msdram -msim -msimnovec -mtf -mtiny=n

           MicroBlaze  Options  -msoft-float  -mhard-float  -msmall-divides  -mcpu=cpu  -mmemcpy   -mxl-soft-mul
           -mxl-soft-div   -mxl-barrel-shift  -mxl-pattern-compare  -mxl-stack-check  -mxl-gp-opt  -mno-clearbss
           -mxl-multiply-high -mxl-float-convert -mxl-float-sqrt -mxl-mode-app-model

           MIPS Options -EL  -EB  -march=arch  -mtune=arch -mips1  -mips2  -mips3   -mips4   -mips32   -mips32r2
           -mips64   -mips64r2  -mips16   -mno-mips16   -mflip-mips16  -minterlink-mips16  -mno-interlink-mips16
           -mabi=abi  -mabicalls  -mno-abicalls -mshared  -mno-shared  -mplt  -mno-plt  -mxgot  -mno-xgot -mgp32
           -mgp64  -mfp32  -mfp64  -mhard-float  -msoft-float -msingle-float   -mdouble-float   -mdsp   -mno-dsp
           -mdspr2   -mno-dspr2  -mfpu=fpu-type  -msmartmips  -mno-smartmips -mpaired-single  -mno-paired-single
           -mdmx  -mno-mdmx -mips3d  -mno-mips3d  -mmt  -mno-mt  -mllsc  -mno-llsc -mlong64   -mlong32   -msym32
           -mno-sym32   -Gnum    -mlocal-sdata    -mno-local-sdata  -mextern-sdata   -mno-extern-sdata   -mgpopt
           -mno-gopt -membedded-data  -mno-embedded-data  -muninit-const-in-rodata   -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
           -mcode-readable=setting        -msplit-addresses         -mno-split-addresses       -mexplicit-relocs
           -mno-explicit-relocs -mcheck-zero-division  -mno-check-zero-division -mdivide-traps   -mdivide-breaks
           -mmemcpy   -mno-memcpy   -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls -mmad  -mno-mad  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd
           -nocpp  -mfix-r4000   -mno-fix-r4000   -mfix-r4400    -mno-fix-r4400   -mfix-r10000   -mno-fix-r10000
           -mfix-vr4120      -mno-fix-vr4120     -mfix-vr4130     -mno-fix-vr4130     -mfix-sb1     -mno-fix-sb1
           -mflush-func=func     -mno-flush-func    -mbranch-cost=num     -mbranch-likely     -mno-branch-likely
           -mfp-exceptions    -mno-fp-exceptions    -mvr4130-align    -mno-vr4130-align    -msynci    -mno-synci
           -mrelax-pic-calls -mno-relax-pic-calls -mmcount-ra-address

           MMIX  Options  -mlibfuncs    -mno-libfuncs    -mepsilon    -mno-epsilon    -mabi=gnu   -mabi=mmixware
           -mzero-extend     -mknuthdiv    -mtoplevel-symbols   -melf    -mbranch-predict    -mno-branch-predict
           -mbase-addresses -mno-base-addresses  -msingle-exit  -mno-single-exit

           MN10300  Options  -mmult-bug   -mno-mult-bug  -mno-am33  -mam33   -mam33-2   -mam34   -mtune=cpu-type
           -mreturn-pointer-on-d0 -mno-crt0  -mrelax -mliw

           PDP-11  Options  -mfpu   -msoft-float   -mac0   -mno-ac0   -m40   -m45  -m10 -mbcopy  -mbcopy-builtin
           -mint32  -mno-int16 -mint16  -mno-int32  -mfloat32   -mno-float64  -mfloat64   -mno-float32   -mabshi
           -mno-abshi -mbranch-expensive  -mbranch-cheap -munix-asm  -mdec-asm

           picoChip Options -mae=ae_type -mvliw-lookahead=N -msymbol-as-address -mno-inefficient-warnings

           PowerPC Options See RS/6000 and PowerPC Options.

           RS/6000  and  PowerPC  Options -mcpu=cpu-type -mtune=cpu-type -mcmodel=code-model -mpower  -mno-power
           -mpower2  -mno-power2 -mpowerpc  -mpowerpc64  -mno-powerpc  -maltivec   -mno-altivec  -mpowerpc-gpopt
           -mno-powerpc-gpopt -mpowerpc-gfxopt  -mno-powerpc-gfxopt -mmfcrf  -mno-mfcrf  -mpopcntb  -mno-popcntb
           -mpopcntd   -mno-popcntd   -mfprnd   -mno-fprnd  -mcmpb  -mno-cmpb  -mmfpgpr  -mno-mfpgpr  -mhard-dfp
           -mno-hard-dfp   -mnew-mnemonics    -mold-mnemonics   -mfull-toc      -mminimal-toc     -mno-fp-in-toc
           -mno-sum-in-toc   -m64    -m32   -mxl-compat   -mno-xl-compat   -mpe  -malign-power   -malign-natural
           -msoft-float  -mhard-float   -mmultiple   -mno-multiple  -msingle-float  -mdouble-float  -msimple-fpu
           -mstring   -mno-string  -mupdate  -mno-update -mavoid-indexed-addresses  -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
           -mfused-madd   -mno-fused-madd    -mbit-align    -mno-bit-align   -mstrict-align    -mno-strict-align
           -mrelocatable  -mno-relocatable   -mrelocatable-lib   -mno-relocatable-lib  -mtoc  -mno-toc  -mlittle
           -mlittle-endian   -mbig   -mbig-endian   -mdynamic-no-pic    -maltivec   -mswdiv    -msingle-pic-base
           -mprioritize-restricted-insns=priority  -msched-costly-dep=dependence_type -minsert-sched-nops=scheme
           -mcall-sysv   -mcall-netbsd  -maix-struct-return   -msvr4-struct-return  -mabi=abi-type  -msecure-plt
           -mbss-plt   -mblock-move-inline-limit=num  -misel  -mno-isel  -misel=yes   -misel=no  -mspe  -mno-spe
           -mspe=yes  -mspe=no -mpaired -mgen-cell-microcode -mwarn-cell-microcode -mvrsave -mno-vrsave  -mmulhw
           -mno-mulhw     -mdlmzb     -mno-dlmzb     -mfloat-gprs=yes     -mfloat-gprs=no    -mfloat-gprs=single
           -mfloat-gprs=double -mprototype  -mno-prototype -msim  -mmvme  -mads  -myellowknife   -memb   -msdata
           -msdata=opt    -mvxworks    -G   num    -pthread  -mrecip  -mrecip=opt  -mno-recip  -mrecip-precision
           -mno-recip-precision -mveclibabi=type -mfriz -mno-friz

           RX   Options   -m64bit-doubles     -m32bit-doubles     -fpu     -nofpu    -mcpu=    -mbig-endian-data
           -mlittle-endian-data   -msmall-data   -msim    -mno-sim   -mas100-syntax   -mno-as100-syntax  -mrelax
           -mmax-constant-size= -mint-register= -msave-acc-in-interrupts

           S/390 and zSeries Options -mtune=cpu-type   -march=cpu-type  -mhard-float   -msoft-float   -mhard-dfp
           -mno-hard-dfp   -mlong-double-64   -mlong-double-128   -mbackchain    -mno-backchain   -mpacked-stack
           -mno-packed-stack -msmall-exec  -mno-small-exec  -mmvcle -mno-mvcle -m64  -m31   -mdebug   -mno-debug
           -mesa    -mzarch   -mtpf-trace   -mno-tpf-trace    -mfused-madd    -mno-fused-madd   -mwarn-framesize
           -mwarn-dynamicstack  -mstack-size -mstack-guard

           Score Options -meb -mel -mnhwloop -muls -mmac -mscore5 -mscore5u -mscore7 -mscore7d

           SH  Options  -m1   -m2   -m2e  -m2a-nofpu  -m2a-single-only  -m2a-single  -m2a  -m3   -m3e  -m4-nofpu
           -m4-single-only   -m4-single   -m4  -m4a-nofpu  -m4a-single-only  -m4a-single  -m4a -m4al -m5-64media
           -m5-64media-nofpu -m5-32media  -m5-32media-nofpu -m5-compact  -m5-compact-nofpu  -mb   -ml   -mdalign
           -mrelax  -mbigtable  -mfmovd  -mhitachi  -mrenesas -mno-renesas -mnomacsave -mieee -mno-ieee -mbitops
           -misize   -minline-ic_invalidate  -mpadstruct  -mspace   -mprefergot    -musermode   -multcost=number
           -mdiv=strategy        -mdivsi3_libfunc=name        -mfixed-range=register-range       -madjust-unroll
           -mindexed-addressing -mgettrcost=number -mpt-fixed -maccumulate-outgoing-args -minvalid-symbols

           Solaris 2 Options -mimpure-text  -mno-impure-text -threads -pthreads -pthread

           SPARC   Options   -mcpu=cpu-type   -mtune=cpu-type   -mcmodel=code-model   -m32    -m64    -mapp-regs
           -mno-app-regs  -mfaster-structs   -mno-faster-structs  -mfpu   -mno-fpu   -mhard-float   -msoft-float
           -mhard-quad-float      -msoft-quad-float      -mlittle-endian      -mstack-bias       -mno-stack-bias
           -munaligned-doubles  -mno-unaligned-doubles -mv8plus  -mno-v8plus  -mvis  -mno-vis -mfix-at697f

           SPU Options -mwarn-reloc -merror-reloc -msafe-dma -munsafe-dma -mbranch-hints -msmall-mem -mlarge-mem
           -mstdmain       -mfixed-range=register-range       -mea32      -mea64      -maddress-space-conversion
           -mno-address-space-conversion -mcache-size=cache-size -matomic-updates -mno-atomic-updates

           System V Options -Qy  -Qn  -YP,paths  -Ym,dir

           V850 Options -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls   -mep   -mno-ep  -mprolog-function   -mno-prolog-function
           -mspace  -mtda=n   -msda=n   -mzda=n  -mapp-regs   -mno-app-regs  -mdisable-callt  -mno-disable-callt
           -mv850e2v3 -mv850e2 -mv850e1 -mv850es -mv850e -mv850  -mbig-switch

           VAX Options -mg  -mgnu  -munix

           VxWorks Options -mrtp  -non-static  -Bstatic  -Bdynamic -Xbind-lazy  -Xbind-now

           x86-64 Options See i386 and x86-64 Options.

           Xstormy16 Options -msim

           Xtensa    Options    -mconst16    -mno-const16    -mfused-madd     -mno-fused-madd     -mforce-no-pic
           -mserialize-volatile    -mno-serialize-volatile  -mtext-section-literals   -mno-text-section-literals
           -mtarget-align  -mno-target-align -mlongcalls  -mno-longcalls

           zSeries Options See S/390 and zSeries Options.

       Code Generation Options
           -fcall-saved-reg  -fcall-used-reg -ffixed-reg   -fexceptions  -fnon-call-exceptions   -funwind-tables
           -fasynchronous-unwind-tables             -finhibit-size-directive              -finstrument-functions
           -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=sym,sym,...
           -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=file,file,...  -fno-common   -fno-ident  -fpcc-struct-return
           -fpic   -fPIC  -fpie  -fPIE -fno-jump-tables -frecord-gcc-switches -freg-struct-return  -fshort-enums
           -fshort-double        -fshort-wchar       -fverbose-asm        -fpack-struct[=n]        -fstack-check
           -fstack-limit-register=reg        -fstack-limit-symbol=sym       -fno-stack-limit       -fsplit-stack
           -fleading-underscore     -ftls-model=model    -ftrapv     -fwrapv     -fbounds-check     -fvisibility
           -fstrict-volatile-bitfields

   Options Controlling the Kind of Output
       Compilation  can  involve  up  to  four  stages: preprocessing, compilation proper, assembly and linking,
       always in that order.  GCC is capable of preprocessing and compiling several files  either  into  several
       assembler  input  files,  or  into  one  assembler input file; then each assembler input file produces an
       object file, and linking combines all the object files (those newly  compiled,  and  those  specified  as
       input) into an executable file.

       For any given input file, the file name suffix determines what kind of compilation is done:

       file.c
           C source code which must be preprocessed.

       file.i
           C source code which should not be preprocessed.

       file.ii
           C++ source code which should not be preprocessed.

       file.m
           Objective-C  source  code.   Note  that you must link with the libobjc library to make an Objective-C
           program work.

       file.mi
           Objective-C source code which should not be preprocessed.

       file.mm
       file.M
           Objective-C++ source code.  Note that you must link with the libobjc library to make an Objective-C++
           program work.  Note that .M refers to a literal capital M.

       file.mii
           Objective-C++ source code which should not be preprocessed.

       file.h
           C, C++, Objective-C or Objective-C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header (default), or
           C, C++ header file to be turned into an Ada spec (via the -fdump-ada-spec switch).

       file.cc
       file.cp
       file.cxx
       file.cpp
       file.CPP
       file.c++
       file.C
           C++ source code which must be preprocessed.  Note that in .cxx, the last two  letters  must  both  be
           literally x.  Likewise, .C refers to a literal capital C.

       file.mm
       file.M
           Objective-C++ source code which must be preprocessed.

       file.mii
           Objective-C++ source code which should not be preprocessed.

       file.hh
       file.H
       file.hp
       file.hxx
       file.hpp
       file.HPP
       file.h++
       file.tcc
           C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header or Ada spec.

       file.f
       file.for
       file.ftn
           Fixed form Fortran source code which should not be preprocessed.

       file.F
       file.FOR
       file.fpp
       file.FPP
       file.FTN
           Fixed form Fortran source code which must be preprocessed (with the traditional preprocessor).

       file.f90
       file.f95
       file.f03
       file.f08
           Free form Fortran source code which should not be preprocessed.

       file.F90
       file.F95
       file.F03
       file.F08
           Free form Fortran source code which must be preprocessed (with the traditional preprocessor).

       file.go
           Go source code.

       file.ads
           Ada  source  code  file  which  contains  a  library  unit  declaration  (a declaration of a package,
           subprogram, or generic, or a generic instantiation),  or  a  library  unit  renaming  declaration  (a
           package, generic, or subprogram renaming declaration).  Such files are also called specs.

       file.adb
           Ada  source  code file containing a library unit body (a subprogram or package body).  Such files are
           also called bodies.

       file.s
           Assembler code.

       file.S
       file.sx
           Assembler code which must be preprocessed.

       other
           An object file to be fed straight into linking.  Any file name with no recognized suffix  is  treated
           this way.

       You can specify the input language explicitly with the -x option:

       -x language
           Specify  explicitly  the  language  for  the  following input files (rather than letting the compiler
           choose a default based on the file name suffix).  This option applies to all  following  input  files
           until the next -x option.  Possible values for language are:

                   c  c-header  cpp-output
                   c++  c++-header  c++-cpp-output
                   objective-c  objective-c-header  objective-c-cpp-output
                   objective-c++ objective-c++-header objective-c++-cpp-output
                   assembler  assembler-with-cpp
                   ada
                   f77  f77-cpp-input f95  f95-cpp-input
                   go
                   java

       -x none
           Turn  off  any  specification  of a language, so that subsequent files are handled according to their
           file name suffixes (as they are if -x has not been used at all).

       -pass-exit-codes
           Normally the gcc program will exit with the code of 1 if any phase of the  compiler  returns  a  non-
           success  return  code.   If  you  specify  -pass-exit-codes, the gcc program will instead return with
           numerically highest error produced by any phase that returned an error indication.  The C,  C++,  and
           Fortran frontends return 4, if an internal compiler error is encountered.

       If  you  only  want  some of the stages of compilation, you can use -x (or filename suffixes) to tell gcc
       where to start, and one of the options -c, -S, or -E to say  where  gcc  is  to  stop.   Note  that  some
       combinations (for example, -x cpp-output -E) instruct gcc to do nothing at all.

       -c  Compile  or  assemble  the source files, but do not link.  The linking stage simply is not done.  The
           ultimate output is in the form of an object file for each source file.

           By default, the object file name for a source file is made by replacing the suffix .c, .i, .s,  etc.,
           with .o.

           Unrecognized input files, not requiring compilation or assembly, are ignored.

       -S  Stop  after  the  stage  of  compilation  proper;  do  not assemble.  The output is in the form of an
           assembler code file for each non-assembler input file specified.

           By default, the assembler file name for a source file is made by replacing the suffix .c,  .i,  etc.,
           with .s.

           Input files that don't require compilation are ignored.

       -E  Stop  after  the  preprocessing  stage; do not run the compiler proper.  The output is in the form of
           preprocessed source code, which is sent to the standard output.

           Input files which don't require preprocessing are ignored.

       -o file
           Place output in file file.  This applies regardless to whatever sort of  output  is  being  produced,
           whether it be an executable file, an object file, an assembler file or preprocessed C code.

           If  -o  is  not  specified,  the  default  is to put an executable file in a.out, the object file for
           source.suffix  in  source.o,  its  assembler  file  in  source.s,  a  precompiled  header   file   in
           source.suffix.gch, and all preprocessed C source on standard output.

       -v  Print  (on standard error output) the commands executed to run the stages of compilation.  Also print
           the version number of the compiler driver program and of the preprocessor and the compiler proper.

       -###
           Like -v except the commands are not executed and  arguments  are  quoted  unless  they  contain  only
           alphanumeric  characters or "./-_".  This is useful for shell scripts to capture the driver-generated
           command lines.

       -pipe
           Use pipes rather than temporary files for communication between the various  stages  of  compilation.
           This  fails  to  work  on some systems where the assembler is unable to read from a pipe; but the GNU
           assembler has no trouble.

       --help
           Print (on the standard output) a description of the command line options understood by gcc.   If  the
           -v  option  is  also specified then --help will also be passed on to the various processes invoked by
           gcc, so that they can display the command line options they accept.  If the -Wextra option  has  also
           been  specified  (prior  to the --help option), then command line options which have no documentation
           associated with them will also be displayed.

       --target-help
           Print (on the standard output) a description of target-specific command line options for  each  tool.
           For some targets extra target-specific information may also be printed.

       --help={class|[^]qualifier}[,...]
           Print  (on  the standard output) a description of the command line options understood by the compiler
           that fit into all specified classes and qualifiers.  These are the supported classes:

           optimizers
               This will display all of the optimization options supported by the compiler.

           warnings
               This will display all of the options controlling warning messages produced by the compiler.

           target
               This will display target-specific options.  Unlike  the  --target-help  option  however,  target-
               specific  options of the linker and assembler will not be displayed.  This is because those tools
               do not currently support the extended --help= syntax.

           params
               This will display the values recognized by the --param option.

           language
               This will display the options supported for language, where language is the name of  one  of  the
               languages supported in this version of GCC.

           common
               This will display the options that are common to all languages.

           These are the supported qualifiers:

           undocumented
               Display only those options which are undocumented.

           joined
               Display  options  which  take an argument that appears after an equal sign in the same continuous
               piece of text, such as: --help=target.

           separate
               Display options which take an argument that appears as a separate  word  following  the  original
               option, such as: -o output-file.

           Thus  for  example to display all the undocumented target-specific switches supported by the compiler
           the following can be used:

                   --help=target,undocumented

           The sense of a qualifier can be inverted by prefixing it with the ^  character,  so  for  example  to
           display  all  binary  warning  options  (i.e., ones that are either on or off and that do not take an
           argument), which have a description the following can be used:

                   --help=warnings,^joined,^undocumented

           The argument to --help= should not consist solely of inverted qualifiers.

           Combining several classes is possible, although this usually restricts the output  by  so  much  that
           there  is  nothing  to  display.   One  case where it does work however is when one of the classes is
           target.  So for example to display all the target-specific optimization options the following can  be
           used:

                   --help=target,optimizers

           The  --help=  option  can  be  repeated  on  the  command line.  Each successive use will display its
           requested class of options, skipping those that have already been displayed.

           If the -Q option appears on the command line before the --help= option,  then  the  descriptive  text
           displayed by --help= is changed.  Instead of describing the displayed options, an indication is given
           as  to whether the option is enabled, disabled or set to a specific value (assuming that the compiler
           knows this at the point where the --help= option is used).

           Here is a truncated example from the ARM port of gcc:

                     % gcc -Q -mabi=2 --help=target -c
                     The following options are target specific:
                     -mabi=                                2
                     -mabort-on-noreturn                   [disabled]
                     -mapcs                                [disabled]

           The output is sensitive to the effects of previous  command  line  options,  so  for  example  it  is
           possible to find out which optimizations are enabled at -O2 by using:

                   -Q -O2 --help=optimizers

           Alternatively you can discover which binary optimizations are enabled by -O3 by using:

                   gcc -c -Q -O3 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O3-opts
                   gcc -c -Q -O2 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O2-opts
                   diff /tmp/O2-opts /tmp/O3-opts | grep enabled

       -no-canonical-prefixes
           Do  not  expand any symbolic links, resolve references to /../ or /./, or make the path absolute when
           generating a relative prefix.

       --version
           Display the version number and copyrights of the invoked GCC.

       -wrapper
           Invoke all subcommands under a wrapper program.  The name of the wrapper program and  its  parameters
           are passed as a comma separated list.

                   gcc -c t.c -wrapper gdb,--args

           This  will  invoke  all  subprograms  of gcc under gdb --args, thus the invocation of cc1 will be gdb
           --args cc1 ....

       -fplugin=name.so
           Load the plugin code in file name.so, assumed to be a shared object to be dlopen'd by  the  compiler.
           The  base  name of the shared object file is used to identify the plugin for the purposes of argument
           parsing (See -fplugin-arg-name-key=value below).  Each plugin should define  the  callback  functions
           specified in the Plugins API.

       -fplugin-arg-name-key=value
           Define an argument called key with a value of value for the plugin called name.

       -fdump-ada-spec[-slim]
           For C and C++ source and include files, generate corresponding Ada specs.

       -fdump-go-spec=file
           For  input  files in any language, generate corresponding Go declarations in file.  This generates Go
           "const", "type", "var", and "func" declarations which may be a useful  way  to  start  writing  a  Go
           interface to code written in some other language.

       @file
           Read  command-line  options  from file.  The options read are inserted in place of the original @file
           option.  If file does not exist, or cannot be read, then the option will be  treated  literally,  and
           not removed.

           Options  in file are separated by whitespace.  A whitespace character may be included in an option by
           surrounding the entire option in  either  single  or  double  quotes.   Any  character  (including  a
           backslash)  may be included by prefixing the character to be included with a backslash.  The file may
           itself contain additional @file options; any such options will be processed recursively.

   Compiling C++ Programs
       C++ source files conventionally use one of the suffixes .C, .cc, .cpp, .CPP,  .c++,  .cp,  or  .cxx;  C++
       header  files often use .hh, .hpp, .H, or (for shared template code) .tcc; and preprocessed C++ files use
       the suffix .ii.  GCC recognizes files with these names and compiles them as C++ programs even if you call
       the compiler the same way as for compiling C programs (usually with the name gcc).

       However, the use of gcc does not add the C++ library.  g++ is a program that calls GCC and treats .c,  .h
       and .i files as C++ source files instead of C source files unless -x is used, and automatically specifies
       linking against the C++ library.  This program is also useful when precompiling a C header file with a .h
       extension for use in C++ compilations.  On many systems, g++ is also installed with the name c++.

       When  you  compile  C++  programs, you may specify many of the same command-line options that you use for
       compiling programs in any language; or command-line options meaningful for C and  related  languages;  or
       options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.

   Options Controlling C Dialect
       The following options control the dialect of C (or languages derived from C, such as C++, Objective-C and
       Objective-C++) that the compiler accepts:

       -ansi
           In C mode, this is equivalent to -std=c90. In C++ mode, it is equivalent to -std=c++98.

           This turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO C90 (when compiling C code), or
           of  standard  C++  (when compiling C++ code), such as the "asm" and "typeof" keywords, and predefined
           macros such as "unix" and "vax" that identify the type of system you are using.  It also enables  the
           undesirable and rarely used ISO trigraph feature.  For the C compiler, it disables recognition of C++
           style // comments as well as the "inline" keyword.

           The  alternate  keywords  "__asm__",  "__extension__", "__inline__" and "__typeof__" continue to work
           despite -ansi.  You would not want to use them in an ISO C program, of course, but it  is  useful  to
           put  them  in  header  files  that  might  be  included  in  compilations done with -ansi.  Alternate
           predefined macros such as "__unix__" and "__vax__" are also available, with or without -ansi.

           The -ansi option does not cause non-ISO programs to be rejected gratuitously.  For that, -pedantic is
           required in addition to -ansi.

           The macro "__STRICT_ANSI__" is predefined when the -ansi option  is  used.   Some  header  files  may
           notice  this  macro  and refrain from declaring certain functions or defining certain macros that the
           ISO standard doesn't call for; this is to avoid interfering with any programs that  might  use  these
           names for other things.

           Functions  that  would  normally  be  built  in  but  do not have semantics defined by ISO C (such as
           "alloca" and "ffs") are not built-in functions when -ansi is used.

       -std=
           Determine the language standard.   This option is currently only supported when compiling C or C++.

           The compiler can accept several base standards, such as c90 or  c++98,  and  GNU  dialects  of  those
           standards,  such  as  gnu90  or gnu++98.  By specifying a base standard, the compiler will accept all
           programs following that standard and those using GNU extensions  that  do  not  contradict  it.   For
           example,  -std=c90  turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO C90, such as the
           "asm" and "typeof" keywords, but not other GNU extensions that do not have a meaning in ISO C90, such
           as omitting the middle term of a "?:" expression. On the other hand, by specifying a GNU dialect of a
           standard, all features the compiler support are enabled, even when those features change the  meaning
           of the base standard and some strict-conforming programs may be rejected.  The particular standard is
           used  by  -pedantic to identify which features are GNU extensions given that version of the standard.
           For example -std=gnu90 -pedantic would warn about C++ style // comments, while  -std=gnu99  -pedantic
           would not.

           A value for this option must be provided; possible values are

           c90
           c89
           iso9899:1990
               Support  all  ISO  C90 programs (certain GNU extensions that conflict with ISO C90 are disabled).
               Same as -ansi for C code.

           iso9899:199409
               ISO C90 as modified in amendment 1.

           c99
           c9x
           iso9899:1999
           iso9899:199x
               ISO   C99.     Note    that    this    standard    is    not    yet    fully    supported;    see
               <http://gcc.gnu.org/gcc-4.6/c99status.html> for more information.  The names c9x and iso9899:199x
               are deprecated.

           c1x ISO  C1X,  the  draft  of  the  next  revision  of  the  ISO  C standard.  Support is limited and
               experimental and features enabled by this option may be changed  or  removed  if  changed  in  or
               removed from the standard draft.

           gnu90
           gnu89
               GNU dialect of ISO C90 (including some C99 features). This is the default for C code.

           gnu99
           gnu9x
               GNU  dialect of ISO C99.  When ISO C99 is fully implemented in GCC, this will become the default.
               The name gnu9x is deprecated.

           gnu1x
               GNU dialect of ISO C1X.  Support is limited and experimental and features enabled by this  option
               may be changed or removed if changed in or removed from the standard draft.

           c++98
               The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus amendments. Same as -ansi for C++ code.

           gnu++98
               GNU dialect of -std=c++98.  This is the default for C++ code.

           c++0x
               The  working  draft of the upcoming ISO C++0x standard. This option enables experimental features
               that are likely to be included in C++0x. The  working  draft  is  constantly  changing,  and  any
               feature that is enabled by this flag may be removed from future versions of GCC if it is not part
               of the C++0x standard.

           gnu++0x
               GNU  dialect  of  -std=c++0x.  This  option  enables experimental features that may be removed in
               future versions of GCC.

       -fgnu89-inline
           The option -fgnu89-inline tells GCC to use the traditional GNU semantics for "inline" functions  when
           in C99 mode.
             This  option  is  accepted  and  ignored by GCC versions 4.1.3 up to but not including 4.3.  In GCC
           versions 4.3 and later it changes the behavior of GCC in C99 mode.   Using  this  option  is  roughly
           equivalent to adding the "gnu_inline" function attribute to all inline functions.

           The  option  -fno-gnu89-inline explicitly tells GCC to use the C99 semantics for "inline" when in C99
           or gnu99 mode (i.e., it specifies the default behavior).  This option was first supported in GCC 4.3.
           This option is not supported in -std=c90 or -std=gnu90 mode.

           The preprocessor macros "__GNUC_GNU_INLINE__" and "__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__" may be used to  check  which
           semantics are in effect for "inline" functions.

       -aux-info filename
           Output  to  the given filename prototyped declarations for all functions declared and/or defined in a
           translation unit, including those in header files.  This option is silently ignored in  any  language
           other than C.

           Besides  declarations,  the  file indicates, in comments, the origin of each declaration (source file
           and line), whether the declaration was implicit, prototyped or unprototyped (I, N for new  or  O  for
           old,  respectively,  in the first character after the line number and the colon), and whether it came
           from a declaration or a definition (C or F, respectively, in the following character).  In  the  case
           of  function  definitions,  a  K&R-style  list  of  arguments  followed by their declarations is also
           provided, inside comments, after the declaration.

       -fno-asm
           Do not recognize "asm", "inline" or "typeof" as a keyword, so  that  code  can  use  these  words  as
           identifiers.   You  can  use  the  keywords  "__asm__", "__inline__" and "__typeof__" instead.  -ansi
           implies -fno-asm.

           In C++, this switch only affects  the  "typeof"  keyword,  since  "asm"  and  "inline"  are  standard
           keywords.  You may want to use the -fno-gnu-keywords flag instead, which has the same effect.  In C99
           mode  (-std=c99  or  -std=gnu99),  this  switch  only  affects the "asm" and "typeof" keywords, since
           "inline" is a standard keyword in ISO C99.

       -fno-builtin
       -fno-builtin-function
           Don't recognize built-in functions that do not begin with __builtin_ as prefix.

           GCC normally generates special code to  handle  certain  built-in  functions  more  efficiently;  for
           instance,  calls to "alloca" may become single instructions that adjust the stack directly, and calls
           to "memcpy" may become inline copy loops.  The resulting code is often both smaller and  faster,  but
           since  the  function  calls no longer appear as such, you cannot set a breakpoint on those calls, nor
           can you change the behavior of the functions by linking with a different library.  In addition,  when
           a  function is recognized as a built-in function, GCC may use information about that function to warn
           about problems with calls to that function, or to generate more efficient code, even if the resulting
           code still contains calls to that function.  For example, warnings are given with  -Wformat  for  bad
           calls to "printf", when "printf" is built in, and "strlen" is known not to modify global memory.

           With the -fno-builtin-function option only the built-in function function is disabled.  function must
           not  begin with __builtin_.  If a function is named that is not built-in in this version of GCC, this
           option is ignored.  There is no corresponding -fbuiltin-function option; if you wish to enable built-
           in functions selectively when using -fno-builtin or -ffreestanding, you may define macros such as:

                   #define abs(n)          __builtin_abs ((n))
                   #define strcpy(d, s)    __builtin_strcpy ((d), (s))

       -fhosted
           Assert that compilation takes place in a hosted  environment.   This  implies  -fbuiltin.   A  hosted
           environment  is  one  in  which  the  entire standard library is available, and in which "main" has a
           return type of "int".  Examples are nearly  everything  except  a  kernel.   This  is  equivalent  to
           -fno-freestanding.

       -ffreestanding
           Assert  that  compilation  takes  place in a freestanding environment.  This implies -fno-builtin.  A
           freestanding environment is one in which the standard library may not exist, and program startup  may
           not  necessarily  be  at  "main".   The  most obvious example is an OS kernel.  This is equivalent to
           -fno-hosted.

       -fopenmp
           Enable handling of OpenMP directives "#pragma omp" in C/C++ and "!$omp" in Fortran.  When -fopenmp is
           specified, the compiler generates parallel code according to the OpenMP Application Program Interface
           v3.0 <http://www.openmp.org/>.  This option implies -pthread, and thus is only supported  on  targets
           that have support for -pthread.

       -fms-extensions
           Accept some non-standard constructs used in Microsoft header files.

           In C++ code, this allows member names in structures to be similar to previous types declarations.

                   typedef int UOW;
                   struct ABC {
                     UOW UOW;
                   };

           Some cases of unnamed fields in structures and unions are only accepted with this option.

       -fplan9-extensions
           Accept some non-standard constructs used in Plan 9 code.

           This  enables  -fms-extensions,  permits  passing  pointers  to  structures  with anonymous fields to
           functions which expect pointers to elements of the type  of  the  field,  and  permits  referring  to
           anonymous fields declared using a typedef.    This is only supported for C, not C++.

       -trigraphs
           Support  ISO  C  trigraphs.  The -ansi option (and -std options for strict ISO C conformance) implies
           -trigraphs.

       -no-integrated-cpp
           Performs a compilation in two passes:  preprocessing  and  compiling.   This  option  allows  a  user
           supplied  "cc1",  "cc1plus",  or  "cc1obj" via the -B option.  The user supplied compilation step can
           then add in an additional preprocessing step after normal preprocessing but  before  compiling.   The
           default is to use the integrated cpp (internal cpp)

           The semantics of this option will change if "cc1", "cc1plus", and "cc1obj" are merged.

       -traditional
       -traditional-cpp
           Formerly,  these  options  caused  GCC to attempt to emulate a pre-standard C compiler.  They are now
           only supported with the -E switch.  The preprocessor continues to support a pre-standard  mode.   See
           the GNU CPP manual for details.

       -fcond-mismatch
           Allow  conditional expressions with mismatched types in the second and third arguments.  The value of
           such an expression is void.  This option is not supported for C++.

       -flax-vector-conversions
           Allow implicit conversions between vectors with differing numbers  of  elements  and/or  incompatible
           element types.  This option should not be used for new code.

       -funsigned-char
           Let the type "char" be unsigned, like "unsigned char".

           Each  kind  of machine has a default for what "char" should be.  It is either like "unsigned char" by
           default or like "signed char" by default.

           Ideally, a portable program should always use "signed char" or "unsigned char" when it depends on the
           signedness of an object.  But many programs have been written to use plain "char" and expect it to be
           signed, or expect it to be unsigned, depending on the machines they were written for.   This  option,
           and its inverse, let you make such a program work with the opposite default.

           The  type "char" is always a distinct type from each of "signed char" or "unsigned char", even though
           its behavior is always just like one of those two.

       -fsigned-char
           Let the type "char" be signed, like "signed char".

           Note that this is equivalent to -fno-unsigned-char, which is the negative  form  of  -funsigned-char.
           Likewise, the option -fno-signed-char is equivalent to -funsigned-char.

       -fsigned-bitfields
       -funsigned-bitfields
       -fno-signed-bitfields
       -fno-unsigned-bitfields
           These  options  control  whether a bit-field is signed or unsigned, when the declaration does not use
           either "signed" or "unsigned".  By default, such a bit-field is signed, because this  is  consistent:
           the basic integer types such as "int" are signed types.

   Options Controlling C++ Dialect
       This  section  describes  the command-line options that are only meaningful for C++ programs; but you can
       also use most of the GNU compiler options regardless of what language your program is in.   For  example,
       you might compile a file "firstClass.C" like this:

               g++ -g -frepo -O -c firstClass.C

       In this example, only -frepo is an option meant only for C++ programs; you can use the other options with
       any language supported by GCC.

       Here is a list of options that are only for compiling C++ programs:

       -fabi-version=n
           Use  version  n  of  the C++ ABI.  Version 2 is the version of the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++
           3.4.  Version 1 is the version of the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.2.  Version 0 will  always
           be  the version that conforms most closely to the C++ ABI specification.  Therefore, the ABI obtained
           using version 0 will change as ABI bugs are fixed.

           The default is version 2.

           Version 3 corrects an error in mangling a constant address as a template argument.

           Version 4 implements a standard mangling for vector types.

           Version 5 corrects the mangling of attribute const/volatile on function pointer types, decltype of  a
           plain decl, and use of a function parameter in the declaration of another parameter.

           See also -Wabi.

       -fno-access-control
           Turn  off  all  access  checking.  This switch is mainly useful for working around bugs in the access
           control code.

       -fcheck-new
           Check that the pointer returned by "operator new" is non-null before attempting to modify the storage
           allocated.  This check is normally unnecessary because the C++ standard specifies that "operator new"
           will only return 0 if it is declared throw(), in which case the compiler will always check the return
           value even without this option.  In all other cases, when "operator new" has  a  non-empty  exception
           specification, memory exhaustion is signalled by throwing "std::bad_alloc".  See also new (nothrow).

       -fconserve-space
           Put  uninitialized  or runtime-initialized global variables into the common segment, as C does.  This
           saves space in the executable at the cost of not diagnosing duplicate definitions.   If  you  compile
           with  this  flag  and your program mysteriously crashes after "main()" has completed, you may have an
           object that is being destroyed twice because two definitions were merged.

           This option is no longer useful on most  targets,  now  that  support  has  been  added  for  putting
           variables into BSS without making them common.

       -fconstexpr-depth=n
           Set  the  maximum  nested  evaluation depth for C++0x constexpr functions to n.  A limit is needed to
           detect endless recursion during  constant  expression  evaluation.   The  minimum  specified  by  the
           standard is 512.

       -fno-deduce-init-list
           Disable  deduction  of  a  template  type  parameter  as  std::initializer_list from a brace-enclosed
           initializer list, i.e.

                   template <class T> auto forward(T t) -> decltype (realfn (t))
                   {
                     return realfn (t);
                   }

                   void f()
                   {
                     forward({1,2}); // call forward<std::initializer_list<int>>
                   }

           This option is present because this deduction is an extension to the  current  specification  in  the
           C++0x working draft, and there was some concern about potential overload resolution problems.

       -ffriend-injection
           Inject  friend  functions into the enclosing namespace, so that they are visible outside the scope of
           the class in which they are declared.  Friend functions were documented to work this way in  the  old
           Annotated  C++  Reference Manual, and versions of G++ before 4.1 always worked that way.  However, in
           ISO C++ a friend function which is not declared in  an  enclosing  scope  can  only  be  found  using
           argument  dependent  lookup.   This  option  causes  friends  to  be injected as they were in earlier
           releases.

           This option is for compatibility, and may be removed in a future release of G++.

       -fno-elide-constructors
           The C++ standard allows an implementation to  omit  creating  a  temporary  which  is  only  used  to
           initialize  another  object of the same type.  Specifying this option disables that optimization, and
           forces G++ to call the copy constructor in all cases.

       -fno-enforce-eh-specs
           Don't generate code to check for violation of  exception  specifications  at  runtime.   This  option
           violates  the  C++ standard, but may be useful for reducing code size in production builds, much like
           defining NDEBUG.  This does not give user code permission to throw exceptions  in  violation  of  the
           exception  specifications;  the compiler will still optimize based on the specifications, so throwing
           an unexpected exception will result in undefined behavior.

       -ffor-scope
       -fno-for-scope
           If -ffor-scope is specified, the scope of variables declared in a for-init-statement  is  limited  to
           the  for loop itself, as specified by the C++ standard.  If -fno-for-scope is specified, the scope of
           variables declared in a for-init-statement extends to the end of the enclosing scope, as was the case
           in old versions of G++, and other (traditional) implementations of C++.

           The default if neither flag is given to follow the standard, but to allow and give a warning for old-
           style code that would otherwise be invalid, or have different behavior.

       -fno-gnu-keywords
           Do not recognize "typeof" as a keyword, so that code can use this word as an identifier.  You can use
           the keyword "__typeof__" instead.  -ansi implies -fno-gnu-keywords.

       -fno-implicit-templates
           Never emit code for non-inline templates which are instantiated implicitly (i.e. by use);  only  emit
           code for explicit instantiations.

       -fno-implicit-inline-templates
           Don't  emit  code  for implicit instantiations of inline templates, either.  The default is to handle
           inlines differently so that compiles with and without optimization will need the same set of explicit
           instantiations.

       -fno-implement-inlines
           To  save  space,  do  not  emit  out-of-line  copies  of  inline  functions  controlled  by   #pragma
           implementation.  This will cause linker errors if these functions are not inlined everywhere they are
           called.

       -fms-extensions
           Disable pedantic warnings about constructs used in MFC, such as implicit int and getting a pointer to
           member function via non-standard syntax.

       -fno-nonansi-builtins
           Disable built-in declarations of functions that are not mandated by ANSI/ISO C.  These include "ffs",
           "alloca", "_exit", "index", "bzero", "conjf", and other related functions.

       -fnothrow-opt
           Treat  a  "throw()" exception specification as though it were a "noexcept" specification to reduce or
           eliminate the text size overhead relative to a function with  no  exception  specification.   If  the
           function  has local variables of types with non-trivial destructors, the exception specification will
           actually make the function smaller because the EH cleanups for those variables can be optimized away.
           The semantic effect  is  that  an  exception  thrown  out  of  a  function  with  such  an  exception
           specification will result in a call to "terminate" rather than "unexpected".

       -fno-operator-names
           Do  not  treat the operator name keywords "and", "bitand", "bitor", "compl", "not", "or" and "xor" as
           synonyms as keywords.

       -fno-optional-diags
           Disable diagnostics that the standard says a compiler does not need to issue.   Currently,  the  only
           such diagnostic issued by G++ is the one for a name having multiple meanings within a class.

       -fpermissive
           Downgrade   some  diagnostics  about  nonconformant  code  from  errors  to  warnings.   Thus,  using
           -fpermissive will allow some nonconforming code to compile.

       -fno-pretty-templates
           When an error message refers to a specialization of a function template, the compiler  will  normally
           print  the signature of the template followed by the template arguments and any typedefs or typenames
           in the signature (e.g. "void f(T) [with T = int]" rather than "void f(int)") so that it's clear which
           template is involved.  When an error message refers to a specialization  of  a  class  template,  the
           compiler  will  omit  any  template  arguments  which  match  the default template arguments for that
           template.  If either of these behaviors make it harder to understand the error  message  rather  than
           easier, using -fno-pretty-templates will disable them.

       -frepo
           Enable    automatic    template   instantiation   at   link   time.    This   option   also   implies
           -fno-implicit-templates.

       -fno-rtti
           Disable generation of information about every class with virtual functions for use by the C++ runtime
           type identification features (dynamic_cast and  typeid).   If  you  don't  use  those  parts  of  the
           language,  you  can  save  some space by using this flag.  Note that exception handling uses the same
           information, but it will generate it as needed. The dynamic_cast operator can still be used for casts
           that do not require runtime type information, i.e. casts to "void *" or to unambiguous base classes.

       -fstats
           Emit statistics about front-end processing at the  end  of  the  compilation.   This  information  is
           generally only useful to the G++ development team.

       -fstrict-enums
           Allow  the compiler to optimize using the assumption that a value of enumeration type can only be one
           of the values of the enumeration (as defined in the C++ standard; basically, a  value  which  can  be
           represented  in the minimum number of bits needed to represent all the enumerators).  This assumption
           may not be valid if the program uses a cast to convert an arbitrary integer value to the  enumeration
           type.

       -ftemplate-depth=n
           Set the maximum instantiation depth for template classes to n.  A limit on the template instantiation
           depth  is  needed  to  detect  endless  recursions during template class instantiation.  ANSI/ISO C++
           conforming programs must not rely on a maximum depth greater than 17 (changed to 1024 in C++0x).

       -fno-threadsafe-statics
           Do not emit  the  extra  code  to  use  the  routines  specified  in  the  C++  ABI  for  thread-safe
           initialization  of  local statics.  You can use this option to reduce code size slightly in code that
           doesn't need to be thread-safe.

       -fuse-cxa-atexit
           Register destructors for objects with static storage duration with the "__cxa_atexit" function rather
           than the "atexit" function.  This option is required for fully standards-compliant handling of static
           destructors, but will only work if your C library supports "__cxa_atexit".

       -fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
           Don't use the "__cxa_get_exception_ptr" runtime routine.  This will  cause  "std::uncaught_exception"
           to be incorrect, but is necessary if the runtime routine is not available.

       -fvisibility-inlines-hidden
           This  switch  declares that the user does not attempt to compare pointers to inline methods where the
           addresses of the two functions were taken in different shared objects.

           The effect of this is that GCC may, effectively, mark inline methods with "__attribute__ ((visibility
           ("hidden")))" so that they do not appear in the export table of a  DSO  and  do  not  require  a  PLT
           indirection  when  used  within the DSO.  Enabling this option can have a dramatic effect on load and
           link times of a DSO as it massively reduces the size of the dynamic export  table  when  the  library
           makes heavy use of templates.

           The  behavior of this switch is not quite the same as marking the methods as hidden directly, because
           it does not affect static variables local to the function or cause the compiler to  deduce  that  the
           function is defined in only one shared object.

           You  may  mark a method as having a visibility explicitly to negate the effect of the switch for that
           method.  For example, if you do want to compare pointers to a particular  inline  method,  you  might
           mark it as having default visibility.  Marking the enclosing class with explicit visibility will have
           no effect.

           Explicitly instantiated inline methods are unaffected by this option as their linkage might otherwise
           cross a shared library boundary.

       -fvisibility-ms-compat
           This flag attempts to use visibility settings to make GCC's C++ linkage model compatible with that of
           Microsoft Visual Studio.

           The flag makes these changes to GCC's linkage model:

           1.  It sets the default visibility to "hidden", like -fvisibility=hidden.

           2.  Types, but not their members, are not hidden by default.

           3.  The One Definition Rule is relaxed for types without explicit visibility specifications which are
               defined  in more than one different shared object: those declarations are permitted if they would
               have been permitted when this option was not used.

           In new code it is better to use -fvisibility=hidden and export those classes which are intended to be
           externally visible.  Unfortunately it is possible for code to  rely,  perhaps  accidentally,  on  the
           Visual Studio behavior.

           Among  the  consequences of these changes are that static data members of the same type with the same
           name but defined in different shared objects will be different, so changing one will not  change  the
           other;  and  that  pointers  to  function members defined in different shared objects may not compare
           equal.  When this flag is given, it is a violation of the ODR to define  types  with  the  same  name
           differently.

       -fno-weak
           Do  not use weak symbol support, even if it is provided by the linker.  By default, G++ will use weak
           symbols if they are available.  This option exists only for testing, and should not be used  by  end-
           users;  it  will result in inferior code and has no benefits.  This option may be removed in a future
           release of G++.

       -nostdinc++
           Do not search for header files in the standard directories specific to C++, but do still  search  the
           other standard directories.  (This option is used when building the C++ library.)

       In  addition,  these  optimization,  warning,  and  code  generation  options  have meanings only for C++
       programs:

       -fno-default-inline
           Do not assume inline for functions defined inside a class scope.
             Note that these functions will have linkage like inline functions; they just won't  be  inlined  by
           default.

       -Wabi (C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  when  G++  generates  code  that  is  probably  not compatible with the vendor-neutral C++ ABI.
           Although an effort has been made to warn about all such cases, there are probably some cases that are
           not warned about, even though G++ is generating incompatible code.  There may  also  be  cases  where
           warnings are emitted even though the code that is generated will be compatible.

           You  should  rewrite  your code to avoid these warnings if you are concerned about the fact that code
           generated by G++ may not be binary compatible with code generated by other compilers.

           The known incompatibilities in -fabi-version=2 (the default) include:

           •   A template with a non-type template parameter of reference type is mangled incorrectly:

                       extern int N;
                       template <int &> struct S {};
                       void n (S<N>) {2}

               This is fixed in -fabi-version=3.

           •   SIMD vector types declared using "__attribute ((vector_size))" are mangled in a non-standard  way
               that does not allow for overloading of functions taking vectors of different sizes.

               The mangling is changed in -fabi-version=4.

           The known incompatibilities in -fabi-version=1 include:

           •   Incorrect  handling  of  tail-padding for bit-fields.  G++ may attempt to pack data into the same
               byte as a base class.  For example:

                       struct A { virtual void f(); int f1 : 1; };
                       struct B : public A { int f2 : 1; };

               In this case, G++ will place "B::f2" into the same byte as"A::f1"; other compilers will not.  You
               can avoid this problem by explicitly padding "A" so that its size is a multiple of the byte  size
               on your platform; that will cause G++ and other compilers to layout "B" identically.

           •   Incorrect  handling of tail-padding for virtual bases.  G++ does not use tail padding when laying
               out virtual bases.  For example:

                       struct A { virtual void f(); char c1; };
                       struct B { B(); char c2; };
                       struct C : public A, public virtual B {};

               In this case, G++ will not place "B" into the tail-padding for "A"; other  compilers  will.   You
               can  avoid this problem by explicitly padding "A" so that its size is a multiple of its alignment
               (ignoring virtual base  classes);  that  will  cause  G++  and  other  compilers  to  layout  "C"
               identically.

           •   Incorrect  handling  of  bit-fields  with  declared  widths greater than that of their underlying
               types, when the bit-fields appear in a union.  For example:

                       union U { int i : 4096; };

               Assuming that an "int" does not have 4096 bits, G++ will make the union too small by  the  number
               of bits in an "int".

           •   Empty classes can be placed at incorrect offsets.  For example:

                       struct A {};

                       struct B {
                         A a;
                         virtual void f ();
                       };

                       struct C : public B, public A {};

               G++ will place the "A" base class of "C" at a nonzero offset; it should be placed at offset zero.
               G++ mistakenly believes that the "A" data member of "B" is already at offset zero.

           •   Names of template functions whose types involve "typename" or template template parameters can be
               mangled incorrectly.

                       template <typename Q>
                       void f(typename Q::X) {}

                       template <template <typename> class Q>
                       void f(typename Q<int>::X) {}

               Instantiations of these templates may be mangled incorrectly.

           It also warns psABI related changes.  The known psABI changes at this point include:

           •   For  SYSV/x86-64,  when  passing  union  with  long  double,  it  is changed to pass in memory as
               specified in psABI.  For example:

                       union U {
                         long double ld;
                         int i;
                       };

               "union U" will always be passed in memory.

       -Wctor-dtor-privacy (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when a class seems unusable because all the  constructors  or  destructors  in  that  class  are
           private, and it has neither friends nor public static member functions.

       -Wnoexcept (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when a noexcept-expression evaluates to false because of a call to a function that does not have
           a  non-throwing  exception  specification  (i.e. throw() or noexcept) but is known by the compiler to
           never throw an exception.

       -Wnon-virtual-dtor (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when a class has virtual functions and accessible non-virtual destructor, in which case it would
           be possible but unsafe to delete an instance of a derived class through a pointer to the base  class.
           This warning is also enabled if -Weffc++ is specified.

       -Wreorder (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  when  the order of member initializers given in the code does not match the order in which they
           must be executed.  For instance:

                   struct A {
                     int i;
                     int j;
                     A(): j (0), i (1) { }
                   };

           The compiler will rearrange the member initializers for i and j to match the declaration order of the
           members, emitting a warning to that effect.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       The following -W... options are not affected by -Wall.

       -Weffc++ (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers' Effective C++ book:

           •   Item 11:  Define a copy constructor and an  assignment  operator  for  classes  with  dynamically
               allocated memory.

           •   Item 12:  Prefer initialization to assignment in constructors.

           •   Item 14:  Make destructors virtual in base classes.

           •   Item 15:  Have "operator=" return a reference to *this.

           •   Item 23:  Don't try to return a reference when you must return an object.

           Also  warn  about  violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers' More Effective C++
           book:

           •   Item 6:  Distinguish between prefix and postfix forms of increment and decrement operators.

           •   Item 7:  Never overload "&&", "||", or ",".

           When selecting this option, be aware that the standard library headers  do  not  obey  all  of  these
           guidelines; use grep -v to filter out those warnings.

       -Wstrict-null-sentinel (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  also  about  the use of an uncasted "NULL" as sentinel.  When compiling only with GCC this is a
           valid sentinel, as "NULL" is defined to "__null".  Although it is a null pointer constant not a  null
           pointer,  it  is guaranteed to be of the same size as a pointer.  But this use is not portable across
           different compilers.

       -Wno-non-template-friend (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Disable warnings when non-templatized friend functions are declared within  a  template.   Since  the
           advent  of  explicit  template  specification  support  in  G++,  if  the  name  of  the friend is an
           unqualified-id (i.e., friend foo(int)), the  C++  language  specification  demands  that  the  friend
           declare  or  define  an  ordinary,  nontemplate  function.  (Section 14.5.3).  Before G++ implemented
           explicit specification, unqualified-ids could be interpreted as  a  particular  specialization  of  a
           templatized  function.   Because  this  non-conforming behavior is no longer the default behavior for
           G++, -Wnon-template-friend allows the compiler to check existing code for potential trouble spots and
           is on by default.  This new compiler behavior can be turned off with  -Wno-non-template-friend  which
           keeps the conformant compiler code but disables the helpful warning.

       -Wold-style-cast (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  if  an old-style (C-style) cast to a non-void type is used within a C++ program.  The new-style
           casts (dynamic_cast, static_cast, reinterpret_cast, and const_cast) are less vulnerable to unintended
           effects and much easier to search for.

       -Woverloaded-virtual (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when a function declaration hides virtual functions from a base class.  For example, in:

                   struct A {
                     virtual void f();
                   };

                   struct B: public A {
                     void f(int);
                   };

           the "A" class version of "f" is hidden in "B", and code like:

                   B* b;
                   b->f();

           will fail to compile.

       -Wno-pmf-conversions (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Disable the diagnostic for converting a bound pointer to member function to a plain pointer.

       -Wsign-promo (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when overload resolution chooses a promotion from unsigned or enumerated type to a signed  type,
           over  a  conversion  to  an  unsigned  type  of the same size.  Previous versions of G++ would try to
           preserve unsignedness, but the standard mandates the current behavior.

                   struct A {
                     operator int ();
                     A& operator = (int);
                   };

                   main ()
                   {
                     A a,b;
                     a = b;
                   }

           In this example, G++ will synthesize a default A& operator = (const A&);, while cfront will  use  the
           user-defined operator =.

   Options Controlling Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects
       (NOTE: This manual does not describe the Objective-C and Objective-C++ languages themselves.

       This   section  describes  the  command-line  options  that  are  only  meaningful  for  Objective-C  and
       Objective-C++ programs, but you can also use most of the language-independent GNU compiler options.   For
       example, you might compile a file "some_class.m" like this:

               gcc -g -fgnu-runtime -O -c some_class.m

       In  this  example,  -fgnu-runtime is an option meant only for Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs; you
       can use the other options with any language supported by GCC.

       Note that since Objective-C is an extension of the C language,  Objective-C  compilations  may  also  use
       options specific to the C front-end (e.g., -Wtraditional).  Similarly, Objective-C++ compilations may use
       C++-specific options (e.g., -Wabi).

       Here is a list of options that are only for compiling Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs:

       -fconstant-string-class=class-name
           Use  class-name  as  the  name of the class to instantiate for each literal string specified with the
           syntax "@"..."".  The default class name is "NXConstantString" if the GNU runtime is being used,  and
           "NSConstantString"  if  the NeXT runtime is being used (see below).  The -fconstant-cfstrings option,
           if also present, will override the -fconstant-string-class setting and cause "@"..."" literals to  be
           laid out as constant CoreFoundation strings.

       -fgnu-runtime
           Generate  object  code compatible with the standard GNU Objective-C runtime.  This is the default for
           most types of systems.

       -fnext-runtime
           Generate output compatible with the NeXT runtime.   This  is  the  default  for  NeXT-based  systems,
           including  Darwin  and  Mac  OS  X.  The macro "__NEXT_RUNTIME__" is predefined if (and only if) this
           option is used.

       -fno-nil-receivers
           Assume that all Objective-C message dispatches ("[receiver message:arg]") in  this  translation  unit
           ensure that the receiver is not "nil".  This allows for more efficient entry points in the runtime to
           be used.  This option is only available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime and ABI version 0 or 1.

       -fobjc-abi-version=n
           Use  version  n  of the Objective-C ABI for the selected runtime.  This option is currently supported
           only for the NeXT runtime.  In that case, Version 0 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI  without  support
           for  properties  and other Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 1 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI with
           support for properties and other Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 2 is the  modern  (64-bit)  ABI.
           If  nothing is specified, the default is Version 0 on 32-bit target machines, and Version 2 on 64-bit
           target machines.

       -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
           For each Objective-C class, check if any of its instance variables is a C++ object with a non-trivial
           default constructor.  If so, synthesize a special "- (id) .cxx_construct" instance method  that  will
           run  non-trivial  default  constructors  on  any  such  instance variables, in order, and then return
           "self".  Similarly, check if any instance variable is a C++ object with a non-trivial destructor, and
           if so, synthesize a  special  "-  (void)  .cxx_destruct"  method  that  will  run  all  such  default
           destructors, in reverse order.

           The  "-  (id) .cxx_construct" and "- (void) .cxx_destruct" methods thusly generated will only operate
           on instance variables declared in the  current  Objective-C  class,  and  not  those  inherited  from
           superclasses.   It  is the responsibility of the Objective-C runtime to invoke all such methods in an
           object's inheritance hierarchy.  The "- (id) .cxx_construct" methods will be invoked by  the  runtime
           immediately  after  a  new object instance is allocated; the "- (void) .cxx_destruct" methods will be
           invoked immediately before the runtime deallocates an object instance.

           As of this writing, only the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.4 and later has support for invoking the  "-
           (id) .cxx_construct" and "- (void) .cxx_destruct" methods.

       -fobjc-direct-dispatch
           Allow fast jumps to the message dispatcher.  On Darwin this is accomplished via the comm page.

       -fobjc-exceptions
           Enable syntactic support for structured exception handling in Objective-C, similar to what is offered
           by  C++  and  Java.   This  option  is required to use the Objective-C keywords @try, @throw, @catch,
           @finally and @synchronized.  This option is available with both the GNU runtime and the NeXT  runtime
           (but not available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.2 and earlier).

       -fobjc-gc
           Enable  garbage  collection  (GC)  in  Objective-C  and  Objective-C++ programs.  This option is only
           available with the NeXT runtime; the GNU runtime has a different  garbage  collection  implementation
           that does not require special compiler flags.

       -fobjc-nilcheck
           For the NeXT runtime with version 2 of the ABI, check for a nil receiver in method invocations before
           doing  the  actual  method  call.   This is the default and can be disabled using -fno-objc-nilcheck.
           Class methods and super calls are never checked for nil in this way no matter what this flag  is  set
           to.   Currently  this flag does nothing when the GNU runtime, or an older version of the NeXT runtime
           ABI, is used.

       -fobjc-std=objc1
           Conform to the language syntax of Objective-C 1.0, the language recognized by  GCC  4.0.   This  only
           affects  the  Objective-C  additions  to  the C/C++ language; it does not affect conformance to C/C++
           standards, which is controlled by the separate C/C++ dialect option flags.  When this option is  used
           with  the Objective-C or Objective-C++ compiler, any Objective-C syntax that is not recognized by GCC
           4.0 is rejected.  This is useful if you need to make sure that your Objective-C code can be  compiled
           with older versions of GCC.

       -freplace-objc-classes
           Emit  a  special  marker  instructing  ld(1) not to statically link in the resulting object file, and
           allow dyld(1) to load it in at run time instead.  This is  used  in  conjunction  with  the  Fix-and-
           Continue debugging mode, where the object file in question may be recompiled and dynamically reloaded
           in  the course of program execution, without the need to restart the program itself.  Currently, Fix-
           and-Continue functionality is only available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac  OS  X  10.3
           and later.

       -fzero-link
           When compiling for the NeXT runtime, the compiler ordinarily replaces calls to "objc_getClass("...")"
           (when  the  name  of  the  class  is  known  at  compile  time) with static class references that get
           initialized at load time, which improves  run-time  performance.   Specifying  the  -fzero-link  flag
           suppresses  this behavior and causes calls to "objc_getClass("...")"  to be retained.  This is useful
           in Zero-Link debugging mode, since it allows for individual  class  implementations  to  be  modified
           during  program execution.  The GNU runtime currently always retains calls to "objc_get_class("...")"
           regardless of command line options.

       -gen-decls
           Dump interface declarations for all classes seen in the source file to a file named sourcename.decl.

       -Wassign-intercept (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn whenever an Objective-C assignment is being intercepted by the garbage collector.

       -Wno-protocol (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           If a class is declared to implement a protocol, a warning is issued for every method in the  protocol
           that  is  not  implemented by the class.  The default behavior is to issue a warning for every method
           not explicitly implemented in the class, even if  a  method  implementation  is  inherited  from  the
           superclass.   If  you  use  the  -Wno-protocol option, then methods inherited from the superclass are
           considered to be implemented, and no warning is issued for them.

       -Wselector (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn if multiple methods of different types for the same selector are found during compilation.   The
           check  is  performed on the list of methods in the final stage of compilation.  Additionally, a check
           is performed for each selector appearing in  a  "@selector(...)"   expression,  and  a  corresponding
           method  for  that  selector  has been found during compilation.  Because these checks scan the method
           table only at the end of compilation,  these  warnings  are  not  produced  if  the  final  stage  of
           compilation  is not reached, for example because an error is found during compilation, or because the
           -fsyntax-only option is being used.

       -Wstrict-selector-match (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn if multiple methods with differing argument and/or return types are found for a  given  selector
           when  attempting  to  send a message using this selector to a receiver of type "id" or "Class".  When
           this flag is off (which is the default behavior),  the  compiler  will  omit  such  warnings  if  any
           differences found are confined to types which share the same size and alignment.

       -Wundeclared-selector (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  if  a  "@selector(...)" expression referring to an undeclared selector is found.  A selector is
           considered undeclared if no method with that name  has  been  declared  before  the  "@selector(...)"
           expression,  either  explicitly  in  an  @interface  or  @protocol  declaration,  or implicitly in an
           @implementation section.  This option always performs  its  checks  as  soon  as  a  "@selector(...)"
           expression  is  found,  while  -Wselector only performs its checks in the final stage of compilation.
           This also enforces the coding style convention that methods and selectors  must  be  declared  before
           being used.

       -print-objc-runtime-info
           Generate C header describing the largest structure that is passed by value, if any.

   Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting
       Traditionally,  diagnostic  messages have been formatted irrespective of the output device's aspect (e.g.
       its width, ...).  The options described below can be used to control the diagnostic  messages  formatting
       algorithm,  e.g.  how many characters per line, how often source location information should be reported.
       Right now, only the C++ front end can honor these options.  However it is expected, in the  near  future,
       that the remaining front ends would be able to digest them correctly.

       -fmessage-length=n
           Try  to  format  error  messages  so that they fit on lines of about n characters.  The default is 72
           characters for g++ and 0 for the rest of the front ends supported by GCC.  If  n  is  zero,  then  no
           line-wrapping will be done; each error message will appear on a single line.

       -fdiagnostics-show-location=once
           Only  meaningful  in  line-wrapping  mode.   Instructs  the diagnostic messages reporter to emit once
           source location information; that is, in case the message is too long to fit  on  a  single  physical
           line and has to be wrapped, the source location won't be emitted (as prefix) again, over and over, in
           subsequent continuation lines.  This is the default behavior.

       -fdiagnostics-show-location=every-line
           Only  meaningful  in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic messages reporter to emit the same
           source location information (as prefix) for physical lines that result from the process of breaking a
           message which is too long to fit on a single line.

       -fno-diagnostics-show-option
           By default, each diagnostic emitted includes text  which  indicates  the  command  line  option  that
           directly  controls  the  diagnostic  (if  such  an  option  is  known  to  the diagnostic machinery).
           Specifying the -fno-diagnostics-show-option flag suppresses that behavior.

       -Wcoverage-mismatch
           Warn if feedback profiles do not match when using the -fprofile-use option.  If  a  source  file  was
           changed  between  -fprofile-gen  and  -fprofile-use,  the files with the profile feedback can fail to
           match the source file and GCC can not use the profile feedback information.  By default, this warning
           is enabled and is treated as an error.  -Wno-coverage-mismatch can be used to disable the warning  or
           -Wno-error=coverage-mismatch  can  be  used to disable the error.  Disable the error for this warning
           can result in poorly optimized code, so disabling the error is useful only in the case of very  minor
           changes  such  as  bug  fixes  to  an  existing  code-base.   Completely disabling the warning is not
           recommended.

   Options to Request or Suppress Warnings
       Warnings are diagnostic messages that report constructions which are not inherently erroneous  but  which
       are risky or suggest there may have been an error.

       The  following  language-independent  options  do  not  enable specific warnings but control the kinds of
       diagnostics produced by GCC.

       -fsyntax-only
           Check the code for syntax errors, but don't do anything beyond that.

       -fmax-errors=n
           Limits the maximum number of error messages to n, at which point GCC bails out rather than attempting
           to continue processing the source code.  If n is 0 (the default), there is no limit on the number  of
           error  messages  produced.  If -Wfatal-errors is also specified, then -Wfatal-errors takes precedence
           over this option.

       -w  Inhibit all warning messages.

       -Werror
           Make all warnings into errors.

       -Werror=
           Make the specified warning into an error.  The specifier for  a  warning  is  appended,  for  example
           -Werror=switch  turns  the warnings controlled by -Wswitch into errors.  This switch takes a negative
           form, to be used to negate  -Werror  for  specific  warnings,  for  example  -Wno-error=switch  makes
           -Wswitch warnings not be errors, even when -Werror is in effect.

           The  warning  message  for  each controllable warning includes the option which controls the warning.
           That option can then be used with -Werror= and -Wno-error= as  described  above.   (Printing  of  the
           option in the warning message can be disabled using the -fno-diagnostics-show-option flag.)

           Note that specifying -Werror=foo automatically implies -Wfoo.  However, -Wno-error=foo does not imply
           anything.

       -Wfatal-errors
           This  option  causes the compiler to abort compilation on the first error occurred rather than trying
           to keep going and printing further error messages.

       You can request many specific warnings with options beginning  -W,  for  example  -Wimplicit  to  request
       warnings  on  implicit  declarations.   Each  of  these specific warning options also has a negative form
       beginning -Wno- to turn off warnings; for example, -Wno-implicit.  This manual lists only one of the  two
       forms,  whichever  is  not the default.  For further, language-specific options also refer to C++ Dialect
       Options and Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options.

       When an unrecognized warning option is requested (e.g., -Wunknown-warning), GCC will  emit  a  diagnostic
       stating  that the option is not recognized.  However, if the -Wno- form is used, the behavior is slightly
       different: No diagnostic will be produced for -Wno-unknown-warning unless  other  diagnostics  are  being
       produced.   This allows the use of new -Wno- options with old compilers, but if something goes wrong, the
       compiler will warn that an unrecognized option was used.

       -pedantic
           Issue all the warnings demanded by strict ISO C and ISO C++; reject all programs that  use  forbidden
           extensions,  and  some  other  programs that do not follow ISO C and ISO C++.  For ISO C, follows the
           version of the ISO C standard specified by any -std option used.

           Valid ISO C and ISO C++ programs should compile properly with or without this option (though  a  rare
           few  will require -ansi or a -std option specifying the required version of ISO C).  However, without
           this option, certain GNU extensions and traditional C and C++ features are supported as  well.   With
           this option, they are rejected.

           -pedantic does not cause warning messages for use of the alternate keywords whose names begin and end
           with  __.   Pedantic  warnings  are  also  disabled  in  the expression that follows "__extension__".
           However, only system header files should use these escape routes; application programs  should  avoid
           them.

           Some  users try to use -pedantic to check programs for strict ISO C conformance.  They soon find that
           it does not do quite what they want: it finds some non-ISO practices, but not  all---only  those  for
           which ISO C requires a diagnostic, and some others for which diagnostics have been added.

           A  feature  to  report  any  failure to conform to ISO C might be useful in some instances, but would
           require considerable additional work and would be quite different  from  -pedantic.   We  don't  have
           plans to support such a feature in the near future.

           Where  the  standard  specified  with  -std  represents a GNU extended dialect of C, such as gnu90 or
           gnu99, there is a corresponding base standard, the version of ISO C on which the GNU extended dialect
           is based.  Warnings from -pedantic are given where they are required by the base standard.  (It would
           not make sense for such warnings to be given only for features not in the specified  GNU  C  dialect,
           since  by  definition the GNU dialects of C include all features the compiler supports with the given
           option, and there would be nothing to warn about.)

       -pedantic-errors
           Like -pedantic, except that errors are produced rather than warnings.

       -Wall
           This enables all the warnings about constructions that some users consider questionable, and that are
           easy to avoid (or modify to prevent the warning), even in conjunction with macros.  This also enables
           some language-specific warnings described in C++ Dialect Options and  Objective-C  and  Objective-C++
           Dialect Options.

           -Wall turns on the following warning flags:

           -Waddress  -Warray-bounds (only with -O2) -Wc++0x-compat -Wchar-subscripts -Wenum-compare (in C/Objc;
           this is on by default in C++) -Wimplicit-int (C and Objective-C only) -Wimplicit-function-declaration
           (C and Objective-C only) -Wcomment -Wformat  -Wmain  (only  for  C/ObjC  and  unless  -ffreestanding)
           -Wmissing-braces  -Wnonnull  -Wparentheses  -Wpointer-sign  -Wreorder  -Wreturn-type -Wsequence-point
           -Wsign-compare   (only   in   C++)   -Wstrict-aliasing   -Wstrict-overflow=1   -Wswitch   -Wtrigraphs
           -Wuninitialized  -Wunknown-pragmas  -Wunused-function -Wunused-label -Wunused-value -Wunused-variable
           -Wvolatile-register-var

           Note that some warning flags are not implied by -Wall.  Some of them warn  about  constructions  that
           users  generally  do  not  consider questionable, but which occasionally you might wish to check for;
           others warn about constructions that are necessary or hard to avoid in some cases, and  there  is  no
           simple  way  to modify the code to suppress the warning. Some of them are enabled by -Wextra but many
           of them must be enabled individually.

       -Wextra
           This enables some extra warning flags that are not enabled by -Wall. (This option used to  be  called
           -W.  The older name is still supported, but the newer name is more descriptive.)

           -Wclobbered  -Wempty-body  -Wignored-qualifiers -Wmissing-field-initializers -Wmissing-parameter-type
           (C   only)   -Wold-style-declaration   (C   only)   -Woverride-init   -Wsign-compare    -Wtype-limits
           -Wuninitialized  -Wunused-parameter  (only  with  -Wunused or -Wall) -Wunused-but-set-parameter (only
           with -Wunused or -Wall)

           The option -Wextra also prints warning messages for the following cases:

           •   A pointer is compared against integer zero with <, <=, >, or >=.

           •   (C++ only) An enumerator and a non-enumerator both appear in a conditional expression.

           •   (C++ only) Ambiguous virtual bases.

           •   (C++ only) Subscripting an array which has been declared register.

           •   (C++ only) Taking the address of a variable which has been declared register.

           •   (C++ only) A base class is not initialized in a derived class' copy constructor.

       -Wchar-subscripts
           Warn if an array subscript has type "char".  This is a common cause of error,  as  programmers  often
           forget that this type is signed on some machines.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wcomment
           Warn  whenever  a  comment-start sequence /* appears in a /* comment, or whenever a Backslash-Newline
           appears in a // comment.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wno-cpp
           (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++ and Fortran only)

           Suppress warning messages emitted by "#warning" directives.

       -Wdouble-promotion (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Give a warning when a value of type "float" is implicitly promoted to "double".  CPUs with  a  32-bit
           "single-precision"  floating-point  unit  implement  "float"  in  hardware,  but  emulate "double" in
           software.  On such a machine, doing computations using "double" values is much more expensive because
           of the overhead required for software emulation.

           It is easy to  accidentally  do  computations  with  "double"  because  floating-point  literals  are
           implicitly of type "double".  For example, in:

                   float area(float radius)
                   {
                      return 3.14159 * radius * radius;
                   }

           the  compiler will perform the entire computation with "double" because the floating-point literal is
           a "double".

       -Wformat
           Check calls to "printf" and "scanf", etc., to make  sure  that  the  arguments  supplied  have  types
           appropriate  to  the format string specified, and that the conversions specified in the format string
           make sense.  This includes standard functions, and others specified  by  format  attributes,  in  the
           "printf", "scanf", "strftime" and "strfmon" (an X/Open extension, not in the C standard) families (or
           other  target-specific  families).  Which functions are checked without format attributes having been
           specified depends on the standard  version  selected,  and  such  checks  of  functions  without  the
           attribute specified are disabled by -ffreestanding or -fno-builtin.

           The formats are checked against the format features supported by GNU libc version 2.2.  These include
           all ISO C90 and C99 features, as well as features from the Single Unix Specification and some BSD and
           GNU  extensions.   Other  library  implementations  may  not support all these features; GCC does not
           support warning about features that go  beyond  a  particular  library's  limitations.   However,  if
           -pedantic  is  used  with  -Wformat, warnings will be given about format features not in the selected
           standard version (but not for "strfmon" formats, since  those  are  not  in  any  version  of  the  C
           standard).

           Since  -Wformat  also  checks  for null format arguments for several functions, -Wformat also implies
           -Wnonnull.

           -Wformat is included in -Wall.  For more control over some aspects of format  checking,  the  options
           -Wformat-y2k,       -Wno-format-extra-args,       -Wno-format-zero-length,       -Wformat-nonliteral,
           -Wformat-security, and -Wformat=2 are available, but are not included in -Wall.

           NOTE: In Ubuntu 8.10 and later versions this option is enabled by default for C, C++,  ObjC,  ObjC++.
           To disable, use -Wformat=0.

       -Wformat-y2k
           If -Wformat is specified, also warn about "strftime" formats which may yield only a two-digit year.

       -Wno-format-contains-nul
           If -Wformat is specified, do not warn about format strings that contain NUL bytes.

       -Wno-format-extra-args
           If  -Wformat  is  specified,  do  not  warn  about  excess  arguments to a "printf" or "scanf" format
           function.  The C standard specifies that such arguments are ignored.

           Where the unused arguments lie between used arguments  that  are  specified  with  $  operand  number
           specifications,  normally warnings are still given, since the implementation could not know what type
           to pass to "va_arg" to skip the unused arguments.  However, in the  case  of  "scanf"  formats,  this
           option  will  suppress  the  warning  if the unused arguments are all pointers, since the Single Unix
           Specification says that such unused arguments are allowed.

       -Wno-format-zero-length (C and Objective-C only)
           If -Wformat is specified, do not warn about zero-length formats.  The C standard specifies that zero-
           length formats are allowed.

       -Wformat-nonliteral
           If -Wformat is specified, also warn if the format string is not a string literal  and  so  cannot  be
           checked, unless the format function takes its format arguments as a "va_list".

       -Wformat-security
           If  -Wformat  is specified, also warn about uses of format functions that represent possible security
           problems.  At present, this warns about calls to "printf" and  "scanf"  functions  where  the  format
           string is not a string literal and there are no format arguments, as in "printf (foo);".  This may be
           a security hole if the format string came from untrusted input and contains %n.  (This is currently a
           subset   of   what  -Wformat-nonliteral  warns  about,  but  in  future  warnings  may  be  added  to
           -Wformat-security that are not included in -Wformat-nonliteral.)

           NOTE: In Ubuntu 8.10 and later versions this option is enabled by default for C, C++,  ObjC,  ObjC++.
           To disable, use -Wno-format-security, or disable all format warnings with -Wformat=0.  To make format
           security warnings fatal, specify -Werror=format-security.

       -Wformat=2
           Enable  -Wformat  plus  format  checks  not  included  in -Wformat.  Currently equivalent to -Wformat
           -Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security -Wformat-y2k.

       -Wnonnull (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn about passing a null pointer for arguments marked as requiring a non-null value by the "nonnull"
           function attribute.

           -Wnonnull is included in -Wall and -Wformat.  It can be disabled with the -Wno-nonnull option.

       -Winit-self (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn about uninitialized variables which are initialized with themselves.  Note this option can  only
           be used with the -Wuninitialized option.

           For  example,  GCC  will  warn  about  "i"  being  uninitialized  in  the following snippet only when
           -Winit-self has been specified:

                   int f()
                   {
                     int i = i;
                     return i;
                   }

       -Wimplicit-int (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn when a declaration does not specify a type.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wimplicit-function-declaration (C and Objective-C only)
           Give a warning whenever a  function  is  used  before  being  declared.  In  C99  mode  (-std=c99  or
           -std=gnu99),  this  warning  is  enabled by default and it is made into an error by -pedantic-errors.
           This warning is also enabled by -Wall.

       -Wimplicit (C and Objective-C only)
           Same as -Wimplicit-int and -Wimplicit-function-declaration.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wignored-qualifiers (C and C++ only)
           Warn if the return type of a function has a type qualifier such as "const".  For ISO C  such  a  type
           qualifier  has  no  effect,  since  the  value returned by a function is not an lvalue.  For C++, the
           warning is only emitted for scalar types or "void".  ISO C prohibits qualified "void" return types on
           function definitions, so such return types always receive a warning even without this option.

           This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.

       -Wmain
           Warn if the type of main is suspicious.  main should be a function with external  linkage,  returning
           int,  taking  either  zero  arguments, two, or three arguments of appropriate types.  This warning is
           enabled by default in C++ and is enabled by either -Wall or -pedantic.

       -Wmissing-braces
           Warn if an aggregate or union initializer is not fully bracketed.   In  the  following  example,  the
           initializer for a is not fully bracketed, but that for b is fully bracketed.

                   int a[2][2] = { 0, 1, 2, 3 };
                   int b[2][2] = { { 0, 1 }, { 2, 3 } };

           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wmissing-include-dirs (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn if a user-supplied include directory does not exist.

       -Wparentheses
           Warn if parentheses are omitted in certain contexts, such as when there is an assignment in a context
           where  a  truth  value  is  expected,  or when operators are nested whose precedence people often get
           confused about.

           Also warn if a comparison like x<=y<=z appears; this is equivalent to (x<=y ? 1 : 0) <= z, which is a
           different interpretation from that of ordinary mathematical notation.

           Also warn about constructions where there may be confusion to which "if" statement an  "else"  branch
           belongs.  Here is an example of such a case:

                   {
                     if (a)
                       if (b)
                         foo ();
                     else
                       bar ();
                   }

           In C/C++, every "else" branch belongs to the innermost possible "if" statement, which in this example
           is  "if (b)".  This is often not what the programmer expected, as illustrated in the above example by
           indentation the programmer chose.  When there is the potential for this confusion, GCC will  issue  a
           warning  when  this  flag  is  specified.   To  eliminate the warning, add explicit braces around the
           innermost "if" statement so there is no way the "else" could  belong  to  the  enclosing  "if".   The
           resulting code would look like this:

                   {
                     if (a)
                       {
                         if (b)
                           foo ();
                         else
                           bar ();
                       }
                   }

           Also  warn for dangerous uses of the ?: with omitted middle operand GNU extension. When the condition
           in the ?: operator is a boolean expression the omitted value will be always 1. Often the user expects
           it to be a value computed inside the conditional expression instead.

           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wsequence-point
           Warn about code that may have undefined semantics because of violations of sequence  point  rules  in
           the C and C++ standards.

           The  C  and  C++ standards defines the order in which expressions in a C/C++ program are evaluated in
           terms of sequence points, which represent a partial ordering between the execution of  parts  of  the
           program:  those  executed  before the sequence point, and those executed after it.  These occur after
           the evaluation of a full expression (one which is  not  part  of  a  larger  expression),  after  the
           evaluation  of the first operand of a "&&", "||", "? :" or "," (comma) operator, before a function is
           called (but after the evaluation of its arguments and the expression denoting the  called  function),
           and  in  certain  other  places.   Other  than as expressed by the sequence point rules, the order of
           evaluation of subexpressions of an expression is not specified.  All  these  rules  describe  only  a
           partial  order  rather than a total order, since, for example, if two functions are called within one
           expression with no sequence point between them, the order in which the functions are  called  is  not
           specified.  However, the standards committee have ruled that function calls do not overlap.

           It  is not specified when between sequence points modifications to the values of objects take effect.
           Programs whose behavior depends on this have undefined behavior; the C and C++ standards specify that
           "Between the previous and next sequence point an object shall have its stored value modified at  most
           once  by  the  evaluation  of  an  expression.   Furthermore,  the  prior value shall be read only to
           determine the value to be stored.".  If a program breaks these rules, the results on  any  particular
           implementation are entirely unpredictable.

           Examples  of  code  with  undefined behavior are "a = a++;", "a[n] = b[n++]" and "a[i++] = i;".  Some
           more complicated cases are not diagnosed by this option, and it may give an occasional false positive
           result, but in general it has been found fairly effective  at  detecting  this  sort  of  problem  in
           programs.

           The  standard  is  worded confusingly, therefore there is some debate over the precise meaning of the
           sequence point rules in subtle cases.  Links to discussions of the problem, including proposed formal
           definitions, may be found on the GCC readings page, at <http://gcc.gnu.org/readings.html>.

           This warning is enabled by -Wall for C and C++.

       -Wreturn-type
           Warn whenever a function is defined with a return-type that defaults to "int".  Also warn  about  any
           "return"  statement  with  no return-value in a function whose return-type is not "void" (falling off
           the end of the function body is considered returning without a value), and about a "return" statement
           with an expression in a function whose return-type is "void".

           For  C++,  a  function  without  return  type  always  produces  a  diagnostic  message,  even   when
           -Wno-return-type is specified.  The only exceptions are main and functions defined in system headers.

           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wswitch
           Warn whenever a "switch" statement has an index of enumerated type and lacks a "case" for one or more
           of  the  named codes of that enumeration.  (The presence of a "default" label prevents this warning.)
           "case" labels outside the enumeration range also provoke warnings when this option is used  (even  if
           there is a "default" label).  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wswitch-default
           Warn whenever a "switch" statement does not have a "default" case.

       -Wswitch-enum
           Warn whenever a "switch" statement has an index of enumerated type and lacks a "case" for one or more
           of  the  named  codes  of that enumeration.  "case" labels outside the enumeration range also provoke
           warnings when this option is used.  The only difference between -Wswitch and this option is that this
           option gives a warning about an omitted enumeration code even if there is a "default" label.

       -Wsync-nand (C and C++ only)
           Warn when "__sync_fetch_and_nand" and "__sync_nand_and_fetch" built-in  functions  are  used.   These
           functions changed semantics in GCC 4.4.

       -Wtrigraphs
           Warn  if any trigraphs are encountered that might change the meaning of the program (trigraphs within
           comments are not warned about).  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wunused-but-set-parameter
           Warn whenever a function parameter is assigned to, but otherwise unused (aside from its declaration).

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

           This warning is also enabled by -Wunused together with -Wextra.

       -Wunused-but-set-variable
           Warn whenever a local variable is assigned to, but otherwise unused  (aside  from  its  declaration).
           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

           This warning is also enabled by -Wunused, which is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wunused-function
           Warn  whenever  a  static  function  is  declared  but not defined or a non-inline static function is
           unused.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wunused-label
           Warn whenever a label is declared but not used.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

       -Wunused-parameter
           Warn whenever a function parameter is unused aside from its declaration.

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

       -Wno-unused-result
           Do not warn if a caller of a function marked with attribute "warn_unused_result"  does  not  use  its
           return value. The default is -Wunused-result.

       -Wunused-variable
           Warn  whenever a local variable or non-constant static variable is unused aside from its declaration.
           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

       -Wunused-value
           Warn whenever a statement computes a result that is explicitly not used.  To  suppress  this  warning
           cast  the unused expression to void. This includes an expression-statement or the left-hand side of a
           comma expression that contains no side effects. For example, an expression such as x[i,j] will  cause
           a warning, while x[(void)i,j] will not.

           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wunused
           All the above -Wunused options combined.

           In  order  to  get  a  warning  about  an  unused function parameter, you must either specify -Wextra
           -Wunused (note that -Wall implies -Wunused), or separately specify -Wunused-parameter.

       -Wuninitialized
           Warn if an automatic variable is used without first  being  initialized  or  if  a  variable  may  be
           clobbered  by  a  "setjmp"  call.  In  C++, warn if a non-static reference or non-static const member
           appears in a class without constructors.

           If you want to warn about code which uses  the  uninitialized  value  of  the  variable  in  its  own
           initializer, use the -Winit-self option.

           These  warnings occur for individual uninitialized or clobbered elements of structure, union or array
           variables as well as for variables which are uninitialized or clobbered as  a  whole.   They  do  not
           occur  for variables or elements declared "volatile".  Because these warnings depend on optimization,
           the exact variables or elements for which there are warnings will depend on the precise  optimization
           options and version of GCC used.

           Note  that  there may be no warning about a variable that is used only to compute a value that itself
           is never used, because such computations may be deleted by data flow analysis before the warnings are
           printed.

           These warnings are made optional because GCC is not smart enough to see all the reasons why the  code
           might be correct despite appearing to have an error.  Here is one example of how this can happen:

                   {
                     int x;
                     switch (y)
                       {
                       case 1: x = 1;
                         break;
                       case 2: x = 4;
                         break;
                       case 3: x = 5;
                       }
                     foo (x);
                   }

           If  the  value of "y" is always 1, 2 or 3, then "x" is always initialized, but GCC doesn't know this.
           Here is another common case:

                   {
                     int save_y;
                     if (change_y) save_y = y, y = new_y;
                     ...
                     if (change_y) y = save_y;
                   }

           This has no bug because "save_y" is used only if it is set.

           This option also warns when a  non-volatile  automatic  variable  might  be  changed  by  a  call  to
           "longjmp".  These warnings as well are possible only in optimizing compilation.

           The  compiler  sees  only  the  calls to "setjmp".  It cannot know where "longjmp" will be called; in
           fact, a signal handler could call it at any point in the code.  As a result, you may  get  a  warning
           even  when  there is in fact no problem because "longjmp" cannot in fact be called at the place which
           would cause a problem.

           Some spurious warnings can be avoided if you declare all the functions you use that never  return  as
           "noreturn".

           This warning is enabled by -Wall or -Wextra.

       -Wunknown-pragmas
           Warn  when  a  #pragma directive is encountered which is not understood by GCC.  If this command line
           option is used, warnings will even be issued for unknown pragmas in system header files.  This is not
           the case if the warnings were only enabled by the -Wall command line option.

       -Wno-pragmas
           Do not warn about misuses of pragmas, such as incorrect  parameters,  invalid  syntax,  or  conflicts
           between pragmas.  See also -Wunknown-pragmas.

       -Wstrict-aliasing
           This  option  is only active when -fstrict-aliasing is active.  It warns about code which might break
           the strict aliasing rules that the compiler is using for optimization.  The warning  does  not  catch
           all  cases,  but  does  attempt  to  catch the more common pitfalls.  It is included in -Wall.  It is
           equivalent to -Wstrict-aliasing=3

       -Wstrict-aliasing=n
           This option is only active when -fstrict-aliasing is active.  It warns about code which  might  break
           the  strict  aliasing rules that the compiler is using for optimization.  Higher levels correspond to
           higher accuracy (fewer false positives).  Higher levels also correspond to more  effort,  similar  to
           the way -O works.  -Wstrict-aliasing is equivalent to -Wstrict-aliasing=n, with n=3.

           Level  1: Most aggressive, quick, least accurate.  Possibly useful when higher levels do not warn but
           -fstrict-aliasing still breaks the code, as it has very few false negatives.  However,  it  has  many
           false  positives.   Warns  for  all  pointer conversions between possibly incompatible types, even if
           never dereferenced.  Runs in the frontend only.

           Level 2: Aggressive, quick, not too precise.  May still have many false positives  (not  as  many  as
           level  1  though), and few false negatives (but possibly more than level 1).  Unlike level 1, it only
           warns when an address is taken.  Warns about incomplete types.  Runs in the frontend only.

           Level 3 (default for  -Wstrict-aliasing):  Should  have  very  few  false  positives  and  few  false
           negatives.   Slightly  slower  than  levels  1  or 2 when optimization is enabled.  Takes care of the
           common pun+dereference pattern in the frontend: "*(int*)&some_float".  If optimization is enabled, it
           also runs in the backend, where it deals with multiple statement cases using flow-sensitive points-to
           information.  Only warns when the converted pointer is dereferenced.  Does not warn about  incomplete
           types.

       -Wstrict-overflow
       -Wstrict-overflow=n
           This option is only active when -fstrict-overflow is active.  It warns about cases where the compiler
           optimizes  based  on  the assumption that signed overflow does not occur.  Note that it does not warn
           about all cases where the code  might  overflow:  it  only  warns  about  cases  where  the  compiler
           implements some optimization.  Thus this warning depends on the optimization level.

           An  optimization which assumes that signed overflow does not occur is perfectly safe if the values of
           the variables involved are such that overflow never does, in fact, occur.  Therefore this warning can
           easily give a false positive: a warning about code which is not actually a problem.  To help focus on
           important issues, several warning levels are  defined.   No  warnings  are  issued  for  the  use  of
           undefined signed overflow when estimating how many iterations a loop will require, in particular when
           determining whether a loop will be executed at all.

           -Wstrict-overflow=1
               Warn  about  cases which are both questionable and easy to avoid.  For example: "x + 1 > x"; with
               -fstrict-overflow, the compiler will simplify this to 1.   This  level  of  -Wstrict-overflow  is
               enabled by -Wall; higher levels are not, and must be explicitly requested.

           -Wstrict-overflow=2
               Also  warn  about  other cases where a comparison is simplified to a constant.  For example: "abs
               (x) >= 0".  This can only be  simplified  when  -fstrict-overflow  is  in  effect,  because  "abs
               (INT_MIN)" overflows to "INT_MIN", which is less than zero.  -Wstrict-overflow (with no level) is
               the same as -Wstrict-overflow=2.

           -Wstrict-overflow=3
               Also  warn  about other cases where a comparison is simplified.  For example: "x + 1 > 1" will be
               simplified to "x > 0".

           -Wstrict-overflow=4
               Also warn about other simplifications not covered by the above cases.  For example: "(x *  10)  /
               5" will be simplified to "x * 2".

           -Wstrict-overflow=5
               Also  warn  about  cases  where  the  compiler  reduces the magnitude of a constant involved in a
               comparison.  For example: "x + 2 > y" will be simplified to "x + 1 >= y".  This is reported  only
               at  the  highest  warning  level because this simplification applies to many comparisons, so this
               warning level will give a very large number of false positives.

       -Wsuggest-attribute=[pure|const|noreturn]
           Warn for cases where adding an attribute may be beneficial. The attributes  currently  supported  are
           listed below.

           -Wsuggest-attribute=pure
           -Wsuggest-attribute=const
           -Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
               Warn about functions which might be candidates for attributes "pure", "const" or "noreturn".  The
               compiler  only  warns  for functions visible in other compilation units or (in the case of "pure"
               and "const") if it cannot prove that the function returns normally. A function  returns  normally
               if  it  doesn't contain an infinite loop nor returns abnormally by throwing, calling "abort()" or
               trapping.  This analysis requires option -fipa-pure-const, which is enabled by default at -O  and
               higher.  Higher optimization levels improve the accuracy of the analysis.

       -Warray-bounds
           This  option  is  only  active  when -ftree-vrp is active (default for -O2 and above). It warns about
           subscripts to arrays that are always out of bounds. This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wno-div-by-zero
           Do not warn about compile-time integer division by zero.  Floating point  division  by  zero  is  not
           warned about, as it can be a legitimate way of obtaining infinities and NaNs.

       -Wsystem-headers
           Print warning messages for constructs found in system header files.  Warnings from system headers are
           normally suppressed, on the assumption that they usually do not indicate real problems and would only
           make  the  compiler output harder to read.  Using this command line option tells GCC to emit warnings
           from system headers as if they occurred in user code.  However, note that using -Wall in  conjunction
           with  this option will not warn about unknown pragmas in system headers---for that, -Wunknown-pragmas
           must also be used.

       -Wtrampolines
            Warn about trampolines generated for pointers to nested functions.

            A trampoline is a small piece of data or code that is created at run
            time on the stack when the address of a nested function is taken, and
            is used to call the nested function indirectly.  For some targets, it
            is made up of data only and thus requires no special treatment.  But,
            for most targets, it is made up of code and thus requires the stack
            to be made executable in order for the program to work properly.

       -Wfloat-equal
           Warn if floating point values are used in equality comparisons.

           The idea behind this is that sometimes it is convenient (for the programmer)  to  consider  floating-
           point  values  as approximations to infinitely precise real numbers.  If you are doing this, then you
           need to compute (by analyzing the code, or in some other way) the maximum  or  likely  maximum  error
           that  the  computation  introduces,  and allow for it when performing comparisons (and when producing
           output, but that's a different problem).  In particular, instead of testing for equality,  you  would
           check  to  see  whether the two values have ranges that overlap; and this is done with the relational
           operators, so equality comparisons are probably mistaken.

       -Wtraditional (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and ISO C.  Also warn about  ISO
           C  constructs  that  have  no traditional C equivalent, and/or problematic constructs which should be
           avoided.

           •   Macro parameters that appear within string literals in the macro body.  In  traditional  C  macro
               replacement takes place within string literals, but does not in ISO C.

           •   In  traditional  C,  some preprocessor directives did not exist.  Traditional preprocessors would
               only consider a line to be a directive if the # appeared in column  1  on  the  line.   Therefore
               -Wtraditional  warns about directives that traditional C understands but would ignore because the
               # does not appear as the first character on the line.  It also suggests you hide directives  like
               #pragma  not  understood  by  traditional  C by indenting them.  Some traditional implementations
               would not recognize #elif, so it suggests avoiding it altogether.

           •   A function-like macro that appears without arguments.

           •   The unary plus operator.

           •   The U integer constant suffix, or the F or L floating point constant  suffixes.   (Traditional  C
               does  support  the L suffix on integer constants.)  Note, these suffixes appear in macros defined
               in the system headers of most modern systems, e.g. the _MIN/_MAX macros in "<limits.h>".  Use  of
               these  macros  in  user  code  might normally lead to spurious warnings, however GCC's integrated
               preprocessor has enough context to avoid warning in these cases.

           •   A function declared external in one block and then used after the end of the block.

           •   A "switch" statement has an operand of type "long".

           •   A non-"static" function declaration follows a "static" one.  This construct is  not  accepted  by
               some traditional C compilers.

           •   The  ISO  type  of  an  integer constant has a different width or signedness from its traditional
               type.  This warning is only issued if the base of the constant is ten.  I.e. hexadecimal or octal
               values, which typically represent bit patterns, are not warned about.

           •   Usage of ISO string concatenation is detected.

           •   Initialization of automatic aggregates.

           •   Identifier conflicts with labels.  Traditional C lacks a separate namespace for labels.

           •   Initialization of unions.  If the initializer is zero, the warning  is  omitted.   This  is  done
               under  the  assumption  that  the  zero  initializer  in  user  code  appears conditioned on e.g.
               "__STDC__" to avoid missing initializer warnings and relies on default initialization to zero  in
               the traditional C case.

           •   Conversions  by  prototypes  between  fixed/floating point values and vice versa.  The absence of
               these prototypes when compiling with traditional C would  cause  serious  problems.   This  is  a
               subset of the possible conversion warnings, for the full set use -Wtraditional-conversion.

           •   Use  of ISO C style function definitions.  This warning intentionally is not issued for prototype
               declarations or variadic functions because these ISO C features will appear  in  your  code  when
               using  libiberty's  traditional  C compatibility macros, "PARAMS" and "VPARAMS".  This warning is
               also bypassed for nested functions because that feature is already a GCC extension and  thus  not
               relevant to traditional C compatibility.

       -Wtraditional-conversion (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn  if  a  prototype  causes a type conversion that is different from what would happen to the same
           argument in the absence of a prototype.  This includes conversions of fixed  point  to  floating  and
           vice  versa,  and  conversions changing the width or signedness of a fixed point argument except when
           the same as the default promotion.

       -Wdeclaration-after-statement (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn when a declaration is found after a statement in a block.  This construct, known from  C++,  was
           introduced with ISO C99 and is by default allowed in GCC.  It is not supported by ISO C90 and was not
           supported by GCC versions before GCC 3.0.

       -Wundef
           Warn if an undefined identifier is evaluated in an #if directive.

       -Wno-endif-labels
           Do not warn whenever an #else or an #endif are followed by text.

       -Wshadow
           Warn  whenever  a  local  variable  or type declaration shadows another variable, parameter, type, or
           class member (in C++), or whenever a built-in function is shadowed. Note that in  C++,  the  compiler
           will  not  warn  if  a  local  variable  shadows  a struct/class/enum, but will warn if it shadows an
           explicit typedef.

       -Wlarger-than=len
           Warn whenever an object of larger than len bytes is defined.

       -Wframe-larger-than=len
           Warn if the size of a function frame is larger than len bytes.  The computation done to determine the
           stack frame size is approximate and not  conservative.   The  actual  requirements  may  be  somewhat
           greater  than  len  even if you do not get a warning.  In addition, any space allocated via "alloca",
           variable-length arrays, or related constructs is  not  included  by  the  compiler  when  determining
           whether or not to issue a warning.

       -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
           Warn  if the loop cannot be optimized because the compiler could not assume anything on the bounds of
           the loop indices.  With -funsafe-loop-optimizations warn if the compiler made such assumptions.

       -Wno-pedantic-ms-format (MinGW targets only)
           Disables the warnings about non-ISO "printf" / "scanf" format width specifiers "I32", "I64", and  "I"
           used  on  Windows  targets  depending  on the MS runtime, when you are using the options -Wformat and
           -pedantic without gnu-extensions.

       -Wpointer-arith
           Warn about anything that depends on the "size of" a function type or of "void".  GNU C assigns  these
           types  a size of 1, for convenience in calculations with "void *" pointers and pointers to functions.
           In C++, warn also when an arithmetic operation involves "NULL".  This  warning  is  also  enabled  by
           -pedantic.

       -Wtype-limits
           Warn if a comparison is always true or always false due to the limited range of the data type, but do
           not  warn  for  constant  expressions.  For example, warn if an unsigned variable is compared against
           zero with < or >=.  This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.

       -Wbad-function-cast (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn whenever a function call is cast to a non-matching type.  For example, warn if "int malloc()" is
           cast to "anything *".

       -Wc++-compat (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn about ISO C constructs that are outside of the common subset of ISO C and ISO C++, e.g.  request
           for implicit conversion from "void *" to a pointer to non-"void" type.

       -Wc++0x-compat (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  about  C++  constructs  whose  meaning  differs  between  ISO  C++ 1998 and ISO C++ 200x, e.g.,
           identifiers in ISO C++ 1998 that will become keywords in ISO C++ 200x.  This warning  is  enabled  by
           -Wall.

       -Wcast-qual
           Warn  whenever a pointer is cast so as to remove a type qualifier from the target type.  For example,
           warn if a "const char *" is cast to an ordinary "char *".

           Also warn when making a cast which introduces a type  qualifier  in  an  unsafe  way.   For  example,
           casting "char **" to "const char **" is unsafe, as in this example:

                     /* p is char ** value.  */
                     const char **q = (const char **) p;
                     /* Assignment of readonly string to const char * is OK.  */
                     *q = "string";
                     /* Now char** pointer points to read-only memory.  */
                     **p = 'b';

       -Wcast-align
           Warn  whenever  a  pointer  is cast such that the required alignment of the target is increased.  For
           example, warn if a "char *" is cast to an "int *" on machines where integers can only be accessed  at
           two- or four-byte boundaries.

       -Wwrite-strings
           When  compiling C, give string constants the type "const char[length]" so that copying the address of
           one into a non-"const" "char *" pointer will get a warning.  These warnings will  help  you  find  at
           compile  time  code  that  can  try  to  write into a string constant, but only if you have been very
           careful about using "const" in declarations and prototypes.  Otherwise, it will just be  a  nuisance.
           This is why we did not make -Wall request these warnings.

           When  compiling  C++,  warn  about  the deprecated conversion from string literals to "char *".  This
           warning is enabled by default for C++ programs.

       -Wclobbered
           Warn for variables that might be changed by longjmp or  vfork.   This  warning  is  also  enabled  by
           -Wextra.

       -Wconversion
           Warn  for  implicit  conversions  that  may alter a value. This includes conversions between real and
           integer, like "abs (x)" when "x" is "double"; conversions between signed and unsigned, like "unsigned
           ui = -1"; and conversions to smaller types, like "sqrtf (M_PI)". Do not warn for explicit casts  like
           "abs  ((int)  x)"  and "ui = (unsigned) -1", or if the value is not changed by the conversion like in
           "abs (2.0)".  Warnings about conversions between signed and unsigned  integers  can  be  disabled  by
           using -Wno-sign-conversion.

           For  C++,  also  warn for confusing overload resolution for user-defined conversions; and conversions
           that will never use a type conversion operator: conversions to "void", the same type, a base class or
           a reference to them. Warnings about conversions between signed and unsigned integers are disabled  by
           default in C++ unless -Wsign-conversion is explicitly enabled.

       -Wno-conversion-null (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Do  not  warn  for  conversions between "NULL" and non-pointer types. -Wconversion-null is enabled by
           default.

       -Wempty-body
           Warn if an empty body occurs in an if, else or do while statement.  This warning is also  enabled  by
           -Wextra.

       -Wenum-compare
           Warn  about  a  comparison  between values of different enum types. In C++ this warning is enabled by
           default.  In C this warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wjump-misses-init (C, Objective-C only)
           Warn if a "goto" statement or a "switch" statement jumps  forward  across  the  initialization  of  a
           variable,  or  jumps  backward  to  a label after the variable has been initialized.  This only warns
           about variables which are initialized when they are declared.  This warning is only supported  for  C
           and Objective C; in C++ this sort of branch is an error in any case.

           -Wjump-misses-init  is  included  in -Wc++-compat.  It can be disabled with the -Wno-jump-misses-init
           option.

       -Wsign-compare
           Warn when a comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce an incorrect result when  the
           signed  value  is  converted  to unsigned.  This warning is also enabled by -Wextra; to get the other
           warnings of -Wextra without this warning, use -Wextra -Wno-sign-compare.

       -Wsign-conversion
           Warn for implicit conversions that may change the sign of an integer value, like assigning  a  signed
           integer expression to an unsigned integer variable. An explicit cast silences the warning. In C, this
           option is enabled also by -Wconversion.

       -Waddress
           Warn  about  suspicious  uses of memory addresses. These include using the address of a function in a
           conditional expression, such as "void func(void); if (func)",  and  comparisons  against  the  memory
           address  of  a  string literal, such as "if (x == "abc")".  Such uses typically indicate a programmer
           error: the address of a function always evaluates to true, so their  use  in  a  conditional  usually
           indicate  that  the  programmer  forgot  the  parentheses in a function call; and comparisons against
           string literals result in unspecified behavior and are not portable in C, so  they  usually  indicate
           that the programmer intended to use "strcmp".  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wlogical-op
           Warn  about  suspicious  uses  of  logical  operators  in  expressions.   This includes using logical
           operators in contexts where a bit-wise operator is likely to be expected.

       -Waggregate-return
           Warn if any functions that return structures or unions are defined or called.   (In  languages  where
           you can return an array, this also elicits a warning.)

       -Wno-attributes
           Do  not  warn  if  an  unexpected  "__attribute__" is used, such as unrecognized attributes, function
           attributes applied to variables, etc.  This will not stop  errors  for  incorrect  use  of  supported
           attributes.

       -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
           Do  not  warn if certain built-in macros are redefined.  This suppresses warnings for redefinition of
           "__TIMESTAMP__", "__TIME__", "__DATE__", "__FILE__", and "__BASE_FILE__".

       -Wstrict-prototypes (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn if a function is declared or defined without  specifying  the  argument  types.   (An  old-style
           function  definition  is permitted without a warning if preceded by a declaration which specifies the
           argument types.)

       -Wold-style-declaration (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn for obsolescent usages, according to the C Standard, in a  declaration.  For  example,  warn  if
           storage-class  specifiers  like  "static" are not the first things in a declaration.  This warning is
           also enabled by -Wextra.

       -Wold-style-definition (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn if an old-style function definition is used.  A warning is given even if  there  is  a  previous
           prototype.

       -Wmissing-parameter-type (C and Objective-C only)
           A function parameter is declared without a type specifier in K&R-style functions:

                   void foo(bar) { }

           This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.

       -Wmissing-prototypes (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn  if  a  global  function  is  defined without a previous prototype declaration.  This warning is
           issued even if the definition itself provides a prototype.  The aim is  to  detect  global  functions
           that fail to be declared in header files.

       -Wmissing-declarations
           Warn  if  a  global function is defined without a previous declaration.  Do so even if the definition
           itself provides a prototype.  Use this option to detect global functions that  are  not  declared  in
           header files.  In C++, no warnings are issued for function templates, or for inline functions, or for
           functions in anonymous namespaces.

       -Wmissing-field-initializers
           Warn  if  a  structure's  initializer has some fields missing.  For example, the following code would
           cause such a warning, because "x.h" is implicitly zero:

                   struct s { int f, g, h; };
                   struct s x = { 3, 4 };

           This option does not warn about designated initializers, so  the  following  modification  would  not
           trigger a warning:

                   struct s { int f, g, h; };
                   struct s x = { .f = 3, .g = 4 };

           This  warning  is  included  in -Wextra.  To get other -Wextra warnings without this one, use -Wextra
           -Wno-missing-field-initializers.

       -Wmissing-format-attribute
           Warn about function pointers which might be candidates for "format" attributes.  Note these are  only
           possible  candidates,  not  absolute  ones.   GCC  will  guess  that  function pointers with "format"
           attributes that are used in assignment, initialization, parameter passing or return statements should
           have a corresponding "format" attribute in the resulting  type.   I.e.  the  left-hand  side  of  the
           assignment  or  initialization,  the  type  of  the  parameter  variable,  or  the return type of the
           containing function respectively should also have a "format" attribute to avoid the warning.

           GCC will also warn about function definitions which might  be  candidates  for  "format"  attributes.
           Again,  these  are  only  possible  candidates.   GCC  will  guess  that "format" attributes might be
           appropriate for any function that calls a function like "vprintf" or "vscanf",  but  this  might  not
           always  be  the  case,  and  some  functions for which "format" attributes are appropriate may not be
           detected.

       -Wno-multichar
           Do not warn if a multicharacter constant ('FOOF') is used.  Usually  they  indicate  a  typo  in  the
           user's code, as they have implementation-defined values, and should not be used in portable code.

       -Wnormalized=<none|id|nfc|nfkc>
           In  ISO  C  and ISO C++, two identifiers are different if they are different sequences of characters.
           However, sometimes when characters outside the basic ASCII character set are used, you can  have  two
           different  character  sequences  that look the same.  To avoid confusion, the ISO 10646 standard sets
           out some normalization rules which when applied ensure that two sequences  that  look  the  same  are
           turned  into  the  same  sequence.  GCC can warn you if you are using identifiers which have not been
           normalized; this option controls that warning.

           There are four levels of warning that GCC supports.  The default  is  -Wnormalized=nfc,  which  warns
           about  any identifier which is not in the ISO 10646 "C" normalized form, NFC.  NFC is the recommended
           form for most uses.

           Unfortunately, there are some characters which ISO C and ISO  C++  allow  in  identifiers  that  when
           turned  into  NFC  aren't  allowable as identifiers.  That is, there's no way to use these symbols in
           portable ISO C or C++ and have all your identifiers in NFC.  -Wnormalized=id suppresses  the  warning
           for  these characters.  It is hoped that future versions of the standards involved will correct this,
           which is why this option is not the default.

           You can switch the warning off for all characters by writing -Wnormalized=none.  You would only  want
           to  do  this  if you were using some other normalization scheme (like "D"), because otherwise you can
           easily create bugs that are literally impossible to see.

           Some characters in ISO 10646 have distinct meanings but look  identical  in  some  fonts  or  display
           methodologies,  especially  once  formatting  has  been applied.  For instance "\u207F", "SUPERSCRIPT
           LATIN SMALL LETTER N", will display just like a regular "n" which has been placed in  a  superscript.
           ISO  10646  defines  the NFKC normalization scheme to convert all these into a standard form as well,
           and GCC will warn if your code is not  in  NFKC  if  you  use  -Wnormalized=nfkc.   This  warning  is
           comparable  to warning about every identifier that contains the letter O because it might be confused
           with the digit 0, and so is not the default, but may be useful as a local coding  convention  if  the
           programming environment is unable to be fixed to display these characters distinctly.

       -Wno-deprecated
           Do not warn about usage of deprecated features.

       -Wno-deprecated-declarations
           Do  not  warn  about  uses  of  functions,  variables,  and  types  marked as deprecated by using the
           "deprecated" attribute.

       -Wno-overflow
           Do not warn about compile-time overflow in constant expressions.

       -Woverride-init (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn if an initialized field without side effects is overridden when using designated initializers.

           This warning is included in -Wextra.  To get other -Wextra warnings without  this  one,  use  -Wextra
           -Wno-override-init.

       -Wpacked
           Warn  if  a  structure  is  given the packed attribute, but the packed attribute has no effect on the
           layout or size of the structure.  Such  structures  may  be  mis-aligned  for  little  benefit.   For
           instance,  in  this  code,  the variable "f.x" in "struct bar" will be misaligned even though "struct
           bar" does not itself have the packed attribute:

                   struct foo {
                     int x;
                     char a, b, c, d;
                   } __attribute__((packed));
                   struct bar {
                     char z;
                     struct foo f;
                   };

       -Wpacked-bitfield-compat
           The 4.1, 4.2 and 4.3 series of GCC ignore the "packed" attribute on bit-fields of type "char".   This
           has  been  fixed  in  GCC  4.4  but  the change can lead to differences in the structure layout.  GCC
           informs you when the offset of such a field has changed in GCC 4.4.  For example there is no longer a
           4-bit padding between field "a" and "b" in this structure:

                   struct foo
                   {
                     char a:4;
                     char b:8;
                   } __attribute__ ((packed));

           This warning is enabled by default.  Use -Wno-packed-bitfield-compat to disable this warning.

       -Wpadded
           Warn if padding is included in a structure, either to align an element of the structure or  to  align
           the  whole  structure.   Sometimes  when  this  happens it is possible to rearrange the fields of the
           structure to reduce the padding and so make the structure smaller.

       -Wredundant-decls
           Warn if anything is declared more than  once  in  the  same  scope,  even  in  cases  where  multiple
           declaration is valid and changes nothing.

       -Wnested-externs (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn if an "extern" declaration is encountered within a function.

       -Winline
           Warn  if  a  function  can  not be inlined and it was declared as inline.  Even with this option, the
           compiler will not warn about failures to inline functions declared in system headers.

           The compiler uses a variety of heuristics to determine whether or not  to  inline  a  function.   For
           example,  the  compiler  takes  into account the size of the function being inlined and the amount of
           inlining that has already been done in the  current  function.   Therefore,  seemingly  insignificant
           changes in the source program can cause the warnings produced by -Winline to appear or disappear.

       -Wno-invalid-offsetof (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Suppress  warnings from applying the offsetof macro to a non-POD type.  According to the 1998 ISO C++
           standard, applying offsetof to a  non-POD  type  is  undefined.   In  existing  C++  implementations,
           however,  offsetof  typically  gives meaningful results even when applied to certain kinds of non-POD
           types. (Such as a simple struct that fails to be a POD type only by virtue of having a  constructor.)
           This flag is for users who are aware that they are writing nonportable code and who have deliberately
           chosen to ignore the warning about it.

           The restrictions on offsetof may be relaxed in a future version of the C++ standard.

       -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
           Suppress  warnings from casts to pointer type of an integer of a different size. In C++, casting to a
           pointer type of smaller size is an error. Wint-to-pointer-cast is enabled by default.

       -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast (C and Objective-C only)
           Suppress warnings from casts from a pointer to an integer type of a different size.

       -Winvalid-pch
           Warn if a precompiled header is found in the search path but can't be used.

       -Wlong-long
           Warn if long long type is used.  This is enabled by either -pedantic or -Wtraditional in ISO C90  and
           C++98 modes.  To inhibit the warning messages, use -Wno-long-long.

       -Wvariadic-macros
           Warn  if  variadic  macros  are  used  in  pedantic ISO C90 mode, or the GNU alternate syntax when in
           pedantic ISO C99 mode.  This is default.  To inhibit the warning messages, use -Wno-variadic-macros.

       -Wvla
           Warn if variable length array is used in the code.  -Wno-vla will prevent the  -pedantic  warning  of
           the variable length array.

       -Wvolatile-register-var
           Warn  if  a  register  variable  is  declared  volatile.   The volatile modifier does not inhibit all
           optimizations that may eliminate reads and/or writes to register variables.  This warning is  enabled
           by -Wall.

       -Wdisabled-optimization
           Warn  if  a  requested  optimization pass is disabled.  This warning does not generally indicate that
           there is anything wrong with your code; it merely indicates that  GCC's  optimizers  were  unable  to
           handle  the  code  effectively.   Often, the problem is that your code is too big or too complex; GCC
           will refuse to optimize programs when the optimization itself is likely to take inordinate amounts of
           time.

       -Wpointer-sign (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn for pointer argument passing or assignment with  different  signedness.   This  option  is  only
           supported for C and Objective-C.  It is implied by -Wall and by -pedantic, which can be disabled with
           -Wno-pointer-sign.

       -Wstack-protector
           This  option is only active when -fstack-protector is active.  It warns about functions that will not
           be protected against stack smashing.

       -Wno-mudflap
           Suppress warnings about constructs that cannot be instrumented by -fmudflap.

       -Woverlength-strings
           Warn about string constants which are longer than the "minimum maximum" length  specified  in  the  C
           standard.   Modern  compilers  generally  allow  string  constants  which  are  much  longer than the
           standard's minimum limit, but very portable programs should avoid using longer strings.

           The limit applies after string constant concatenation, and does not count the trailing NUL.  In  C90,
           the  limit  was  509  characters;  in C99, it was raised to 4095.  C++98 does not specify a normative
           minimum maximum, so we do not diagnose overlength strings in C++.

           This option is implied by -pedantic, and can be disabled with -Wno-overlength-strings.

       -Wunsuffixed-float-constants (C and Objective-C only)
           GCC will issue a warning for any floating constant that does not have a suffix.  When  used  together
           with  -Wsystem-headers  it will warn about such constants in system header files.  This can be useful
           when preparing code to use with the "FLOAT_CONST_DECIMAL64" pragma from  the  decimal  floating-point
           extension to C99.

   Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC
       GCC has various special options that are used for debugging either your program or GCC:

       -g  Produce  debugging  information in the operating system's native format (stabs, COFF, XCOFF, or DWARF
           2).  GDB can work with this debugging information.

           On most systems that use stabs format, -g enables use of extra debugging information  that  only  GDB
           can  use;  this  extra  information  makes  debugging work better in GDB but will probably make other
           debuggers crash or refuse to read the program.  If  you  want  to  control  for  certain  whether  to
           generate the extra information, use -gstabs+, -gstabs, -gxcoff+, -gxcoff, or -gvms (see below).

           GCC  allows  you  to  use -g with -O.  The shortcuts taken by optimized code may occasionally produce
           surprising results: some variables you declared may not exist at all; flow  of  control  may  briefly
           move  where  you did not expect it; some statements may not be executed because they compute constant
           results or their values were already at hand; some statements may execute in different places because
           they were moved out of loops.

           Nevertheless it proves possible to debug optimized output.  This  makes  it  reasonable  to  use  the
           optimizer for programs that might have bugs.

           The  following  options  are  useful  when  GCC  is  generated  with the capability for more than one
           debugging format.

       -ggdb
           Produce debugging information for use by GDB.  This means to use the most expressive format available
           (DWARF 2, stabs, or the native format if neither of those are supported), including GDB extensions if
           at all possible.

       -gstabs
           Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported), without GDB  extensions.   This
           is  the  format  used by DBX on most BSD systems.  On MIPS, Alpha and System V Release 4 systems this
           option produces stabs debugging output which is not understood by DBX or SDB.  On System V Release  4
           systems this option requires the GNU assembler.

       -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
           Produce  debugging  information  in  stabs  format  (if that is supported), for only symbols that are
           actually used.

       -femit-class-debug-always
           Instead of emitting debugging information for a C++ class in only one object file,  emit  it  in  all
           object  files  using  the  class.   This option should be used only with debuggers that are unable to
           handle the way GCC normally emits debugging information for classes because using  this  option  will
           increase the size of debugging information by as much as a factor of two.

       -gstabs+
           Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported), using GNU extensions understood
           only  by the GNU debugger (GDB).  The use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash
           or refuse to read the program.

       -gcoff
           Produce debugging information in COFF format (if that is supported).  This is the format used by  SDB
           on most System V systems prior to System V Release 4.

       -gxcoff
           Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported).  This is the format used by the
           DBX debugger on IBM RS/6000 systems.

       -gxcoff+
           Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported), using GNU extensions understood
           only  by the GNU debugger (GDB).  The use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash
           or refuse to read the program, and may cause assemblers other than the GNU assembler  (GAS)  to  fail
           with an error.

       -gdwarf-version
           Produce debugging information in DWARF format (if that is supported).  This is the format used by DBX
           on IRIX 6.  The value of version may be either 2, 3 or 4; the default version is 2.

           Note  that with DWARF version 2 some ports require, and will always use, some non-conflicting DWARF 3
           extensions in the unwind tables.

           Version 4 may require GDB 7.0 and -fvar-tracking-assignments for maximum benefit.

       -gstrict-dwarf
           Disallow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than  selected  with  -gdwarf-version.   On
           most targets using non-conflicting DWARF extensions from later standard versions is allowed.

       -gno-strict-dwarf
           Allow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected with -gdwarf-version.

       -gvms
           Produce debugging information in VMS debug format (if that is supported).  This is the format used by
           DEBUG on VMS systems.

       -glevel
       -ggdblevel
       -gstabslevel
       -gcofflevel
       -gxcofflevel
       -gvmslevel
           Request  debugging information and also use level to specify how much information.  The default level
           is 2.

           Level 0 produces no debug information at all.  Thus, -g0 negates -g.

           Level 1 produces minimal information, enough for making backtraces in parts of the program  that  you
           don't  plan  to  debug.   This  includes  descriptions  of  functions  and external variables, but no
           information about local variables and no line numbers.

           Level 3 includes extra information, such as all the macro definitions present in the  program.   Some
           debuggers support macro expansion when you use -g3.

           -gdwarf-2  does  not accept a concatenated debug level, because GCC used to support an option -gdwarf
           that meant to generate debug information in version 1 of the DWARF format (which  is  very  different
           from  version  2), and it would have been too confusing.  That debug format is long obsolete, but the
           option cannot be changed now.  Instead use an additional -glevel option to change the debug level for
           DWARF.

       -gtoggle
           Turn off generation of debug info, if leaving out this option would have generated it, or turn it  on
           at  level  2  otherwise.  The position of this argument in the command line does not matter, it takes
           effect after all other options are processed, and it does so only once, no matter how many  times  it
           is given.  This is mainly intended to be used with -fcompare-debug.

       -fdump-final-insns[=file]
           Dump  the  final  internal  representation (RTL) to file.  If the optional argument is omitted (or if
           file is "."), the name of the dump file will be determined by appending  ".gkd"  to  the  compilation
           output file name.

       -fcompare-debug[=opts]
           If   no  error  occurs  during  compilation,  run  the  compiler  a  second  time,  adding  opts  and
           -fcompare-debug-second to the arguments passed to the second compilation.  Dump  the  final  internal
           representation in both compilations, and print an error if they differ.

           If the equal sign is omitted, the default -gtoggle is used.

           The  environment  variable  GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG,  if defined, non-empty and nonzero, implicitly enables
           -fcompare-debug.  If GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG is defined to a string starting with a dash, then it  is  used
           for opts, otherwise the default -gtoggle is used.

           -fcompare-debug=,  with  the  equal sign but without opts, is equivalent to -fno-compare-debug, which
           disables the dumping of  the  final  representation  and  the  second  compilation,  preventing  even
           GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG from taking effect.

           To   verify   full   coverage   during   -fcompare-debug   testing,   set  GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG  to  say
           -fcompare-debug-not-overridden, which GCC will reject as an invalid option in any actual  compilation
           (rather  than  preprocessing, assembly or linking).  To get just a warning, setting GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
           to -w%n-fcompare-debug not overridden will do.

       -fcompare-debug-second
           This  option  is  implicitly  passed  to  the  compiler  for  the  second  compilation  requested  by
           -fcompare-debug,  along with options to silence warnings, and omitting other options that would cause
           side-effect compiler outputs to files or to the standard output.  Dump files and preserved  temporary
           files  are  renamed so as to contain the ".gk" additional extension during the second compilation, to
           avoid overwriting those generated by the first.

           When this option is passed to the compiler driver, it causes the first  compilation  to  be  skipped,
           which makes it useful for little other than debugging the compiler proper.

       -feliminate-dwarf2-dups
           Compress  DWARF2 debugging information by eliminating duplicated information about each symbol.  This
           option only makes sense when generating DWARF2 debugging information with -gdwarf-2.

       -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
           Emit debug information for struct-like types only when the base name of the compilation  source  file
           matches the base name of file in which the struct was defined.

           This  option  substantially  reduces  the size of debugging information, but at significant potential
           loss in type information to the debugger.  See  -femit-struct-debug-reduced  for  a  less  aggressive
           option.  See -femit-struct-debug-detailed for more detailed control.

           This option works only with DWARF 2.

       -femit-struct-debug-reduced
           Emit  debug  information for struct-like types only when the base name of the compilation source file
           matches the base name of file in which the type was defined, unless  the  struct  is  a  template  or
           defined in a system header.

           This option significantly reduces the size of debugging information, with some potential loss in type
           information  to  the  debugger.   See -femit-struct-debug-baseonly for a more aggressive option.  See
           -femit-struct-debug-detailed for more detailed control.

           This option works only with DWARF 2.

       -femit-struct-debug-detailed[=spec-list]
           Specify the struct-like types for which the compiler will generate debug information.  The intent  is
           to reduce duplicate struct debug information between different object files within the same program.

           This  option  is  a detailed version of -femit-struct-debug-reduced and -femit-struct-debug-baseonly,
           which will serve for most needs.

           A specification has the syntax[dir:|ind:][ord:|gen:](any|sys|base|none)

           The optional first word limits the specification to structs that are used  directly  (dir:)  or  used
           indirectly  (ind:).   A  struct  type  is  used  directly  when it is the type of a variable, member.
           Indirect uses arise through pointers to structs.  That is, when use of an incomplete struct would  be
           legal, the use is indirect.  An example is struct one direct; struct two * indirect;.

           The  optional  second  word  limits  the  specification to ordinary structs (ord:) or generic structs
           (gen:).  Generic structs are  a  bit  complicated  to  explain.   For  C++,  these  are  non-explicit
           specializations  of  template  classes,  or non-template classes within the above.  Other programming
           languages have generics, but -femit-struct-debug-detailed does not yet implement them.

           The third word specifies the source files for those structs for which the compiler  will  emit  debug
           information.  The values none and any have the normal meaning.  The value base means that the base of
           name  of  the  file in which the type declaration appears must match the base of the name of the main
           compilation file.  In practice, this means that types declared in foo.c and  foo.h  will  have  debug
           information, but types declared in other header will not.  The value sys means those types satisfying
           base or declared in system or compiler headers.

           You may need to experiment to determine the best settings for your application.

           The default is -femit-struct-debug-detailed=all.

           This option works only with DWARF 2.

       -fenable-icf-debug
           Generate  additional  debug  information  to  support identical code folding (ICF).  This option only
           works with DWARF version 2 or higher.

       -fno-merge-debug-strings
           Direct the linker to not merge together strings in the debugging information which are  identical  in
           different  object  files.   Merging is not supported by all assemblers or linkers.  Merging decreases
           the size of the debug information in the output file at the cost of increasing link processing  time.
           Merging is enabled by default.

       -fdebug-prefix-map=old=new
           When  compiling  files  in  directory  old,  record  debugging  information describing them as in new
           instead.

       -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
           Emit DWARF 2 unwind info as compiler generated ".eh_frame" section  instead  of  using  GAS  ".cfi_*"
           directives.

       -p  Generate  extra  code  to write profile information suitable for the analysis program prof.  You must
           use this option when compiling the source files you want data about, and you must also  use  it  when
           linking.

       -pg Generate  extra  code to write profile information suitable for the analysis program gprof.  You must
           use this option when compiling the source files you want data about, and you must also  use  it  when
           linking.

       -Q  Makes  the  compiler  print out each function name as it is compiled, and print some statistics about
           each pass when it finishes.

       -ftime-report
           Makes the compiler print some statistics about the time consumed by each pass when it finishes.

       -fmem-report
           Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory allocation when it finishes.

       -fpre-ipa-mem-report
       -fpost-ipa-mem-report
           Makes the  compiler  print  some  statistics  about  permanent  memory  allocation  before  or  after
           interprocedural optimization.

       -fstack-usage
           Makes  the  compiler  output  stack  usage information for the program, on a per-function basis.  The
           filename for the dump is made by appending .su to the auxname.  auxname is generated from the name of
           the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not an executable, otherwise it is the basename of
           the source file.  An entry is made up of three fields:

           •   The name of the function.

           •   A number of bytes.

           •   One or more qualifiers: "static", "dynamic", "bounded".

           The qualifier "static" means that the function manipulates the stack statically: a  fixed  number  of
           bytes  are  allocated  for  the  frame  on  function  entry  and  released on function exit; no stack
           adjustments are otherwise made in the function.  The second field is this fixed number of bytes.

           The qualifier "dynamic" means that the function manipulates the stack dynamically: in addition to the
           static allocation described above, stack adjustments are made  in  the  body  of  the  function,  for
           example to push/pop arguments around function calls.  If the qualifier "bounded" is also present, the
           amount  of these adjustments is bounded at compile-time and the second field is an upper bound of the
           total amount of stack used by the function.  If it is not present, the amount of these adjustments is
           not bounded at compile-time and the second field only represents the bounded part.

       -fprofile-arcs
           Add code so that program flow arcs are instrumented.  During execution the program records  how  many
           times  each branch and call is executed and how many times it is taken or returns.  When the compiled
           program exits it saves this data to a file called auxname.gcda for each source file.  The data may be
           used for profile-directed optimizations  (-fbranch-probabilities),  or  for  test  coverage  analysis
           (-ftest-coverage).   Each  object  file's  auxname  is generated from the name of the output file, if
           explicitly specified and it is not the final executable, otherwise it is the basename of  the  source
           file.   In  both cases any suffix is removed (e.g. foo.gcda for input file dir/foo.c, or dir/foo.gcda
           for output file specified as -o dir/foo.o).

       --coverage
           This option is used to compile and link code instrumented for coverage analysis.   The  option  is  a
           synonym  for  -fprofile-arcs  -ftest-coverage  (when  compiling)  and -lgcov (when linking).  See the
           documentation for those options for more details.

           •   Compile the source files with -fprofile-arcs plus optimization and code generation options.   For
               test  coverage  analysis,  use the additional -ftest-coverage option.  You do not need to profile
               every source file in a program.

           •   Link your object files with -lgcov or -fprofile-arcs (the latter implies the former).

           •   Run the program on a representative workload to generate the arc profile information.   This  may
               be  repeated any number of times.  You can run concurrent instances of your program, and provided
               that the file system supports locking, the data files will be  correctly  updated.   Also  "fork"
               calls are detected and correctly handled (double counting will not happen).

           •   For profile-directed optimizations, compile the source files again with the same optimization and
               code generation options plus -fbranch-probabilities.

           •   For  test  coverage  analysis,  use gcov to produce human readable information from the .gcno and
               .gcda files.  Refer to the gcov documentation for further information.

           With -fprofile-arcs, for each function of your program GCC creates a program flow graph, then finds a
           spanning tree for the graph.  Only arcs that are not on the spanning tree have  to  be  instrumented:
           the compiler adds code to count the number of times that these arcs are executed.  When an arc is the
           only exit or only entrance to a block, the instrumentation code can be added to the block; otherwise,
           a new basic block must be created to hold the instrumentation code.

       -ftest-coverage
           Produce  a  notes  file  that  the gcov code-coverage utility can use to show program coverage.  Each
           source file's note file is called auxname.gcno.  Refer to  the  -fprofile-arcs  option  above  for  a
           description  of  auxname  and instructions on how to generate test coverage data.  Coverage data will
           match the source files more closely, if you do not optimize.

       -fdbg-cnt-list
           Print the name and the counter upper bound for all debug counters.

       -fdbg-cnt=counter-value-list
           Set the internal debug  counter  upper  bound.   counter-value-list  is  a  comma-separated  list  of
           name:value  pairs which sets the upper bound of each debug counter name to value.  All debug counters
           have the initial upper bound of UINT_MAX, thus dbg_cnt() returns true always unless the  upper  bound
           is set by this option.  e.g. With -fdbg-cnt=dce:10,tail_call:0 dbg_cnt(dce) will return true only for
           first 10 invocations and dbg_cnt(tail_call) will return false always.

       -dletters
       -fdump-rtl-pass
           Says  to  make  debugging  dumps  during compilation at times specified by letters.  This is used for
           debugging the RTL-based passes of the compiler.  The file names for most of the  dumps  are  made  by
           appending a pass number and a word to the dumpname, and the files are created in the directory of the
           output file.  Note that the pass number is computed statically as passes get registered into the pass
           manager.   Thus  the  numbering  is  not  related  to  the  dynamic order of execution of passes.  In
           particular, a pass installed by a plugin could have a number over  200  even  if  it  executed  quite
           early.  dumpname is generated from the name of the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not
           an  executable,  otherwise  it  is the basename of the source file. These switches may have different
           effects when -E is used for preprocessing.

           Debug dumps can be enabled with a -fdump-rtl switch or some -d option letters.  Here are the possible
           letters for use in pass and letters, and their meanings:

           -fdump-rtl-alignments
               Dump after branch alignments have been computed.

           -fdump-rtl-asmcons
               Dump after fixing rtl statements that have unsatisfied in/out constraints.

           -fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
               Dump after auto-inc-dec discovery.  This pass is only run on architectures that have auto inc  or
               auto dec instructions.

           -fdump-rtl-barriers
               Dump after cleaning up the barrier instructions.

           -fdump-rtl-bbpart
               Dump after partitioning hot and cold basic blocks.

           -fdump-rtl-bbro
               Dump after block reordering.

           -fdump-rtl-btl1
           -fdump-rtl-btl2
               -fdump-rtl-btl1  and -fdump-rtl-btl2 enable dumping after the two branch target load optimization
               passes.

           -fdump-rtl-bypass
               Dump after jump bypassing and control flow optimizations.

           -fdump-rtl-combine
               Dump after the RTL instruction combination pass.

           -fdump-rtl-compgotos
               Dump after duplicating the computed gotos.

           -fdump-rtl-ce1
           -fdump-rtl-ce2
           -fdump-rtl-ce3
               -fdump-rtl-ce1, -fdump-rtl-ce2, and -fdump-rtl-ce3 enable dumping after the three  if  conversion
               passes.

           -fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
               Dump after hard register copy propagation.

           -fdump-rtl-csa
               Dump after combining stack adjustments.

           -fdump-rtl-cse1
           -fdump-rtl-cse2
               -fdump-rtl-cse1   and   -fdump-rtl-cse2  enable  dumping  after  the  two  common  sub-expression
               elimination passes.

           -fdump-rtl-dce
               Dump after the standalone dead code elimination passes.

           -fdump-rtl-dbr
               Dump after delayed branch scheduling.

           -fdump-rtl-dce1
           -fdump-rtl-dce2
               -fdump-rtl-dce1 and -fdump-rtl-dce2 enable dumping after the two dead store elimination passes.

           -fdump-rtl-eh
               Dump after finalization of EH handling code.

           -fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
               Dump after conversion of EH handling range regions.

           -fdump-rtl-expand
               Dump after RTL generation.

           -fdump-rtl-fwprop1
           -fdump-rtl-fwprop2
               -fdump-rtl-fwprop1 and -fdump-rtl-fwprop2  enable  dumping  after  the  two  forward  propagation
               passes.

           -fdump-rtl-gcse1
           -fdump-rtl-gcse2
               -fdump-rtl-gcse1   and   -fdump-rtl-gcse2   enable  dumping  after  global  common  subexpression
               elimination.

           -fdump-rtl-init-regs
               Dump after the initialization of the registers.

           -fdump-rtl-initvals
               Dump after the computation of the initial value sets.

           -fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
               Dump after converting to cfglayout mode.

           -fdump-rtl-ira
               Dump after iterated register allocation.

           -fdump-rtl-jump
               Dump after the second jump optimization.

           -fdump-rtl-loop2
               -fdump-rtl-loop2 enables dumping after the rtl loop optimization passes.

           -fdump-rtl-mach
               Dump after performing the machine dependent reorganization pass, if that pass exists.

           -fdump-rtl-mode_sw
               Dump after removing redundant mode switches.

           -fdump-rtl-rnreg
               Dump after register renumbering.

           -fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
               Dump after converting from cfglayout mode.

           -fdump-rtl-peephole2
               Dump after the peephole pass.

           -fdump-rtl-postreload
               Dump after post-reload optimizations.

           -fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
               Dump after generating the function pro and epilogues.

           -fdump-rtl-regmove
               Dump after the register move pass.

           -fdump-rtl-sched1
           -fdump-rtl-sched2
               -fdump-rtl-sched1 and -fdump-rtl-sched2 enable dumping after the basic block scheduling passes.

           -fdump-rtl-see
               Dump after sign extension elimination.

           -fdump-rtl-seqabstr
               Dump after common sequence discovery.

           -fdump-rtl-shorten
               Dump after shortening branches.

           -fdump-rtl-sibling
               Dump after sibling call optimizations.

           -fdump-rtl-split1
           -fdump-rtl-split2
           -fdump-rtl-split3
           -fdump-rtl-split4
           -fdump-rtl-split5
               -fdump-rtl-split1, -fdump-rtl-split2, -fdump-rtl-split3, -fdump-rtl-split4 and  -fdump-rtl-split5
               enable dumping after five rounds of instruction splitting.

           -fdump-rtl-sms
               Dump after modulo scheduling.  This pass is only run on some architectures.

           -fdump-rtl-stack
               Dump  after  conversion  from  GCC's  "flat  register  file"  registers  to  the x87's stack-like
               registers.  This pass is only run on x86 variants.

           -fdump-rtl-subreg1
           -fdump-rtl-subreg2
               -fdump-rtl-subreg1 and -fdump-rtl-subreg2 enable dumping after the two subreg expansion passes.

           -fdump-rtl-unshare
               Dump after all rtl has been unshared.

           -fdump-rtl-vartrack
               Dump after variable tracking.

           -fdump-rtl-vregs
               Dump after converting virtual registers to hard registers.

           -fdump-rtl-web
               Dump after live range splitting.

           -fdump-rtl-regclass
           -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
           -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
           -fdump-rtl-dfinit
           -fdump-rtl-dfinish
               These dumps are defined but always produce empty files.

           -da
           -fdump-rtl-all
               Produce all the dumps listed above.

           -dA Annotate the assembler output with miscellaneous debugging information.

           -dD Dump all macro definitions, at the end of preprocessing, in addition to normal output.

           -dH Produce a core dump whenever an error occurs.

           -dp Annotate the assembler output with a comment indicating which pattern and alternative  was  used.
               The length of each instruction is also printed.

           -dP Dump  the  RTL  in  the assembler output as a comment before each instruction.  Also turns on -dp
               annotation.

           -dv For each of the other indicated dump  files  (-fdump-rtl-pass),  dump  a  representation  of  the
               control flow graph suitable for viewing with VCG to file.pass.vcg.

           -dx Just generate RTL for a function instead of compiling it.  Usually used with -fdump-rtl-expand.

       -fdump-noaddr
           When  doing  debugging  dumps,  suppress  address output.  This makes it more feasible to use diff on
           debugging dumps for compiler invocations with different compiler binaries and/or different text / bss
           / data / heap / stack / dso start locations.

       -fdump-unnumbered
           When doing debugging dumps, suppress instruction numbers and address  output.   This  makes  it  more
           feasible  to  use  diff  on  debugging  dumps  for  compiler  invocations  with different options, in
           particular with and without -g.

       -fdump-unnumbered-links
           When doing debugging dumps (see -d option above), suppress instruction numbers for the links  to  the
           previous and next instructions in a sequence.

       -fdump-translation-unit (C++ only)
       -fdump-translation-unit-options (C++ only)
           Dump a representation of the tree structure for the entire translation unit to a file.  The file name
           is  made  by  appending .tu to the source file name, and the file is created in the same directory as
           the output file.  If the -options form is used, options controls the details of the dump as described
           for the -fdump-tree options.

       -fdump-class-hierarchy (C++ only)
       -fdump-class-hierarchy-options (C++ only)
           Dump a representation of each class's hierarchy and virtual function table layout  to  a  file.   The
           file  name  is  made by appending .class to the source file name, and the file is created in the same
           directory as the output file.  If the -options form is used, options controls the details of the dump
           as described for the -fdump-tree options.

       -fdump-ipa-switch
           Control the dumping at various stages of inter-procedural analysis language tree to a file.  The file
           name is generated by appending a switch specific suffix to the source file  name,  and  the  file  is
           created in the same directory as the output file.  The following dumps are possible:

           all Enables all inter-procedural analysis dumps.

           cgraph
               Dumps information about call-graph optimization, unused function removal, and inlining decisions.

           inline
               Dump after function inlining.

       -fdump-statistics-option
           Enable  and  control  dumping  of  pass statistics in a separate file.  The file name is generated by
           appending a suffix ending in .statistics to the source file name, and the file is created in the same
           directory as the output file.  If the -option form is used, -stats will cause counters to  be  summed
           over  the  whole  compilation  unit while -details will dump every event as the passes generate them.
           The default with no option is to sum counters for each function compiled.

       -fdump-tree-switch
       -fdump-tree-switch-options
           Control the dumping at various stages of processing the intermediate language tree to  a  file.   The
           file name is generated by appending a switch specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is
           created in the same directory as the output file.  If the -options form is used, options is a list of
           -  separated  options  that  control  the details of the dump.  Not all options are applicable to all
           dumps, those which are not meaningful will be ignored.  The following options are available

           address
               Print the address of each node.  Usually this is not meaningful as it changes  according  to  the
               environment  and  source  file.   Its  primary  use  is  for  tying  up  a dump file with a debug
               environment.

           asmname
               If "DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME" has been set for  a  given  decl,  use  that  in  the  dump  instead  of
               "DECL_NAME".   Its primary use is ease of use working backward from mangled names in the assembly
               file.

           slim
               Inhibit dumping of members of a scope or body of a function merely because that  scope  has  been
               reached.  Only dump such items when they are directly reachable by some other path.  When dumping
               pretty-printed trees, this option inhibits dumping the bodies of control structures.

           raw Print  a  raw  representation  of  the  tree.  By default, trees are pretty-printed into a C-like
               representation.

           details
               Enable more detailed dumps (not honored by every dump option).

           stats
               Enable dumping various statistics about the pass (not honored by every dump option).

           blocks
               Enable showing basic block boundaries (disabled in raw dumps).

           vops
               Enable showing virtual operands for every statement.

           lineno
               Enable showing line numbers for statements.

           uid Enable showing the unique ID ("DECL_UID") for each variable.

           verbose
               Enable showing the tree dump for each statement.

           eh  Enable showing the EH region number holding each statement.

           all Turn on all options, except raw, slim, verbose and lineno.

           The following tree dumps are possible:

           original
               Dump before any tree based optimization, to file.original.

           optimized
               Dump after all tree based optimization, to file.optimized.

           gimple
               Dump each function before and after the gimplification pass to a file.  The file name is made  by
               appending .gimple to the source file name.

           cfg Dump  the control flow graph of each function to a file.  The file name is made by appending .cfg
               to the source file name.

           vcg Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file in VCG format.  The file name is  made  by
               appending  .vcg  to the source file name.  Note that if the file contains more than one function,
               the generated file cannot be used directly  by  VCG.   You  will  need  to  cut  and  paste  each
               function's graph into its own separate file first.

           ch  Dump  each  function  after  copying loop headers.  The file name is made by appending .ch to the
               source file name.

           ssa Dump SSA related information to a file.  The file name is made by appending .ssa  to  the  source
               file name.

           alias
               Dump  aliasing  information  for each function.  The file name is made by appending .alias to the
               source file name.

           ccp Dump each function after CCP.  The file name is made by appending .ccp to the source file name.

           storeccp
               Dump each function after STORE-CCP.  The file name is made by appending .storeccp to  the  source
               file name.

           pre Dump  trees after partial redundancy elimination.  The file name is made by appending .pre to the
               source file name.

           fre Dump trees after full redundancy elimination.  The file name is made by  appending  .fre  to  the
               source file name.

           copyprop
               Dump  trees  after  copy propagation.  The file name is made by appending .copyprop to the source
               file name.

           store_copyprop
               Dump trees after store copy-propagation.  The file name is made by appending  .store_copyprop  to
               the source file name.

           dce Dump  each  function after dead code elimination.  The file name is made by appending .dce to the
               source file name.

           mudflap
               Dump each function after adding mudflap instrumentation.  The file  name  is  made  by  appending
               .mudflap to the source file name.

           sra Dump  each  function after performing scalar replacement of aggregates.  The file name is made by
               appending .sra to the source file name.

           sink
               Dump each function after performing code sinking.  The file name is made by  appending  .sink  to
               the source file name.

           dom Dump  each  function  after  applying  dominator  tree  optimizations.   The file name is made by
               appending .dom to the source file name.

           dse Dump each function after applying dead store elimination.  The file name  is  made  by  appending
               .dse to the source file name.

           phiopt
               Dump  each  function after optimizing PHI nodes into straightline code.  The file name is made by
               appending .phiopt to the source file name.

           forwprop
               Dump each function after forward propagating single use variables.  The  file  name  is  made  by
               appending .forwprop to the source file name.

           copyrename
               Dump  each  function  after  applying  the  copy  rename  optimization.  The file name is made by
               appending .copyrename to the source file name.

           nrv Dump each function after applying the named return value optimization on generic trees.  The file
               name is made by appending .nrv to the source file name.

           vect
               Dump each function after applying vectorization of loops.  The file name  is  made  by  appending
               .vect to the source file name.

           slp Dump  each  function  after  applying  vectorization  of  basic blocks.  The file name is made by
               appending .slp to the source file name.

           vrp Dump each function after Value Range Propagation (VRP).  The file name is made by appending  .vrp
               to the source file name.

           all Enable all the available tree dumps with the flags provided in this option.

       -ftree-vectorizer-verbose=n
           This  option  controls  the  amount  of  debugging output the vectorizer prints.  This information is
           written to standard error, unless -fdump-tree-all or -fdump-tree-vect is specified, in which case  it
           is  output to the usual dump listing file, .vect.  For n=0 no diagnostic information is reported.  If
           n=1 the vectorizer reports each loop that got vectorized, and the total  number  of  loops  that  got
           vectorized.   If  n=2 the vectorizer also reports non-vectorized loops that passed the first analysis
           phase (vect_analyze_loop_form) - i.e.  countable,  inner-most,  single-bb,  single-entry/exit  loops.
           This  is  the  same  verbosity  level that -fdump-tree-vect-stats uses.  Higher verbosity levels mean
           either more information dumped for each reported loop, or same amount  of  information  reported  for
           more  loops:  if  n=3,  vectorizer  cost  model  information  is reported.  If n=4, alignment related
           information is added to the reports.   If  n=5,  data-references  related  information  (e.g.  memory
           dependences,  memory  access-patterns)  is added to the reports.  If n=6, the vectorizer reports also
           non-vectorized inner-most loops that did not  pass  the  first  analysis  phase  (i.e.,  may  not  be
           countable, or may have complicated control-flow).  If n=7, the vectorizer reports also non-vectorized
           nested loops.  If n=8, SLP related information is added to the reports.  For n=9, all the information
           the  vectorizer  generates  during  its  analysis  and  transformation is reported.  This is the same
           verbosity level that -fdump-tree-vect-details uses.

       -frandom-seed=string
           This option provides a seed that GCC uses when it would otherwise use random numbers.  It is used  to
           generate  certain  symbol names that have to be different in every compiled file.  It is also used to
           place unique stamps in coverage data files and the object files that produce them.  You can  use  the
           -frandom-seed option to produce reproducibly identical object files.

           The string should be different for every file you compile.

       -fsched-verbose=n
           On  targets  that use instruction scheduling, this option controls the amount of debugging output the
           scheduler prints.  This information  is  written  to  standard  error,  unless  -fdump-rtl-sched1  or
           -fdump-rtl-sched2 is specified, in which case it is output to the usual dump listing file, .sched1 or
           .sched2  respectively.   However  for  n  greater than nine, the output is always printed to standard
           error.

           For n greater than zero, -fsched-verbose  outputs  the  same  information  as  -fdump-rtl-sched1  and
           -fdump-rtl-sched2.   For n greater than one, it also output basic block probabilities, detailed ready
           list information and unit/insn info.  For n greater  than  two,  it  includes  RTL  at  abort  point,
           control-flow and regions info.  And for n over four, -fsched-verbose also includes dependence info.

       -save-temps
       -save-temps=cwd
           Store  the  usual "temporary" intermediate files permanently; place them in the current directory and
           name them based on the source file.  Thus, compiling foo.c with -c -save-temps  would  produce  files
           foo.i  and  foo.s,  as  well as foo.o.  This creates a preprocessed foo.i output file even though the
           compiler now normally uses an integrated preprocessor.

           When used in combination with the -x command line option, -save-temps is  sensible  enough  to  avoid
           over writing an input source file with the same extension as an intermediate file.  The corresponding
           intermediate file may be obtained by renaming the source file before using -save-temps.

           If you invoke GCC in parallel, compiling several different source files that share a common base name
           in  different subdirectories or the same source file compiled for multiple output destinations, it is
           likely that the different parallel compilers will  interfere  with  each  other,  and  overwrite  the
           temporary files.  For instance:

                   gcc -save-temps -o outdir1/foo.o indir1/foo.c&
                   gcc -save-temps -o outdir2/foo.o indir2/foo.c&

           may result in foo.i and foo.o being written to simultaneously by both compilers.

       -save-temps=obj
           Store  the usual "temporary" intermediate files permanently.  If the -o option is used, the temporary
           files are based on the object file.  If the -o option is not used, the -save-temps=obj switch behaves
           like -save-temps.

           For example:

                   gcc -save-temps=obj -c foo.c
                   gcc -save-temps=obj -c bar.c -o dir/xbar.o
                   gcc -save-temps=obj foobar.c -o dir2/yfoobar

           would  create   foo.i,   foo.s,   dir/xbar.i,   dir/xbar.s,   dir2/yfoobar.i,   dir2/yfoobar.s,   and
           dir2/yfoobar.o.

       -time[=file]
           Report  the  CPU time taken by each subprocess in the compilation sequence.  For C source files, this
           is the compiler proper and assembler (plus the linker if linking is done).

           Without the specification of an output file, the output looks like this:

                   # cc1 0.12 0.01
                   # as 0.00 0.01

           The first number on each line is the "user time", that is time spent executing  the  program  itself.
           The  second  number is "system time", time spent executing operating system routines on behalf of the
           program.  Both numbers are in seconds.

           With the specification of an output file, the output is appended to the named file, and it looks like
           this:

                   0.12 0.01 cc1 <options>
                   0.00 0.01 as <options>

           The "user time" and the "system time" are moved before the program name, and the  options  passed  to
           the  program  are  displayed, so that one can later tell what file was being compiled, and with which
           options.

       -fvar-tracking
           Run variable tracking pass.  It computes where variables are stored at each position in code.  Better
           debugging  information  is  then  generated  (if  the  debugging  information  format  supports  this
           information).

           It  is enabled by default when compiling with optimization (-Os, -O, -O2, ...), debugging information
           (-g) and the debug info format supports it.

       -fvar-tracking-assignments
           Annotate assignments to user variables early in the compilation and attempt to carry the  annotations
           over  throughout  the  compilation all the way to the end, in an attempt to improve debug information
           while optimizing.  Use of -gdwarf-4 is recommended along with it.

           It can be enabled even if var-tracking is disabled, in which case annotations  will  be  created  and
           maintained, but discarded at the end.

       -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
           Toggle -fvar-tracking-assignments, in the same way that -gtoggle toggles -g.

       -print-file-name=library
           Print  the full absolute name of the library file library that would be used when linking---and don't
           do anything else.  With this option, GCC does not compile or link anything; it just prints  the  file
           name.

       -print-multi-directory
           Print  the directory name corresponding to the multilib selected by any other switches present in the
           command line.  This directory is supposed to exist in GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.

       -print-multi-lib
           Print the mapping from multilib directory names to compiler switches that enable them.  The directory
           name is separated from the switches by ;, and each switch starts with an @ instead of the -,  without
           spaces between multiple switches.  This is supposed to ease shell-processing.

       -print-multi-os-directory
           Print  the  path to OS libraries for the selected multilib, relative to some lib subdirectory.  If OS
           libraries are present in the lib subdirectory and no multilibs are used, this is usually just  .,  if
           OS  libraries  are  present  in  libsuffix  sibling  directories this prints e.g. ../lib64, ../lib or
           ../lib32, or if OS libraries are present in lib/subdir subdirectories it prints e.g.  amd64,  sparcv9
           or ev6.

       -print-multiarch
           Print the path to OS libraries for the selected multiarch, relative to some lib subdirectory.

       -print-prog-name=program
           Like -print-file-name, but searches for a program such as cpp.

       -print-libgcc-file-name
           Same as -print-file-name=libgcc.a.

           This  is  useful when you use -nostdlib or -nodefaultlibs but you do want to link with libgcc.a.  You
           can do

                   gcc -nostdlib <files>... `gcc -print-libgcc-file-name`

       -print-search-dirs
           Print the name of the configured installation directory and a list of program and library directories
           gcc will search---and don't do anything else.

           This is useful when gcc prints the error message installation problem, cannot exec cpp0: No such file
           or directory.  To resolve this you either need to put cpp0 and the other  compiler  components  where
           gcc  expects  to  find them, or you can set the environment variable GCC_EXEC_PREFIX to the directory
           where you installed them.  Don't forget the trailing /.

       -print-sysroot
           Print the target sysroot directory that will be used during compilation.  This is the target  sysroot
           specified  either at configure time or using the --sysroot option, possibly with an extra suffix that
           depends on compilation options.  If no target sysroot is specified, the option prints nothing.

       -print-sysroot-headers-suffix
           Print the suffix added to the target sysroot when searching for headers, or  give  an  error  if  the
           compiler is not configured with such a suffix---and don't do anything else.

       -dumpmachine
           Print the compiler's target machine (for example, i686-pc-linux-gnu)---and don't do anything else.

       -dumpversion
           Print the compiler version (for example, 3.0)---and don't do anything else.

       -dumpspecs
           Print  the  compiler's built-in specs---and don't do anything else.  (This is used when GCC itself is
           being built.)

       -feliminate-unused-debug-types
           Normally, when producing DWARF2 output, GCC will emit debugging information for all types declared in
           a compilation unit, regardless of whether or not they are actually used  in  that  compilation  unit.
           Sometimes this is useful, such as if, in the debugger, you want to cast a value to a type that is not
           actually  used in your program (but is declared).  More often, however, this results in a significant
           amount of wasted space.  With this option, GCC will avoid producing debug  symbol  output  for  types
           that are nowhere used in the source file being compiled.

   Options That Control Optimization
       These options control various sorts of optimizations.

       Without  any  optimization  option,  the compiler's goal is to reduce the cost of compilation and to make
       debugging produce the expected results.  Statements are independent: if  you  stop  the  program  with  a
       breakpoint  between  statements,  you  can  then assign a new value to any variable or change the program
       counter to any other statement in the function and get exactly the results  you  would  expect  from  the
       source code.

       Turning  on  optimization flags makes the compiler attempt to improve the performance and/or code size at
       the expense of compilation time and possibly the ability to debug the program.

       The compiler performs optimization based on the knowledge it has  of  the  program.   Compiling  multiple
       files  at once to a single output file mode allows the compiler to use information gained from all of the
       files when compiling each of them.

       Not all optimizations are controlled directly by a flag.  Only optimizations that have a flag are  listed
       in this section.

       Most  optimizations  are  only  enabled  if  an  -O level is set on the command line.  Otherwise they are
       disabled, even if individual optimization flags are specified.

       Depending on the target and how GCC was configured, a slightly different  set  of  optimizations  may  be
       enabled  at  each  -O level than those listed here.  You can invoke GCC with -Q --help=optimizers to find
       out the exact set of optimizations that are enabled at each level.

       -O
       -O1 Optimize.  Optimizing compilation takes somewhat more time,  and  a  lot  more  memory  for  a  large
           function.

           With  -O,  the  compiler  tries  to  reduce  code  size  and  execution  time, without performing any
           optimizations that take a great deal of compilation time.

           -O turns on the following optimization flags:

           -fauto-inc-dec   -fcompare-elim   -fcprop-registers   -fdce   -fdefer-pop   -fdelayed-branch    -fdse
           -fguess-branch-probability    -fif-conversion2    -fif-conversion    -fipa-pure-const   -fipa-profile
           -fipa-reference   -fmerge-constants   -fsplit-wide-types    -ftree-bit-ccp    -ftree-builtin-call-dce
           -ftree-ccp  -ftree-ch  -ftree-copyrename  -ftree-dce -ftree-dominator-opts -ftree-dse -ftree-forwprop
           -ftree-fre -ftree-phiprop -ftree-sra -ftree-pta -ftree-ter -funit-at-a-time

           -O also turns on -fomit-frame-pointer on machines where doing so does not interfere with debugging.

       -O2 Optimize even more.  GCC performs nearly all supported optimizations that do  not  involve  a  space-
           speed  tradeoff.   As compared to -O, this option increases both compilation time and the performance
           of the generated code.

           -O2 turns on all optimization flags specified by -O.  It also turns  on  the  following  optimization
           flags:  -fthread-jumps  -falign-functions  -falign-jumps -falign-loops  -falign-labels -fcaller-saves
           -fcrossjumping  -fcse-follow-jumps   -fcse-skip-blocks  -fdelete-null-pointer-checks   -fdevirtualize
           -fexpensive-optimizations  -fgcse   -fgcse-lm  -finline-small-functions -findirect-inlining -fipa-sra
           -foptimize-sibling-calls     -fpartial-inlining      -fpeephole2      -fregmove      -freorder-blocks
           -freorder-functions    -frerun-cse-after-loop   -fsched-interblock    -fsched-spec   -fschedule-insns
           -fschedule-insns2 -fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-pre -ftree-vrp

           Please note the warning under -fgcse about invoking -O2 on programs that use computed gotos.

           NOTE: In Ubuntu 8.10 and later versions, -D_FORTIFY_SOURCE=2 is set by default, and is activated when
           -O is set to 2 or higher.  This enables additional compile-time and run-time checks for several  libc
           functions.  To disable, specify either -U_FORTIFY_SOURCE or -D_FORTIFY_SOURCE=0.

       -O3 Optimize  yet  more.   -O3  turns  on  all  optimizations  specified  by  -O2  and  also turns on the
           -finline-functions, -funswitch-loops, -fpredictive-commoning,  -fgcse-after-reload,  -ftree-vectorize
           and -fipa-cp-clone options.

       -O0 Reduce compilation time and make debugging produce the expected results.  This is the default.

       -Os Optimize  for  size.  -Os enables all -O2 optimizations that do not typically increase code size.  It
           also performs further optimizations designed to reduce code size.

           -Os disables  the  following  optimization  flags:  -falign-functions   -falign-jumps   -falign-loops
           -falign-labels       -freorder-blocks       -freorder-blocks-and-partition     -fprefetch-loop-arrays
           -ftree-vect-loop-version

       -Ofast
           Disregard strict standards compliance.  -Ofast  enables  all  -O3  optimizations.   It  also  enables
           optimizations that are not valid for all standard compliant programs.  It turns on -ffast-math.

           If  you  use multiple -O options, with or without level numbers, the last such option is the one that
           is effective.

       Options of the form -fflag specify machine-independent flags.  Most flags have both positive and negative
       forms; the negative form of -ffoo would be -fno-foo.  In the table  below,  only  one  of  the  forms  is
       listed---the  one  you  typically  will use.  You can figure out the other form by either removing no- or
       adding it.

       The following options control specific optimizations.  They are either activated by  -O  options  or  are
       related  to  ones  that  are.   You  can  use the following flags in the rare cases when "fine-tuning" of
       optimizations to be performed is desired.

       -fno-default-inline
           Do not make member functions inline by default merely because they are defined inside the class scope
           (C++ only).  Otherwise, when you specify -O, member functions defined inside class scope are compiled
           inline by default; i.e., you don't need to add inline in front of the member function name.

       -fno-defer-pop
           Always pop the arguments to each function call as soon as that function returns.  For machines  which
           must  pop  arguments  after  a  function call, the compiler normally lets arguments accumulate on the
           stack for several function calls and pops them all at once.

           Disabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fforward-propagate
           Perform a forward propagation pass on RTL.  The pass tries to combine two instructions and checks  if
           the  result  can be simplified.  If loop unrolling is active, two passes are performed and the second
           is scheduled after loop unrolling.

           This option is enabled by default at optimization levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -ffp-contract=style
           -ffp-contract=off  disables  floating-point  expression  contraction.    -ffp-contract=fast   enables
           floating-point  expression contraction such as forming of fused multiply-add operations if the target
           has native support for them.   -ffp-contract=on  enables  floating-point  expression  contraction  if
           allowed  by  the  language  standard.   This  is  currently  not  implemented  and  treated  equal to
           -ffp-contract=off.

           The default is -ffp-contract=fast.

       -fomit-frame-pointer
           Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for functions  that  don't  need  one.   This  avoids  the
           instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers; it also makes an extra register available in
           many functions.  It also makes debugging impossible on some machines.

           On  some  machines,  such  as the VAX, this flag has no effect, because the standard calling sequence
           automatically handles the frame pointer and nothing is saved by pretending  it  doesn't  exist.   The
           machine-description  macro  "FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED"  controls whether a target machine supports this
           flag.

           Starting with GCC version 4.6, the default setting (when not optimizing for size)  for  32-bit  Linux
           x86  and  32-bit  Darwin  x86  targets  has been changed to -fomit-frame-pointer.  The default can be
           reverted to -fno-omit-frame-pointer by configuring  GCC  with  the  --enable-frame-pointer  configure
           option.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -foptimize-sibling-calls
           Optimize sibling and tail recursive calls.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fno-inline
           Don't  pay attention to the "inline" keyword.  Normally this option is used to keep the compiler from
           expanding any functions inline.  Note that if you are not optimizing, no functions  can  be  expanded
           inline.

       -finline-small-functions
           Integrate  functions  into  their callers when their body is smaller than expected function call code
           (so overall size of program gets smaller).  The compiler heuristically decides  which  functions  are
           simple enough to be worth integrating in this way.

           Enabled at level -O2.

       -findirect-inlining
           Inline  also  indirect  calls  that  are  discovered  to  be known at compile time thanks to previous
           inlining.   This  option  has  any  effect  only  when  inlining  itself  is   turned   on   by   the
           -finline-functions or -finline-small-functions options.

           Enabled at level -O2.

       -finline-functions
           Integrate  all  simple  functions  into  their  callers.   The  compiler  heuristically decides which
           functions are simple enough to be worth integrating in this way.

           If all calls to a given function are integrated, and the function  is  declared  "static",  then  the
           function is normally not output as assembler code in its own right.

           Enabled at level -O3.

       -finline-functions-called-once
           Consider  all  "static"  functions  called  once  for inlining into their caller even if they are not
           marked "inline".  If a call to a given function is integrated, then the function  is  not  output  as
           assembler code in its own right.

           Enabled at levels -O1, -O2, -O3 and -Os.

       -fearly-inlining
           Inline  functions  marked by "always_inline" and functions whose body seems smaller than the function
           call overhead early before doing -fprofile-generate instrumentation and real inlining pass.  Doing so
           makes profiling significantly cheaper and usually inlining faster on programs having large chains  of
           nested wrapper functions.

           Enabled by default.

       -fipa-sra
           Perform   interprocedural  scalar  replacement  of  aggregates,  removal  of  unused  parameters  and
           replacement of parameters passed by reference by parameters passed by value.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3 and -Os.

       -finline-limit=n
           By default, GCC limits the size of functions that can be inlined.  This flag allows coarse control of
           this limit.  n is the size of functions that can be inlined in number of pseudo instructions.

           Inlining is actually controlled by a number of parameters, which may  be  specified  individually  by
           using --param name=value.  The -finline-limit=n option sets some of these parameters as follows:

           max-inline-insns-single
               is set to n/2.

           max-inline-insns-auto
               is set to n/2.

           See  below for a documentation of the individual parameters controlling inlining and for the defaults
           of these parameters.

           Note: there may be no value to -finline-limit that results in default behavior.

           Note: pseudo  instruction  represents,  in  this  particular  context,  an  abstract  measurement  of
           function's  size.  In no way does it represent a count of assembly instructions and as such its exact
           meaning might change from one release to an another.

       -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
           This is a more fine-grained version of -fkeep-inline-functions, which applies only to functions  that
           are declared using the "dllexport" attribute or declspec

       -fkeep-inline-functions
           In  C,  emit "static" functions that are declared "inline" into the object file, even if the function
           has been inlined into all of its callers.  This switch does not affect functions  using  the  "extern
           inline" extension in GNU C90.  In C++, emit any and all inline functions into the object file.

       -fkeep-static-consts
           Emit  variables  declared  "static  const"  when  optimization isn't turned on, even if the variables
           aren't referenced.

           GCC enables this option by default.  If you want to force the compiler to check if the  variable  was
           referenced,  regardless  of whether or not optimization is turned on, use the -fno-keep-static-consts
           option.

       -fmerge-constants
           Attempt to  merge  identical  constants  (string  constants  and  floating  point  constants)  across
           compilation units.

           This  option  is  the  default for optimized compilation if the assembler and linker support it.  Use
           -fno-merge-constants to inhibit this behavior.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fmerge-all-constants
           Attempt to merge identical constants and identical variables.

           This option implies -fmerge-constants.  In addition to -fmerge-constants  this  considers  e.g.  even
           constant  initialized arrays or initialized constant variables with integral or floating point types.
           Languages like C or C++ require each variable, including multiple instances of the same  variable  in
           recursive  calls,  to  have  distinct  locations,  so using this option will result in non-conforming
           behavior.

       -fmodulo-sched
           Perform swing modulo scheduling immediately before the first scheduling pass.   This  pass  looks  at
           innermost loops and reorders their instructions by overlapping different iterations.

       -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
           Perform  more  aggressive  SMS  based modulo scheduling with register moves allowed.  By setting this
           flag certain anti-dependences edges will be deleted which will trigger the  generation  of  reg-moves
           based on the life-range analysis.  This option is effective only with -fmodulo-sched enabled.

       -fno-branch-count-reg
           Do  not  use "decrement and branch" instructions on a count register, but instead generate a sequence
           of instructions that decrement a register, compare it  against  zero,  then  branch  based  upon  the
           result.   This  option  is  only  meaningful  on  architectures that support such instructions, which
           include x86, PowerPC, IA-64 and S/390.

           The default is -fbranch-count-reg.

       -fno-function-cse
           Do not put function addresses in registers; make each instruction  that  calls  a  constant  function
           contain the function's address explicitly.

           This  option  results  in less efficient code, but some strange hacks that alter the assembler output
           may be confused by the optimizations performed when this option is not used.

           The default is -ffunction-cse

       -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
           If the target supports a BSS section, GCC by default puts variables that are initialized to zero into
           BSS.  This can save space in the resulting code.

           This option turns off this behavior because some programs explicitly rely on variables going  to  the
           data  section.   E.g., so that the resulting executable can find the beginning of that section and/or
           make assumptions based on that.

           The default is -fzero-initialized-in-bss.

       -fmudflap -fmudflapth -fmudflapir
           For front-ends that support  it  (C  and  C++),  instrument  all  risky  pointer/array  dereferencing
           operations,  some  standard  library string/heap functions, and some other associated constructs with
           range/validity tests.  Modules so instrumented should be immune to  buffer  overflows,  invalid  heap
           use,  and  some  other classes of C/C++ programming errors.  The instrumentation relies on a separate
           runtime library (libmudflap), which will be linked into a program if -fmudflap is given at link time.
           Run-time behavior of the instrumented  program  is  controlled  by  the  MUDFLAP_OPTIONS  environment
           variable.  See "env MUDFLAP_OPTIONS=-help a.out" for its options.

           Use  -fmudflapth  instead of -fmudflap to compile and to link if your program is multi-threaded.  Use
           -fmudflapir, in addition to -fmudflap or -fmudflapth, if instrumentation should ignore pointer reads.
           This produces  less  instrumentation  (and  therefore  faster  execution)  and  still  provides  some
           protection  against  outright memory corrupting writes, but allows erroneously read data to propagate
           within a program.

       -fthread-jumps
           Perform optimizations where we check to see if a jump branches to a location where another comparison
           subsumed by the first is found.  If so, the first branch is redirected to either the  destination  of
           the second branch or a point immediately following it, depending on whether the condition is known to
           be true or false.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fsplit-wide-types
           When using a type that occupies multiple registers, such as "long long" on a 32-bit system, split the
           registers  apart  and  allocate  them  independently.   This normally generates better code for those
           types, but may make debugging more difficult.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fcse-follow-jumps
           In common subexpression elimination (CSE), scan through jump instructions when the target of the jump
           is not reached by any other path.  For example, when CSE encounters an "if" statement with an  "else"
           clause, CSE will follow the jump when the condition tested is false.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fcse-skip-blocks
           This  is  similar to -fcse-follow-jumps, but causes CSE to follow jumps which conditionally skip over
           blocks.  When CSE encounters a simple "if" statement with no else  clause,  -fcse-skip-blocks  causes
           CSE to follow the jump around the body of the "if".

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -frerun-cse-after-loop
           Re-run common subexpression elimination after loop optimizations has been performed.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fgcse
           Perform  a global common subexpression elimination pass.  This pass also performs global constant and
           copy propagation.

           Note: When compiling a program using computed gotos, a GCC extension,  you  may  get  better  runtime
           performance  if  you  disable the global common subexpression elimination pass by adding -fno-gcse to
           the command line.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fgcse-lm
           When -fgcse-lm is enabled, global common subexpression elimination will attempt to move  loads  which
           are only killed by stores into themselves.  This allows a loop containing a load/store sequence to be
           changed to a load outside the loop, and a copy/store within the loop.

           Enabled by default when gcse is enabled.

       -fgcse-sm
           When  -fgcse-sm is enabled, a store motion pass is run after global common subexpression elimination.
           This pass will attempt to move stores out of loops.  When used in conjunction with  -fgcse-lm,  loops
           containing a load/store sequence can be changed to a load before the loop and a store after the loop.

           Not enabled at any optimization level.

       -fgcse-las
           When  -fgcse-las  is  enabled,  the global common subexpression elimination pass eliminates redundant
           loads that come after stores to the same memory location (both partial and full redundancies).

           Not enabled at any optimization level.

       -fgcse-after-reload
           When -fgcse-after-reload is enabled, a redundant load elimination pass  is  performed  after  reload.
           The purpose of this pass is to cleanup redundant spilling.

       -funsafe-loop-optimizations
           If  given,  the loop optimizer will assume that loop indices do not overflow, and that the loops with
           nontrivial exit condition are not infinite.  This enables a wider range of loop optimizations even if
           the   loop   optimizer   itself   cannot   prove   that   these   assumptions   are   valid.    Using
           -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations, the compiler will warn you if it finds this kind of loop.

       -fcrossjumping
           Perform  cross-jumping  transformation.   This  transformation  unifies equivalent code and save code
           size.  The resulting code may or may not perform better than without cross-jumping.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fauto-inc-dec
           Combine increments or decrements of addresses with memory accesses.  This pass is always  skipped  on
           architectures  that do not have instructions to support this.  Enabled by default at -O and higher on
           architectures that support this.

       -fdce
           Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on RTL.  Enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fdse
           Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on RTL.  Enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fif-conversion
           Attempt to transform conditional jumps into branch-less equivalents.  This include use of conditional
           moves, min, max, set flags and abs instructions, and some tricks doable by standard arithmetics.  The
           use of conditional execution on chips where it is available is controlled by "if-conversion2".

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fif-conversion2
           Use  conditional  execution  (where  available)  to  transform  conditional  jumps  into  branch-less
           equivalents.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
           Assume  that  programs  cannot  safely  dereference  null  pointers, and that no code or data element
           resides there.  This enables simple constant folding optimizations at all  optimization  levels.   In
           addition,  other  optimization  passes  in GCC use this flag to control global dataflow analyses that
           eliminate useless checks for null pointers; these assume that if a pointer is checked  after  it  has
           already been dereferenced, it cannot be null.

           Note    however    that    in    some    environments    this    assumption   is   not   true.    Use
           -fno-delete-null-pointer-checks to disable this  optimization  for  programs  which  depend  on  that
           behavior.

           Some  targets,  especially embedded ones, disable this option at all levels.  Otherwise it is enabled
           at all levels: -O0, -O1, -O2, -O3, -Os.  Passes that use the information are enabled independently at
           different optimization levels.

       -fdevirtualize
           Attempt to convert calls to virtual functions to direct calls.  This is done both within a  procedure
           and  interprocedurally  as  part  of  indirect  inlining  ("-findirect-inlining") and interprocedural
           constant propagation (-fipa-cp).  Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fexpensive-optimizations
           Perform a number of minor optimizations that are relatively expensive.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -foptimize-register-move
       -fregmove
           Attempt to  reassign  register  numbers  in  move  instructions  and  as  operands  of  other  simple
           instructions  in  order  to  maximize  the  amount  of register tying.  This is especially helpful on
           machines with two-operand instructions.

           Note -fregmove and -foptimize-register-move are the same optimization.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fira-algorithm=algorithm
           Use specified coloring algorithm for the  integrated  register  allocator.   The  algorithm  argument
           should be "priority" or "CB".  The first algorithm specifies Chow's priority coloring, the second one
           specifies Chaitin-Briggs coloring.  The second algorithm can be unimplemented for some architectures.
           If  it is implemented, it is the default because Chaitin-Briggs coloring as a rule generates a better
           code.

       -fira-region=region
           Use specified regions for the integrated register allocator.  The region argument should  be  one  of
           "all",  "mixed", or "one".  The first value means using all loops as register allocation regions, the
           second value which is the default means using all loops except for loops with small register pressure
           as the regions, and third one means using all function as a single region.  The first value can  give
           best  result for machines with small size and irregular register set, the third one results in faster
           and generates decent code and the smallest size code, and the default value  usually  give  the  best
           results in most cases and for most architectures.

       -fira-loop-pressure
           Use  IRA  to evaluate register pressure in loops for decision to move loop invariants.  Usage of this
           option usually results in generation of faster and smaller code on machines with big  register  files
           (>= 32 registers) but it can slow compiler down.

           This option is enabled at level -O3 for some targets.

       -fno-ira-share-save-slots
           Switch  off sharing stack slots used for saving call used hard registers living through a call.  Each
           hard register will get a separate stack slot and as a result function stack frame will be bigger.

       -fno-ira-share-spill-slots
           Switch off sharing stack slots allocated for pseudo-registers.  Each pseudo-register  which  did  not
           get  a  hard  register  will  get  a separate stack slot and as a result function stack frame will be
           bigger.

       -fira-verbose=n
           Set up how verbose dump file for the integrated register allocator will be.  Default value is 5.   If
           the value is greater or equal to 10, the dump file will be stderr as if the value were n minus 10.

       -fdelayed-branch
           If  supported  for  the  target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to exploit instruction slots
           available after delayed branch instructions.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fschedule-insns
           If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to  eliminate  execution  stalls
           due  to required data being unavailable.  This helps machines that have slow floating point or memory
           load instructions by allowing other instructions to be  issued  until  the  result  of  the  load  or
           floating point instruction is required.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -fschedule-insns2
           Similar to -fschedule-insns, but requests an additional pass of instruction scheduling after register
           allocation  has  been  done.  This is especially useful on machines with a relatively small number of
           registers and where memory load instructions take more than one cycle.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fno-sched-interblock
           Don't schedule instructions across basic blocks.  This is normally enabled by default when scheduling
           before register allocation, i.e.  with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.

       -fno-sched-spec
           Don't allow speculative motion of non-load instructions.  This is normally enabled  by  default  when
           scheduling before register allocation, i.e.  with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-pressure
           Enable  register  pressure sensitive insn scheduling before the register allocation.  This only makes
           sense when scheduling before register allocation is enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or at -O2  or
           higher.   Usage  of  this  option  can improve the generated code and decrease its size by preventing
           register pressure increase above the number of available hard registers and as a consequence register
           spills in the register allocation.

       -fsched-spec-load
           Allow speculative motion of some load instructions.  This only makes  sense  when  scheduling  before
           register allocation, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
           Allow  speculative  motion  of  more load instructions.  This only makes sense when scheduling before
           register allocation, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-stalled-insns
       -fsched-stalled-insns=n
           Define how many insns (if any) can be moved prematurely from the queue  of  stalled  insns  into  the
           ready  list, during the second scheduling pass.  -fno-sched-stalled-insns means that no insns will be
           moved prematurely, -fsched-stalled-insns=0 means there is no limit on how many queued  insns  can  be
           moved prematurely.  -fsched-stalled-insns without a value is equivalent to -fsched-stalled-insns=1.

       -fsched-stalled-insns-dep
       -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=n
           Define  how  many  insn  groups  (cycles) will be examined for a dependency on a stalled insn that is
           candidate for premature removal from the queue of stalled insns.  This has an effect only during  the
           second  scheduling  pass, and only if -fsched-stalled-insns is used.  -fno-sched-stalled-insns-dep is
           equivalent to -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=0.  -fsched-stalled-insns-dep without a value  is  equivalent
           to -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=1.

       -fsched2-use-superblocks
           When  scheduling  after  register  allocation,  do  use  superblock scheduling algorithm.  Superblock
           scheduling allows motion across basic block boundaries resulting on faster schedules.  This option is
           experimental, as not all machine descriptions used by GCC model  the  CPU  closely  enough  to  avoid
           unreliable results from the algorithm.

           This  only  makes  sense when scheduling after register allocation, i.e. with -fschedule-insns2 or at
           -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-group-heuristic
           Enable the group heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors the instruction that belongs to a
           schedule group.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or
           -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-critical-path-heuristic
           Enable the critical-path heuristic in the scheduler.   This  heuristic  favors  instructions  on  the
           critical  path.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or
           -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
           Enable the speculative instruction heuristic in the scheduler.   This  heuristic  favors  speculative
           instructions  with  greater  dependency  weakness.   This  is  enabled  by default when scheduling is
           enabled, i.e.  with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-rank-heuristic
           Enable the rank heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors the  instruction  belonging  to  a
           basic  block  with greater size or frequency.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled,
           i.e.  with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-last-insn-heuristic
           Enable the last-instruction heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors the  instruction  that
           is  less  dependent on the last instruction scheduled.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is
           enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-dep-count-heuristic
           Enable the dependent-count heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors  the  instruction  that
           has  more  instructions depending on it.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.
           with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
           The modulo scheduling comes before the traditional scheduling, if a loop was modulo scheduled we  may
           want to prevent the later scheduling passes from changing its schedule, we use this option to control
           that.

       -fselective-scheduling
           Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective scheduling runs instead of the
           first scheduler pass.

       -fselective-scheduling2
           Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective scheduling runs instead of the
           second scheduler pass.

       -fsel-sched-pipelining
           Enable software pipelining of innermost loops during selective scheduling.  This option has no effect
           until one of -fselective-scheduling or -fselective-scheduling2 is turned on.

       -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
           When  pipelining  loops  during  selective scheduling, also pipeline outer loops.  This option has no
           effect until -fsel-sched-pipelining is turned on.

       -fcaller-saves
           Enable values to be allocated in registers that will be clobbered  by  function  calls,  by  emitting
           extra instructions to save and restore the registers around such calls.  Such allocation is done only
           when it seems to result in better code than would otherwise be produced.

           This  option  is  always  enabled  by  default on certain machines, usually those which have no call-
           preserved registers to use instead.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fcombine-stack-adjustments
           Tracks stack adjustments (pushes and pops) and stack memory references and then tries to find ways to
           combine them.

           Enabled by default at -O1 and higher.

       -fconserve-stack
           Attempt to minimize stack usage.  The compiler will attempt to use less stack  space,  even  if  that
           makes the program slower.  This option implies setting the large-stack-frame parameter to 100 and the
           large-stack-frame-growth parameter to 400.

       -ftree-reassoc
           Perform reassociation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-pre
           Perform  partial  redundancy  elimination (PRE) on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and
           -O3.

       -ftree-forwprop
           Perform forward propagation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-fre
           Perform full redundancy elimination (FRE) on trees.  The difference between FRE and PRE is  that  FRE
           only considers expressions that are computed on all paths leading to the redundant computation.  This
           analysis  is  faster than PRE, though it exposes fewer redundancies.  This flag is enabled by default
           at -O and higher.

       -ftree-phiprop
           Perform hoisting of loads from conditional pointers on trees.  This pass is enabled by default at  -O
           and higher.

       -ftree-copy-prop
           Perform  copy  propagation on trees.  This pass eliminates unnecessary copy operations.  This flag is
           enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fipa-pure-const
           Discover which functions are pure or constant.  Enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fipa-reference
           Discover which static variables do not escape cannot escape the compilation unit.  Enabled by default
           at -O and higher.

       -fipa-struct-reorg
           Perform structure reorganization optimization, that change  C-like  structures  layout  in  order  to
           better  utilize spatial locality.  This transformation is affective for programs containing arrays of
           structures.  Available in two compilation modes: profile-based (enabled with  -fprofile-generate)  or
           static  (which  uses  built-in  heuristics).   It  works  only  in whole program mode, so it requires
           -fwhole-program to be enabled.  Structures considered cold by this transformation  are  not  affected
           (see --param struct-reorg-cold-struct-ratio=value).

           With this flag, the program debug info reflects a new structure layout.

       -fipa-pta
           Perform  interprocedural  pointer  analysis  and interprocedural modification and reference analysis.
           This option can cause excessive memory and compile-time usage on large compilation units.  It is  not
           enabled by default at any optimization level.

       -fipa-profile
           Perform  interprocedural  profile  propagation.   The  functions  called only from cold functions are
           marked as cold. Also functions executed once (such as  "cold",  "noreturn",  static  constructors  or
           destructors)  are  identified. Cold functions and loop less parts of functions executed once are then
           optimized for size.  Enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fipa-cp
           Perform interprocedural constant propagation.  This optimization analyzes the  program  to  determine
           when  values passed to functions are constants and then optimizes accordingly.  This optimization can
           substantially increase performance if the application has constants passed to functions.   This  flag
           is enabled by default at -O2, -Os and -O3.

       -fipa-cp-clone
           Perform  function  cloning  to  make  interprocedural  constant  propagation stronger.  When enabled,
           interprocedural constant propagation will perform function cloning when externally  visible  function
           can  be  called  with  constant  arguments.   Because this optimization can create multiple copies of
           functions, it may significantly increase code size (see --param ipcp-unit-growth=value).   This  flag
           is enabled by default at -O3.

       -fipa-matrix-reorg
           Perform  matrix  flattening  and  transposing.   Matrix  flattening tries to replace an m-dimensional
           matrix with its equivalent n-dimensional matrix, where n < m.  This reduces the level of  indirection
           needed  for  accessing the elements of the matrix. The second optimization is matrix transposing that
           attempts to change the order of the matrix's dimensions in order to  improve  cache  locality.   Both
           optimizations need the -fwhole-program flag.  Transposing is enabled only if profiling information is
           available.

       -ftree-sink
           Perform forward store motion  on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-bit-ccp
           Perform  sparse  conditional  bit  constant  propagation  on  trees  and  propagate pointer alignment
           information.  This pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default at  -O  and
           higher.  It requires that -ftree-ccp is enabled.

       -ftree-ccp
           Perform  sparse  conditional  constant  propagation (CCP) on trees.  This pass only operates on local
           scalar variables and is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-switch-conversion
           Perform conversion of simple initializations in a switch to  initializations  from  a  scalar  array.
           This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and higher.

       -ftree-dce
           Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-builtin-call-dce
           Perform  conditional  dead code elimination (DCE) for calls to builtin functions that may set "errno"
           but are otherwise side-effect free.  This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and higher if -Os is  not
           also specified.

       -ftree-dominator-opts
           Perform a variety of simple scalar cleanups (constant/copy propagation, redundancy elimination, range
           propagation  and  expression simplification) based on a dominator tree traversal.  This also performs
           jump threading (to reduce jumps to jumps). This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-dse
           Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on trees.  A dead store is a store into a memory location  which
           will  later  be overwritten by another store without any intervening loads.  In this case the earlier
           store can be deleted.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-ch
           Perform loop header copying on trees.  This is beneficial since it increases  effectiveness  of  code
           motion optimizations.  It also saves one jump.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.  It
           is not enabled for -Os, since it usually increases code size.

       -ftree-loop-optimize
           Perform loop optimizations on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-loop-linear
           Perform  loop  interchange  transformations  on  tree.  Same as -floop-interchange.  To use this code
           transformation, GCC has to be configured with --with-ppl and --with-cloog to enable the Graphite loop
           transformation infrastructure.

       -floop-interchange
           Perform loop interchange transformations on loops.  Interchanging two nested loops switches the inner
           and outer loops.  For example, given a loop like:

                   DO J = 1, M
                     DO I = 1, N
                       A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           loop interchange will transform the loop as if the user had written:

                   DO I = 1, N
                     DO J = 1, M
                       A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           which can be beneficial when "N" is larger than the caches, because in Fortran, the  elements  of  an
           array  are  stored  in  memory  contiguously  by  column,  and  the original loop iterates over rows,
           potentially creating at each access a cache miss.  This optimization applies  to  all  the  languages
           supported  by  GCC  and  is  not  limited to Fortran.  To use this code transformation, GCC has to be
           configured  with  --with-ppl  and  --with-cloog  to   enable   the   Graphite   loop   transformation
           infrastructure.

       -floop-strip-mine
           Perform  loop  strip  mining  transformations  on  loops.  Strip mining splits a loop into two nested
           loops.  The outer loop has strides equal to the strip size and the inner  loop  has  strides  of  the
           original  loop  within  a  strip.   The  strip  length  can be changed using the loop-block-tile-size
           parameter.  For example, given a loop like:

                   DO I = 1, N
                     A(I) = A(I) + C
                   ENDDO

           loop strip mining will transform the loop as if the user had written:

                   DO II = 1, N, 51
                     DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
                       A(I) = A(I) + C
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           This optimization applies to all the languages supported by GCC and is not limited  to  Fortran.   To
           use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured with --with-ppl and --with-cloog to enable the
           Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.

       -floop-block
           Perform loop blocking transformations on loops.  Blocking strip mines each loop in the loop nest such
           that  the  memory  accesses  of the element loops fit inside caches.  The strip length can be changed
           using the loop-block-tile-size parameter.  For example, given a loop like:

                   DO I = 1, N
                     DO J = 1, M
                       A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           loop blocking will transform the loop as if the user had written:

                   DO II = 1, N, 51
                     DO JJ = 1, M, 51
                       DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
                         DO J = JJ, min (JJ + 50, M)
                           A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
                         ENDDO
                       ENDDO
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           which can be beneficial when "M" is larger than the caches, because the innermost loop  will  iterate
           over  a  smaller amount of data that can be kept in the caches.  This optimization applies to all the
           languages supported by GCC and is not limited to Fortran.  To use this code transformation,  GCC  has
           to  be  configured  with  --with-ppl  and  --with-cloog  to  enable  the Graphite loop transformation
           infrastructure.

       -fgraphite-identity
           Enable the identity  transformation  for  graphite.   For  every  SCoP  we  generate  the  polyhedral
           representation  and transform it back to gimple.  Using -fgraphite-identity we can check the costs or
           benefits of the GIMPLE -> GRAPHITE -> GIMPLE transformation.  Some  minimal  optimizations  are  also
           performed by the code generator CLooG, like index splitting and dead code elimination in loops.

       -floop-flatten
           Removes the loop nesting structure: transforms the loop nest into a single loop.  This transformation
           can be useful to vectorize all the levels of the loop nest.

       -floop-parallelize-all
           Use  the  Graphite  data dependence analysis to identify loops that can be parallelized.  Parallelize
           all the loops that can be analyzed to not contain loop carried dependences without checking  that  it
           is profitable to parallelize the loops.

       -fcheck-data-deps
           Compare the results of several data dependence analyzers.  This option is used for debugging the data
           dependence analyzers.

       -ftree-loop-if-convert
           Attempt to transform conditional jumps in the innermost loops to branch-less equivalents.  The intent
           is  to  remove  control-flow  from  the  innermost  loops  in  order  to  improve  the ability of the
           vectorization pass to handle these loops.  This is enabled by default if vectorization is enabled.

       -ftree-loop-if-convert-stores
           Attempt to also if-convert conditional jumps containing memory writes.  This  transformation  can  be
           unsafe  for  multi-threaded  programs  as  it transforms conditional memory writes into unconditional
           memory writes.  For example,

                   for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
                     if (cond)
                       A[i] = expr;

           would be transformed to

                   for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
                     A[i] = cond ? expr : A[i];

           potentially producing data races.

       -ftree-loop-distribution
           Perform loop distribution.  This flag can improve cache performance on  big  loop  bodies  and  allow
           further  loop  optimizations, like parallelization or vectorization, to take place.  For example, the
           loop

                   DO I = 1, N
                     A(I) = B(I) + C
                     D(I) = E(I) * F
                   ENDDO

           is transformed to

                   DO I = 1, N
                      A(I) = B(I) + C
                   ENDDO
                   DO I = 1, N
                      D(I) = E(I) * F
                   ENDDO

       -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns
           Perform loop distribution of patterns that can be code generated with calls to a library.  This  flag
           is enabled by default at -O3.

           This pass distributes the initialization loops and generates a call to memset zero.  For example, the
           loop

                   DO I = 1, N
                     A(I) = 0
                     B(I) = A(I) + I
                   ENDDO

           is transformed to

                   DO I = 1, N
                      A(I) = 0
                   ENDDO
                   DO I = 1, N
                      B(I) = A(I) + I
                   ENDDO

           and the initialization loop is transformed into a call to memset zero.

       -ftree-loop-im
           Perform loop invariant motion on trees.  This pass moves only invariants that would be hard to handle
           at  RTL  level  (function  calls,  operations  that  expand  to nontrivial sequences of insns).  With
           -funswitch-loops it also moves operands of conditions that are invariant out of the loop, so that  we
           can  use  just  trivial  invariantness  analysis  in  loop unswitching.  The pass also includes store
           motion.

       -ftree-loop-ivcanon
           Create a canonical counter for number of iterations in  the  loop  for  that  determining  number  of
           iterations  requires complicated analysis.  Later optimizations then may determine the number easily.
           Useful especially in connection with unrolling.

       -fivopts
           Perform  induction  variable  optimizations  (strength  reduction,  induction  variable  merging  and
           induction variable elimination) on trees.

       -ftree-parallelize-loops=n
           Parallelize  loops, i.e., split their iteration space to run in n threads.  This is only possible for
           loops whose iterations are independent and can be arbitrarily reordered.  The  optimization  is  only
           profitable on multiprocessor machines, for loops that are CPU-intensive, rather than constrained e.g.
           by  memory  bandwidth.  This option implies -pthread, and thus is only supported on targets that have
           support for -pthread.

       -ftree-pta
           Perform function-local points-to analysis on trees.  This flag  is  enabled  by  default  at  -O  and
           higher.

       -ftree-sra
           Perform  scalar  replacement  of aggregates.  This pass replaces structure references with scalars to
           prevent committing structures to memory too early.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-copyrename
           Perform copy renaming on trees.  This pass attempts to rename compiler temporaries to other variables
           at copy locations, usually resulting in variable names  which  more  closely  resemble  the  original
           variables.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-ter
           Perform  temporary  expression  replacement  during  the  SSA->normal  phase.   Single use/single def
           temporaries are replaced at their use location with their defining expression.  This results in  non-
           GIMPLE  code,  but  gives  the  expanders  much more complex trees to work on resulting in better RTL
           generation.  This is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-vectorize
           Perform loop vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at -O3.

       -ftree-slp-vectorize
           Perform basic block vectorization on trees.  This  flag  is  enabled  by  default  at  -O3  and  when
           -ftree-vectorize is enabled.

       -ftree-vect-loop-version
           Perform  loop  versioning  when  doing  loop  vectorization  on  trees.   When  a  loop appears to be
           vectorizable except that data alignment or data dependence cannot be determined at compile time  then
           vectorized  and  non-vectorized  versions  of  the  loop  are generated along with runtime checks for
           alignment or dependence to control which version is executed.  This  option  is  enabled  by  default
           except at level -Os where it is disabled.

       -fvect-cost-model
           Enable cost model for vectorization.

       -ftree-vrp
           Perform  Value  Range  Propagation  on  trees.  This is similar to the constant propagation pass, but
           instead of values, ranges of values are propagated.  This allows the optimizers to remove unnecessary
           range checks like array bound checks and null pointer checks.  This is enabled by default at -O2  and
           higher.  Null pointer check elimination is only done if -fdelete-null-pointer-checks is enabled.

       -ftracer
           Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation simplifies the control flow
           of the function allowing other optimizations to do better job.

       -funroll-loops
           Unroll  loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile time or upon entry to the loop.
           -funroll-loops implies -frerun-cse-after-loop.  This option makes code larger, and  may  or  may  not
           make it run faster.

       -funroll-all-loops
           Unroll  all  loops,  even  if their number of iterations is uncertain when the loop is entered.  This
           usually  makes  programs  run  more  slowly.   -funroll-all-loops  implies  the   same   options   as
           -funroll-loops,

       -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
           Enables  expressing  of  values of induction variables in later iterations of the unrolled loop using
           the value in the first iteration.  This breaks long dependency chains, thus improving  efficiency  of
           the scheduling passes.

           Combination  of  -fweb  and  CSE is often sufficient to obtain the same effect.  However in cases the
           loop body is more complicated than a single basic block, this is not reliable.  It also does not work
           at all on some of the architectures due to restrictions in the CSE pass.

           This optimization is enabled by default.

       -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
           With this option, the compiler will create multiple copies of some local variables when  unrolling  a
           loop which can result in superior code.

       -fpartial-inlining
           Inline  parts of functions.  This option has any effect only when inlining itself is turned on by the
           -finline-functions or -finline-small-functions options.

           Enabled at level -O2.

       -fpredictive-commoning
           Perform predictive commoning optimization, i.e., reusing computations (especially  memory  loads  and
           stores) performed in previous iterations of loops.

           This option is enabled at level -O3.

       -fprefetch-loop-arrays
           If  supported  by  the  target  machine,  generate  instructions  to  prefetch  memory to improve the
           performance of loops that access large arrays.

           This option may generate better or worse code; results are highly dependent on the structure of loops
           within the source code.

           Disabled at level -Os.

       -fno-peephole
       -fno-peephole2
           Disable any machine-specific  peephole  optimizations.   The  difference  between  -fno-peephole  and
           -fno-peephole2  is  in  how  they are implemented in the compiler; some targets use one, some use the
           other, a few use both.

           -fpeephole is enabled by default.  -fpeephole2 enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fno-guess-branch-probability
           Do not guess branch probabilities using heuristics.

           GCC will use heuristics to guess branch probabilities if they are not provided by profiling  feedback
           (-fprofile-arcs).    These  heuristics  are  based  on  the  control  flow  graph.   If  some  branch
           probabilities are specified by __builtin_expect, then the heuristics will be  used  to  guess  branch
           probabilities  for the rest of the control flow graph, taking the __builtin_expect info into account.
           The interactions between the heuristics and __builtin_expect can be complex, and in  some  cases,  it
           may  be  useful  to  disable  the  heuristics  so  that the effects of __builtin_expect are easier to
           understand.

           The default is -fguess-branch-probability at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -freorder-blocks
           Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce number of taken branches and improve
           code locality.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -freorder-blocks-and-partition
           In addition to reordering basic blocks in the compiled function, in order to reduce number  of  taken
           branches,  partitions  hot and cold basic blocks into separate sections of the assembly and .o files,
           to improve paging and cache locality performance.

           This optimization is automatically turned off in the presence of  exception  handling,  for  linkonce
           sections,  for  functions with a user-defined section attribute and on any architecture that does not
           support named sections.

       -freorder-functions
           Reorder functions in the object file in order to improve code locality.  This is implemented by using
           special subsections ".text.hot" for most  frequently  executed  functions  and  ".text.unlikely"  for
           unlikely  executed  functions.   Reordering  is done by the linker so object file format must support
           named sections and linker must place them in a reasonable way.

           Also profile feedback must be available in to make this option  effective.   See  -fprofile-arcs  for
           details.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fstrict-aliasing
           Allow  the compiler to assume the strictest aliasing rules applicable to the language being compiled.
           For C (and C++), this activates optimizations based on the type of expressions.   In  particular,  an
           object  of  one type is assumed never to reside at the same address as an object of a different type,
           unless the types are almost the same.  For example, an "unsigned int" can alias an "int", but  not  a
           "void*" or a "double".  A character type may alias any other type.

           Pay special attention to code like this:

                   union a_union {
                     int i;
                     double d;
                   };

                   int f() {
                     union a_union t;
                     t.d = 3.0;
                     return t.i;
                   }

           The  practice  of reading from a different union member than the one most recently written to (called
           "type-punning") is common.  Even with -fstrict-aliasing, type-punning is allowed, provided the memory
           is accessed through the union type.  So, the code above will work as expected.    However, this  code
           might not:

                   int f() {
                     union a_union t;
                     int* ip;
                     t.d = 3.0;
                     ip = &t.i;
                     return *ip;
                   }

           Similarly,  access  by taking the address, casting the resulting pointer and dereferencing the result
           has undefined behavior, even if the cast uses a union type, e.g.:

                   int f() {
                     double d = 3.0;
                     return ((union a_union *) &d)->i;
                   }

           The -fstrict-aliasing option is enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fstrict-overflow
           Allow the compiler to assume strict signed overflow rules, depending on the language being  compiled.
           For  C  (and  C++)  this  means that overflow when doing arithmetic with signed numbers is undefined,
           which  means  that  the  compiler  may  assume  that  it  will  not  happen.   This  permits  various
           optimizations.   For  example,  the  compiler  will  assume that an expression like "i + 10 > i" will
           always be true for signed "i".  This assumption is only valid if signed overflow is undefined, as the
           expression is false if "i + 10" overflows when using twos complement arithmetic.  When this option is
           in effect any attempt to determine whether an operation on  signed  numbers  will  overflow  must  be
           written carefully to not actually involve overflow.

           This  option  also  allows  the  compiler  to  assume strict pointer semantics: given a pointer to an
           object, if adding an offset to that pointer does not produce  a  pointer  to  the  same  object,  the
           addition  is  undefined.  This permits the compiler to conclude that "p + u > p" is always true for a
           pointer "p" and unsigned integer "u".  This assumption is only valid because  pointer  wraparound  is
           undefined, as the expression is false if "p + u" overflows using twos complement arithmetic.

           See  also  the -fwrapv option.  Using -fwrapv means that integer signed overflow is fully defined: it
           wraps.   When  -fwrapv  is   used,   there   is   no   difference   between   -fstrict-overflow   and
           -fno-strict-overflow  for  integers.   With  -fwrapv  certain  types  of overflow are permitted.  For
           example, if the compiler gets an overflow when doing arithmetic on constants,  the  overflowed  value
           can still be used with -fwrapv, but not otherwise.

           The -fstrict-overflow option is enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -falign-functions
       -falign-functions=n
           Align  the  start  of functions to the next power-of-two greater than n, skipping up to n bytes.  For
           instance,   -falign-functions=32   aligns   functions   to   the   next   32-byte    boundary,    but
           -falign-functions=24 would align to the next 32-byte boundary only if this can be done by skipping 23
           bytes or less.

           -fno-align-functions  and  -falign-functions=1  are  equivalent  and  mean that functions will not be
           aligned.

           Some assemblers only support this flag when n is a power of two; in that case, it is rounded up.

           If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -falign-labels
       -falign-labels=n
           Align all branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to n bytes  like  -falign-functions.
           This  option can easily make code slower, because it must insert dummy operations for when the branch
           target is reached in the usual flow of the code.

           -fno-align-labels and -falign-labels=1 are equivalent and mean that labels will not be aligned.

           If -falign-loops or -falign-jumps are applicable and are greater than this value, then  their  values
           are used instead.

           If  n  is  not  specified  or  is zero, use a machine-dependent default which is very likely to be 1,
           meaning no alignment.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -falign-loops
       -falign-loops=n
           Align loops to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to n bytes like -falign-functions.  The  hope  is
           that  the  loop  will  be  executed  many  times,  which  will make up for any execution of the dummy
           operations.

           -fno-align-loops and -falign-loops=1 are equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.

           If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -falign-jumps
       -falign-jumps=n
           Align branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, for branch targets where the  targets  can  only  be
           reached by jumping, skipping up to n bytes like -falign-functions.  In this case, no dummy operations
           need be executed.

           -fno-align-jumps and -falign-jumps=1 are equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.

           If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -funit-at-a-time
           This   option   is   left   for   compatibility   reasons.  -funit-at-a-time  has  no  effect,  while
           -fno-unit-at-a-time implies -fno-toplevel-reorder and -fno-section-anchors.

           Enabled by default.

       -fno-toplevel-reorder
           Do not reorder top-level functions, variables, and "asm" statements.  Output them in the  same  order
           that they appear in the input file.  When this option is used, unreferenced static variables will not
           be  removed.  This option is intended to support existing code which relies on a particular ordering.
           For new code, it is better to use attributes.

           Enabled at level -O0.  When disabled explicitly, it also imply -fno-section-anchors that is otherwise
           enabled at -O0 on some targets.

       -fweb
           Constructs webs as commonly used for register allocation purposes  and  assign  each  web  individual
           pseudo  register.   This allows the register allocation pass to operate on pseudos directly, but also
           strengthens several other optimization passes, such as CSE, loop  optimizer  and  trivial  dead  code
           remover.   It can, however, make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in a "home
           register".

           Enabled by default with -funroll-loops.

       -fwhole-program
           Assume that the current compilation unit represents the whole program  being  compiled.   All  public
           functions   and   variables   with   the   exception   of   "main"  and  those  merged  by  attribute
           "externally_visible" become static functions  and  in  effect  are  optimized  more  aggressively  by
           interprocedural optimizers. If gold is used as the linker plugin, "externally_visible" attributes are
           automatically  added  to  functions  (not variable yet due to a current gold issue) that are accessed
           outside of LTO objects according to resolution file produced by gold.  For other linkers that  cannot
           generate  resolution  file, explicit "externally_visible" attributes are still necessary.  While this
           option is equivalent to proper use of the "static" keyword for programs consisting of a single  file,
           in  combination  with option -flto this flag can be used to compile many smaller scale programs since
           the functions and variables become local for the whole combined compilation unit, not for the  single
           source file itself.

           This option implies -fwhole-file for Fortran programs.

       -flto[=n]
           This  option  runs  the  standard  link-time  optimizer.  When invoked with source code, it generates
           GIMPLE (one of GCC's internal representations) and writes it to special ELF sections  in  the  object
           file.   When  the  object  files are linked together, all the function bodies are read from these ELF
           sections and instantiated as if they had been part of the same translation unit.

           To use the link-time optimizer, -flto needs to be specified at compile  time  and  during  the  final
           link.  For example:

                   gcc -c -O2 -flto foo.c
                   gcc -c -O2 -flto bar.c
                   gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.o bar.o

           The  first  two invocations to GCC save a bytecode representation of GIMPLE into special ELF sections
           inside foo.o and bar.o.  The final invocation reads the GIMPLE bytecode from foo.o and bar.o,  merges
           the  two  files into a single internal image, and compiles the result as usual.  Since both foo.o and
           bar.o are merged into a single image, this causes all the interprocedural analyses and  optimizations
           in  GCC to work across the two files as if they were a single one.  This means, for example, that the
           inliner is able to inline functions in bar.o into functions in foo.o and vice-versa.

           Another (simpler) way to enable link-time optimization is:

                   gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.c bar.c

           The above generates bytecode for  foo.c  and  bar.c,  merges  them  together  into  a  single  GIMPLE
           representation and optimizes them as usual to produce myprog.

           The  only  important  thing  to keep in mind is that to enable link-time optimizations the -flto flag
           needs to be passed to both the compile and the link commands.

           To make whole program  optimization  effective,  it  is  necessary  to  make  certain  whole  program
           assumptions.   The  compiler  needs to know what functions and variables can be accessed by libraries
           and runtime outside of the link-time optimized unit.  When supported by the linker, the linker plugin
           (see -fuse-linker-plugin) passes information to  the  compiler  about  used  and  externally  visible
           symbols.   When  the  linker  plugin  is  not  available, -fwhole-program should be used to allow the
           compiler to make these assumptions, which leads to more aggressive optimization decisions.

           Note that when a file is compiled with -flto, the generated object file  is  larger  than  a  regular
           object  file  because  it contains GIMPLE bytecodes and the usual final code.  This means that object
           files with LTO information can be linked as normal object files;  if  -flto  is  not  passed  to  the
           linker, no interprocedural optimizations are applied.

           Additionally,  the optimization flags used to compile individual files are not necessarily related to
           those used at link time.  For instance,

                   gcc -c -O0 -flto foo.c
                   gcc -c -O0 -flto bar.c
                   gcc -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o

           This produces individual object files with unoptimized  assembler  code,  but  the  resulting  binary
           myprog is optimized at -O3.  If, instead, the final binary is generated without -flto, then myprog is
           not optimized.

           When  producing  the final binary with -flto, GCC only applies link-time optimizations to those files
           that contain bytecode.  Therefore, you can mix and match  object  files  and  libraries  with  GIMPLE
           bytecodes  and  final object code.  GCC automatically selects which files to optimize in LTO mode and
           which files to link without further processing.

           There are some code generation flags that GCC preserves when generating bytecodes, as they need to be
           used during the final link stage.  Currently,  the  following  options  are  saved  into  the  GIMPLE
           bytecode files: -fPIC, -fcommon and all the -m target flags.

           At link time, these options are read in and reapplied.  Note that the current implementation makes no
           attempt  to  recognize  conflicting  values  for  these options.  If different files have conflicting
           option values (e.g., one file is compiled with -fPIC and another isn't), the compiler simply uses the
           last value read from the bytecode files.  It is recommended, then, that you  compile  all  the  files
           participating in the same link with the same options.

           If  LTO  encounters  objects  with C linkage declared with incompatible types in separate translation
           units to be linked together (undefined behavior according to ISO C99 6.2.7), a  non-fatal  diagnostic
           may be issued.  The behavior is still undefined at runtime.

           Another feature of LTO is that it is possible to apply interprocedural optimizations on files written
           in  different languages.  This requires support in the language front end.  Currently, the C, C++ and
           Fortran front ends are capable of emitting GIMPLE bytecodes, so something like this should work:

                   gcc -c -flto foo.c
                   g++ -c -flto bar.cc
                   gfortran -c -flto baz.f90
                   g++ -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o baz.o -lgfortran

           Notice that the final link is done with g++ to get the C++ runtime libraries and -lgfortran is  added
           to  get the Fortran runtime libraries.  In general, when mixing languages in LTO mode, you should use
           the same link command options as when mixing languages in a regular (non-LTO)  compilation;  all  you
           need to add is -flto to all the compile and link commands.

           If  object  files  containing  GIMPLE  bytecode  are stored in a library archive, say libfoo.a, it is
           possible to extract and use them in an LTO link if you are using a linker with  plugin  support.   To
           enable this feature, use the flag -fuse-linker-plugin at link time:

                   gcc -o myprog -O2 -flto -fuse-linker-plugin a.o b.o -lfoo

           With  the linker plugin enabled, the linker extracts the needed GIMPLE files from libfoo.a and passes
           them on to the running GCC to make them part of the aggregated GIMPLE image to be optimized.

           If you are not using a linker with plugin support and/or do not enable the linker  plugin,  then  the
           objects  inside  libfoo.a  are  extracted and linked as usual, but they do not participate in the LTO
           optimization process.

           Link-time optimizations do not require the presence of the whole program to operate.  If the  program
           does  not  require any symbols to be exported, it is possible to combine -flto and -fwhole-program to
           allow the interprocedural optimizers to use more aggressive assumptions which may  lead  to  improved
           optimization  opportunities.   Use of -fwhole-program is not needed when linker plugin is active (see
           -fuse-linker-plugin).

           The current implementation of LTO makes no attempt to generate  bytecode  that  is  portable  between
           different  types  of hosts.  The bytecode files are versioned and there is a strict version check, so
           bytecode files generated in one version of GCC will not work with an older/newer version of GCC.

           Link-time optimization does not work well with generation of debugging information.  Combining  -flto
           with -g is currently experimental and expected to produce wrong results.

           If  you specify the optional n, the optimization and code generation done at link time is executed in
           parallel using n parallel jobs by utilizing an installed make program.  The environment variable MAKE
           may be used to override the program used.  The default value for n is 1.

           You can also specify -flto=jobserver to use GNU make's job server mode to  determine  the  number  of
           parallel  jobs.  This  is useful when the Makefile calling GCC is already executing in parallel.  You
           must prepend a + to the command recipe in the parent Makefile for this to work.  This  option  likely
           only works if MAKE is GNU make.

           This option is disabled by default.

       -flto-partition=alg
           Specify  the  partitioning  algorithm used by the link-time optimizer.  The value is either "1to1" to
           specify a partitioning mirroring the original source files or "balanced" to specify partitioning into
           equally sized chunks (whenever possible).  Specifying "none" as an  algorithm  disables  partitioning
           and streaming completely. The default value is "balanced".

       -flto-compression-level=n
           This  option  specifies the level of compression used for intermediate language written to LTO object
           files, and is only meaningful in  conjunction  with  LTO  mode  (-flto).   Valid  values  are  0  (no
           compression) to 9 (maximum compression).  Values outside this range are clamped to either 0 or 9.  If
           the option is not given, a default balanced compression setting is used.

       -flto-report
           Prints  a  report  with internal details on the workings of the link-time optimizer.  The contents of
           this report vary from version to version.  It is meant to be useful to GCC developers when processing
           object files in LTO mode (via -flto).

           Disabled by default.

       -fuse-linker-plugin
           Enables the use of a linker plugin during link-time optimization.  This option relies on  the  linker
           plugin support in linker that is available in gold or in GNU ld 2.21 or newer.

           This option enables the extraction of object files with GIMPLE bytecode out of library archives. This
           improves  the  quality  of  optimization  by  exposing  more  code  to the link-time optimizer.  This
           information specifies what symbols can be accessed externally (by non-LTO object  or  during  dynamic
           linking).   Resulting  code  quality  improvements  on binaries (and shared libraries that use hidden
           visibility) are similar to "-fwhole-program".  See -flto for a description of the effect of this flag
           and how to use it.

           This option is enabled by default when LTO support in GCC is enabled and GCC was configured  for  use
           with a linker supporting plugins (GNU ld 2.21 or newer or gold).

       -fcompare-elim
           After  register  allocation  and  post-register allocation instruction splitting, identify arithmetic
           instructions that compute processor flags similar to a comparison operation based on that arithmetic.
           If possible, eliminate the explicit comparison operation.

           This pass only applies to certain targets that cannot explicitly represent the  comparison  operation
           before register allocation is complete.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fcprop-registers
           After  register  allocation  and  post-register  allocation instruction splitting, we perform a copy-
           propagation pass to try to reduce scheduling dependencies and occasionally eliminate the copy.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fprofile-correction
           Profiles collected using an instrumented binary for multi-threaded programs may be  inconsistent  due
           to  missed  counter  updates.  When  this  option is specified, GCC will use heuristics to correct or
           smooth out such inconsistencies. By default, GCC will emit an  error  message  when  an  inconsistent
           profile is detected.

       -fprofile-dir=path
           Set  the  directory  to  search  for the profile data files in to path.  This option affects only the
           profile  data  generated  by  -fprofile-generate,  -ftest-coverage,  -fprofile-arcs   and   used   by
           -fprofile-use  and  -fbranch-probabilities  and  its  related  options.  By default, GCC will use the
           current directory as path, thus the profile data file will appear in the same directory as the object
           file.

       -fprofile-generate
       -fprofile-generate=path
           Enable options usually used for  instrumenting  application  to  produce  profile  useful  for  later
           recompilation  with  profile  feedback based optimization.  You must use -fprofile-generate both when
           compiling and when linking your program.

           The following options are enabled: "-fprofile-arcs", "-fprofile-values", "-fvpt".

           If path is specified, GCC will look at the  path  to  find  the  profile  feedback  data  files.  See
           -fprofile-dir.

       -fprofile-use
       -fprofile-use=path
           Enable  profile  feedback  directed  optimizations,  and optimizations generally profitable only with
           profile feedback available.

           The   following   options   are   enabled:   "-fbranch-probabilities",   "-fvpt",   "-funroll-loops",
           "-fpeel-loops", "-ftracer"

           By  default,  GCC emits an error message if the feedback profiles do not match the source code.  This
           error can be turned into a warning by using -Wcoverage-mismatch.  Note  this  may  result  in  poorly
           optimized code.

           If  path  is  specified,  GCC  will  look  at  the  path to find the profile feedback data files. See
           -fprofile-dir.

       The following options control compiler behavior regarding floating point arithmetic.  These options trade
       off between speed and correctness.  All must be specifically enabled.

       -ffloat-store
           Do not store floating point variables in registers, and  inhibit  other  options  that  might  change
           whether a floating point value is taken from a register or memory.

           This  option  prevents  undesirable excess precision on machines such as the 68000 where the floating
           registers (of the 68881) keep more precision than a "double" is supposed to have.  Similarly for  the
           x86 architecture.  For most programs, the excess precision does only good, but a few programs rely on
           the  precise definition of IEEE floating point.  Use -ffloat-store for such programs, after modifying
           them to store all pertinent intermediate computations into variables.

       -fexcess-precision=style
           This option allows further control over excess precision on machines where  floating-point  registers
           have  more  precision  than  the  IEEE  "float" and "double" types and the processor does not support
           operations rounding to those types.  By default, -fexcess-precision=fast is  in  effect;  this  means
           that  operations  are carried out in the precision of the registers and that it is unpredictable when
           rounding  to  the  types  specified  in  the  source  code  takes  place.   When  compiling   C,   if
           -fexcess-precision=standard is specified then excess precision will follow the rules specified in ISO
           C99;  in  particular,  both  casts and assignments cause values to be rounded to their semantic types
           (whereas -ffloat-store only affects assignments).  This option is enabled  by  default  for  C  if  a
           strict conformance option such as -std=c99 is used.

           -fexcess-precision=standard  is  not  implemented  for  languages  other than C, and has no effect if
           -funsafe-math-optimizations or -ffast-math is specified.  On the  x86,  it  also  has  no  effect  if
           -mfpmath=sse  or  -mfpmath=sse+387  is  specified;  in  the former case, IEEE semantics apply without
           excess precision, and in the latter, rounding is unpredictable.

       -ffast-math
           Sets   -fno-math-errno,    -funsafe-math-optimizations,    -ffinite-math-only,    -fno-rounding-math,
           -fno-signaling-nans and -fcx-limited-range.

           This option causes the preprocessor macro "__FAST_MATH__" to be defined.

           This  option is not turned on by any -O option besides -Ofast since it can result in incorrect output
           for programs which depend on an exact implementation of IEEE or  ISO  rules/specifications  for  math
           functions.  It  may,  however,  yield  faster code for programs that do not require the guarantees of
           these specifications.

       -fno-math-errno
           Do not set ERRNO after calling math functions that are executed  with  a  single  instruction,  e.g.,
           sqrt.  A program that relies on IEEE exceptions for math error handling may want to use this flag for
           speed while maintaining IEEE arithmetic compatibility.

           This  option  is  not turned on by any -O option since it can result in incorrect output for programs
           which depend on an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for  math  functions.  It
           may,  however,  yield  faster  code  for  programs  that  do  not  require  the  guarantees  of these
           specifications.

           The default is -fmath-errno.

           On Darwin systems, the math library never sets  "errno".   There  is  therefore  no  reason  for  the
           compiler to consider the possibility that it might, and -fno-math-errno is the default.

       -funsafe-math-optimizations
           Allow  optimizations  for  floating-point  arithmetic  that (a) assume that arguments and results are
           valid and (b) may violate IEEE or ANSI standards.  When used at link-time, it may  include  libraries
           or startup files that change the default FPU control word or other similar optimizations.

           This  option  is  not turned on by any -O option since it can result in incorrect output for programs
           which depend on an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for  math  functions.  It
           may,  however,  yield  faster  code  for  programs  that  do  not  require  the  guarantees  of these
           specifications.     Enables    -fno-signed-zeros,    -fno-trapping-math,    -fassociative-math    and
           -freciprocal-math.

           The default is -fno-unsafe-math-optimizations.

       -fassociative-math
           Allow re-association of operands in series of floating-point operations.  This violates the ISO C and
           C++ language standard by possibly changing computation result.  NOTE: re-ordering may change the sign
           of  zero  as well as ignore NaNs and inhibit or create underflow or overflow (and thus cannot be used
           on a code which relies on rounding behavior like "(x + 2**52) - 2**52)".  May also reorder  floating-
           point  comparisons  and  thus  may  not  be  used when ordered comparisons are required.  This option
           requires that both -fno-signed-zeros and -fno-trapping-math be in effect.  Moreover, it doesn't  make
           much  sense  with  -frounding-math.  For  Fortran  the  option  is  automatically  enabled  when both
           -fno-signed-zeros and -fno-trapping-math are in effect.

           The default is -fno-associative-math.

       -freciprocal-math
           Allow the reciprocal of a value to be  used  instead  of  dividing  by  the  value  if  this  enables
           optimizations.   For  example  "x / y" can be replaced with "x * (1/y)" which is useful if "(1/y)" is
           subject to common subexpression elimination.  Note that this loses precision and increases the number
           of flops operating on the value.

           The default is -fno-reciprocal-math.

       -ffinite-math-only
           Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that assume that arguments and results are not NaNs
           or +-Infs.

           This option is not turned on by any -O option since it can result in incorrect  output  for  programs
           which  depend  on  an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math functions. It
           may, however,  yield  faster  code  for  programs  that  do  not  require  the  guarantees  of  these
           specifications.

           The default is -fno-finite-math-only.

       -fno-signed-zeros
           Allow  optimizations  for  floating  point  arithmetic  that  ignore  the  signedness  of zero.  IEEE
           arithmetic  specifies  the  behavior  of  distinct  +0.0  and  -0.0  values,  which  then   prohibits
           simplification  of  expressions  such  as x+0.0 or 0.0*x (even with -ffinite-math-only).  This option
           implies that the sign of a zero result isn't significant.

           The default is -fsigned-zeros.

       -fno-trapping-math
           Compile code assuming that floating-point operations cannot generate user-visible traps.  These traps
           include division by zero, overflow, underflow, inexact result and  invalid  operation.   This  option
           requires  that  -fno-signaling-nans  be  in effect.  Setting this option may allow faster code if one
           relies on "non-stop" IEEE arithmetic, for example.

           This option should never be turned on by any -O option since it can result in  incorrect  output  for
           programs  which  depend  on  an  exact  implementation  of  IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math
           functions.

           The default is -ftrapping-math.

       -frounding-math
           Disable transformations and optimizations that assume default floating point rounding behavior.  This
           is round-to-zero for all floating point to integer conversions, and round-to-nearest  for  all  other
           arithmetic  truncations.   This  option  should be specified for programs that change the FP rounding
           mode dynamically, or that may be executed with a non-default rounding  mode.   This  option  disables
           constant  folding  of  floating  point expressions at compile-time (which may be affected by rounding
           mode) and arithmetic transformations that are unsafe  in  the  presence  of  sign-dependent  rounding
           modes.

           The default is -fno-rounding-math.

           This  option  is  experimental and does not currently guarantee to disable all GCC optimizations that
           are affected by rounding mode.  Future versions of GCC may provide  finer  control  of  this  setting
           using C99's "FENV_ACCESS" pragma.  This command line option will be used to specify the default state
           for "FENV_ACCESS".

       -fsignaling-nans
           Compile  code assuming that IEEE signaling NaNs may generate user-visible traps during floating-point
           operations.  Setting this option disables optimizations that may  change  the  number  of  exceptions
           visible with signaling NaNs.  This option implies -ftrapping-math.

           This option causes the preprocessor macro "__SUPPORT_SNAN__" to be defined.

           The default is -fno-signaling-nans.

           This  option  is  experimental and does not currently guarantee to disable all GCC optimizations that
           affect signaling NaN behavior.

       -fsingle-precision-constant
           Treat floating point constant as single precision constant instead of  implicitly  converting  it  to
           double precision constant.

       -fcx-limited-range
           When  enabled,  this  option states that a range reduction step is not needed when performing complex
           division.  Also, there is no checking whether the result of a complex multiplication or  division  is
           "NaN   +   I*NaN",  with  an  attempt  to  rescue  the  situation  in  that  case.   The  default  is
           -fno-cx-limited-range, but is enabled by -ffast-math.

           This option controls the default setting of the ISO C99 "CX_LIMITED_RANGE" pragma.  Nevertheless, the
           option applies to all languages.

       -fcx-fortran-rules
           Complex multiplication and division follow Fortran rules.  Range reduction is done as part of complex
           division, but there is no checking whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is "NaN
           + I*NaN", with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case.

           The default is -fno-cx-fortran-rules.

       The following options control optimizations that may improve performance, but are not enabled by  any  -O
       options.  This section includes experimental options that may produce broken code.

       -fbranch-probabilities
           After  running  a  program  compiled  with  -fprofile-arcs,  you  can  compile it a second time using
           -fbranch-probabilities, to improve optimizations based on the number of times each branch was  taken.
           When  the  program  compiled with -fprofile-arcs exits it saves arc execution counts to a file called
           sourcename.gcda for each source file.  The information in this data file is  very  dependent  on  the
           structure  of  the  generated  code,  so  you must use the same source code and the same optimization
           options for both compilations.

           With -fbranch-probabilities, GCC puts a REG_BR_PROB note on each JUMP_INSN and CALL_INSN.  These  can
           be  used to improve optimization.  Currently, they are only used in one place: in reorg.c, instead of
           guessing which path a branch is most likely to take, the  REG_BR_PROB  values  are  used  to  exactly
           determine which path is taken more often.

       -fprofile-values
           If  combined  with  -fprofile-arcs, it adds code so that some data about values of expressions in the
           program is gathered.

           With -fbranch-probabilities, it reads back the data gathered from profiling values of expressions for
           usage in optimizations.

           Enabled with -fprofile-generate and -fprofile-use.

       -fvpt
           If combined with -fprofile-arcs, it instructs the compiler to add a code to gather information  about
           values of expressions.

           With  -fbranch-probabilities, it reads back the data gathered and actually performs the optimizations
           based on them.  Currently the optimizations include specialization of division  operation  using  the
           knowledge about the value of the denominator.

       -frename-registers
           Attempt  to  avoid  false  dependencies  in scheduled code by making use of registers left over after
           register allocation.  This  optimization  will  most  benefit  processors  with  lots  of  registers.
           Depending  on  the  debug  information  format  adopted by the target, however, it can make debugging
           impossible, since variables will no longer stay in a "home register".

           Enabled by default with -funroll-loops and -fpeel-loops.

       -ftracer
           Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation simplifies the control flow
           of the function allowing other optimizations to do better job.

           Enabled with -fprofile-use.

       -funroll-loops
           Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile time or upon entry to the  loop.
           -funroll-loops  implies  -frerun-cse-after-loop,  -fweb  and  -frename-registers.   It  also turns on
           complete loop peeling (i.e. complete removal of loops with  small  constant  number  of  iterations).
           This option makes code larger, and may or may not make it run faster.

           Enabled with -fprofile-use.

       -funroll-all-loops
           Unroll  all  loops,  even  if their number of iterations is uncertain when the loop is entered.  This
           usually  makes  programs  run  more  slowly.   -funroll-all-loops  implies  the   same   options   as
           -funroll-loops.

       -fpeel-loops
           Peels  the  loops  for  that  there  is  enough  information that they do not roll much (from profile
           feedback).  It also turns on complete loop  peeling  (i.e.  complete  removal  of  loops  with  small
           constant number of iterations).

           Enabled with -fprofile-use.

       -fmove-loop-invariants
           Enables the loop invariant motion pass in the RTL loop optimizer.  Enabled at level -O1

       -funswitch-loops
           Move  branches  with  loop  invariant conditions out of the loop, with duplicates of the loop on both
           branches (modified according to result of the condition).

       -ffunction-sections
       -fdata-sections
           Place each function or data item into its own section in the  output  file  if  the  target  supports
           arbitrary  sections.   The name of the function or the name of the data item determines the section's
           name in the output file.

           Use these options on systems where the linker  can  perform  optimizations  to  improve  locality  of
           reference  in  the  instruction space.  Most systems using the ELF object format and SPARC processors
           running Solaris 2 have linkers with such optimizations.  AIX may  have  these  optimizations  in  the
           future.

           Only  use  these  options  when there are significant benefits from doing so.  When you specify these
           options, the assembler and linker will create larger object and executable files  and  will  also  be
           slower.   You  will  not be able to use "gprof" on all systems if you specify this option and you may
           have problems with debugging if you specify both this option and -g.

       -fbranch-target-load-optimize
           Perform branch target register load optimization before prologue / epilogue threading.   The  use  of
           target  registers  can  typically be exposed only during reload, thus hoisting loads out of loops and
           doing inter-block scheduling needs a separate optimization pass.

       -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
           Perform branch target register load optimization after prologue / epilogue threading.

       -fbtr-bb-exclusive
           When performing branch target register load optimization, don't  reuse  branch  target  registers  in
           within any basic block.

       -fstack-protector
           Emit  extra  code  to  check  for  buffer overflows, such as stack smashing attacks.  This is done by
           adding a guard variable to functions with vulnerable objects.   This  includes  functions  that  call
           alloca,  and  functions with buffers larger than 8 bytes.  The guards are initialized when a function
           is entered and then checked when the function exits.  If a guard check fails,  an  error  message  is
           printed and the program exits.

           NOTE:  In  Ubuntu 6.10 and later versions this option is enabled by default for C, C++, ObjC, ObjC++,
           if none of -fno-stack-protector, -nostdlib, nor -ffreestanding are found.

       -fstack-protector-all
           Like -fstack-protector except that all functions are protected.

       -fsection-anchors
           Try to reduce the number of symbolic address calculations by using shared "anchor" symbols to address
           nearby objects.  This transformation can help to reduce the number of GOT entries and GOT accesses on
           some targets.

           For example, the implementation of the following function "foo":

                   static int a, b, c;
                   int foo (void) { return a + b + c; }

           would usually  calculate  the  addresses  of  all  three  variables,  but  if  you  compile  it  with
           -fsection-anchors,  it  will  access the variables from a common anchor point instead.  The effect is
           similar to the following pseudocode (which isn't valid C):

                   int foo (void)
                   {
                     register int *xr = &x;
                     return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
                   }

           Not all targets support this option.

       --param name=value
           In some places, GCC uses various constants to control the amount of optimization that is  done.   For
           example,  GCC will not inline functions that contain more that a certain number of instructions.  You
           can control some of these constants on the command-line using the --param option.

           The names of specific parameters, and the meaning of the values, are tied to  the  internals  of  the
           compiler, and are subject to change without notice in future releases.

           In  each  case,  the  value is an integer.  The allowable choices for name are given in the following
           table:

           struct-reorg-cold-struct-ratio
               The threshold ratio (as a percentage) between a structure frequency  and  the  frequency  of  the
               hottest structure in the program.  This parameter is used by struct-reorg optimization enabled by
               -fipa-struct-reorg.   We say that if the ratio of a structure frequency, calculated by profiling,
               to the hottest structure frequency in the program is less than  this  parameter,  then  structure
               reorganization is not applied to this structure.  The default is 10.

           predictable-branch-outcome
               When  branch  is  predicted  to be taken with probability lower than this threshold (in percent),
               then it is considered well predictable. The default is 10.

           max-crossjump-edges
               The maximum number of incoming edges  to  consider  for  crossjumping.   The  algorithm  used  by
               -fcrossjumping  is  O(N^2) in the number of edges incoming to each block.  Increasing values mean
               more aggressive optimization, making the compile time increase with probably small improvement in
               executable size.

           min-crossjump-insns
               The minimum number of instructions which must  be  matched  at  the  end  of  two  blocks  before
               crossjumping will be performed on them.  This value is ignored in the case where all instructions
               in the block being crossjumped from are matched.  The default value is 5.

           max-grow-copy-bb-insns
               The  maximum  code  size  expansion  factor  when  copying  basic blocks instead of jumping.  The
               expansion is relative to a jump instruction.  The default value is 8.

           max-goto-duplication-insns
               The maximum number of instructions to duplicate to a block that jumps to  a  computed  goto.   To
               avoid  O(N^2) behavior in a number of passes, GCC factors computed gotos early in the compilation
               process, and unfactors them as late as possible.  Only computed jumps  at  the  end  of  a  basic
               blocks with no more than max-goto-duplication-insns are unfactored.  The default value is 8.

           max-delay-slot-insn-search
               The  maximum  number  of instructions to consider when looking for an instruction to fill a delay
               slot.  If more than this arbitrary number of instructions is  searched,  the  time  savings  from
               filling the delay slot will be minimal so stop searching.  Increasing values mean more aggressive
               optimization,  making the compile time increase with probably small improvement in executable run
               time.

           max-delay-slot-live-search
               When trying to fill delay slots, the maximum number of instructions to  consider  when  searching
               for a block with valid live register information.  Increasing this arbitrarily chosen value means
               more aggressive optimization, increasing the compile time.  This parameter should be removed when
               the delay slot code is rewritten to maintain the control-flow graph.

           max-gcse-memory
               The  approximate  maximum  amount of memory that will be allocated in order to perform the global
               common subexpression elimination optimization.  If more memory than specified  is  required,  the
               optimization will not be done.

           max-gcse-insertion-ratio
               If  the ratio of expression insertions to deletions is larger than this value for any expression,
               then RTL PRE will insert or remove the expression and thus leave partially redundant computations
               in the instruction stream.  The default value is 20.

           max-pending-list-length
               The maximum number of pending dependencies scheduling will  allow  before  flushing  the  current
               state and starting over.  Large functions with few branches or calls can create excessively large
               lists which needlessly consume memory and resources.

           max-inline-insns-single
               Several  parameters control the tree inliner used in gcc.  This number sets the maximum number of
               instructions (counted in GCC's internal representation)  in  a  single  function  that  the  tree
               inliner  will  consider  for  inlining.   This only affects functions declared inline and methods
               implemented in a class declaration (C++).  The default value is 400.

           max-inline-insns-auto
               When you use -finline-functions (included in -O3), a lot of functions that would otherwise not be
               considered for inlining by the compiler will be investigated.  To those  functions,  a  different
               (more restrictive) limit compared to functions declared inline can be applied.  The default value
               is 40.

           large-function-insns
               The  limit  specifying  really  large  functions.   For  functions  larger  than this limit after
               inlining, inlining is constrained by --param large-function-growth.   This  parameter  is  useful
               primarily  to avoid extreme compilation time caused by non-linear algorithms used by the backend.
               The default value is 2700.

           large-function-growth
               Specifies maximal growth of large function caused by inlining in percents.  The default value  is
               100 which limits large function growth to 2.0 times the original size.

           large-unit-insns
               The limit specifying large translation unit.  Growth caused by inlining of units larger than this
               limit  is  limited  by  --param  inline-unit-growth.   For  small  units  this might be too tight
               (consider unit consisting of function A that is inline and B that just calls A three time.  If  B
               is small relative to A, the growth of unit is 300\% and yet such inlining is very sane.  For very
               large  units  consisting  of  small inlineable functions however the overall unit growth limit is
               needed to avoid exponential explosion of  code  size.   Thus  for  smaller  units,  the  size  is
               increased to --param large-unit-insns before applying --param inline-unit-growth.  The default is
               10000

           inline-unit-growth
               Specifies  maximal  overall growth of the compilation unit caused by inlining.  The default value
               is 30 which limits unit growth to 1.3 times the original size.

           ipcp-unit-growth
               Specifies maximal overall growth of the  compilation  unit  caused  by  interprocedural  constant
               propagation.  The default value is 10 which limits unit growth to 1.1 times the original size.

           large-stack-frame
               The limit specifying large stack frames.  While inlining the algorithm is trying to not grow past
               this limit too much.  Default value is 256 bytes.

           large-stack-frame-growth
               Specifies maximal growth of large stack frames caused by inlining in percents.  The default value
               is 1000 which limits large stack frame growth to 11 times the original size.

           max-inline-insns-recursive
           max-inline-insns-recursive-auto
               Specifies  maximum  number of instructions out-of-line copy of self recursive inline function can
               grow into by performing recursive inlining.

               For functions declared inline --param max-inline-insns-recursive  is  taken  into  account.   For
               function  not  declared inline, recursive inlining happens only when -finline-functions (included
               in -O3) is enabled and --param max-inline-insns-recursive-auto is used.   The  default  value  is
               450.

           max-inline-recursive-depth
           max-inline-recursive-depth-auto
               Specifies maximum recursion depth used by the recursive inlining.

               For  functions  declared  inline  --param  max-inline-recursive-depth is taken into account.  For
               function not declared inline, recursive inlining happens only when  -finline-functions  (included
               in -O3) is enabled and --param max-inline-recursive-depth-auto is used.  The default value is 8.

           min-inline-recursive-probability
               Recursive  inlining is profitable only for function having deep recursion in average and can hurt
               for function having little recursion depth by increasing  the  prologue  size  or  complexity  of
               function body to other optimizers.

               When  profile  feedback  is  available (see -fprofile-generate) the actual recursion depth can be
               guessed from probability that function will recurse via given call  expression.   This  parameter
               limits  inlining only to call expression whose probability exceeds given threshold (in percents).
               The default value is 10.

           early-inlining-insns
               Specify growth that early inliner can make.  In effect it increases amount of inlining  for  code
               having large abstraction penalty.  The default value is 10.

           max-early-inliner-iterations
           max-early-inliner-iterations
               Limit  of  iterations  of  early  inliner.  This basically bounds number of nested indirect calls
               early inliner can resolve.  Deeper chains are still handled by late inlining.

           comdat-sharing-probability
           comdat-sharing-probability
               Probability (in percent) that C++ inline function with comdat visibility will  be  shared  across
               multiple compilation units.  The default value is 20.

           min-vect-loop-bound
               The minimum number of iterations under which a loop will not get vectorized when -ftree-vectorize
               is  used.   The  number  of  iterations  after  vectorization  needs to be greater than the value
               specified by this option to allow vectorization.  The default value is 0.

           gcse-cost-distance-ratio
               Scaling  factor  in  calculation  of  maximum  distance  an  expression  can  be  moved  by  GCSE
               optimizations.   This  is  currently  supported  only  in the code hoisting pass.  The bigger the
               ratio, the more aggressive code hoisting will be with simple expressions, i.e.,  the  expressions
               which  have  cost less than gcse-unrestricted-cost.  Specifying 0 will disable hoisting of simple
               expressions.  The default value is 10.

           gcse-unrestricted-cost
               Cost, roughly measured as the cost of  a  single  typical  machine  instruction,  at  which  GCSE
               optimizations  will  not  constrain  the  distance  an  expression can travel.  This is currently
               supported only in the code hoisting pass.  The lesser the cost, the more aggressive code hoisting
               will be.  Specifying 0 will allow all expressions to travel unrestricted distances.  The  default
               value is 3.

           max-hoist-depth
               The  depth  of  search  in  the  dominator  tree for expressions to hoist.  This is used to avoid
               quadratic behavior in hoisting algorithm.  The value of 0 will avoid limiting the search, but may
               slow down compilation of huge functions.  The default value is 30.

           max-unrolled-insns
               The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop is unrolled, and  if  the
               loop is unrolled, it determines how many times the loop code is unrolled.

           max-average-unrolled-insns
               The  maximum number of instructions biased by probabilities of their execution that a loop should
               have if that loop is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled, it determines how many times the loop
               code is unrolled.

           max-unroll-times
               The maximum number of unrollings of a single loop.

           max-peeled-insns
               The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop is  peeled,  and  if  the
               loop is peeled, it determines how many times the loop code is peeled.

           max-peel-times
               The maximum number of peelings of a single loop.

           max-completely-peeled-insns
               The maximum number of insns of a completely peeled loop.

           max-completely-peel-times
               The maximum number of iterations of a loop to be suitable for complete peeling.

           max-completely-peel-loop-nest-depth
               The maximum depth of a loop nest suitable for complete peeling.

           max-unswitch-insns
               The maximum number of insns of an unswitched loop.

           max-unswitch-level
               The maximum number of branches unswitched in a single loop.

           lim-expensive
               The minimum cost of an expensive expression in the loop invariant motion.

           iv-consider-all-candidates-bound
               Bound  on  number  of candidates for induction variables below that all candidates are considered
               for each use in  induction  variable  optimizations.   Only  the  most  relevant  candidates  are
               considered if there are more candidates, to avoid quadratic time complexity.

           iv-max-considered-uses
               The induction variable optimizations give up on loops that contain more induction variable uses.

           iv-always-prune-cand-set-bound
               If  number  of  candidates  in  the  set  is  smaller  than  this  value, we always try to remove
               unnecessary ivs from the set during its optimization when a new iv is added to the set.

           scev-max-expr-size
               Bound on size of expressions used in the scalar evolutions analyzer.  Large expressions slow  the
               analyzer.

           scev-max-expr-complexity
               Bound  on  the  complexity  of  the  expressions  in  the  scalar  evolutions  analyzer.  Complex
               expressions slow the analyzer.

           omega-max-vars
               The maximum number of variables in an Omega constraint system.  The default value is 128.

           omega-max-geqs
               The maximum number of inequalities in an Omega constraint system.  The default value is 256.

           omega-max-eqs
               The maximum number of equalities in an Omega constraint system.  The default value is 128.

           omega-max-wild-cards
               The maximum number of wildcard variables that the Omega solver  will  be  able  to  insert.   The
               default value is 18.

           omega-hash-table-size
               The size of the hash table in the Omega solver.  The default value is 550.

           omega-max-keys
               The maximal number of keys used by the Omega solver.  The default value is 500.

           omega-eliminate-redundant-constraints
               When  set  to 1, use expensive methods to eliminate all redundant constraints.  The default value
               is 0.

           vect-max-version-for-alignment-checks
               The maximum number of runtime checks that  can  be  performed  when  doing  loop  versioning  for
               alignment in the vectorizer.  See option ftree-vect-loop-version for more information.

           vect-max-version-for-alias-checks
               The  maximum  number of runtime checks that can be performed when doing loop versioning for alias
               in the vectorizer.  See option ftree-vect-loop-version for more information.

           max-iterations-to-track
               The maximum number of iterations of a loop the  brute  force  algorithm  for  analysis  of  #  of
               iterations of the loop tries to evaluate.

           hot-bb-count-fraction
               Select  fraction  of the maximal count of repetitions of basic block in program given basic block
               needs to have to be considered hot.

           hot-bb-frequency-fraction
               Select fraction of the entry block frequency of executions of basic block in function given basic
               block needs to have to be considered hot

           max-predicted-iterations
               The maximum number of loop iterations we predict statically.   This  is  useful  in  cases  where
               function  contain single loop with known bound and other loop with unknown.  We predict the known
               number of iterations correctly, while the unknown number of iterations  average  to  roughly  10.
               This means that the loop without bounds would appear artificially cold relative to the other one.

           align-threshold
               Select  fraction  of  the  maximal frequency of executions of basic block in function given basic
               block will get aligned.

           align-loop-iterations
               A loop expected to iterate at lest the selected number of iterations will get aligned.

           tracer-dynamic-coverage
           tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
               This value is  used  to  limit  superblock  formation  once  the  given  percentage  of  executed
               instructions is covered.  This limits unnecessary code size expansion.

               The  tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback  is used only when profile feedback is available.  The real
               profiles (as opposed to statically estimated ones) are much less balanced allowing the  threshold
               to be larger value.

           tracer-max-code-growth
               Stop  tail  duplication  once  code  growth  has  reached given percentage.  This is rather hokey
               argument, as most of the duplicates will be eliminated later in cross jumping, so it may  be  set
               to much higher values than is the desired code growth.

           tracer-min-branch-ratio
               Stop  reverse  growth  when  the reverse probability of best edge is less than this threshold (in
               percent).

           tracer-min-branch-ratio
           tracer-min-branch-ratio-feedback
               Stop forward growth if the best edge do have probability lower than this threshold.

               Similarly to tracer-dynamic-coverage two values are present,  one  for  compilation  for  profile
               feedback  and one for compilation without.  The value for compilation with profile feedback needs
               to be more conservative (higher) in order to make tracer effective.

           max-cse-path-length
               Maximum number of basic blocks on path that cse considers.  The default is 10.

           max-cse-insns
               The maximum instructions CSE process before flushing. The default is 1000.

           ggc-min-expand
               GCC uses a garbage collector to manage its own memory allocation.  This parameter  specifies  the
               minimum  percentage  by  which  the  garbage collector's heap should be allowed to expand between
               collections.  Tuning this may improve compilation speed; it has no effect on code generation.

               The default is 30% + 70% * (RAM/1GB) with an upper bound of 100% when RAM >= 1GB.  If "getrlimit"
               is available, the notion of "RAM" is the smallest of actual RAM and "RLIMIT_DATA" or "RLIMIT_AS".
               If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a particular platform, the lower bound  of  30%  is  used.
               Setting  this  parameter  and ggc-min-heapsize to zero causes a full collection to occur at every
               opportunity.  This is extremely slow, but can be useful for debugging.

           ggc-min-heapsize
               Minimum size of the garbage collector's heap before it begins bothering to collect garbage.   The
               first  collection  occurs  after  the  heap  expands  by ggc-min-expand% beyond ggc-min-heapsize.
               Again, tuning this may improve compilation speed, and has no effect on code generation.

               The default is the smaller  of  RAM/8,  RLIMIT_RSS,  or  a  limit  which  tries  to  ensure  that
               RLIMIT_DATA or RLIMIT_AS are not exceeded, but with a lower bound of 4096 (four megabytes) and an
               upper  bound  of  131072  (128  megabytes).   If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a particular
               platform, the lower bound is used.   Setting  this  parameter  very  large  effectively  disables
               garbage  collection.   Setting this parameter and ggc-min-expand to zero causes a full collection
               to occur at every opportunity.

           max-reload-search-insns
               The  maximum  number  of  instruction  reload  should  look  backward  for  equivalent  register.
               Increasing  values  mean  more  aggressive  optimization,  making  the compile time increase with
               probably slightly better performance.  The default value is 100.

           max-cselib-memory-locations
               The maximum number of memory locations cselib should take into account.  Increasing  values  mean
               more  aggressive  optimization,  making  the  compile time increase with probably slightly better
               performance.  The default value is 500.

           reorder-blocks-duplicate
           reorder-blocks-duplicate-feedback
               Used by basic block reordering pass to decide whether to use unconditional  branch  or  duplicate
               the  code  on  its  destination.  Code is duplicated when its estimated size is smaller than this
               value multiplied by the estimated size of unconditional jump in the hot spots of the program.

               The reorder-block-duplicate-feedback is used only when profile feedback is available and  may  be
               set  to  higher values than reorder-block-duplicate since information about the hot spots is more
               accurate.

           max-sched-ready-insns
               The maximum number of instructions ready to be issued the scheduler should consider at any  given
               time during the first scheduling pass.  Increasing values mean more thorough searches, making the
               compilation time increase with probably little benefit.  The default value is 100.

           max-sched-region-blocks
               The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for interblock scheduling.  The default
               value is 10.

           max-pipeline-region-blocks
               The  maximum  number  of  blocks  in  a  region  to be considered for pipelining in the selective
               scheduler.  The default value is 15.

           max-sched-region-insns
               The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for interblock scheduling.  The  default
               value is 100.

           max-pipeline-region-insns
               The  maximum  number  of  insns  in  a  region  to  be considered for pipelining in the selective
               scheduler.  The default value is 200.

           min-spec-prob
               The minimum probability (in percents) of reaching  a  source  block  for  interblock  speculative
               scheduling.  The default value is 40.

           max-sched-extend-regions-iters
               The  maximum number of iterations through CFG to extend regions.  0 - disable region extension, N
               - do at most N iterations.  The default value is 0.

           max-sched-insn-conflict-delay
               The maximum conflict delay for an insn to be considered  for  speculative  motion.   The  default
               value is 3.

           sched-spec-prob-cutoff
               The  minimal  probability  of speculation success (in percents), so that speculative insn will be
               scheduled.  The default value is 40.

           sched-mem-true-dep-cost
               Minimal distance (in CPU cycles) between store and load targeting  same  memory  locations.   The
               default value is 1.

           selsched-max-lookahead
               The  maximum  size  of the lookahead window of selective scheduling.  It is a depth of search for
               available instructions.  The default value is 50.

           selsched-max-sched-times
               The maximum number of times that an instruction will be scheduled  during  selective  scheduling.
               This  is  the  limit  on the number of iterations through which the instruction may be pipelined.
               The default value is 2.

           selsched-max-insns-to-rename
               The maximum number of best instructions in the ready list that are considered for renaming in the
               selective scheduler.  The default value is 2.

           sms-min-sc
               The minimum value of stage count that swing modulo scheduler will generate.  The default value is
               2.

           max-last-value-rtl
               The maximum size measured as number of RTLs that can be recorded in an expression in combiner for
               a pseudo register as last known value of that register.  The default is 10000.

           integer-share-limit
               Small integer constants can use a shared data structure, reducing the compiler's memory usage and
               increasing its speed.  This sets the maximum value of a shared  integer  constant.   The  default
               value is 256.

           min-virtual-mappings
               Specifies  the  minimum  number of virtual mappings in the incremental SSA updater that should be
               registered to trigger the virtual mappings  heuristic  defined  by  virtual-mappings-ratio.   The
               default value is 100.

           virtual-mappings-ratio
               If  the  number  of  virtual mappings is virtual-mappings-ratio bigger than the number of virtual
               symbols to be updated, then the incremental SSA updater switches  to  a  full  update  for  those
               symbols.  The default ratio is 3.

           ssp-buffer-size
               The  minimum  size  of  buffers  (i.e.  arrays)  that will receive stack smashing protection when
               -fstack-protection is used.

           max-jump-thread-duplication-stmts
               Maximum number of statements allowed in a block that needs to be duplicated when threading jumps.

           max-fields-for-field-sensitive
               Maximum number of fields in a structure we will treat in a field sensitive manner during  pointer
               analysis.  The default is zero for -O0, and -O1 and 100 for -Os, -O2, and -O3.

           prefetch-latency
               Estimate  on  average  number  of  instructions  that are executed before prefetch finishes.  The
               distance we prefetch ahead is proportional to this constant.  Increasing  this  number  may  also
               lead to less streams being prefetched (see simultaneous-prefetches).

           simultaneous-prefetches
               Maximum number of prefetches that can run at the same time.

           l1-cache-line-size
               The size of cache line in L1 cache, in bytes.

           l1-cache-size
               The size of L1 cache, in kilobytes.

           l2-cache-size
               The size of L2 cache, in kilobytes.

           min-insn-to-prefetch-ratio
               The  minimum  ratio  between  the  number  of instructions and the number of prefetches to enable
               prefetching in a loop.

           prefetch-min-insn-to-mem-ratio
               The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and  the  number  of  memory  references  to
               enable prefetching in a loop.

           use-canonical-types
               Whether  the  compiler should use the "canonical" type system.  By default, this should always be
               1, which uses a more efficient internal mechanism for comparing types in C++  and  Objective-C++.
               However, if bugs in the canonical type system are causing compilation failures, set this value to
               0 to disable canonical types.

           switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio
               Switch  initialization  conversion  will  refuse  to  create  arrays that are bigger than switch-
               conversion-max-branch-ratio times the number of branches in the switch.

           max-partial-antic-length
               Maximum length of the partial antic set computed during the tree partial  redundancy  elimination
               optimization  (-ftree-pre)  when  optimizing at -O3 and above.  For some sorts of source code the
               enhanced partial redundancy elimination optimization can run away, consuming all  of  the  memory
               available  on  the  host machine.  This parameter sets a limit on the length of the sets that are
               computed, which prevents the runaway behavior.  Setting a value of  0  for  this  parameter  will
               allow an unlimited set length.

           sccvn-max-scc-size
               Maximum  size  of a strongly connected component (SCC) during SCCVN processing.  If this limit is
               hit, SCCVN processing for the whole function will not be done and optimizations depending  on  it
               will be disabled.  The default maximum SCC size is 10000.

           ira-max-loops-num
               IRA  uses  a  regional  register  allocation  by default.  If a function contains loops more than
               number given by the parameter, only at most given number of the most  frequently  executed  loops
               will  form  regions  for the regional register allocation.  The default value of the parameter is
               100.

           ira-max-conflict-table-size
               Although IRA uses a sophisticated algorithm of compression conflict table, the table can be still
               big for huge functions.  If the conflict table for a function could be more than size in MB given
               by the parameter, the conflict table is not built and faster, simpler, and lower quality register
               allocation algorithm will be used.  The algorithm do  not  use  pseudo-register  conflicts.   The
               default value of the parameter is 2000.

           ira-loop-reserved-regs
               IRA  can  be  used to evaluate more accurate register pressure in loops for decision to move loop
               invariants (see -O3).  The number of available registers reserved  for  some  other  purposes  is
               described  by this parameter.  The default value of the parameter is 2 which is minimal number of
               registers needed for execution of typical  instruction.   This  value  is  the  best  found  from
               numerous experiments.

           loop-invariant-max-bbs-in-loop
               Loop invariant motion can be very expensive, both in compile time and in amount of needed compile
               time  memory, with very large loops.  Loops with more basic blocks than this parameter won't have
               loop invariant motion optimization performed on them.  The default value of the parameter is 1000
               for -O1 and 10000 for -O2 and above.

           max-vartrack-size
               Sets a maximum number of hash table slots to use during variable tracking  dataflow  analysis  of
               any  function.  If this limit is exceeded with variable tracking at assignments enabled, analysis
               for that function is retried without it, after removing all debug insns from  the  function.   If
               the  limit is exceeded even without debug insns, var tracking analysis is completely disabled for
               the function.  Setting the parameter to zero makes it unlimited.

           min-nondebug-insn-uid
               Use uids starting at this parameter for  nondebug  insns.   The  range  below  the  parameter  is
               reserved  exclusively  for debug insns created by -fvar-tracking-assignments, but debug insns may
               get (non-overlapping) uids above it if the reserved range is exhausted.

           ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor
               IPA-SRA will replace a pointer to an aggregate with one or more new parameters  only  when  their
               cumulative  size  is  less  or  equal to ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor times the size of the original
               pointer parameter.

           graphite-max-nb-scop-params
               To avoid exponential effects in the Graphite loop transforms,  the  number  of  parameters  in  a
               Static  Control  Part  (SCoP)  is bounded.  The default value is 10 parameters.  A variable whose
               value is unknown at compile time and defined outside a SCoP is a parameter of the SCoP.

           graphite-max-bbs-per-function
               To avoid exponential effects in the detection of SCoPs, the size of  the  functions  analyzed  by
               Graphite is bounded.  The default value is 100 basic blocks.

           loop-block-tile-size
               Loop  blocking  or strip mining transforms, enabled with -floop-block or -floop-strip-mine, strip
               mine each loop in the loop nest by a given number of iterations.  The strip length can be changed
               using the loop-block-tile-size parameter.  The default value is 51 iterations.

           devirt-type-list-size
               IPA-CP attempts to track all possible types passed to a function's parameter in order to  perform
               devirtualization.   devirt-type-list-size  is  the maximum number of types it stores per a single
               formal parameter of a function.

           lto-partitions
               Specify desired number of partitions produced during WHOPR compilation.  The number of partitions
               should exceed the number of CPUs used for compilation.  The default value is 32.

           lto-minpartition
               Size of minimal partition for WHOPR (in  estimated  instructions).   This  prevents  expenses  of
               splitting very small programs into too many partitions.

           cxx-max-namespaces-for-diagnostic-help
               The  maximum  number  of  namespaces to consult for suggestions when C++ name lookup fails for an
               identifier.  The default is 1000.

           max-stores-to-sink
               The maximum number of  conditional  stores  paires  that  can  be  sunk.   Set  to  0  if  either
               vectorization  (-ftree-vectorize)  or  if-conversion  (-ftree-loop-if-convert)  is disabled.  The
               default is 2.

   Options Controlling the Preprocessor
       These options control the C preprocessor, which is run on each C source file before actual compilation.

       If you use the -E option, nothing is done except preprocessing.  Some of these options  make  sense  only
       together with -E because they cause the preprocessor output to be unsuitable for actual compilation.

       -Wp,option
           You  can  use  -Wp,option  to  bypass  the  compiler  driver  and pass option directly through to the
           preprocessor.  If option contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.   However,
           many  options  are  modified, translated or interpreted by the compiler driver before being passed to
           the preprocessor, and -Wp forcibly bypasses this  phase.   The  preprocessor's  direct  interface  is
           undocumented  and  subject  to  change,  so  whenever possible you should avoid using -Wp and let the
           driver handle the options instead.

       -Xpreprocessor option
           Pass option as  an  option  to  the  preprocessor.   You  can  use  this  to  supply  system-specific
           preprocessor options which GCC does not know how to recognize.

           If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use -Xpreprocessor twice, once for the
           option and once for the argument.

       -D name
           Predefine name as a macro, with definition 1.

       -D name=definition
           The  contents  of definition are tokenized and processed as if they appeared during translation phase
           three in a #define directive.  In particular, the definition will be truncated  by  embedded  newline
           characters.

           If  you  are  invoking  the  preprocessor  from a shell or shell-like program you may need to use the
           shell's quoting syntax to protect characters such as spaces that have a meaning in the shell syntax.

           If you wish to define a function-like macro on  the  command  line,  write  its  argument  list  with
           surrounding  parentheses before the equals sign (if any).  Parentheses are meaningful to most shells,
           so you will need to quote the option.  With sh and csh, -D'name(args...)=definition' works.

           -D and -U options are processed in the order they are given on the command line.  All  -imacros  file
           and -include file options are processed after all -D and -U options.

       -U name
           Cancel any previous definition of name, either built in or provided with a -D option.

       -undef
           Do  not  predefine any system-specific or GCC-specific macros.  The standard predefined macros remain
           defined.

       -I dir
           Add the directory dir to the list of directories to be searched for header files.  Directories  named
           by  -I  are  searched  before  the  standard  system  include directories.  If the directory dir is a
           standard system include directory, the option is ignored to ensure that the default search order  for
           system directories and the special treatment of system headers are not defeated .  If dir begins with
           "=", then the "=" will be replaced by the sysroot prefix; see --sysroot and -isysroot.

       -o file
           Write  output to file.  This is the same as specifying file as the second non-option argument to cpp.
           gcc has a different interpretation of a second non-option argument, so you must use -o to specify the
           output file.

       -Wall
           Turns on all optional warnings which are desirable for normal code.  At present  this  is  -Wcomment,
           -Wtrigraphs,  -Wmultichar  and  a  warning  about integer promotion causing a change of sign in "#if"
           expressions.  Note that many of the preprocessor's warnings are on by default and have no options  to
           control them.

       -Wcomment
       -Wcomments
           Warn  whenever  a  comment-start sequence /* appears in a /* comment, or whenever a backslash-newline
           appears in a // comment.  (Both forms have the same effect.)

       -Wtrigraphs
           Most trigraphs in comments cannot affect the meaning of the program.  However, a trigraph that  would
           form an escaped newline (??/ at the end of a line) can, by changing where the comment begins or ends.
           Therefore, only trigraphs that would form escaped newlines produce warnings inside a comment.

           This  option  is  implied  by  -Wall.   If  -Wall  is  not given, this option is still enabled unless
           trigraphs are enabled.  To get  trigraph  conversion  without  warnings,  but  get  the  other  -Wall
           warnings, use -trigraphs -Wall -Wno-trigraphs.

       -Wtraditional
           Warn  about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and ISO C.  Also warn about ISO
           C constructs that have no traditional C  equivalent,  and  problematic  constructs  which  should  be
           avoided.

       -Wundef
           Warn  whenever  an  identifier  which  is  not a macro is encountered in an #if directive, outside of
           defined.  Such identifiers are replaced with zero.

       -Wunused-macros
           Warn about macros defined in the main file that are unused.  A macro is used if  it  is  expanded  or
           tested  for  existence at least once.  The preprocessor will also warn if the macro has not been used
           at the time it is redefined or undefined.

           Built-in macros, macros defined on the command line, and macros defined  in  include  files  are  not
           warned about.

           Note:  If a macro is actually used, but only used in skipped conditional blocks, then CPP will report
           it as unused.  To avoid the warning in such a case, you  might  improve  the  scope  of  the  macro's
           definition by, for example, moving it into the first skipped block.  Alternatively, you could provide
           a dummy use with something like:

                   #if defined the_macro_causing_the_warning
                   #endif

       -Wendif-labels
           Warn whenever an #else or an #endif are followed by text.  This usually happens in code of the form

                   #if FOO
                   ...
                   #else FOO
                   ...
                   #endif FOO

           The  second and third "FOO" should be in comments, but often are not in older programs.  This warning
           is on by default.

       -Werror
           Make all warnings into hard errors.  Source code which triggers warnings will be rejected.

       -Wsystem-headers
           Issue warnings for code in system headers.  These are normally unhelpful in finding bugs in your  own
           code, therefore suppressed.  If you are responsible for the system library, you may want to see them.

       -w  Suppress all warnings, including those which GNU CPP issues by default.

       -pedantic
           Issue  all the mandatory diagnostics listed in the C standard.  Some of them are left out by default,
           since they trigger frequently on harmless code.

       -pedantic-errors
           Issue all the mandatory diagnostics, and make all mandatory diagnostics into errors.   This  includes
           mandatory diagnostics that GCC issues without -pedantic but treats as warnings.

       -M  Instead  of  outputting  the  result of preprocessing, output a rule suitable for make describing the
           dependencies of the main source file.  The preprocessor outputs one make rule containing  the  object
           file  name  for  that  source file, a colon, and the names of all the included files, including those
           coming from -include or -imacros command line options.

           Unless specified explicitly (with -MT or -MQ), the object file name  consists  of  the  name  of  the
           source  file  with  any  suffix replaced with object file suffix and with any leading directory parts
           removed.  If there are many included files then the rule is split into several lines using \-newline.
           The rule has no commands.

           This option does not suppress the preprocessor's debug output, such as -dM.   To  avoid  mixing  such
           debug  output with the dependency rules you should explicitly specify the dependency output file with
           -MF, or use an environment variable like DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT.  Debug output will still be sent to the
           regular output stream as normal.

           Passing -M to the driver implies -E, and suppresses warnings with an implicit -w.

       -MM Like -M but do not mention header files that are found in system header directories, nor header files
           that are included, directly or indirectly, from such a header.

           This implies that the choice of angle brackets or double quotes in an #include directive does not  in
           itself  determine  whether that header will appear in -MM dependency output.  This is a slight change
           in semantics from GCC versions 3.0 and earlier.

       -MF file
           When used with -M or -MM, specifies a file to write the dependencies to.  If no -MF switch  is  given
           the preprocessor sends the rules to the same place it would have sent preprocessed output.

           When used with the driver options -MD or -MMD, -MF overrides the default dependency output file.

       -MG In conjunction with an option such as -M requesting dependency generation, -MG assumes missing header
           files  are  generated  files  and  adds  them  to  the dependency list without raising an error.  The
           dependency filename is taken directly from the "#include" directive without prepending any path.  -MG
           also suppresses preprocessed output, as a missing header file renders this useless.

           This feature is used in automatic updating of makefiles.

       -MP This option instructs CPP to add a phony target for each dependency other than the main file, causing
           each to depend on nothing.  These dummy rules work around errors make  gives  if  you  remove  header
           files without updating the Makefile to match.

           This is typical output:

                   test.o: test.c test.h

                   test.h:

       -MT target
           Change the target of the rule emitted by dependency generation.  By default CPP takes the name of the
           main  input  file,  deletes  any directory components and any file suffix such as .c, and appends the
           platform's usual object suffix.  The result is the target.

           An -MT option will set the target to be exactly  the  string  you  specify.   If  you  want  multiple
           targets, you can specify them as a single argument to -MT, or use multiple -MT options.

           For example, -MT '$(objpfx)foo.o' might give

                   $(objpfx)foo.o: foo.c

       -MQ target
           Same as -MT, but it quotes any characters which are special to Make.  -MQ '$(objpfx)foo.o' gives

                   $$(objpfx)foo.o: foo.c

           The default target is automatically quoted, as if it were given with -MQ.

       -MD -MD is equivalent to -M -MF file, except that -E is not implied.  The driver determines file based on
           whether  an  -o  option  is  given.   If it is, the driver uses its argument but with a suffix of .d,
           otherwise it takes the name of the input file, removes  any  directory  components  and  suffix,  and
           applies a .d suffix.

           If  -MD  is used in conjunction with -E, any -o switch is understood to specify the dependency output
           file, but if used without -E, each -o is understood to specify a target object file.

           Since -E is not implied, -MD can be used to generate a dependency output file as a side-effect of the
           compilation process.

       -MMD
           Like -MD except mention only user header files, not system header files.

       -fpch-deps
           When using precompiled headers, this flag will cause the dependency-output flags  to  also  list  the
           files from the precompiled header's dependencies.  If not specified only the precompiled header would
           be  listed and not the files that were used to create it because those files are not consulted when a
           precompiled header is used.

       -fpch-preprocess
           This option allows use of a precompiled header together with -E.  It  inserts  a  special  "#pragma",
           "#pragma  GCC pch_preprocess "filename"" in the output to mark the place where the precompiled header
           was found, and its filename.  When -fpreprocessed is in use, GCC recognizes this "#pragma" and  loads
           the PCH.

           This  option  is off by default, because the resulting preprocessed output is only really suitable as
           input to GCC.  It is switched on by -save-temps.

           You should not write this "#pragma" in your own code, but it is safe to edit the filename if the  PCH
           file  is  available  in  a different location.  The filename may be absolute or it may be relative to
           GCC's current directory.

       -x c
       -x c++
       -x objective-c
       -x assembler-with-cpp
           Specify the source language: C, C++, Objective-C, or assembly.  This has nothing to do with standards
           conformance or extensions; it merely selects which base syntax to expect.  If you give none of  these
           options,  cpp  will  deduce  the  language from the extension of the source file: .c, .cc, .m, or .S.
           Some other common extensions for C++ and assembly are also recognized.  If cpp does not recognize the
           extension, it will treat the file as C; this is the most generic mode.

           Note: Previous versions of cpp accepted a -lang option which  selected  both  the  language  and  the
           standards conformance level.  This option has been removed, because it conflicts with the -l option.

       -std=standard
       -ansi
           Specify  the  standard  to  which  the  code  should  conform.   Currently  CPP knows about C and C++
           standards; others may be added in the future.

           standard may be one of:

           "c90"
           "c89"
           "iso9899:1990"
               The ISO C standard from 1990.  c90 is the customary shorthand for this version of the standard.

               The -ansi option is equivalent to -std=c90.

           "iso9899:199409"
               The 1990 C standard, as amended in 1994.

           "iso9899:1999"
           "c99"
           "iso9899:199x"
           "c9x"
               The revised ISO C standard, published in December 1999.  Before publication, this  was  known  as
               C9X.

           "c1x"
               The next version of the ISO C standard, still under development.

           "gnu90"
           "gnu89"
               The 1990 C standard plus GNU extensions.  This is the default.

           "gnu99"
           "gnu9x"
               The 1999 C standard plus GNU extensions.

           "gnu1x"
               The next version of the ISO C standard, still under development, plus GNU extensions.

           "c++98"
               The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus amendments.

           "gnu++98"
               The same as -std=c++98 plus GNU extensions.  This is the default for C++ code.

       -I- Split  the  include path.  Any directories specified with -I options before -I- are searched only for
           headers requested with "#include "file""; they are not searched for "#include <file>".  If additional
           directories are specified with -I options after the -I-,  those  directories  are  searched  for  all
           #include directives.

           In  addition, -I- inhibits the use of the directory of the current file directory as the first search
           directory for "#include "file"".  This option has been deprecated.

       -nostdinc
           Do not search the standard system directories for  header  files.   Only  the  directories  you  have
           specified with -I options (and the directory of the current file, if appropriate) are searched.

       -nostdinc++
           Do  not  search  for  header  files in the C++-specific standard directories, but do still search the
           other standard directories.  (This option is used when building the C++ library.)

       -include file
           Process file as if "#include "file"" appeared as the first line of the primary source file.  However,
           the first directory searched for  file  is  the  preprocessor's  working  directory  instead  of  the
           directory  containing  the main source file.  If not found there, it is searched for in the remainder
           of the "#include "..."" search chain as normal.

           If multiple -include options are given, the files are included  in  the  order  they  appear  on  the
           command line.

       -imacros file
           Exactly  like  -include,  except that any output produced by scanning file is thrown away.  Macros it
           defines remain defined.  This allows you to acquire  all  the  macros  from  a  header  without  also
           processing its declarations.

           All files specified by -imacros are processed before all files specified by -include.

       -idirafter dir
           Search  dir  for  header  files,  but  do it after all directories specified with -I and the standard
           system directories have been exhausted.  dir is treated as a system include directory.  If dir begins
           with "=", then the "=" will be replaced by the sysroot prefix; see --sysroot and -isysroot.

       -iprefix prefix
           Specify prefix as the prefix for  subsequent  -iwithprefix  options.   If  the  prefix  represents  a
           directory, you should include the final /.

       -iwithprefix dir
       -iwithprefixbefore dir
           Append  dir  to the prefix specified previously with -iprefix, and add the resulting directory to the
           include search path.  -iwithprefixbefore puts it in the same place -I  would;  -iwithprefix  puts  it
           where -idirafter would.

       -isysroot dir
           This  option  is  like  the  --sysroot  option,  but  applies only to header files (except for Darwin
           targets, where it applies to both header files and libraries).  See the  --sysroot  option  for  more
           information.

       -imultilib dir
           Use dir as a subdirectory of the directory containing target-specific C++ headers.

       -isystem dir
           Search  dir  for  header  files, after all directories specified by -I but before the standard system
           directories.  Mark it as a system directory, so that it gets the same special treatment as is applied
           to the standard system directories.  If dir begins with "=", then the "=" will  be  replaced  by  the
           sysroot prefix; see --sysroot and -isysroot.

       -iquote dir
           Search  dir  only  for  header  files  requested  with  "#include "file"";  they are not searched for
           "#include <file>", before all directories specified by -I and before the standard system directories.
           If dir begins with "=", then the "=" will be replaced  by  the  sysroot  prefix;  see  --sysroot  and
           -isysroot.

       -fdirectives-only
           When preprocessing, handle directives, but do not expand macros.

           The option's behavior depends on the -E and -fpreprocessed options.

           With  -E,  preprocessing  is  limited  to the handling of directives such as "#define", "#ifdef", and
           "#error".  Other preprocessor operations, such as macro expansion and  trigraph  conversion  are  not
           performed.  In addition, the -dD option is implicitly enabled.

           With  -fpreprocessed, predefinition of command line and most builtin macros is disabled.  Macros such
           as "__LINE__", which are contextually dependent, are handled normally.  This enables  compilation  of
           files previously preprocessed with "-E -fdirectives-only".

           With  both  -E  and  -fpreprocessed, the rules for -fpreprocessed take precedence.  This enables full
           preprocessing of files previously preprocessed with "-E -fdirectives-only".

       -fdollars-in-identifiers
           Accept $ in identifiers.

       -fextended-identifiers
           Accept universal character names in identifiers.  This option is experimental; in a future version of
           GCC, it will be enabled by default for C99 and C++.

       -fpreprocessed
           Indicate to the preprocessor that the input file has  already  been  preprocessed.   This  suppresses
           things  like  macro  expansion, trigraph conversion, escaped newline splicing, and processing of most
           directives.  The preprocessor still recognizes and removes comments, so that  you  can  pass  a  file
           preprocessed  with  -C to the compiler without problems.  In this mode the integrated preprocessor is
           little more than a tokenizer for the front ends.

           -fpreprocessed is implicit if the input file has one of the extensions .i, .ii or .mi.  These are the
           extensions that GCC uses for preprocessed files created by -save-temps.

       -ftabstop=width
           Set the distance between tab stops.  This helps the preprocessor report  correct  column  numbers  in
           warnings  or  errors,  even  if tabs appear on the line.  If the value is less than 1 or greater than
           100, the option is ignored.  The default is 8.

       -fexec-charset=charset
           Set the execution character set, used for string and character  constants.   The  default  is  UTF-8.
           charset can be any encoding supported by the system's "iconv" library routine.

       -fwide-exec-charset=charset
           Set  the  wide execution character set, used for wide string and character constants.  The default is
           UTF-32 or UTF-16, whichever corresponds to the width of "wchar_t".  As with  -fexec-charset,  charset
           can  be  any  encoding  supported  by  the  system's  "iconv" library routine; however, you will have
           problems with encodings that do not fit exactly in "wchar_t".

       -finput-charset=charset
           Set the input character set, used for translation from the character set of the  input  file  to  the
           source character set used by GCC.  If the locale does not specify, or GCC cannot get this information
           from  the  locale, the default is UTF-8.  This can be overridden by either the locale or this command
           line option.  Currently the command line option takes precedence if there's a conflict.  charset  can
           be any encoding supported by the system's "iconv" library routine.

       -fworking-directory
           Enable  generation  of  linemarkers  in  the  preprocessor output that will let the compiler know the
           current working  directory  at  the  time  of  preprocessing.   When  this  option  is  enabled,  the
           preprocessor  will  emit,  after the initial linemarker, a second linemarker with the current working
           directory followed by  two  slashes.   GCC  will  use  this  directory,  when  it's  present  in  the
           preprocessed  input,  as  the  directory  emitted  as the current working directory in some debugging
           information formats.  This option is implicitly enabled if debugging information is enabled, but this
           can be inhibited with the negated form -fno-working-directory.  If the -P  flag  is  present  in  the
           command line, this option has no effect, since no "#line" directives are emitted whatsoever.

       -fno-show-column
           Do  not  print column numbers in diagnostics.  This may be necessary if diagnostics are being scanned
           by a program that does not understand the column numbers, such as dejagnu.

       -A predicate=answer
           Make an assertion with the predicate predicate and answer answer.  This  form  is  preferred  to  the
           older  form  -A  predicate(answer),  which  is still supported, because it does not use shell special
           characters.

       -A -predicate=answer
           Cancel an assertion with the predicate predicate and answer answer.

       -dCHARS
           CHARS is a sequence of one or more of the following characters, and must not be preceded by a  space.
           Other  characters are interpreted by the compiler proper, or reserved for future versions of GCC, and
           so are silently ignored.   If  you  specify  characters  whose  behavior  conflicts,  the  result  is
           undefined.

           M   Instead  of  the  normal output, generate a list of #define directives for all the macros defined
               during the execution of the preprocessor, including predefined macros.  This gives you a  way  of
               finding  out  what  is predefined in your version of the preprocessor.  Assuming you have no file
               foo.h, the command

                       touch foo.h; cpp -dM foo.h

               will show all the predefined macros.

               If you use -dM without the -E option, -dM is interpreted as a synonym for -fdump-rtl-mach.

           D   Like M except in two respects: it does not include the predefined macros, and it outputs both the
               #define directives and the result of preprocessing.  Both kinds of  output  go  to  the  standard
               output file.

           N   Like D, but emit only the macro names, not their expansions.

           I   Output #include directives in addition to the result of preprocessing.

           U   Like  D except that only macros that are expanded, or whose definedness is tested in preprocessor
               directives, are output; the output is delayed until the use or test  of  the  macro;  and  #undef
               directives are also output for macros tested but undefined at the time.

       -P  Inhibit  generation  of  linemarkers  in the output from the preprocessor.  This might be useful when
           running the preprocessor on something that is not C code, and will be sent to a program  which  might
           be confused by the linemarkers.

       -C  Do  not discard comments.  All comments are passed through to the output file, except for comments in
           processed directives, which are deleted along with the directive.

           You should be prepared for side effects when using -C; it causes the preprocessor to  treat  comments
           as  tokens  in  their  own  right.   For  example, comments appearing at the start of what would be a
           directive line have the effect of turning that line into an ordinary source  line,  since  the  first
           token on the line is no longer a #.

       -CC Do  not  discard  comments,  including during macro expansion.  This is like -C, except that comments
           contained within macros are also passed through to the output file where the macro is expanded.

           In addition to the side-effects of the -C option, the -CC option causes all C++-style comments inside
           a macro to be converted to C-style comments.  This is  to  prevent  later  use  of  that  macro  from
           inadvertently commenting out the remainder of the source line.

           The -CC option is generally used to support lint comments.

       -traditional-cpp
           Try to imitate the behavior of old-fashioned C preprocessors, as opposed to ISO C preprocessors.

       -trigraphs
           Process  trigraph  sequences.   These  are  three-character sequences, all starting with ??, that are
           defined by ISO C to stand for single characters.  For example, ??/ stands  for  \,  so  '??/n'  is  a
           character  constant  for  a  newline.   By default, GCC ignores trigraphs, but in standard-conforming
           modes it converts them.  See the -std and -ansi options.

           The nine trigraphs and their replacements are

                   Trigraph:       ??(  ??)  ??<  ??>  ??=  ??/  ??'  ??!  ??-
                   Replacement:      [    ]    {    }    #    \    ^    |    ~

       -remap
           Enable special code to work around file systems which only permit very short file names, such as  MS-
           DOS.

       --help
       --target-help
           Print text describing all the command line options instead of preprocessing anything.

       -v  Verbose mode.  Print out GNU CPP's version number at the beginning of execution, and report the final
           form of the include path.

       -H  Print  the  name  of  each  header  file  used, in addition to other normal activities.  Each name is
           indented to show how deep in the #include stack it is.  Precompiled header files  are  also  printed,
           even  if  they are found to be invalid; an invalid precompiled header file is printed with ...x and a
           valid one with ...! .

       -version
       --version
           Print out GNU CPP's version number.  With one dash,  proceed  to  preprocess  as  normal.   With  two
           dashes, exit immediately.

   Passing Options to the Assembler
       You can pass options to the assembler.

       -Wa,option
           Pass  option  as  an  option  to the assembler.  If option contains commas, it is split into multiple
           options at the commas.

       -Xassembler option
           Pass option as an option to the assembler.  You can use  this  to  supply  system-specific  assembler
           options which GCC does not know how to recognize.

           If  you  want  to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use -Xassembler twice, once for the
           option and once for the argument.

   Options for Linking
       These options come into play when the compiler links object files into an executable output  file.   They
       are meaningless if the compiler is not doing a link step.

       object-file-name
           A  file name that does not end in a special recognized suffix is considered to name an object file or
           library.  (Object files are distinguished  from  libraries  by  the  linker  according  to  the  file
           contents.)  If linking is done, these object files are used as input to the linker.

       -c
       -S
       -E  If any of these options is used, then the linker is not run, and object file names should not be used
           as arguments.

       -llibrary
       -l library
           Search  the  library  named  library  when  linking.   (The  second alternative with the library as a
           separate argument is only for POSIX compliance and is not recommended.)

           It makes a difference where in the command you write this option; the linker searches  and  processes
           libraries and object files in the order they are specified.  Thus, foo.o -lz bar.o searches library z
           after  file  foo.o  but  before bar.o.  If bar.o refers to functions in z, those functions may not be
           loaded.

           The linker searches a standard list of directories for the library, which is actually  a  file  named
           liblibrary.a.  The linker then uses this file as if it had been specified precisely by name.

           The  directories  searched include several standard system directories plus any that you specify with
           -L.

           Normally the files found this way are library files---archive files whose members are  object  files.
           The  linker handles an archive file by scanning through it for members which define symbols that have
           so far been referenced but not defined.  But if the file that is found is an ordinary object file, it
           is linked in the usual fashion.  The only difference between using an -l option and specifying a file
           name is that -l surrounds library with lib and .a and searches several directories.

       -lobjc
           You need this special case of the -l option in order to link an Objective-C or Objective-C++ program.

       -nostartfiles
           Do not use the standard system startup files when linking.  The standard system  libraries  are  used
           normally, unless -nostdlib or -nodefaultlibs is used.

       -nodefaultlibs
           Do not use the standard system libraries when linking.  Only the libraries you specify will be passed
           to  the  linker,  options  specifying  linkage  of  the system libraries, such as "-static-libgcc" or
           "-shared-libgcc",  will  be  ignored.   The  standard  startup  files  are  used   normally,   unless
           -nostartfiles  is  used.   The  compiler  may  generate  calls  to  "memcmp",  "memset", "memcpy" and
           "memmove".  These entries are usually resolved by entries in libc.   These  entry  points  should  be
           supplied through some other mechanism when this option is specified.

       -nostdlib
           Do  not  use  the standard system startup files or libraries when linking.  No startup files and only
           the libraries you specify will be passed to the linker, options  specifying  linkage  of  the  system
           libraries,  such as "-static-libgcc" or "-shared-libgcc", will be ignored.  The compiler may generate
           calls to "memcmp", "memset", "memcpy" and "memmove".  These entries are usually resolved  by  entries
           in  libc.   These  entry  points  should be supplied through some other mechanism when this option is
           specified.

           One of the standard libraries bypassed by -nostdlib and -nodefaultlibs  is  libgcc.a,  a  library  of
           internal  subroutines that GCC uses to overcome shortcomings of particular machines, or special needs
           for some languages.

           In most cases, you need libgcc.a even when you want to avoid  other  standard  libraries.   In  other
           words,  when  you specify -nostdlib or -nodefaultlibs you should usually specify -lgcc as well.  This
           ensures that you have no unresolved references to internal GCC library  subroutines.   (For  example,
           __main, used to ensure C++ constructors will be called.)

       -pie
           Produce  a position independent executable on targets which support it.  For predictable results, you
           must also specify the same set of options that were used to generate code  (-fpie,  -fPIE,  or  model
           suboptions) when you specify this option.

       -rdynamic
           Pass  the  flag  -export-dynamic  to  the  ELF linker, on targets that support it. This instructs the
           linker to add all symbols, not only used ones, to the dynamic symbol table. This option is needed for
           some uses of "dlopen" or to allow obtaining backtraces from within a program.

       -s  Remove all symbol table and relocation information from the executable.

       -static
           On systems that support dynamic linking, this prevents linking with the shared libraries.   On  other
           systems, this option has no effect.

       -shared
           Produce  a  shared object which can then be linked with other objects to form an executable.  Not all
           systems support this option.  For predictable results, you must also specify the same set of  options
           that were used to generate code (-fpic, -fPIC, or model suboptions) when you specify this option.[1]

       -shared-libgcc
       -static-libgcc
           On  systems that provide libgcc as a shared library, these options force the use of either the shared
           or static version respectively.  If no shared version of libgcc  was  built  when  the  compiler  was
           configured, these options have no effect.

           There  are  several  situations  in  which an application should use the shared libgcc instead of the
           static version.  The most common of  these  is  when  the  application  wishes  to  throw  and  catch
           exceptions  across  different  shared  libraries.  In that case, each of the libraries as well as the
           application itself should use the shared libgcc.

           Therefore, the G++ and GCJ drivers automatically add  -shared-libgcc  whenever  you  build  a  shared
           library  or a main executable, because C++ and Java programs typically use exceptions, so this is the
           right thing to do.

           If, instead, you use the GCC driver to create shared libraries, you  may  find  that  they  will  not
           always  be  linked  with the shared libgcc.  If GCC finds, at its configuration time, that you have a
           non-GNU linker or a GNU linker that does not support option --eh-frame-hdr, it will link  the  shared
           version  of libgcc into shared libraries by default.  Otherwise, it will take advantage of the linker
           and optimize away the linking with the shared version of libgcc, linking with the static  version  of
           libgcc  by  default.   This  allows  exceptions  to  propagate through such shared libraries, without
           incurring relocation costs at library load time.

           However, if a library or main executable is supposed to throw or catch exceptions, you must  link  it
           using  the  G++  or  GCJ  driver,  as appropriate for the languages used in the program, or using the
           option -shared-libgcc, such that it is linked with the shared libgcc.

       -static-libstdc++
           When the g++ program is used to link a C++ program,  it  will  normally  automatically  link  against
           libstdc++.   If  libstdc++ is available as a shared library, and the -static option is not used, then
           this will link against the shared version of libstdc++.  That  is  normally  fine.   However,  it  is
           sometimes  useful to freeze the version of libstdc++ used by the program without going all the way to
           a fully static link.   The  -static-libstdc++  option  directs  the  g++  driver  to  link  libstdc++
           statically, without necessarily linking other libraries statically.

       -symbolic
           Bind  references  to  global  symbols  when  building  a  shared  object.   Warn about any unresolved
           references (unless overridden by the link editor option -Xlinker  -z  -Xlinker  defs).   Only  a  few
           systems support this option.

       -T script
           Use  script as the linker script.  This option is supported by most systems using the GNU linker.  On
           some targets, such as bare-board targets without an operating system, the -T option may  be  required
           when linking to avoid references to undefined symbols.

       -Xlinker option
           Pass  option  as  an option to the linker.  You can use this to supply system-specific linker options
           which GCC does not know how to recognize.

           If you want to pass an option that takes a separate argument, you must use -Xlinker twice,  once  for
           the  option  and  once  for  the  argument.  For example, to pass -assert definitions, you must write
           -Xlinker -assert -Xlinker definitions.  It does not work to  write  -Xlinker  "-assert  definitions",
           because this passes the entire string as a single argument, which is not what the linker expects.

           When  using  the  GNU linker, it is usually more convenient to pass arguments to linker options using
           the option=value  syntax  than  as  separate  arguments.   For  example,  you  can  specify  -Xlinker
           -Map=output.map  rather  than  -Xlinker -Map -Xlinker output.map.  Other linkers may not support this
           syntax for command-line options.

       -Wl,option
           Pass option as an option to the linker.  If option contains commas, it is split into multiple options
           at the commas.  You  can  use  this  syntax  to  pass  an  argument  to  the  option.   For  example,
           -Wl,-Map,output.map  passes  -Map  output.map to the linker.  When using the GNU linker, you can also
           get the same effect with -Wl,-Map=output.map.

           NOTE: In Ubuntu 8.10 and later versions, for LDFLAGS, the option -Wl,-z,relro is used.   To  disable,
           use -Wl,-z,norelro.

       -u symbol
           Pretend  the  symbol  symbol is undefined, to force linking of library modules to define it.  You can
           use -u multiple times with different symbols to force loading of additional library modules.

   Options for Directory Search
       These options specify directories to search for  header  files,  for  libraries  and  for  parts  of  the
       compiler:

       -Idir
           Add  the  directory dir to the head of the list of directories to be searched for header files.  This
           can be used to override a system header file, substituting your own version, since these  directories
           are  searched  before the system header file directories.  However, you should not use this option to
           add directories that contain vendor-supplied system header files (use -isystem for that).  If you use
           more than one -I option, the directories are scanned in  left-to-right  order;  the  standard  system
           directories come after.

           If  a  standard  system  include directory, or a directory specified with -isystem, is also specified
           with -I, the -I option will be ignored.  The directory  will  still  be  searched  but  as  a  system
           directory at its normal position in the system include chain.  This is to ensure that GCC's procedure
           to  fix  buggy  system  headers and the ordering for the include_next directive are not inadvertently
           changed.  If you really need to change the search order for system  directories,  use  the  -nostdinc
           and/or -isystem options.

       -iplugindir=dir
           Set   the   directory   to   search  for  plugins  which  are  passed  by  -fplugin=name  instead  of
           -fplugin=path/name.so.  This option is not meant to be used by the  user,  but  only  passed  by  the
           driver.

       -iquotedir
           Add the directory dir to the head of the list of directories to be searched for header files only for
           the case of #include "file"; they are not searched for #include <file>, otherwise just like -I.

       -Ldir
           Add directory dir to the list of directories to be searched for -l.

       -Bprefix
           This  option specifies where to find the executables, libraries, include files, and data files of the
           compiler itself.

           The compiler driver program runs one or more of the subprograms cpp, cc1, as and ld.  It tries prefix
           as a prefix for each program it tries to run, both with and without machine/version/.

           For each subprogram to be run, the compiler driver first tries the -B prefix, if any.  If  that  name
           is  not  found,  or  if  -B  was  not  specified,  the  driver tries two standard prefixes, which are
           /usr/lib/gcc/ and /usr/local/lib/gcc/.  If neither of those results in a file name that is found, the
           unmodified program name is searched for using the directories  specified  in  your  PATH  environment
           variable.

           The compiler will check to see if the path provided by the -B refers to a directory, and if necessary
           it will add a directory separator character at the end of the path.

           -B  prefixes  that effectively specify directory names also apply to libraries in the linker, because
           the compiler translates these options into -L options for the linker.  They also  apply  to  includes
           files  in  the  preprocessor, because the compiler translates these options into -isystem options for
           the preprocessor.  In this case, the compiler appends include to the prefix.

           The run-time support file libgcc.a can also be searched for using the -B prefix, if needed.  If it is
           not found there, the two standard prefixes above are tried, and that is all.  The file is left out of
           the link if it is not found by those means.

           Another way to specify a prefix  much  like  the  -B  prefix  is  to  use  the  environment  variable
           GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.

           As  a special kludge, if the path provided by -B is [dir/]stageN/, where N is a number in the range 0
           to 9, then it will be replaced by [dir/]include.  This is to help with boot-strapping the compiler.

       -specs=file
           Process file after the compiler reads in the standard specs file, in order to override  the  defaults
           that the gcc driver program uses when determining what switches to pass to cc1, cc1plus, as, ld, etc.
           More than one -specs=file can be specified on the command line, and they are processed in order, from
           left to right.

       --sysroot=dir
           Use  dir as the logical root directory for headers and libraries.  For example, if the compiler would
           normally search for headers in /usr/include  and  libraries  in  /usr/lib,  it  will  instead  search
           dir/usr/include and dir/usr/lib.

           If  you  use  both  this  option  and  the  -isysroot option, then the --sysroot option will apply to
           libraries, but the -isysroot option will apply to header files.

           The GNU linker (beginning with version 2.16) has the necessary support  for  this  option.   If  your
           linker  does  not  support  this option, the header file aspect of --sysroot will still work, but the
           library aspect will not.

       -I- This option has been deprecated.  Please use -iquote instead for -I directories before  the  -I-  and
           remove  the -I-.  Any directories you specify with -I options before the -I- option are searched only
           for the case of #include "file"; they are not searched for #include <file>.

           If additional directories are specified with -I options after the -I-, these directories are searched
           for all #include directives.  (Ordinarily all -I directories are used this way.)

           In addition, the -I- option inhibits the use of the current directory (where the current  input  file
           came  from)  as  the  first  search  directory for #include "file".  There is no way to override this
           effect of -I-.  With -I. you can specify searching the directory which was current when the  compiler
           was  invoked.  That is not exactly the same as what the preprocessor does by default, but it is often
           satisfactory.

           -I- does not inhibit the use of the standard system directories for  header  files.   Thus,  -I-  and
           -nostdinc are independent.

   Specifying Target Machine and Compiler Version
       The  usual  way  to  run GCC is to run the executable called gcc, or machine-gcc when cross-compiling, or
       machine-gcc-version to run a version other than the one that was installed last.

   Hardware Models and Configurations
       Each target machine types can have its own special options, starting with -m,  to  choose  among  various
       hardware  models or configurations---for example, 68010 vs 68020, floating coprocessor or none.  A single
       installed version of the compiler can compile for any model or configuration, according  to  the  options
       specified.

       Some  configurations  of  the compiler also support additional special options, usually for compatibility
       with other compilers on the same platform.

       ARC Options

       These options are defined for ARC implementations:

       -EL Compile code for little endian mode.  This is the default.

       -EB Compile code for big endian mode.

       -mmangle-cpu
           Prepend the name of the CPU to all public symbol names.  In  multiple-processor  systems,  there  are
           many  ARC  variants  with different instruction and register set characteristics.  This flag prevents
           code compiled for one CPU to be linked with code  compiled  for  another.   No  facility  exists  for
           handling variants that are "almost identical".  This is an all or nothing option.

       -mcpu=cpu
           Compile  code  for  ARC  variant cpu.  Which variants are supported depend on the configuration.  All
           variants support -mcpu=base, this is the default.

       -mtext=text-section
       -mdata=data-section
       -mrodata=readonly-data-section
           Put functions, data, and readonly  data  in  text-section,  data-section,  and  readonly-data-section
           respectively by default.  This can be overridden with the "section" attribute.

       ARM Options

       These -m options are defined for Advanced RISC Machines (ARM) architectures:

       -mabi=name
           Generate code for the specified ABI.  Permissible values are: apcs-gnu, atpcs, aapcs, aapcs-linux and
           iwmmxt.

       -mapcs-frame
           Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the ARM Procedure Call Standard for all functions, even
           if this is not strictly necessary for correct execution of the code.  Specifying -fomit-frame-pointer
           with  this option will cause the stack frames not to be generated for leaf functions.  The default is
           -mno-apcs-frame.

       -mapcs
           This is a synonym for -mapcs-frame.

       -mthumb-interwork
           Generate code which supports calling between the ARM and Thumb instruction sets.  Without this option
           the  two  instruction  sets  cannot  be  reliably  used  inside  one   program.    The   default   is
           -mno-thumb-interwork, since slightly larger code is generated when -mthumb-interwork is specified.

       -mno-sched-prolog
           Prevent  the  reordering  of instructions in the function prolog, or the merging of those instruction
           with the instructions in the function's body.  This means  that  all  functions  will  start  with  a
           recognizable  set  of instructions (or in fact one of a choice from a small set of different function
           prologues), and this information can be used to locate the start if functions  inside  an  executable
           piece of code.  The default is -msched-prolog.

       -mfloat-abi=name
           Specifies which floating-point ABI to use.  Permissible values are: soft, softfp and hard.

           Specifying soft causes GCC to generate output containing library calls for floating-point operations.
           softfp  allows  the generation of code using hardware floating-point instructions, but still uses the
           soft-float calling conventions.  hard allows generation of floating-point instructions and uses  FPU-
           specific calling conventions.

           The  default  depends  on the specific target configuration.  Note that the hard-float and soft-float
           ABIs are not link-compatible; you must compile your entire program with the same ABI, and link with a
           compatible set of libraries.

       -mhard-float
           Equivalent to -mfloat-abi=hard.

       -msoft-float
           Equivalent to -mfloat-abi=soft.

       -mlittle-endian
           Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode.  This is the default  for  all  standard
           configurations.

       -mbig-endian
           Generate  code  for  a  processor  running  in  big-endian mode; the default is to compile code for a
           little-endian processor.

       -mwords-little-endian
           This option only applies when generating code for big-endian processors.  Generate code for a little-
           endian word order but a big-endian byte order.  That is, a byte order of the  form  32107654.   Note:
           this  option should only be used if you require compatibility with code for big-endian ARM processors
           generated by versions of the compiler prior to 2.8.

       -mcpu=name
           This specifies the name of the target ARM processor.  GCC uses this name to determine  what  kind  of
           instructions  it  can emit when generating assembly code.  Permissible names are: arm2, arm250, arm3,
           arm6, arm60, arm600, arm610, arm620, arm7, arm7m, arm7d,  arm7dm,  arm7di,  arm7dmi,  arm70,  arm700,
           arm700i,  arm710,  arm710c,  arm7100,  arm720,  arm7500,  arm7500fe,  arm7tdmi,  arm7tdmi-s, arm710t,
           arm720t, arm740t, strongarm, strongarm110, strongarm1100, strongarm1110, arm8, arm810,  arm9,  arm9e,
           arm920,  arm920t, arm922t, arm946e-s, arm966e-s, arm968e-s, arm926ej-s, arm940t, arm9tdmi, arm10tdmi,
           arm1020t, arm1026ej-s, arm10e, arm1020e,  arm1022e,  arm1136j-s,  arm1136jf-s,  mpcore,  mpcorenovfp,
           arm1156t2-s,  arm1156t2f-s,  arm1176jz-s,  arm1176jzf-s,  cortex-a5, cortex-a7, cortex-a8, cortex-a9,
           cortex-a15, cortex-r4, cortex-r4f, cortex-r5, cortex-m4,  cortex-m3,  cortex-m1,  cortex-m0,  xscale,
           iwmmxt, iwmmxt2, ep9312.

           -mcpu=generic-arch  is  also  permissible, and is equivalent to -march=arch -mtune=generic-arch.  See
           -mtune for more information.

           -mcpu=native causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU of the  build  computer.   At  present,  this
           feature  is only supported on Linux, and not all architectures are recognised.  If the auto-detect is
           unsuccessful the option has no effect.

       -mtune=name
           This option is very similar to the -mcpu= option, except that instead of specifying the actual target
           processor type, and hence restricting which instructions can be used, it specifies  that  GCC  should
           tune  the  performance  of  the  code as if the target were of the type specified in this option, but
           still choosing the instructions that it will generate based on the CPU specified by a -mcpu=  option.
           For some ARM implementations better performance can be obtained by using this option.

           -mtune=generic-arch  specifies  that GCC should tune the performance for a blend of processors within
           architecture arch.  The aim is to generate code that run well on the current most popular processors,
           balancing between optimizations that benefit  some  CPUs  in  the  range,  and  avoiding  performance
           pitfalls  of  other CPUs.  The effects of this option may change in future GCC versions as CPU models
           come and go.

           -mtune=native causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU of the build  computer.   At  present,  this
           feature  is only supported on Linux, and not all architectures are recognised.  If the auto-detect is
           unsuccessful the option has no effect.

       -march=name
           This specifies the name of the target ARM architecture.  GCC uses this name to determine what kind of
           instructions it can emit when generating assembly code.  This option can be used in conjunction  with
           or instead of the -mcpu= option.  Permissible names are: armv2, armv2a, armv3, armv3m, armv4, armv4t,
           armv5,  armv5t,  armv5e,  armv5te,  armv6, armv6j, armv6t2, armv6z, armv6zk, armv6-m, armv7, armv7-a,
           armv7-r, armv7-m, iwmmxt, iwmmxt2, ep9312.

           -march=native causes the compiler to auto-detect the architecture of the build computer.  At present,
           this feature is only supported on Linux, and not all architectures  are  recognised.   If  the  auto-
           detect is unsuccessful the option has no effect.

       -mfpu=name
       -mfpe=number
       -mfp=number
           This  specifies  what  floating  point  hardware  (or hardware emulation) is available on the target.
           Permissible names are: fpa, fpe2, fpe3, maverick, vfp, vfpv3, vfpv3-fp16, vfpv3-d16,  vfpv3-d16-fp16,
           vfpv3xd, vfpv3xd-fp16, neon, neon-fp16, vfpv4, vfpv4-d16, fpv4-sp-d16 and neon-vfpv4.  -mfp and -mfpe
           are synonyms for -mfpu=fpenumber, for compatibility with older versions of GCC.

           If -msoft-float is specified this specifies the format of floating point values.

           If  the  selected  floating-point  hardware  includes the NEON extension (e.g. -mfpu=neon), note that
           floating-point  operations   will   not   be   used   by   GCC's   auto-vectorization   pass   unless
           -funsafe-math-optimizations  is  also  specified.   This  is  because  NEON  hardware  does not fully
           implement the IEEE 754 standard for floating-point arithmetic  (in  particular  denormal  values  are
           treated as zero), so the use of NEON instructions may lead to a loss of precision.

       -mfp16-format=name
           Specify  the  format of the "__fp16" half-precision floating-point type.  Permissible names are none,
           ieee, and alternative; the default is none, in which case the "__fp16" type is not defined.

       -mstructure-size-boundary=n
           The size of all structures and unions will be rounded up to a multiple of the number of bits  set  by
           this  option.   Permissible  values  are  8,  32  and  64.   The  default  value varies for different
           toolchains.  For the COFF targeted toolchain the default value is 8.  A value of 64 is  only  allowed
           if the underlying ABI supports it.

           Specifying  the larger number can produce faster, more efficient code, but can also increase the size
           of the program.  Different values are potentially incompatible.  Code compiled with one value  cannot
           necessarily  expect  to  work  with  code  or libraries compiled with another value, if they exchange
           information using structures or unions.

       -mabort-on-noreturn
           Generate a call to the function "abort" at the end of a "noreturn" function.  It will be executed  if
           the function tries to return.

       -mlong-calls
       -mno-long-calls
           Tells  the  compiler  to  perform  function calls by first loading the address of the function into a
           register and then performing a subroutine call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target
           function will lie outside of the 64  megabyte  addressing  range  of  the  offset  based  version  of
           subroutine call instruction.

           Even if this switch is enabled, not all function calls will be turned into long calls.  The heuristic
           is  that  static  functions, functions which have the short-call attribute, functions that are inside
           the scope of a #pragma no_long_calls directive and functions  whose  definitions  have  already  been
           compiled  within  the current compilation unit, will not be turned into long calls.  The exception to
           this rule is that weak function definitions, functions with the long-call attribute  or  the  section
           attribute,  and functions that are within the scope of a #pragma long_calls directive, will always be
           turned into long calls.

           This feature is not  enabled  by  default.   Specifying  -mno-long-calls  will  restore  the  default
           behavior,  as will placing the function calls within the scope of a #pragma long_calls_off directive.
           Note these switches have no effect on how the compiler generates code to handle  function  calls  via
           function pointers.

       -msingle-pic-base
           Treat  the  register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than loading it in the prologue for
           each function.  The run-time system is responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate
           value before execution begins.

       -mpic-register=reg
           Specify the register to be used for PIC addressing.  The default  is  R10  unless  stack-checking  is
           enabled, when R9 is used.

       -mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
           Insert  NOPs  into  the  instruction stream to in order to work around problems with invalid Maverick
           instruction combinations.  This option is only valid if the -mcpu=ep9312  option  has  been  used  to
           enable  generation  of instructions for the Cirrus Maverick floating point co-processor.  This option
           is not enabled by default, since the problem is only present in older Maverick implementations.   The
           default can be re-enabled by use of the -mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns switch.

       -mpoke-function-name
           Write the name of each function into the text section, directly preceding the function prologue.  The
           generated code is similar to this:

                        t0
                            .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
                            .align
                        t1
                            .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
                        arm_poke_function_name
                            mov     ip, sp
                            stmfd   sp!, {fp, ip, lr, pc}
                            sub     fp, ip, #4

           When  performing  a  stack  backtrace, code can inspect the value of "pc" stored at "fp + 0".  If the
           trace function then looks at location "pc - 12" and the top 8 bits are set, then we know  that  there
           is  a  function  name  embedded  immediately  preceding  this  location  and  has length "((pc[-3]) &
           0xff000000)".

       -mthumb
           Generate code for the Thumb instruction set.  The default is to use the 32-bit ARM  instruction  set.
           This option automatically enables either 16-bit Thumb-1 or mixed 16/32-bit Thumb-2 instructions based
           on  the  -mcpu=name and -march=name options.  This option is not passed to the assembler. If you want
           to force assembler files to be interpreted as Thumb code, either add a .thumb directive to the source
           or pass the -mthumb option directly to the assembler by prefixing it with -Wa.

       -mtpcs-frame
           Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure  Call  Standard  for  all  non-leaf
           functions.   (A  leaf  function  is  one  that  does  not  call any other functions.)  The default is
           -mno-tpcs-frame.

       -mtpcs-leaf-frame
           Generate a stack frame that is compliant  with  the  Thumb  Procedure  Call  Standard  for  all  leaf
           functions.   (A  leaf  function  is  one  that  does  not  call any other functions.)  The default is
           -mno-apcs-leaf-frame.

       -mcallee-super-interworking
           Gives all externally visible functions in the file being compiled an ARM instruction set header which
           switches to Thumb mode before executing the rest of the function.  This allows these functions to  be
           called  from  non-interworking  code.   This  option  is  not  valid  in AAPCS configurations because
           interworking is enabled by default.

       -mcaller-super-interworking
           Allows calls via function pointers (including virtual functions) to execute correctly  regardless  of
           whether  the target code has been compiled for interworking or not.  There is a small overhead in the
           cost of executing a function pointer if this option is enabled.  This option is not  valid  in  AAPCS
           configurations because interworking is enabled by default.

       -mtp=name
           Specify  the  access  model  for  the thread local storage pointer.  The valid models are soft, which
           generates calls to "__aeabi_read_tp", cp15, which fetches the thread  pointer  from  "cp15"  directly
           (supported  in  the  arm6k  architecture),  and  auto,  which  uses the best available method for the
           selected processor.  The default setting is auto.

       -mword-relocations
           Only generate absolute relocations on word sized values  (i.e.  R_ARM_ABS32).   This  is  enabled  by
           default  on  targets (uClinux, SymbianOS) where the runtime loader imposes this restriction, and when
           -fpic or -fPIC is specified.

       -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
           Some Cortex-M3 cores can cause data corruption when "ldrd" instructions with overlapping  destination
           and  base  registers  are  used.   This  option avoids generating these instructions.  This option is
           enabled by default when -mcpu=cortex-m3 is specified.

       AVR Options

       These options are defined for AVR implementations:

       -mmcu=mcu
           Specify ATMEL AVR instruction set or MCU type.

           Instruction set avr1 is for the minimal AVR core, not supported by the C compiler, only for assembler
           programs (MCU types: at90s1200, attiny10, attiny11, attiny12, attiny15, attiny28).

           Instruction set avr2 (default) is for the classic AVR core with up to 8K program  memory  space  (MCU
           types:  at90s2313,  at90s2323,  attiny22,  at90s2333,  at90s2343,  at90s4414,  at90s4433,  at90s4434,
           at90s8515, at90c8534, at90s8535).

           Instruction set avr3 is for the classic AVR core with up to 128K program  memory  space  (MCU  types:
           atmega103, atmega603, at43usb320, at76c711).

           Instruction  set  avr4  is  for  the enhanced AVR core with up to 8K program memory space (MCU types:
           atmega8, atmega83, atmega85).

           Instruction set avr5 is for the enhanced AVR core with up to 128K program memory  space  (MCU  types:
           atmega16, atmega161, atmega163, atmega32, atmega323, atmega64, atmega128, at43usb355, at94k).

       -mno-interrupts
           Generated code is not compatible with hardware interrupts.  Code size will be smaller.

       -mcall-prologues
           Functions  prologues/epilogues  expanded  as  call  to  appropriate  subroutines.   Code size will be
           smaller.

       -mtiny-stack
           Change only the low 8 bits of the stack pointer.

       -mint8
           Assume int to be 8 bit integer.  This affects the sizes of all types: A char will be 1 byte,  an  int
           will  be  1 byte, a long will be 2 bytes and long long will be 4 bytes.  Please note that this option
           does not comply to the C standards, but it will provide you with smaller code size.

       "EIND" and Devices with more than 128k Bytes of Flash

       Pointers in the implementation are 16 bits wide.  The address of a function or label  is  represented  as
       word address so that indirect jumps and calls can address any code address in the range of 64k words.

       In  order  to faciliate indirect jump on devices with more than 128k bytes of program memory space, there
       is a special function register called "EIND" that serves as most significant part of the  target  address
       when "EICALL" or "EIJMP" instructions are used.

       Indirect jumps and calls on these devices are handled as follows and are subject to some limitations:

       •   The compiler never sets "EIND".

       •   The  startup  code  from  libgcc never sets "EIND".  Notice that startup code is a blend of code from
           libgcc  and  avr-libc.   For  the  impact  of  avr-libc  on  "EIND",  see  the   avr-libc user manual
           ("http://nongnu.org/avr-libc/user-manual").

       •   The compiler uses "EIND" implicitely in "EICALL"/"EIJMP" instructions or might read "EIND" directly.

       •   The  compiler assumes that "EIND" never changes during the startup code or run of the application. In
           particular, "EIND" is not saved/restored in function or interrupt service routine prologue/epilogue.

       •   It is legitimate for user-specific startup code to set up "EIND"  early,  for  example  by  means  of
           initialization  code  located  in  section  ".init3",  and  thus  prior  to general startup code that
           initializes RAM and calls constructors.

       •   For indirect calls to functions and computed goto, the linker will generate  stubs.  Stubs  are  jump
           pads  sometimes  also called trampolines. Thus, the indirect call/jump will jump to such a stub.  The
           stub contains a direct jump to the desired address.

       •   Stubs will be generated automatically by the linker if the following two conditions are met:

           -<The address of a label is taken by means of the "gs" modifier>
               (short for generate stubs) like so:

                       LDI r24, lo8(gs(<func>))
                       LDI r25, hi8(gs(<func>))

           -<The final location of that label is in a code segment>
               outside the segment where the stubs are located.

       •   The compiler will emit such "gs" modifiers for code labels in the following situations:

           -<Taking address of a function or code label.>
           -<Computed goto.>
           -<If prologue-save function is used, see -mcall-prologues>
               command line option.

           -<Switch/case dispatch tables. If you do not want such dispatch>
               tables you can specify the -fno-jump-tables command line option.

           -<C and C++ constructors/destructors called during startup/shutdown.>
           -<If the tools hit a "gs()" modifier explained above.>
       •   The default linker script is arranged for code with "EIND = 0".  If code is supposed to  work  for  a
           setup  with  "EIND  != 0", a custom linker script has to be used in order to place the sections whose
           name start with ".trampolines" into the segment where "EIND" points to.

       •   Jumping to non-symbolic addresses like so is not supported:

                   int main (void)
                   {
                       /* Call function at word address 0x2 */
                       return ((int(*)(void)) 0x2)();
                   }

           Instead, a stub has to be set up:

                   int main (void)
                   {
                       extern int func_4 (void);

                       /* Call function at byte address 0x4 */
                       return func_4();
                   }

           and the application be linked with "-Wl,--defsym,func_4=0x4".  Alternatively, "func_4" can be defined
           in the linker script.

       Blackfin Options

       -mcpu=cpu[-sirevision]
           Specifies the name of the target Blackfin processor.  Currently, cpu can  be  one  of  bf512,  bf514,
           bf516,  bf518,  bf522,  bf523,  bf524, bf525, bf526, bf527, bf531, bf532, bf533, bf534, bf536, bf537,
           bf538, bf539, bf542, bf544, bf547, bf548, bf549, bf542m, bf544m, bf547m, bf548m, bf549m, bf561.   The
           optional sirevision specifies the silicon revision of the target Blackfin processor.  Any workarounds
           available  for  the targeted silicon revision will be enabled.  If sirevision is none, no workarounds
           are enabled.  If sirevision is any, all workarounds for the targeted processor will be enabled.   The
           "__SILICON_REVISION__"  macro  is  defined to two hexadecimal digits representing the major and minor
           numbers in the silicon revision.  If sirevision is none, the "__SILICON_REVISION__" is  not  defined.
           If  sirevision  is  any,  the  "__SILICON_REVISION__"  is  defined  to  be  0xffff.  If this optional
           sirevision is not used, GCC assumes the latest  known  silicon  revision  of  the  targeted  Blackfin
           processor.

           Support  for  bf561  is  incomplete.   For  bf561, Only the processor macro is defined.  Without this
           option, bf532 is used as the processor by default.  The corresponding predefined processor macros for
           cpu is to be defined.  And for bfin-elf toolchain, this causes the hardware BSP provided by  libgloss
           to be linked in if -msim is not given.

       -msim
           Specifies  that  the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes the simulator BSP provided by
           libgloss to be linked in.  This option  has  effect  only  for  bfin-elf  toolchain.   Certain  other
           options, such as -mid-shared-library and -mfdpic, imply -msim.

       -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
           Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This avoids the instructions to save,
           set  up  and  restore  frame  pointers  and makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The
           option -fomit-frame-pointer removes the frame pointer for all functions which  might  make  debugging
           harder.

       -mspecld-anomaly
           When  enabled,  the  compiler  will ensure that the generated code does not contain speculative loads
           after jump instructions. If this option is used, "__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_LOADS" is defined.

       -mno-specld-anomaly
           Don't generate extra code to prevent speculative loads from occurring.

       -mcsync-anomaly
           When enabled, the compiler will ensure that the generated  code  does  not  contain  CSYNC  or  SSYNC
           instructions    too    soon    after    conditional    branches.     If    this   option   is   used,
           "__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_SYNCS" is defined.

       -mno-csync-anomaly
           Don't generate extra code to prevent CSYNC or SSYNC instructions from  occurring  too  soon  after  a
           conditional branch.

       -mlow-64k
           When  enabled,  the  compiler is free to take advantage of the knowledge that the entire program fits
           into the low 64k of memory.

       -mno-low-64k
           Assume that the program is arbitrarily large.  This is the default.

       -mstack-check-l1
           Do stack checking using information placed into L1 scratchpad memory by the uClinux kernel.

       -mid-shared-library
           Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.  This allows for  execute  in
           place  and shared libraries in an environment without virtual memory management.  This option implies
           -fPIC.  With a bfin-elf target, this option implies -msim.

       -mno-id-shared-library
           Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.  This is the default.

       -mleaf-id-shared-library
           Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method, but assumes that this library
           or executable won't link against any other ID shared libraries.  That  allows  the  compiler  to  use
           faster code for jumps and calls.

       -mno-leaf-id-shared-library
           Do  not  assume that the code being compiled won't link against any ID shared libraries.  Slower code
           will be generated for jump and call insns.

       -mshared-library-id=n
           Specified the identification number of the ID based shared  library  being  compiled.   Specifying  a
           value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying other values will force the allocation of that
           number to the current library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.

       -msep-data
           Generate  code that allows the data segment to be located in a different area of memory from the text
           segment.  This allows for execute in place in an environment without  virtual  memory  management  by
           eliminating relocations against the text section.

       -mno-sep-data
           Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.  This is the default.

       -mlong-calls
       -mno-long-calls
           Tells  the  compiler  to  perform  function calls by first loading the address of the function into a
           register and then performing a subroutine call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target
           function will lie outside of the 24 bit addressing range of the offset based  version  of  subroutine
           call instruction.

           This  feature  is  not  enabled  by  default.   Specifying  -mno-long-calls  will restore the default
           behavior.  Note these switches have no effect on how the compiler generates code to  handle  function
           calls via function pointers.

       -mfast-fp
           Link  with  the  fast  floating-point  library.  This library relaxes some of the IEEE floating-point
           standard's rules for checking inputs against Not-a-Number (NAN), in the interest of performance.

       -minline-plt
           Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are not known to bind locally.  It
           has no effect without -mfdpic.

       -mmulticore
           Build standalone application for multicore Blackfin processor. Proper start files  and  link  scripts
           will  be used to support multicore.  This option defines "__BFIN_MULTICORE". It can only be used with
           -mcpu=bf561[-sirevision]. It can be used with -mcorea or -mcoreb. If it's  used  without  -mcorea  or
           -mcoreb,  single application/dual core programming model is used. In this model, the main function of
           Core B should be named as coreb_main. If it's used with -mcorea or -mcoreb, one application per  core
           programming  model is used.  If this option is not used, single core application programming model is
           used.

       -mcorea
           Build standalone application for Core A of BF561 when using  one  application  per  core  programming
           model.  Proper  start  files  and  link  scripts  will be used to support Core A. This option defines
           "__BFIN_COREA". It must be used with -mmulticore.

       -mcoreb
           Build standalone application for Core B of BF561 when using  one  application  per  core  programming
           model.  Proper  start  files  and  link  scripts  will be used to support Core B. This option defines
           "__BFIN_COREB". When this option is used, coreb_main should be used instead of main. It must be  used
           with -mmulticore.

       -msdram
           Build  standalone  application for SDRAM. Proper start files and link scripts will be used to put the
           application into SDRAM.  Loader should initialize SDRAM before loading the  application  into  SDRAM.
           This option defines "__BFIN_SDRAM".

       -micplb
           Assume  that  ICPLBs are enabled at runtime.  This has an effect on certain anomaly workarounds.  For
           Linux targets, the default is to assume ICPLBs are enabled; for standalone applications  the  default
           is off.

       CRIS Options

       These options are defined specifically for the CRIS ports.

       -march=architecture-type
       -mcpu=architecture-type
           Generate  code  for the specified architecture.  The choices for architecture-type are v3, v8 and v10
           for respectively ETRAX 4, ETRAX 100, and ETRAX 100 LX.  Default is v0 except for cris-axis-linux-gnu,
           where the default is v10.

       -mtune=architecture-type
           Tune to architecture-type everything applicable about the generated code, except for the ABI and  the
           set   of   available   instructions.    The  choices  for  architecture-type  are  the  same  as  for
           -march=architecture-type.

       -mmax-stack-frame=n
           Warn when the stack frame of a function exceeds n bytes.

       -metrax4
       -metrax100
           The options -metrax4 and -metrax100 are synonyms for -march=v3 and -march=v8 respectively.

       -mmul-bug-workaround
       -mno-mul-bug-workaround
           Work around a bug in the "muls" and "mulu" instructions for CPU models where it applies.  This option
           is active by default.

       -mpdebug
           Enable CRIS-specific verbose debug-related information in the assembly code.  This  option  also  has
           the  effect to turn off the #NO_APP formatted-code indicator to the assembler at the beginning of the
           assembly file.

       -mcc-init
           Do  not  use  condition-code  results  from  previous  instruction;  always  emit  compare  and  test
           instructions before use of condition codes.

       -mno-side-effects
           Do not emit instructions with side-effects in addressing modes other than post-increment.

       -mstack-align
       -mno-stack-align
       -mdata-align
       -mno-data-align
       -mconst-align
       -mno-const-align
           These options (no-options) arranges (eliminate arrangements) for the stack-frame, individual data and
           constants  to  be  aligned  for  the  maximum  single data access size for the chosen CPU model.  The
           default is to arrange for 32-bit alignment.  ABI details such as structure layout are not affected by
           these options.

       -m32-bit
       -m16-bit
       -m8-bit
           Similar to the stack- data- and const-align options above, these  options  arrange  for  stack-frame,
           writable  data  and  constants  to  all  be  32-bit,  16-bit or 8-bit aligned.  The default is 32-bit
           alignment.

       -mno-prologue-epilogue
       -mprologue-epilogue
           With -mno-prologue-epilogue, the normal function prologue and epilogue that sets up  the  stack-frame
           are  omitted  and  no  return  instructions  or return sequences are generated in the code.  Use this
           option only together with visual inspection of the compiled code: no warnings or errors are generated
           when call-saved registers must be saved, or storage for local variable needs to be allocated.

       -mno-gotplt
       -mgotplt
           With -fpic and -fPIC, don't generate (do generate) instruction  sequences  that  load  addresses  for
           functions  from the PLT part of the GOT rather than (traditional on other architectures) calls to the
           PLT.  The default is -mgotplt.

       -melf
           Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-elf and cris-axis-linux-gnu targets.

       -mlinux
           Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-linux-gnu target.

       -sim
           This option, recognized for the cris-axis-elf arranges to link with  input-output  functions  from  a
           simulator library.  Code, initialized data and zero-initialized data are allocated consecutively.

       -sim2
           Like -sim, but pass linker options to locate initialized data at 0x40000000 and zero-initialized data
           at 0x80000000.

       CRX Options

       These options are defined specifically for the CRX ports.

       -mmac
           Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.

       -mpush-args
           Push  instructions  will  be  used  to  pass outgoing arguments when functions are called. Enabled by
           default.

       Darwin Options

       These options are defined for all architectures running the Darwin operating system.

       FSF GCC on Darwin does not create "fat" object files; it will  create  an  object  file  for  the  single
       architecture  that  it  was  built  to target.  Apple's GCC on Darwin does create "fat" files if multiple
       -arch options are used; it does so by running the compiler or  linker  multiple  times  and  joining  the
       results together with lipo.

       The  subtype of the file created (like ppc7400 or ppc970 or i686) is determined by the flags that specify
       the ISA that GCC is targetting, like -mcpu or -march.  The -force_cpusubtype_ALL option can  be  used  to
       override this.

       The  Darwin  tools  vary  in their behavior when presented with an ISA mismatch.  The assembler, as, will
       only permit instructions to be used that are valid for the subtype of the file it is generating,  so  you
       cannot   put   64-bit   instructions  in  a  ppc750  object  file.   The  linker  for  shared  libraries,
       /usr/bin/libtool, will fail and print an  error  if  asked  to  create  a  shared  library  with  a  less
       restrictive  subtype  than its input files (for instance, trying to put a ppc970 object file in a ppc7400
       library).  The linker for executables, ld, will quietly give the executable the most restrictive  subtype
       of any of its input files.

       -Fdir
           Add  the  framework  directory  dir  to the head of the list of directories to be searched for header
           files.  These directories are interleaved with those specified by -I options and  are  scanned  in  a
           left-to-right order.

           A  framework  directory  is  a  directory  with  frameworks in it.  A framework is a directory with a
           "Headers" and/or "PrivateHeaders" directory contained directly in it that ends in ".framework".   The
           name  of  a  framework  is the name of this directory excluding the ".framework".  Headers associated
           with the framework are found in one of those two directories, with "Headers" being searched first.  A
           subframework is a framework directory that is in a framework's "Frameworks" directory.   Includes  of
           subframework headers can only appear in a header of a framework that contains the subframework, or in
           a  sibling  subframework header.  Two subframeworks are siblings if they occur in the same framework.
           A subframework should not have the same name as a framework, a warning will  be  issued  if  this  is
           violated.   Currently  a  subframework cannot have subframeworks, in the future, the mechanism may be
           extended to support this.  The standard frameworks can be found in  "/System/Library/Frameworks"  and
           "/Library/Frameworks".    An  example  include  looks  like  "#include  <Framework/header.h>",  where
           Framework denotes the name of the  framework  and  header.h  is  found  in  the  "PrivateHeaders"  or
           "Headers" directory.

       -iframeworkdir
           Like  -F  except  the directory is a treated as a system directory.  The main difference between this
           -iframework and -F is that with -iframework the compiler does not  warn  about  constructs  contained
           within header files found via dir.  This option is valid only for the C family of languages.

       -gused
           Emit  debugging  information  for  symbols  that  are used.  For STABS debugging format, this enables
           -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols.  This is by default ON.

       -gfull
           Emit debugging information for all symbols and types.

       -mmacosx-version-min=version
           The earliest version of MacOS X that this executable will run  on  is  version.   Typical  values  of
           version include 10.1, 10.2, and 10.3.9.

           If the compiler was built to use the system's headers by default, then the default for this option is
           the  system  version on which the compiler is running, otherwise the default is to make choices which
           are compatible with as many systems and code bases as possible.

       -mkernel
           Enable kernel development mode.  The -mkernel  option  sets  -static,  -fno-common,  -fno-cxa-atexit,
           -fno-exceptions,  -fno-non-call-exceptions,  -fapple-kext,  -fno-weak and -fno-rtti where applicable.
           This mode also sets -mno-altivec, -msoft-float, -fno-builtin and -mlong-branch for PowerPC targets.

       -mone-byte-bool
           Override the defaults for bool so that sizeof(bool)==1.  By default sizeof(bool) is 4 when  compiling
           for Darwin/PowerPC and 1 when compiling for Darwin/x86, so this option has no effect on x86.

           Warning:  The  -mone-byte-bool  switch causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible with
           code generated without that switch.  Using this switch may require recompiling all other modules in a
           program, including system libraries.  Use this switch to conform to a non-default data model.

       -mfix-and-continue
       -ffix-and-continue
       -findirect-data
           Generate code suitable for fast turn around development.  Needed to enable gdb  to  dynamically  load
           ".o"  files  into  already running programs.  -findirect-data and -ffix-and-continue are provided for
           backwards compatibility.

       -all_load
           Loads all members of static archive libraries.  See man ld(1) for more information.

       -arch_errors_fatal
           Cause the errors having to do with files that have the wrong architecture to be fatal.

       -bind_at_load
           Causes the output file to be marked such that the dynamic linker will bind all  undefined  references
           when the file is loaded or launched.

       -bundle
           Produce a Mach-o bundle format file.  See man ld(1) for more information.

       -bundle_loader executable
           This  option  specifies  the executable that will be loading the build output file being linked.  See
           man ld(1) for more information.

       -dynamiclib
           When passed this option, GCC will produce a dynamic library instead of an  executable  when  linking,
           using the Darwin libtool command.

       -force_cpusubtype_ALL
           This  causes  GCC's  output  file  to have the ALL subtype, instead of one controlled by the -mcpu or
           -march option.

       -allowable_client  client_name
       -client_name
       -compatibility_version
       -current_version
       -dead_strip
       -dependency-file
       -dylib_file
       -dylinker_install_name
       -dynamic
       -exported_symbols_list
       -filelist
       -flat_namespace
       -force_flat_namespace
       -headerpad_max_install_names
       -image_base
       -init
       -install_name
       -keep_private_externs
       -multi_module
       -multiply_defined
       -multiply_defined_unused
       -noall_load
       -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
       -nofixprebinding
       -nomultidefs
       -noprebind
       -noseglinkedit
       -pagezero_size
       -prebind
       -prebind_all_twolevel_modules
       -private_bundle
       -read_only_relocs
       -sectalign
       -sectobjectsymbols
       -whyload
       -seg1addr
       -sectcreate
       -sectobjectsymbols
       -sectorder
       -segaddr
       -segs_read_only_addr
       -segs_read_write_addr
       -seg_addr_table
       -seg_addr_table_filename
       -seglinkedit
       -segprot
       -segs_read_only_addr
       -segs_read_write_addr
       -single_module
       -static
       -sub_library
       -sub_umbrella
       -twolevel_namespace
       -umbrella
       -undefined
       -unexported_symbols_list
       -weak_reference_mismatches
       -whatsloaded
           These options are passed to the Darwin linker.  The Darwin linker man page describes them in detail.

       DEC Alpha Options

       These -m options are defined for the DEC Alpha implementations:

       -mno-soft-float
       -msoft-float
           Use (do not use) the  hardware  floating-point  instructions  for  floating-point  operations.   When
           -msoft-float  is  specified, functions in libgcc.a will be used to perform floating-point operations.
           Unless they are replaced by routines that emulate the floating-point operations, or compiled in  such
           a  way as to call such emulations routines, these routines will issue floating-point operations.   If
           you are compiling for an Alpha without floating-point operations, you must ensure that the library is
           built so as not to call them.

           Note that Alpha implementations without floating-point operations are required to have floating-point
           registers.

       -mfp-reg
       -mno-fp-regs
           Generate code that uses (does  not  use)  the  floating-point  register  set.   -mno-fp-regs  implies
           -msoft-float.   If the floating-point register set is not used, floating point operands are passed in
           integer registers as if they were integers and floating-point results are passed  in  $0  instead  of
           $f0.   This  is  a  non-standard  calling sequence, so any function with a floating-point argument or
           return value called by code compiled with -mno-fp-regs must also be compiled with that option.

           A typical use of this option is building a kernel that does not use, and  hence  need  not  save  and
           restore, any floating-point registers.

       -mieee
           The  Alpha  architecture implements floating-point hardware optimized for maximum performance.  It is
           mostly compliant with the IEEE floating point  standard.   However,  for  full  compliance,  software
           assistance  is  required.   This  option  generates  code  fully  IEEE compliant code except that the
           inexact-flag is not maintained (see below).  If this option is  turned  on,  the  preprocessor  macro
           "_IEEE_FP"  is  defined  during  compilation.   The  resulting  code is less efficient but is able to
           correctly support  denormalized  numbers  and  exceptional  IEEE  values  such  as  not-a-number  and
           plus/minus infinity.  Other Alpha compilers call this option -ieee_with_no_inexact.

       -mieee-with-inexact
           This  is like -mieee except the generated code also maintains the IEEE inexact-flag.  Turning on this
           option causes the generated code to implement fully-compliant IEEE math.  In addition to  "_IEEE_FP",
           "_IEEE_FP_EXACT"  is  defined  as  a preprocessor macro.  On some Alpha implementations the resulting
           code may execute significantly slower than the code generated by default.  Since there is very little
           code that depends on the inexact-flag, you should normally not  specify  this  option.   Other  Alpha
           compilers call this option -ieee_with_inexact.

       -mfp-trap-mode=trap-mode
           This  option controls what floating-point related traps are enabled.  Other Alpha compilers call this
           option -fptm trap-mode.  The trap mode can be set to one of four values:

           n   This is the default (normal) setting.  The only traps that are enabled are the ones  that  cannot
               be disabled in software (e.g., division by zero trap).

           u   In addition to the traps enabled by n, underflow traps are enabled as well.

           su  Like  u,  but  the  instructions  are  marked  to  be  safe  for  software  completion (see Alpha
               architecture manual for details).

           sui Like su, but inexact traps are enabled as well.

       -mfp-rounding-mode=rounding-mode
           Selects the IEEE rounding mode.  Other Alpha compilers call this  option  -fprm  rounding-mode.   The
           rounding-mode can be one of:

           n   Normal IEEE rounding mode.  Floating point numbers are rounded towards the nearest machine number
               or towards the even machine number in case of a tie.

           m   Round towards minus infinity.

           c   Chopped rounding mode.  Floating point numbers are rounded towards zero.

           d   Dynamic  rounding  mode.   A  field  in  the  floating  point  control  register (fpcr, see Alpha
               architecture reference manual) controls the rounding mode in effect.  The C  library  initializes
               this register for rounding towards plus infinity.  Thus, unless your program modifies the fpcr, d
               corresponds to round towards plus infinity.

       -mtrap-precision=trap-precision
           In  the  Alpha  architecture,  floating  point  traps  are  imprecise.   This  means without software
           assistance it is impossible to recover from a floating trap and program execution normally  needs  to
           be  terminated.   GCC can generate code that can assist operating system trap handlers in determining
           the exact location that  caused  a  floating  point  trap.   Depending  on  the  requirements  of  an
           application, different levels of precisions can be selected:

           p   Program  precision.   This option is the default and means a trap handler can only identify which
               program caused a floating point exception.

           f   Function precision.  The trap handler can determine the function that  caused  a  floating  point
               exception.

           i   Instruction  precision.   The  trap  handler  can  determine  the exact instruction that caused a
               floating point exception.

           Other Alpha compilers provide the equivalent options called -scope_safe and -resumption_safe.

       -mieee-conformant
           This option marks the generated code as IEEE conformant.  You must not use  this  option  unless  you
           also  specify -mtrap-precision=i and either -mfp-trap-mode=su or -mfp-trap-mode=sui.  Its only effect
           is to emit the line .eflag 48 in the function prologue of the generated  assembly  file.   Under  DEC
           Unix, this has the effect that IEEE-conformant math library routines will be linked in.

       -mbuild-constants
           Normally  GCC  examines  a  32- or 64-bit integer constant to see if it can construct it from smaller
           constants in two or three instructions.  If it cannot, it will output the constant as a  literal  and
           generate code to load it from the data segment at runtime.

           Use  this  option to require GCC to construct all integer constants using code, even if it takes more
           instructions (the maximum is six).

           You would typically use this option to build a  shared  library  dynamic  loader.   Itself  a  shared
           library,  it must relocate itself in memory before it can find the variables and constants in its own
           data segment.

       -malpha-as
       -mgas
           Select whether to generate code to be assembled by the vendor-supplied assembler (-malpha-as)  or  by
           the GNU assembler -mgas.

       -mbwx
       -mno-bwx
       -mcix
       -mno-cix
       -mfix
       -mno-fix
       -mmax
       -mno-max
           Indicate whether GCC should generate code to use the optional BWX, CIX, FIX and MAX instruction sets.
           The  default  is to use the instruction sets supported by the CPU type specified via -mcpu= option or
           that of the CPU on which GCC was built if none was specified.

       -mfloat-vax
       -mfloat-ieee
           Generate code that uses (does not use) VAX F and G floating point arithmetic instead of  IEEE  single
           and double precision.

       -mexplicit-relocs
       -mno-explicit-relocs
           Older  Alpha  assemblers  provided no way to generate symbol relocations except via assembler macros.
           Use of these macros does not allow optimal instruction scheduling.  GNU binutils as of  version  2.12
           supports  a  new syntax that allows the compiler to explicitly mark which relocations should apply to
           which instructions.  This option is mostly useful for debugging, as GCC detects the  capabilities  of
           the assembler when it is built and sets the default accordingly.

       -msmall-data
       -mlarge-data
           When  -mexplicit-relocs  is  in  effect,  static  data is accessed via gp-relative relocations.  When
           -msmall-data is used, objects 8 bytes long or smaller are placed in a small data area  (the  ".sdata"
           and  ".sbss"  sections) and are accessed via 16-bit relocations off of the $gp register.  This limits
           the size of the small data area to 64KB, but allows the variables  to  be  directly  accessed  via  a
           single instruction.

           The  default is -mlarge-data.  With this option the data area is limited to just below 2GB.  Programs
           that require more than 2GB of data must use "malloc" or "mmap" to  allocate  the  data  in  the  heap
           instead of in the program's data segment.

           When generating code for shared libraries, -fpic implies -msmall-data and -fPIC implies -mlarge-data.

       -msmall-text
       -mlarge-text
           When  -msmall-text  is  used,  the  compiler  assumes  that the code of the entire program (or shared
           library) fits in 4MB, and is thus reachable with a branch instruction.  When  -msmall-data  is  used,
           the  compiler  can assume that all local symbols share the same $gp value, and thus reduce the number
           of instructions required for a function call from 4 to 1.

           The default is -mlarge-text.

       -mcpu=cpu_type
           Set the instruction set and instruction scheduling parameters for machine  type  cpu_type.   You  can
           specify  either  the  EV  style  name  or  the  corresponding  chip  number.  GCC supports scheduling
           parameters for the EV4, EV5 and EV6 family of processors and will choose the default values  for  the
           instruction  set  from  the  processor you specify.  If you do not specify a processor type, GCC will
           default to the processor on which the compiler was built.

           Supported values for cpu_type are

           ev4
           ev45
           21064
               Schedules as an EV4 and has no instruction set extensions.

           ev5
           21164
               Schedules as an EV5 and has no instruction set extensions.

           ev56
           21164a
               Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX extension.

           pca56
           21164pc
           21164PC
               Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX and MAX extensions.

           ev6
           21264
               Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, FIX, and MAX extensions.

           ev67
           21264a
               Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, CIX, FIX, and MAX extensions.

           Native Linux/GNU toolchains also support the value native, which selects the best architecture option
           for the host processor.  -mcpu=native has no effect if GCC does not recognize the processor.

       -mtune=cpu_type
           Set only the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type cpu_type.  The instruction set is not
           changed.

           Native Linux/GNU toolchains also support the value native, which selects the best architecture option
           for the host processor.  -mtune=native has no effect if GCC does not recognize the processor.

       -mmemory-latency=time
           Sets the latency  the  scheduler  should  assume  for  typical  memory  references  as  seen  by  the
           application.   This  number is highly dependent on the memory access patterns used by the application
           and the size of the external cache on the machine.

           Valid options for time are

           number
               A decimal number representing clock cycles.

           L1
           L2
           L3
           main
               The compiler contains estimates of the number of clock cycles for "typical" EV4  &  EV5  hardware
               for  the  Level  1,  2  &  3  caches (also called Dcache, Scache, and Bcache), as well as to main
               memory.  Note that L3 is only valid for EV5.

       DEC Alpha/VMS Options

       These -m options are defined for the DEC Alpha/VMS implementations:

       -mvms-return-codes
           Return VMS condition codes from main.  The default is to return POSIX style  condition  (e.g.  error)
           codes.

       -mdebug-main=prefix
           Flag the first routine whose name starts with prefix as the main routine for the debugger.

       -mmalloc64
           Default to 64bit memory allocation routines.

       FR30 Options

       These options are defined specifically for the FR30 port.

       -msmall-model
           Use  the  small  address  space  model.   This  can produce smaller code, but it does assume that all
           symbolic values and addresses will fit into a 20-bit range.

       -mno-lsim
           Assume that run-time support has been provided and so there is  no  need  to  include  the  simulator
           library (libsim.a) on the linker command line.

       FRV Options

       -mgpr-32
           Only use the first 32 general purpose registers.

       -mgpr-64
           Use all 64 general purpose registers.

       -mfpr-32
           Use only the first 32 floating point registers.

       -mfpr-64
           Use all 64 floating point registers

       -mhard-float
           Use hardware instructions for floating point operations.

       -msoft-float
           Use library routines for floating point operations.

       -malloc-cc
           Dynamically allocate condition code registers.

       -mfixed-cc
           Do not try to dynamically allocate condition code registers, only use "icc0" and "fcc0".

       -mdword
           Change ABI to use double word insns.

       -mno-dword
           Do not use double word instructions.

       -mdouble
           Use floating point double instructions.

       -mno-double
           Do not use floating point double instructions.

       -mmedia
           Use media instructions.

       -mno-media
           Do not use media instructions.

       -mmuladd
           Use multiply and add/subtract instructions.

       -mno-muladd
           Do not use multiply and add/subtract instructions.

       -mfdpic
           Select the FDPIC ABI, that uses function descriptors to represent pointers to functions.  Without any
           PIC/PIE-related  options,  it  implies  -fPIE.  With -fpic or -fpie, it assumes GOT entries and small
           data are within a 12-bit range from the GOT base address;  with  -fPIC  or  -fPIE,  GOT  offsets  are
           computed with 32 bits.  With a bfin-elf target, this option implies -msim.

       -minline-plt
           Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are not known to bind locally.  It
           has  no  effect  without  -mfdpic.  It's enabled by default if optimizing for speed and compiling for
           shared libraries (i.e., -fPIC or -fpic), or when an optimization option  such  as  -O3  or  above  is
           present in the command line.

       -mTLS
           Assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.

       -mtls
           Do not assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.

       -mgprel-ro
           Enable  the  use  of  "GPREL"  relocations in the FDPIC ABI for data that is known to be in read-only
           sections.  It's enabled by default, except for -fpic or -fpie: even  though  it  may  help  make  the
           global  offset  table  smaller,  it  trades  1  instruction  for 4.  With -fPIC or -fPIE, it trades 3
           instructions for 4, one of which may be shared by multiple symbols, and it avoids the need for a  GOT
           entry for the referenced symbol, so it's more likely to be a win.  If it is not, -mno-gprel-ro can be
           used to disable it.

       -multilib-library-pic
           Link  with  the  (library, not FD) pic libraries.  It's implied by -mlibrary-pic, as well as by -fPIC
           and -fpic without -mfdpic.  You should never have to use it explicitly.

       -mlinked-fp
           Follow the EABI requirement of always creating a frame pointer whenever a stack frame  is  allocated.
           This option is enabled by default and can be disabled with -mno-linked-fp.

       -mlong-calls
           Use  indirect  addressing  to  call  functions outside the current compilation unit.  This allows the
           functions to be placed anywhere within the 32-bit address space.

       -malign-labels
           Try to align labels to an 8-byte boundary by inserting nops into the previous  packet.   This  option
           only  has an effect when VLIW packing is enabled.  It doesn't create new packets; it merely adds nops
           to existing ones.

       -mlibrary-pic
           Generate position-independent EABI code.

       -macc-4
           Use only the first four media accumulator registers.

       -macc-8
           Use all eight media accumulator registers.

       -mpack
           Pack VLIW instructions.

       -mno-pack
           Do not pack VLIW instructions.

       -mno-eflags
           Do not mark ABI switches in e_flags.

       -mcond-move
           Enable the use of conditional-move instructions (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-cond-move
           Disable the use of conditional-move instructions.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mscc
           Enable the use of conditional set instructions (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-scc
           Disable the use of conditional set instructions.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mcond-exec
           Enable the use of conditional execution (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-cond-exec
           Disable the use of conditional execution.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mvliw-branch
           Run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-vliw-branch
           Do not run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mmulti-cond-exec
           Enable optimization of "&&" and "||" in conditional execution (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-multi-cond-exec
           Disable optimization of "&&" and "||" in conditional execution.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mnested-cond-exec
           Enable nested conditional execution optimizations (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-nested-cond-exec
           Disable nested conditional execution optimizations.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -moptimize-membar
           This switch removes redundant "membar" instructions from the compiler generated code.  It is  enabled
           by default.

       -mno-optimize-membar
           This  switch  disables  the  automatic  removal of redundant "membar" instructions from the generated
           code.

       -mtomcat-stats
           Cause gas to print out tomcat statistics.

       -mcpu=cpu
           Select the processor type for which to generate code.  Possible values are frv, fr550, tomcat, fr500,
           fr450, fr405, fr400, fr300 and simple.

       GNU/Linux Options

       These -m options are defined for GNU/Linux targets:

       -mglibc
           Use the GNU C library.  This is the default  except  on  *-*-linux-*uclibc*  and  *-*-linux-*android*
           targets.

       -muclibc
           Use uClibc C library.  This is the default on *-*-linux-*uclibc* targets.

       -mbionic
           Use Bionic C library.  This is the default on *-*-linux-*android* targets.

       -mandroid
           Compile code compatible with Android platform.  This is the default on *-*-linux-*android* targets.

           When  compiling, this option enables -mbionic, -fPIC, -fno-exceptions and -fno-rtti by default.  When
           linking, this option makes the GCC driver pass Android-specific options to the linker.  Finally, this
           option causes the preprocessor macro "__ANDROID__" to be defined.

       -tno-android-cc
           Disable compilation effects of -mandroid, i.e., do not enable -mbionic,  -fPIC,  -fno-exceptions  and
           -fno-rtti by default.

       -tno-android-ld
           Disable linking effects of -mandroid, i.e., pass standard Linux linking options to the linker.

       H8/300 Options

       These -m options are defined for the H8/300 implementations:

       -mrelax
           Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the linker option -relax.

       -mh Generate code for the H8/300H.

       -ms Generate code for the H8S.

       -mn Generate  code  for the H8S and H8/300H in the normal mode.  This switch must be used either with -mh
           or -ms.

       -ms2600
           Generate code for the H8S/2600.  This switch must be used with -ms.

       -mint32
           Make "int" data 32 bits by default.

       -malign-300
           On the H8/300H and H8S, use the same alignment rules as for the H8/300.  The default for the  H8/300H
           and  H8S is to align longs and floats on 4 byte boundaries.  -malign-300 causes them to be aligned on
           2 byte boundaries.  This option has no effect on the H8/300.

       HPPA Options

       These -m options are defined for the HPPA family of computers:

       -march=architecture-type
           Generate code for the specified architecture.  The choices for architecture-type are 1.0 for PA  1.0,
           1.1  for PA 1.1, and 2.0 for PA 2.0 processors.  Refer to /usr/lib/sched.models on an HP-UX system to
           determine the proper architecture  option  for  your  machine.   Code  compiled  for  lower  numbered
           architectures will run on higher numbered architectures, but not the other way around.

       -mpa-risc-1-0
       -mpa-risc-1-1
       -mpa-risc-2-0
           Synonyms for -march=1.0, -march=1.1, and -march=2.0 respectively.

       -mbig-switch
           Generate  code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if the assembler/linker complain
           about out of range branches within a switch table.

       -mjump-in-delay
           Fill delay slots of function calls with unconditional  jump  instructions  by  modifying  the  return
           pointer for the function call to be the target of the conditional jump.

       -mdisable-fpregs
           Prevent  floating  point  registers  from  being used in any manner.  This is necessary for compiling
           kernels which perform lazy context switching of floating point registers.  If you use this option and
           attempt to perform floating point operations, the compiler will abort.

       -mdisable-indexing
           Prevent the compiler from using indexing address modes.  This avoids  some  rather  obscure  problems
           when compiling MIG generated code under MACH.

       -mno-space-regs
           Generate  code  that  assumes  the target has no space registers.  This allows GCC to generate faster
           indirect calls and use unscaled index address modes.

           Such code is suitable for level 0 PA systems and kernels.

       -mfast-indirect-calls
           Generate code that assumes calls never cross space boundaries.  This allows GCC to  emit  code  which
           performs faster indirect calls.

           This option will not work in the presence of shared libraries or nested functions.

       -mfixed-range=register-range
           Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.  A fixed register is one that the
           register  allocator  can  not  use.   This is useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is
           specified as two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be specified  separated
           by a comma.

       -mlong-load-store
           Generate  3-instruction  load and store sequences as sometimes required by the HP-UX 10 linker.  This
           is equivalent to the +k option to the HP compilers.

       -mportable-runtime
           Use the portable calling conventions proposed by HP for ELF systems.

       -mgas
           Enable the use of assembler directives only GAS understands.

       -mschedule=cpu-type
           Schedule code according to the constraints for the machine type cpu-type.  The choices  for  cpu-type
           are  700  7100,  7100LC,  7200,  7300 and 8000.  Refer to /usr/lib/sched.models on an HP-UX system to
           determine the proper scheduling option for your machine.  The default scheduling is 8000.

       -mlinker-opt
           Enable the optimization pass in the HP-UX linker.  Note this makes symbolic debugging impossible.  It
           also triggers a bug in the HP-UX 8 and HP-UX 9 linkers in which they give bogus error  messages  when
           linking some programs.

       -msoft-float
           Generate  output  containing  library calls for floating point.  Warning: the requisite libraries are
           not available for all HPPA targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual  C  compiler  are
           used,  but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make your own arrangements to
           provide suitable library functions for cross-compilation.

           -msoft-float changes the calling convention in the output file; therefore, it is only useful  if  you
           compile  all of a program with this option.  In particular, you need to compile libgcc.a, the library
           that comes with GCC, with -msoft-float in order for this to work.

       -msio
           Generate the predefine,  "_SIO",  for  server  IO.   The  default  is  -mwsio.   This  generates  the
           predefines,  "__hp9000s700",  "__hp9000s700__"  and  "_WSIO",  for workstation IO.  These options are
           available under HP-UX and HI-UX.

       -mgnu-ld
           Use GNU ld specific options.  This passes -shared to ld when building a shared library.   It  is  the
           default  when GCC is configured, explicitly or implicitly, with the GNU linker.  This option does not
           have any affect on which ld is called, it only changes what parameters are passed to that ld.  The ld
           that is called is determined by the --with-ld  configure  option,  GCC's  program  search  path,  and
           finally   by   the   user's  PATH.   The  linker  used  by  GCC  can  be  printed  using  which  `gcc
           -print-prog-name=ld`.  This option is only available on the 64 bit HP-UX GCC,  i.e.  configured  with
           hppa*64*-*-hpux*.

       -mhp-ld
           Use  HP  ld specific options.  This passes -b to ld when building a shared library and passes +Accept
           TypeMismatch to ld on all links.  It is the default when GCC is configured, explicitly or implicitly,
           with the HP linker.  This option does not have any affect on which ld is called, it only changes what
           parameters are passed to that ld.  The ld that is called is determined  by  the  --with-ld  configure
           option,  GCC's  program  search  path, and finally by the user's PATH.  The linker used by GCC can be
           printed using which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`.  This option is only available on  the  64  bit  HP-UX
           GCC, i.e. configured with hppa*64*-*-hpux*.

       -mlong-calls
           Generate code that uses long call sequences.  This ensures that a call is always able to reach linker
           generated  stubs.  The default is to generate long calls only when the distance from the call site to
           the beginning of the function or translation unit, as the case may be, exceeds a predefined limit set
           by the branch type being used.  The  limits  for  normal  calls  are  7,600,000  and  240,000  bytes,
           respectively for the PA 2.0 and PA 1.X architectures.  Sibcalls are always limited at 240,000 bytes.

           Distances  are measured from the beginning of functions when using the -ffunction-sections option, or
           when using the -mgas and -mno-portable-runtime options together under HP-UX with the SOM linker.

           It is normally not desirable to use this option as it will degrade performance.  However, it  may  be
           useful in large applications, particularly when partial linking is used to build the application.

           The types of long calls used depends on the capabilities of the assembler and linker, and the type of
           code  being  generated.  The impact on systems that support long absolute calls, and long pic symbol-
           difference or pc-relative calls should be relatively small.  However, an indirect  call  is  used  on
           32-bit ELF systems in pic code and it is quite long.

       -munix=unix-std
           Generate compiler predefines and select a startfile for the specified UNIX standard.  The choices for
           unix-std  are  93, 95 and 98.  93 is supported on all HP-UX versions.  95 is available on HP-UX 10.10
           and later.  98 is available on HP-UX 11.11 and later.  The default values are 93 for HP-UX 10.00,  95
           for HP-UX 10.10 though to 11.00, and 98 for HP-UX 11.11 and later.

           -munix=93  provides the same predefines as GCC 3.3 and 3.4.  -munix=95 provides additional predefines
           for "XOPEN_UNIX" and  "_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED",  and  the  startfile  unix95.o.   -munix=98  provides
           additional  predefines  for  "_XOPEN_UNIX",  "_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED", "_INCLUDE__STDC_A1_SOURCE" and
           "_INCLUDE_XOPEN_SOURCE_500", and the startfile unix98.o.

           It is important to note that this option changes the interfaces for  various  library  routines.   It
           also  affects  the operational behavior of the C library.  Thus, extreme care is needed in using this
           option.

           Library code that is intended to operate with more than one UNIX standard must test, set and  restore
           the variable __xpg4_extended_mask as appropriate.  Most GNU software doesn't provide this capability.

       -nolibdld
           Suppress  the  generation of link options to search libdld.sl when the -static option is specified on
           HP-UX 10 and later.

       -static
           The HP-UX implementation of setlocale in libc has a dependency on libdld.sl.  There isn't an  archive
           version of libdld.sl.  Thus, when the -static option is specified, special link options are needed to
           resolve this dependency.

           On  HP-UX  10  and  later,  the GCC driver adds the necessary options to link with libdld.sl when the
           -static option is specified.  This causes the resulting binary to be dynamic.  On  the  64-bit  port,
           the  linkers  generate  dynamic binaries by default in any case.  The -nolibdld option can be used to
           prevent the GCC driver from adding these link options.

       -threads
           Add support for multithreading with the dce thread library under HP-UX.  This option sets  flags  for
           both the preprocessor and linker.

       Intel 386 and AMD x86-64 Options

       These -m options are defined for the i386 and x86-64 family of computers:

       -mtune=cpu-type
           Tune  to  cpu-type  everything applicable about the generated code, except for the ABI and the set of
           available instructions.  The choices for cpu-type are:

           generic
               Produce code optimized for the most common IA32/AMD64/EM64T processors.  If you know the  CPU  on
               which  your  code  will  run,  then  you  should  use  the corresponding -mtune option instead of
               -mtune=generic.  But, if you do not know exactly what CPU users of your  application  will  have,
               then you should use this option.

               As  new  processors  are  deployed  in  the marketplace, the behavior of this option will change.
               Therefore, if you upgrade to a newer version of GCC, the code generated  option  will  change  to
               reflect the processors that were most common when that version of GCC was released.

               There  is  no -march=generic option because -march indicates the instruction set the compiler can
               use, and there is no generic instruction set applicable to all processors.  In  contrast,  -mtune
               indicates  the  processor  (or,  in  this  case,  collection of processors) for which the code is
               optimized.

           native
               This selects the CPU to tune for at compilation time by determining the  processor  type  of  the
               compiling  machine.   Using -mtune=native will produce code optimized for the local machine under
               the constraints of the selected instruction set.  Using -march=native will enable all instruction
               subsets supported by the local machine (hence the result might not run on different machines).

           i386
               Original Intel's i386 CPU.

           i486
               Intel's i486 CPU.  (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)

           i586, pentium
               Intel Pentium CPU with no MMX support.

           pentium-mmx
               Intel PentiumMMX CPU based on Pentium core with MMX instruction set support.

           pentiumpro
               Intel PentiumPro CPU.

           i686
               Same as "generic", but when used as "march" option, PentiumPro instruction set will be  used,  so
               the code will run on all i686 family chips.

           pentium2
               Intel Pentium2 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX instruction set support.

           pentium3, pentium3m
               Intel Pentium3 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX and SSE instruction set support.

           pentium-m
               Low  power version of Intel Pentium3 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support.  Used by
               Centrino notebooks.

           pentium4, pentium4m
               Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support.

           prescott
               Improved version of Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction set support.

           nocona
               Improved version of  Intel  Pentium4  CPU  with  64-bit  extensions,  MMX,  SSE,  SSE2  and  SSE3
               instruction set support.

           core2
               Intel Core2 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3 instruction set support.

           corei7
               Intel  Core  i7  CPU  with  64-bit  extensions,  MMX,  SSE,  SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1 and SSE4.2
               instruction set support.

           corei7-avx
               Intel Core i7 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2,  AVX,  AES
               and PCLMUL instruction set support.

           core-avx-i
               Intel  Core  CPU  with  64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, AVX, AES,
               PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND and F16C instruction set support.

           atom
               Intel Atom CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3 instruction set support.

           k6  AMD K6 CPU with MMX instruction set support.

           k6-2, k6-3
               Improved versions of AMD K6 CPU with MMX and 3DNow! instruction set support.

           athlon, athlon-tbird
               AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3DNow! and SSE prefetch instructions support.

           athlon-4, athlon-xp, athlon-mp
               Improved AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow! and full SSE instruction set support.

           k8, opteron, athlon64, athlon-fx
               AMD K8 core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.   (This  supersets  MMX,  SSE,  SSE2,
               3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow! and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)

           k8-sse3, opteron-sse3, athlon64-sse3
               Improved versions of k8, opteron and athlon64 with SSE3 instruction set support.

           amdfam10, barcelona
               AMD  Family  10h  core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This supersets MMX, SSE,
               SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)

           winchip-c6
               IDT Winchip C6 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX instruction set support.

           winchip2
               IDT Winchip2 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with  additional  MMX  and  3DNow!   instruction  set
               support.

           c3  Via  C3  CPU with MMX and 3DNow! instruction set support.  (No scheduling is implemented for this
               chip.)

           c3-2
               Via C3-2 CPU with MMX and SSE instruction set support.  (No scheduling is  implemented  for  this
               chip.)

           geode
               Embedded AMD CPU with MMX and 3DNow! instruction set support.

           While  picking  a  specific cpu-type will schedule things appropriately for that particular chip, the
           compiler will not generate any code that does not run on the i386 without the -march=cpu-type  option
           being used.

       -march=cpu-type
           Generate  instructions  for  the machine type cpu-type.  The choices for cpu-type are the same as for
           -mtune.  Moreover, specifying -march=cpu-type implies -mtune=cpu-type.

       -mcpu=cpu-type
           A deprecated synonym for -mtune.

       -mfpmath=unit
           Generate floating point arithmetics for selected unit unit.  The choices for unit are:

           387 Use the standard 387 floating point coprocessor present majority of chips and emulated otherwise.
               Code compiled with this option will run almost everywhere.  The temporary results are computed in
               80bit precision instead of precision specified  by  the  type  resulting  in  slightly  different
               results compared to most of other chips.  See -ffloat-store for more detailed description.

               This is the default choice for i386 compiler.

           sse Use  scalar floating point instructions present in the SSE instruction set.  This instruction set
               is supported by Pentium3 and newer chips, in the AMD line by Athlon-4,  Athlon-xp  and  Athlon-mp
               chips.   The  earlier  version of SSE instruction set supports only single precision arithmetics,
               thus the double and extended precision arithmetics is  still  done  using  387.   Later  version,
               present  only  in  Pentium4 and the future AMD x86-64 chips supports double precision arithmetics
               too.

               For the i386 compiler, you need to use -march=cpu-type, -msse or -msse2 switches  to  enable  SSE
               extensions and make this option effective.  For the x86-64 compiler, these extensions are enabled
               by default.

               The resulting code should be considerably faster in the majority of cases and avoid the numerical
               instability problems of 387 code, but may break some existing code that expects temporaries to be
               80bit.

               This is the default choice for the x86-64 compiler.

           sse,387
           sse+387
           both
               Attempt  to  utilize  both  instruction  sets  at  once.   This  effectively double the amount of
               available registers and on chips with separate execution units for  387  and  SSE  the  execution
               resources  too.  Use this option with care, as it is still experimental, because the GCC register
               allocator does not model separate functional units well resulting in instable performance.

       -masm=dialect
           Output asm instructions using selected dialect.  Supported choices are  intel  or  att  (the  default
           one).  Darwin does not support intel.

       -mieee-fp
       -mno-ieee-fp
           Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating point comparisons.  These handle correctly the
           case where the result of a comparison is unordered.

       -msoft-float
           Generate  output  containing  library calls for floating point.  Warning: the requisite libraries are
           not part of GCC.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are used, but this  can't
           be  done  directly  in  cross-compilation.   You  must make your own arrangements to provide suitable
           library functions for cross-compilation.

           On machines where a function returns floating  point  results  in  the  80387  register  stack,  some
           floating point opcodes may be emitted even if -msoft-float is used.

       -mno-fp-ret-in-387
           Do not use the FPU registers for return values of functions.

           The  usual  calling  convention  has  functions return values of types "float" and "double" in an FPU
           register, even if there is no FPU.  The idea is that the operating system should emulate an FPU.

           The option -mno-fp-ret-in-387 causes such values to be returned in ordinary CPU registers instead.

       -mno-fancy-math-387
           Some 387 emulators do not support the "sin", "cos" and "sqrt" instructions for the 387.  Specify this
           option to avoid generating those instructions.  This option is the default on  FreeBSD,  OpenBSD  and
           NetBSD.   This option is overridden when -march indicates that the target CPU will always have an FPU
           and so the instruction will not need emulation.  As of revision 2.6.1,  these  instructions  are  not
           generated unless you also use the -funsafe-math-optimizations switch.

       -malign-double
       -mno-align-double
           Control  whether GCC aligns "double", "long double", and "long long" variables on a two word boundary
           or a one word boundary.  Aligning "double" variables on a two word boundary will  produce  code  that
           runs somewhat faster on a Pentium at the expense of more memory.

           On x86-64, -malign-double is enabled by default.

           Warning:  if you use the -malign-double switch, structures containing the above types will be aligned
           differently than the published application binary interface specifications for the 386 and  will  not
           be binary compatible with structures in code compiled without that switch.

       -m96bit-long-double
       -m128bit-long-double
           These  switches  control  the  size  of  "long  double"  type.  The i386 application binary interface
           specifies the size to be 96 bits, so -m96bit-long-double is the default in 32 bit mode.

           Modern architectures (Pentium and newer) would prefer "long double" to be aligned to an 8 or 16  byte
           boundary.   In arrays or structures conforming to the ABI, this would not be possible.  So specifying
           a -m128bit-long-double will align "long double" to a 16 byte boundary by padding  the  "long  double"
           with an additional 32 bit zero.

           In  the  x86-64  compiler, -m128bit-long-double is the default choice as its ABI specifies that "long
           double" is to be aligned on 16 byte boundary.

           Notice that neither of these options enable any extra precision over the x87 standard of 80 bits  for
           a "long double".

           Warning:  if you override the default value for your target ABI, the structures and arrays containing
           "long double" variables will change their size as well as function calling  convention  for  function
           taking  "long  double"  will  be  modified.   Hence they will not be binary compatible with arrays or
           structures in code compiled without that switch.

       -mlarge-data-threshold=number
           When -mcmodel=medium is specified, the data greater than threshold are placed in large data  section.
           This value must be the same across all object linked into the binary and defaults to 65535.

       -mrtd
           Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that take a fixed number of arguments
           return  with  the  "ret" num instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.  This saves one
           instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments there.

           You can specify that an individual function is called with this calling sequence  with  the  function
           attribute stdcall.  You can also override the -mrtd option by using the function attribute cdecl.

           Warning:  this  calling  convention is incompatible with the one normally used on Unix, so you cannot
           use it if you need to call libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.

           Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that take variable numbers of  arguments
           (including "printf"); otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those functions.

           In  addition,  seriously  incorrect  code will result if you call a function with too many arguments.
           (Normally, extra arguments are harmlessly ignored.)

       -mregparm=num
           Control how many registers are used to pass integer arguments.  By default, no registers are used  to
           pass  arguments,  and  at most 3 registers can be used.  You can control this behavior for a specific
           function by using the function attribute regparm.

           Warning: if you use this switch, and num is nonzero, then you must build all modules  with  the  same
           value, including any libraries.  This includes the system libraries and startup modules.

       -msseregparm
           Use  SSE  register  passing  conventions  for  float and double arguments and return values.  You can
           control this behavior for a specific function by using the function attribute sseregparm.

           Warning: if you use this switch then you must build all modules with the same  value,  including  any
           libraries.  This includes the system libraries and startup modules.

       -mvect8-ret-in-mem
           Return  8-byte vectors in memory instead of MMX registers.  This is the default on Solaris@tie{}8 and
           9 and VxWorks to match the ABI of the Sun Studio compilers until version 12.  Later compiler versions
           (starting with Studio 12 Update@tie{}1) follow the ABI used  by  other  x86  targets,  which  is  the
           default  on  Solaris@tie{}10  and  later.  Only use this option if you need to remain compatible with
           existing code produced by those previous compiler versions or older versions of GCC.

       -mpc32
       -mpc64
       -mpc80
           Set 80387 floating-point precision to 32, 64 or 80 bits.  When -mpc32 is specified, the  significands
           of  results of floating-point operations are rounded to 24 bits (single precision); -mpc64 rounds the
           significands of results of floating-point operations to 53 bits (double precision) and -mpc80  rounds
           the  significands  of  results  of  floating-point operations to 64 bits (extended double precision),
           which is the default.  When this option is used, floating-point operations in higher  precisions  are
           not available to the programmer without setting the FPU control word explicitly.

           Setting  the  rounding  of  floating-point operations to less than the default 80 bits can speed some
           programs by 2% or more.  Note that some mathematical libraries assume  that  extended  precision  (80
           bit)  floating-point  operations  are  enabled  by  default;  routines in such libraries could suffer
           significant loss of accuracy, typically through  so-called  "catastrophic  cancellation",  when  this
           option is used to set the precision to less than extended precision.

       -mstackrealign
           Realign  the  stack at entry.  On the Intel x86, the -mstackrealign option will generate an alternate
           prologue and epilogue that realigns the runtime stack if  necessary.   This  supports  mixing  legacy
           codes  that  keep  a  4-byte  aligned  stack  with  modern  codes  that  keep a 16-byte stack for SSE
           compatibility.  See also the attribute "force_align_arg_pointer", applicable to individual functions.

       -mpreferred-stack-boundary=num
           Attempt  to  keep  the  stack  boundary  aligned  to  a  2  raised  to   num   byte   boundary.    If
           -mpreferred-stack-boundary is not specified, the default is 4 (16 bytes or 128 bits).

       -mincoming-stack-boundary=num
           Assume   the   incoming   stack   is   aligned   to   a   2   raised   to   num  byte  boundary.   If
           -mincoming-stack-boundary is not specified, the one specified by -mpreferred-stack-boundary  will  be
           used.

           On  Pentium and PentiumPro, "double" and "long double" values should be aligned to an 8 byte boundary
           (see -malign-double) or suffer significant run time  performance  penalties.   On  Pentium  III,  the
           Streaming SIMD Extension (SSE) data type "__m128" may not work properly if it is not 16 byte aligned.

           To ensure proper alignment of this values on the stack, the stack boundary must be as aligned as that
           required  by  any  value stored on the stack.  Further, every function must be generated such that it
           keeps the stack aligned.  Thus calling a function compiled with a  higher  preferred  stack  boundary
           from  a  function compiled with a lower preferred stack boundary will most likely misalign the stack.
           It is recommended that libraries that use callbacks always use the default setting.

           This extra alignment does consume extra stack space, and generally increases code size.  Code that is
           sensitive to stack space usage, such as embedded systems and operating system kernels,  may  want  to
           reduce the preferred alignment to -mpreferred-stack-boundary=2.

       -mmmx
       -mno-mmx
       -msse
       -mno-sse
       -msse2
       -mno-sse2
       -msse3
       -mno-sse3
       -mssse3
       -mno-ssse3
       -msse4.1
       -mno-sse4.1
       -msse4.2
       -mno-sse4.2
       -msse4
       -mno-sse4
       -mavx
       -mno-avx
       -maes
       -mno-aes
       -mpclmul
       -mno-pclmul
       -mfsgsbase
       -mno-fsgsbase
       -mrdrnd
       -mno-rdrnd
       -mf16c
       -mno-f16c
       -msse4a
       -mno-sse4a
       -mfma4
       -mno-fma4
       -mxop
       -mno-xop
       -mlwp
       -mno-lwp
       -m3dnow
       -mno-3dnow
       -mpopcnt
       -mno-popcnt
       -mabm
       -mno-abm
       -mbmi
       -mno-bmi
       -mtbm
       -mno-tbm
           These  switches enable or disable the use of instructions in the MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1,
           AVX, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, F16C,  SSE4A,  FMA4,  XOP,  LWP,  ABM,  BMI,  or  3DNow!  extended
           instruction  sets.   These  extensions  are  also  available  as built-in functions: see X86 Built-in
           Functions, for details of the functions enabled and disabled by these switches.

           To have SSE/SSE2 instructions generated automatically from floating-point code  (as  opposed  to  387
           instructions), see -mfpmath=sse.

           GCC depresses SSEx instructions when -mavx is used. Instead, it generates new AVX instructions or AVX
           equivalence for all SSEx instructions when needed.

           These  options  will  enable  GCC  to use these extended instructions in generated code, even without
           -mfpmath=sse.  Applications which perform runtime CPU detection must compile separate files for  each
           supported  architecture,  using  the  appropriate  flags.  In particular, the file containing the CPU
           detection code should be compiled without these options.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Do (don't) generate code that uses the fused multiply/add  or  multiply/subtract  instructions.   The
           default is to use these instructions.

       -mcld
           This  option  instructs  GCC to emit a "cld" instruction in the prologue of functions that use string
           instructions.  String instructions  depend  on  the  DF  flag  to  select  between  autoincrement  or
           autodecrement  mode.   While  the  ABI  specifies  the  DF flag to be cleared on function entry, some
           operating systems violate this  specification  by  not  clearing  the  DF  flag  in  their  exception
           dispatchers.   The  exception  handler  can  be  invoked  with  the  DF flag set which leads to wrong
           direction mode, when string instructions are used.  This option can be enabled by default  on  32-bit
           x86  targets  by  configuring  GCC  with  the  --enable-cld  configure  option.   Generation of "cld"
           instructions can be suppressed with the -mno-cld compiler option in this case.

       -mvzeroupper
           This option instructs GCC to emit a "vzeroupper" instruction before a transfer of control flow out of
           the function to minimize AVX to SSE transition  penalty  as  well  as  remove  unnecessary  zeroupper
           intrinsics.

       -mprefer-avx128
           This  option instructs GCC to use 128-bit AVX instructions instead of 256-bit AVX instructions in the
           auto-vectorizer.

       -mcx16
           This option will enable GCC to use CMPXCHG16B instruction in generated code.  CMPXCHG16B  allows  for
           atomic  operations  on  128-bit  double  quadword  (or  oword)  data  types.  This is useful for high
           resolution counters that could be updated by multiple processors (or  cores).   This  instruction  is
           generated as part of atomic built-in functions: see Atomic Builtins for details.

       -msahf
           This  option will enable GCC to use SAHF instruction in generated 64-bit code.  Early Intel CPUs with
           Intel 64 lacked LAHF and SAHF instructions supported by AMD64 until introduction of Pentium 4 G1 step
           in December 2005.  LAHF and SAHF are load and store instructions, respectively,  for  certain  status
           flags.   In  64-bit mode, SAHF instruction is used to optimize "fmod", "drem" or "remainder" built-in
           functions: see Other Builtins for details.

       -mmovbe
           This  option  will  enable  GCC  to  use  movbe  instruction  to  implement  "__builtin_bswap32"  and
           "__builtin_bswap64".

       -mcrc32
           This  option  will  enable  built-in  functions,  "__builtin_ia32_crc32qi", "__builtin_ia32_crc32hi".
           "__builtin_ia32_crc32si" and "__builtin_ia32_crc32di" to generate the crc32 machine instruction.

       -mrecip
           This option will enable GCC to use RCPSS and RSQRTSS  instructions  (and  their  vectorized  variants
           RCPPS  and RSQRTPS) with an additional Newton-Raphson step to increase precision instead of DIVSS and
           SQRTSS (and their  vectorized  variants)  for  single  precision  floating  point  arguments.   These
           instructions   are   generated   only  when  -funsafe-math-optimizations  is  enabled  together  with
           -finite-math-only and -fno-trapping-math.  Note that while the throughput of the sequence  is  higher
           than the throughput of the non-reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be decreased
           by up to 2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994).

           Note  that GCC implements 1.0f/sqrtf(x) in terms of RSQRTSS (or RSQRTPS) already with -ffast-math (or
           the above option combination), and doesn't need -mrecip.

       -mveclibabi=type
           Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an external library.  Supported  types
           are  "svml" for the Intel short vector math library and "acml" for the AMD math core library style of
           interfacing.  GCC will currently emit calls to  "vmldExp2",  "vmldLn2",  "vmldLog102",  "vmldLog102",
           "vmldPow2", "vmldTanh2", "vmldTan2", "vmldAtan2", "vmldAtanh2", "vmldCbrt2", "vmldSinh2", "vmldSin2",
           "vmldAsinh2", "vmldAsin2", "vmldCosh2", "vmldCos2", "vmldAcosh2", "vmldAcos2", "vmlsExp4", "vmlsLn4",
           "vmlsLog104",   "vmlsLog104",   "vmlsPow4",   "vmlsTanh4",   "vmlsTan4",  "vmlsAtan4",  "vmlsAtanh4",
           "vmlsCbrt4",   "vmlsSinh4",   "vmlsSin4",   "vmlsAsinh4",   "vmlsAsin4",   "vmlsCosh4",   "vmlsCos4",
           "vmlsAcosh4"  and  "vmlsAcos4"  for  corresponding  function  type  when -mveclibabi=svml is used and
           "__vrd2_sin", "__vrd2_cos", "__vrd2_exp", "__vrd2_log", "__vrd2_log2", "__vrd2_log10", "__vrs4_sinf",
           "__vrs4_cosf", "__vrs4_expf", "__vrs4_logf", "__vrs4_log2f", "__vrs4_log10f"  and  "__vrs4_powf"  for
           corresponding   function   type   when   -mveclibabi=acml   is   used.   Both   -ftree-vectorize  and
           -funsafe-math-optimizations have to be enabled. A SVML or ACML ABI compatible library will have to be
           specified at link time.

       -mabi=name
           Generate code for the specified calling convention.  Permissible values are: sysv for the ABI used on
           GNU/Linux and other systems and ms for the Microsoft ABI.  The default is to use  the  Microsoft  ABI
           when  targeting  Windows.   On  all other systems, the default is the SYSV ABI.  You can control this
           behavior for a specific function by using the function attribute ms_abi/sysv_abi.

       -mpush-args
       -mno-push-args
           Use PUSH operations to store outgoing parameters.  This method is shorter and usually equally fast as
           method using SUB/MOV operations and is enabled by default.  In some cases disabling  it  may  improve
           performance because of improved scheduling and reduced dependencies.

       -maccumulate-outgoing-args
           If  enabled,  the  maximum  amount  of  space required for outgoing arguments will be computed in the
           function prologue.  This is faster on most modern CPUs  because  of  reduced  dependencies,  improved
           scheduling  and reduced stack usage when preferred stack boundary is not equal to 2.  The drawback is
           a notable increase in code size.  This switch implies -mno-push-args.

       -mthreads
           Support thread-safe exception handling  on  Mingw32.   Code  that  relies  on  thread-safe  exception
           handling must compile and link all code with the -mthreads option.  When compiling, -mthreads defines
           -D_MT;  when  linking,  it  links  in a special thread helper library -lmingwthrd which cleans up per
           thread exception handling data.

       -mno-align-stringops
           Do not align destination of inlined string operations.  This switch reduces code  size  and  improves
           performance in case the destination is already aligned, but GCC doesn't know about it.

       -minline-all-stringops
           By  default  GCC inlines string operations only when destination is known to be aligned at least to 4
           byte boundary.  This enables more inlining, increase code size, but may improve performance  of  code
           that depends on fast memcpy, strlen and memset for short lengths.

       -minline-stringops-dynamically
           For  string operation of unknown size, inline runtime checks so for small blocks inline code is used,
           while for large blocks library call is used.

       -mstringop-strategy=alg
           Overwrite internal decision heuristic about particular algorithm to  inline  string  operation  with.
           The  allowed values are "rep_byte", "rep_4byte", "rep_8byte" for expanding using i386 "rep" prefix of
           specified size, "byte_loop", "loop", "unrolled_loop" for expanding inline loop, "libcall" for  always
           expanding library call.

       -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
           Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This avoids the instructions to save,
           set  up  and  restore  frame  pointers  and makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The
           option -fomit-frame-pointer removes the frame pointer for all functions which  might  make  debugging
           harder.

       -mtls-direct-seg-refs
       -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
           Controls  whether  TLS  variables may be accessed with offsets from the TLS segment register (%gs for
           32-bit, %fs for 64-bit), or whether the thread base pointer must be added.  Whether or  not  this  is
           legal depends on the operating system, and whether it maps the segment to cover the entire TLS area.

           For systems that use GNU libc, the default is on.

       -msse2avx
       -mno-sse2avx
           Specify  that  the  assembler should encode SSE instructions with VEX prefix.  The option -mavx turns
           this on by default.

       -mfentry
       -mno-fentry
           If profiling  is  active  -pg  put  the  profiling  counter  call  before  prologue.   Note:  On  x86
           architectures the attribute "ms_hook_prologue" isn't possible at the moment for -mfentry and -pg.

       -m8bit-idiv
       -mno-8bit-idiv
           On  some  processors,  like  Intel Atom, 8bit unsigned integer divide is much faster than 32bit/64bit
           integer divide.  This option will generate a runt-time check.   If  both  dividend  and  divisor  are
           within  range  of  0 to 255, 8bit unsigned integer divide will be used instead of 32bit/64bit integer
           divide.

       -mavx256-split-unaligned-load
       -mavx256-split-unaligned-store
           Split 32-byte AVX unaligned load and store.

       These -m switches are supported in addition to the above on AMD x86-64 processors in 64-bit environments.

       -m32
       -m64
           Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The 32-bit environment sets int, long and  pointer
           to  32  bits  and generates code that runs on any i386 system.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32
           bits and long and pointer to 64 bits and generates code for AMD's  x86-64  architecture.  For  darwin
           only the -m64 option turns off the -fno-pic and -mdynamic-no-pic options.

       -mno-red-zone
           Do not use a so called red zone for x86-64 code.  The red zone is mandated by the x86-64 ABI, it is a
           128-byte  area  beyond  the  location  of  the  stack  pointer that will not be modified by signal or
           interrupt handlers and therefore can be used for temporary data without adjusting the stack  pointer.
           The flag -mno-red-zone disables this red zone.

       -mcmodel=small
           Generate  code for the small code model: the program and its symbols must be linked in the lower 2 GB
           of the address space.  Pointers are 64 bits.  Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.  This
           is the default code model.

       -mcmodel=kernel
           Generate code for the kernel code model.  The kernel runs in the negative 2 GB of the address  space.
           This model has to be used for Linux kernel code.

       -mcmodel=medium
           Generate  code  for  the  medium model: The program is linked in the lower 2 GB of the address space.
           Small symbols are also placed there.  Symbols with sizes larger than -mlarge-data-threshold  are  put
           into  large  data  or  bss  sections  and  can  be  located above 2GB.  Programs can be statically or
           dynamically linked.

       -mcmodel=large
           Generate code for the large model: This model makes no  assumptions  about  addresses  and  sizes  of
           sections.

       i386 and x86-64 Windows Options

       These additional options are available for Windows targets:

       -mconsole
           This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies that a console application is to
           be  generated,  by  instructing  the  linker to set the PE header subsystem type required for console
           applications.  This is the default behavior for Cygwin and MinGW targets.

       -mdll
           This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies that a  DLL  -  a  dynamic  link
           library - is to be generated, enabling the selection of the required runtime startup object and entry
           point.

       -mnop-fun-dllimport
           This  option  is  available  for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies that the dllimport attribute
           should be ignored.

       -mthread
           This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that MinGW-specific thread support is to  be
           used.

       -municode
           This  option is available for mingw-w64 targets.  It specifies that the UNICODE macro is getting pre-
           defined and that the unicode capable runtime startup code is chosen.

       -mwin32
           This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies that the  typical  Windows  pre-
           defined  macros  are  to  be  set  in the pre-processor, but does not influence the choice of runtime
           library/startup code.

       -mwindows
           This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies that a GUI application is to  be
           generated by instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type appropriately.

       -fno-set-stack-executable
           This  option  is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that the executable flag for stack used by
           nested functions isn't set. This is necessary for binaries running in  kernel  mode  of  Windows,  as
           there the user32 API, which is used to set executable privileges, isn't available.

       -mpe-aligned-commons
           This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies that the GNU extension to the PE
           file  format  that  permits  the correct alignment of COMMON variables should be used when generating
           code.  It will be enabled  by  default  if  GCC  detects  that  the  target  assembler  found  during
           configuration supports the feature.

       See also under i386 and x86-64 Options for standard options.

       IA-64 Options

       These are the -m options defined for the Intel IA-64 architecture.

       -mbig-endian
           Generate code for a big endian target.  This is the default for HP-UX.

       -mlittle-endian
           Generate code for a little endian target.  This is the default for AIX5 and GNU/Linux.

       -mgnu-as
       -mno-gnu-as
           Generate (or don't) code for the GNU assembler.  This is the default.

       -mgnu-ld
       -mno-gnu-ld
           Generate (or don't) code for the GNU linker.  This is the default.

       -mno-pic
           Generate  code  that  does not use a global pointer register.  The result is not position independent
           code, and violates the IA-64 ABI.

       -mvolatile-asm-stop
       -mno-volatile-asm-stop
           Generate (or don't) a stop bit immediately before and after volatile asm statements.

       -mregister-names
       -mno-register-names
           Generate (or don't) in, loc, and out register  names  for  the  stacked  registers.   This  may  make
           assembler output more readable.

       -mno-sdata
       -msdata
           Disable  (or  enable)  optimizations that use the small data section.  This may be useful for working
           around optimizer bugs.

       -mconstant-gp
           Generate code that uses a single constant global pointer value.  This is useful when compiling kernel
           code.

       -mauto-pic
           Generate code that is self-relocatable.  This implies -mconstant-gp.  This is useful  when  compiling
           firmware code.

       -minline-float-divide-min-latency
           Generate code for inline divides of floating point values using the minimum latency algorithm.

       -minline-float-divide-max-throughput
           Generate code for inline divides of floating point values using the maximum throughput algorithm.

       -mno-inline-float-divide
           Do not generate inline code for divides of floating point values.

       -minline-int-divide-min-latency
           Generate code for inline divides of integer values using the minimum latency algorithm.

       -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
           Generate code for inline divides of integer values using the maximum throughput algorithm.

       -mno-inline-int-divide
           Do not generate inline code for divides of integer values.

       -minline-sqrt-min-latency
           Generate code for inline square roots using the minimum latency algorithm.

       -minline-sqrt-max-throughput
           Generate code for inline square roots using the maximum throughput algorithm.

       -mno-inline-sqrt
           Do not generate inline code for sqrt.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Do  (don't)  generate  code  that uses the fused multiply/add or multiply/subtract instructions.  The
           default is to use these instructions.

       -mno-dwarf2-asm
       -mdwarf2-asm
           Don't (or do) generate assembler code for the DWARF2 line number debugging info.  This may be  useful
           when not using the GNU assembler.

       -mearly-stop-bits
       -mno-early-stop-bits
           Allow  stop  bits  to be placed earlier than immediately preceding the instruction that triggered the
           stop bit.  This can improve instruction scheduling, but does not always do so.

       -mfixed-range=register-range
           Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.  A fixed register is one that the
           register allocator can not use.  This is useful when compiling kernel  code.   A  register  range  is
           specified  as two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be specified separated
           by a comma.

       -mtls-size=tls-size
           Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets.  Valid values are 14, 22, and 64.

       -mtune=cpu-type
           Tune the instruction scheduling for a particular CPU, Valid values  are  itanium,  itanium1,  merced,
           itanium2, and mckinley.

       -milp32
       -mlp64
           Generate  code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer
           to 32 bits.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.   These  are
           HP-UX specific flags.

       -mno-sched-br-data-spec
       -msched-br-data-spec
           (Dis/En)able  data  speculative scheduling before reload.  This will result in generation of the ld.a
           instructions and the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).  The default is 'disable'.

       -msched-ar-data-spec
       -mno-sched-ar-data-spec
           (En/Dis)able data speculative scheduling after reload.  This will result in generation  of  the  ld.a
           instructions and the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).  The default is 'enable'.

       -mno-sched-control-spec
       -msched-control-spec
           (Dis/En)able control speculative scheduling.  This feature is available only during region scheduling
           (i.e.  before reload).  This will result in generation of the ld.s instructions and the corresponding
           check instructions chk.s .  The default is 'disable'.

       -msched-br-in-data-spec
       -mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
           (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that are dependent on  the  data  speculative
           loads  before  reload.   This  is  effective  only with -msched-br-data-spec enabled.  The default is
           'enable'.

       -msched-ar-in-data-spec
       -mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
           (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that are dependent on  the  data  speculative
           loads  after  reload.   This  is  effective  only  with -msched-ar-data-spec enabled.  The default is
           'enable'.

       -msched-in-control-spec
       -mno-sched-in-control-spec
           (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that are dependent on the control speculative
           loads.  This is effective only with -msched-control-spec enabled.  The default is 'enable'.

       -mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
       -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
           If enabled, data speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule only  if  there  are  no  other
           choices  at  the moment.  This will make the use of the data speculation much more conservative.  The
           default is 'disable'.

       -mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
       -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
           If enabled, control speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule only if there are  no  other
           choices  at  the  moment.   This will make the use of the control speculation much more conservative.
           The default is 'disable'.

       -mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
       -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
           If enabled, speculative dependencies will  be  considered  during  computation  of  the  instructions
           priorities.   This  will  make  the  use  of the speculation a bit more conservative.  The default is
           'disable'.

       -msched-spec-ldc
           Use a simple data speculation check.  This option is on by default.

       -msched-control-spec-ldc
           Use a simple check for control speculation.  This option is on by default.

       -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
           Place a stop bit after every cycle when scheduling.  This option is on by default.

       -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
           Assume that floating-point stores and loads are not likely to cause a conflict when placed  into  the
           same instruction group.  This option is disabled by default.

       -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
           Generate checks for control speculation in selective scheduling.  This flag is disabled by default.

       -msched-max-memory-insns=max-insns
           Limit on the number of memory insns per instruction group, giving lower priority to subsequent memory
           insns  attempting  to schedule in the same instruction group. Frequently useful to prevent cache bank
           conflicts.  The default value is 1.

       -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
           Disallow more than `msched-max-memory-insns'  in  instruction  group.   Otherwise,  limit  is  `soft'
           meaning  that  we  would  prefer  non-memory  operations when limit is reached but may still schedule
           memory operations.

       IA-64/VMS Options

       These -m options are defined for the IA-64/VMS implementations:

       -mvms-return-codes
           Return VMS condition codes from main. The default is to return POSIX  style  condition  (e.g.  error)
           codes.

       -mdebug-main=prefix
           Flag the first routine whose name starts with prefix as the main routine for the debugger.

       -mmalloc64
           Default to 64bit memory allocation routines.

       LM32 Options

       These -m options are defined for the Lattice Mico32 architecture:

       -mbarrel-shift-enabled
           Enable barrel-shift instructions.

       -mdivide-enabled
           Enable divide and modulus instructions.

       -mmultiply-enabled
           Enable multiply instructions.

       -msign-extend-enabled
           Enable sign extend instructions.

       -muser-enabled
           Enable user-defined instructions.

       M32C Options

       -mcpu=name
           Select the CPU for which code is generated.  name may be one of r8c for the R8C/Tiny series, m16c for
           the M16C (up to /60) series, m32cm for the M16C/80 series, or m32c for the M32C/80 series.

       -msim
           Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes an alternate runtime library to
           be  linked  in  which  supports, for example, file I/O.  You must not use this option when generating
           programs that will run on real hardware; you must provide your own runtime library for  whatever  I/O
           functions are needed.

       -memregs=number
           Specifies  the  number  of  memory-based pseudo-registers GCC will use during code generation.  These
           pseudo-registers will be used like real registers, so there is a tradeoff between  GCC's  ability  to
           fit  the  code  into  available  registers,  and  the  performance penalty of using memory instead of
           registers.  Note that all modules in a program must be compiled with the same value for this  option.
           Because of that, you must not use this option with the default runtime libraries gcc builds.

       M32R/D Options

       These -m options are defined for Renesas M32R/D architectures:

       -m32r2
           Generate code for the M32R/2.

       -m32rx
           Generate code for the M32R/X.

       -m32r
           Generate code for the M32R.  This is the default.

       -mmodel=small
           Assume  all  objects live in the lower 16MB of memory (so that their addresses can be loaded with the
           "ld24" instruction), and assume all subroutines are reachable with the "bl" instruction.  This is the
           default.

           The addressability of a particular object can be set with the "model" attribute.

       -mmodel=medium
           Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler  will  generate  "seth/add3"
           instructions  to  load  their  addresses),  and  assume  all  subroutines are reachable with the "bl"
           instruction.

       -mmodel=large
           Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler  will  generate  "seth/add3"
           instructions  to  load  their  addresses),  and assume subroutines may not be reachable with the "bl"
           instruction (the compiler will generate the much slower "seth/add3/jl" instruction sequence).

       -msdata=none
           Disable use of the small data area.  Variables will be put into one of .data, bss, or .rodata (unless
           the "section" attribute has been specified).  This is the default.

           The small data area consists of sections .sdata and .sbss.  Objects may  be  explicitly  put  in  the
           small data area with the "section" attribute using one of these sections.

       -msdata=sdata
           Put  small  global  and  static  data  in  the  small  data area, but do not generate special code to
           reference them.

       -msdata=use
           Put small global and static data in the  small  data  area,  and  generate  special  instructions  to
           reference them.

       -G num
           Put  global  and  static  objects less than or equal to num bytes into the small data or bss sections
           instead of the normal data or bss sections.  The default value of num is 8.  The -msdata option  must
           be set to one of sdata or use for this option to have any effect.

           All  modules  should  be compiled with the same -G num value.  Compiling with different values of num
           may or may not work; if it doesn't the linker will give an error message---incorrect code will not be
           generated.

       -mdebug
           Makes the M32R specific code in the compiler display some statistics that  might  help  in  debugging
           programs.

       -malign-loops
           Align all loops to a 32-byte boundary.

       -mno-align-loops
           Do not enforce a 32-byte alignment for loops.  This is the default.

       -missue-rate=number
           Issue number instructions per cycle.  number can only be 1 or 2.

       -mbranch-cost=number
           number  can  only be 1 or 2.  If it is 1 then branches will be preferred over conditional code, if it
           is 2, then the opposite will apply.

       -mflush-trap=number
           Specifies the trap number to use to flush the cache.  The default is 12.  Valid numbers are between 0
           and 15 inclusive.

       -mno-flush-trap
           Specifies that the cache cannot be flushed by using a trap.

       -mflush-func=name
           Specifies the name of the operating system function to call to  flush  the  cache.   The  default  is
           _flush_cache, but a function call will only be used if a trap is not available.

       -mno-flush-func
           Indicates that there is no OS function for flushing the cache.

       M680x0 Options

       These  are  the  -m  options  defined for M680x0 and ColdFire processors.  The default settings depend on
       which architecture was selected when the compiler was  configured;  the  defaults  for  the  most  common
       choices are given below.

       -march=arch
           Generate  code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire instruction set architecture.  Permissible values of
           arch for M680x0 architectures are: 68000, 68010, 68020, 68030,  68040,  68060  and  cpu32.   ColdFire
           architectures  are  selected  according  to Freescale's ISA classification and the permissible values
           are: isaa, isaaplus, isab and isac.

           gcc defines a macro __mcfarch__ whenever it is generating code for a ColdFire target.   The  arch  in
           this macro is one of the -march arguments given above.

           When  used  together,  -march  and -mtune select code that runs on a family of similar processors but
           that is optimized for a particular microarchitecture.

       -mcpu=cpu
           Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire processor.  The M680x0 cpus are: 68000, 68010, 68020,
           68030, 68040, 68060, 68302, 68332 and cpu32.  The ColdFire cpus are given by the table  below,  which
           also classifies the CPUs into families:

           Family : -mcpu arguments
           51 : 51 51ac 51cn 51em 51qe
           5206 : 5202 5204 5206
           5206e : 5206e
           5208 : 5207 5208
           5211a : 5210a 5211a
           5213 : 5211 5212 5213
           5216 : 5214 5216
           52235 : 52230 52231 52232 52233 52234 52235
           5225 : 5224 5225
           52259 : 52252 52254 52255 52256 52258 52259
           5235 : 5232 5233 5234 5235 523x
           5249 : 5249
           5250 : 5250
           5271 : 5270 5271
           5272 : 5272
           5275 : 5274 5275
           5282 : 5280 5281 5282 528x
           53017 : 53011 53012 53013 53014 53015 53016 53017
           5307 : 5307
           5329 : 5327 5328 5329 532x
           5373 : 5372 5373 537x
           5407 : 5407
           5475 : 5470 5471 5472 5473 5474 5475 547x 5480 5481 5482 5483 5484 5485

           -mcpu=cpu  overrides  -march=arch  if  arch  is compatible with cpu.  Other combinations of -mcpu and
           -march are rejected.

           gcc defines the  macro  __mcf_cpu_cpu  when  ColdFire  target  cpu  is  selected.   It  also  defines
           __mcf_family_family, where the value of family is given by the table above.

       -mtune=tune
           Tune  the  code  for  a particular microarchitecture, within the constraints set by -march and -mcpu.
           The M680x0 microarchitectures are: 68000, 68010, 68020, 68030, 68040, 68060 and cpu32.  The  ColdFire
           microarchitectures are: cfv1, cfv2, cfv3, cfv4 and cfv4e.

           You can also use -mtune=68020-40 for code that needs to run relatively well on 68020, 68030 and 68040
           targets.   -mtune=68020-60  is  similar but includes 68060 targets as well.  These two options select
           the same tuning decisions as -m68020-40 and -m68020-60 respectively.

           gcc defines the macros __mcarch and __mcarch__ when tuning for  680x0  architecture  arch.   It  also
           defines mcarch unless either -ansi or a non-GNU -std option is used.  If gcc is tuning for a range of
           architectures,  as  selected  by  -mtune=68020-40 or -mtune=68020-60, it defines the macros for every
           architecture in the range.

           gcc also defines the macro __muarch__ when tuning for ColdFire microarchitecture uarch,  where  uarch
           is one of the arguments given above.

       -m68000
       -mc68000
           Generate  output  for  a  68000.  This is the default when the compiler is configured for 68000-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68000.

           Use this option for microcontrollers with a 68000 or EC000 core, including the 68008,  68302,  68306,
           68307, 68322, 68328 and 68356.

       -m68010
           Generate  output  for  a  68010.  This is the default when the compiler is configured for 68010-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68010.

       -m68020
       -mc68020
           Generate output for a 68020.  This is the default when the compiler  is  configured  for  68020-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68020.

       -m68030
           Generate  output  for  a  68030.  This is the default when the compiler is configured for 68030-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68030.

       -m68040
           Generate output for a 68040.  This is the default when the compiler  is  configured  for  68040-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68040.

           This  option inhibits the use of 68881/68882 instructions that have to be emulated by software on the
           68040.  Use this option if your 68040 does not have code to emulate those instructions.

       -m68060
           Generate output for a 68060.  This is the default when the compiler  is  configured  for  68060-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68060.

           This  option  inhibits  the  use  of  68020  and 68881/68882 instructions that have to be emulated by
           software on the 68060.  Use  this  option  if  your  68060  does  not  have  code  to  emulate  those
           instructions.

       -mcpu32
           Generate  output  for  a  CPU32.  This is the default when the compiler is configured for CPU32-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=cpu32.

           Use this option for microcontrollers with a CPU32 or CPU32+ core, including the 68330, 68331,  68332,
           68333, 68334, 68336, 68340, 68341, 68349 and 68360.

       -m5200
           Generate  output  for  a  520X ColdFire CPU.  This is the default when the compiler is configured for
           520X-based systems.  It is equivalent to -mcpu=5206, and is now deprecated in favor of that option.

           Use this option for microcontroller with a 5200 core, including the  MCF5202,  MCF5203,  MCF5204  and
           MCF5206.

       -m5206e
           Generate  output  for  a 5206e ColdFire CPU.  The option is now deprecated in favor of the equivalent
           -mcpu=5206e.

       -m528x
           Generate output for a member of the ColdFire 528X family.  The option is now deprecated in  favor  of
           the equivalent -mcpu=528x.

       -m5307
           Generate  output  for  a  ColdFire 5307 CPU.  The option is now deprecated in favor of the equivalent
           -mcpu=5307.

       -m5407
           Generate output for a ColdFire 5407 CPU.  The option is now deprecated in  favor  of  the  equivalent
           -mcpu=5407.

       -mcfv4e
           Generate  output  for  a  ColdFire  V4e  family  CPU (e.g. 547x/548x).  This includes use of hardware
           floating point instructions.  The option is equivalent to -mcpu=547x, and is now deprecated in  favor
           of that option.

       -m68020-40
           Generate  output  for a 68040, without using any of the new instructions.  This results in code which
           can run relatively efficiently on either a 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a  68040.   The  generated  code
           does use the 68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68040.

           The option is equivalent to -march=68020 -mtune=68020-40.

       -m68020-60
           Generate  output  for a 68060, without using any of the new instructions.  This results in code which
           can run relatively efficiently on either a 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a  68040.   The  generated  code
           does use the 68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68060.

           The option is equivalent to -march=68020 -mtune=68020-60.

       -mhard-float
       -m68881
           Generate  floating-point  instructions.   This  is  the default for 68020 and above, and for ColdFire
           devices that have an FPU.  It defines the macro __HAVE_68881__ on M680x0 targets  and  __mcffpu__  on
           ColdFire targets.

       -msoft-float
           Do  not  generate  floating-point  instructions;  use library calls instead.  This is the default for
           68000, 68010, and 68832 targets.  It is also the default for ColdFire devices that have no FPU.

       -mdiv
       -mno-div
           Generate (do not generate) ColdFire hardware divide and remainder instructions.  If  -march  is  used
           without  -mcpu,  the  default  is "on" for ColdFire architectures and "off" for M680x0 architectures.
           Otherwise, the default is taken from the target CPU (either the default CPU, or the one specified  by
           -mcpu).  For example, the default is "off" for -mcpu=5206 and "on" for -mcpu=5206e.

           gcc defines the macro __mcfhwdiv__ when this option is enabled.

       -mshort
           Consider  type  "int"  to  be 16 bits wide, like "short int".  Additionally, parameters passed on the
           stack are also aligned to a 16-bit boundary even on targets whose API mandates promotion to 32-bit.

       -mno-short
           Do not consider type "int" to be 16 bits wide.  This is the default.

       -mnobitfield
       -mno-bitfield
           Do not use the bit-field instructions.  The -m68000, -mcpu32 and -m5200 options imply -mnobitfield.

       -mbitfield
           Do use the bit-field instructions.  The -m68020 option implies -mbitfield.  This is  the  default  if
           you use a configuration designed for a 68020.

       -mrtd
           Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that take a fixed number of arguments
           return  with  the  "rtd"  instruction,  which  pops  their arguments while returning.  This saves one
           instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments there.

           This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally used on Unix, so you cannot use  it  if
           you need to call libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.

           Also,  you must provide function prototypes for all functions that take variable numbers of arguments
           (including "printf"); otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those functions.

           In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a function  with  too  many  arguments.
           (Normally, extra arguments are harmlessly ignored.)

           The "rtd" instruction is supported by the 68010, 68020, 68030, 68040, 68060 and CPU32 processors, but
           not by the 68000 or 5200.

       -mno-rtd
           Do not use the calling conventions selected by -mrtd.  This is the default.

       -malign-int
       -mno-align-int
           Control whether GCC aligns "int", "long", "long long", "float", "double", and "long double" variables
           on  a  32-bit  boundary  (-malign-int)  or a 16-bit boundary (-mno-align-int).  Aligning variables on
           32-bit boundaries produces code that runs somewhat faster on processors with  32-bit  busses  at  the
           expense of more memory.

           Warning:  if  you  use  the  -malign-int switch, GCC will align structures containing the above types
           differently than most published application binary interface specifications for the m68k.

       -mpcrel
           Use the pc-relative addressing mode of the 68000 directly, instead of using a  global  offset  table.
           At  present,  this option implies -fpic, allowing at most a 16-bit offset for pc-relative addressing.
           -fPIC is not presently supported with -mpcrel, though this could be supported for  68020  and  higher
           processors.

       -mno-strict-align
       -mstrict-align
           Do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references will be handled by the system.

       -msep-data
           Generate  code that allows the data segment to be located in a different area of memory from the text
           segment.  This allows for execute in place in an environment without virtual memory management.  This
           option implies -fPIC.

       -mno-sep-data
           Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.  This is the default.

       -mid-shared-library
           Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.  This allows for  execute  in
           place  and shared libraries in an environment without virtual memory management.  This option implies
           -fPIC.

       -mno-id-shared-library
           Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.  This is the default.

       -mshared-library-id=n
           Specified the identification number of the ID based shared  library  being  compiled.   Specifying  a
           value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying other values will force the allocation of that
           number to the current library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.

       -mxgot
       -mno-xgot
           When  generating position-independent code for ColdFire, generate code that works if the GOT has more
           than 8192 entries.  This code is larger and slower than  code  generated  without  this  option.   On
           M680x0 processors, this option is not needed; -fPIC suffices.

           GCC  normally  uses  a  single  instruction  to  load  values from the GOT.  While this is relatively
           efficient, it only works if the GOT is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger causes the linker  to
           report an error such as:

                   relocation truncated to fit: R_68K_GOT16O foobar

           If  this  happens,  you  should recompile your code with -mxgot.  It should then work with very large
           GOTs.  However, code generated with -mxgot is less efficient, since it takes 4 instructions to  fetch
           the value of a global symbol.

           Note that some linkers, including newer versions of the GNU linker, can create multiple GOTs and sort
           GOT  entries.   If you have such a linker, you should only need to use -mxgot when compiling a single
           object file that accesses more than 8192 GOT entries.  Very few do.

           These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position-independent code.

       M68hc1x Options

       These are the -m options defined for the 68hc11 and 68hc12  microcontrollers.   The  default  values  for
       these  options  depends  on which style of microcontroller was selected when the compiler was configured;
       the defaults for the most common choices are given below.

       -m6811
       -m68hc11
           Generate output for a 68HC11.  This is the default when the compiler is configured  for  68HC11-based
           systems.

       -m6812
       -m68hc12
           Generate  output  for a 68HC12.  This is the default when the compiler is configured for 68HC12-based
           systems.

       -m68S12
       -m68hcs12
           Generate output for a 68HCS12.

       -mauto-incdec
           Enable the use of 68HC12 pre and post auto-increment and auto-decrement addressing modes.

       -minmax
       -mnominmax
           Enable the use of 68HC12 min and max instructions.

       -mlong-calls
       -mno-long-calls
           Treat all calls as being far away (near).  If calls are assumed to be far away, the compiler will use
           the "call" instruction to call a function and the "rtc" instruction for returning.

       -mshort
           Consider type "int" to be 16 bits wide, like "short int".

       -msoft-reg-count=count
           Specify the number of pseudo-soft registers which are used for  the  code  generation.   The  maximum
           number  is 32.  Using more pseudo-soft register may or may not result in better code depending on the
           program.  The default is 4 for 68HC11 and 2 for 68HC12.

       MCore Options

       These are the -m options defined for the Motorola M*Core processors.

       -mhardlit
       -mno-hardlit
           Inline constants into the code stream if it can be done in two instructions or less.

       -mdiv
       -mno-div
           Use the divide instruction.  (Enabled by default).

       -mrelax-immediate
       -mno-relax-immediate
           Allow arbitrary sized immediates in bit operations.

       -mwide-bitfields
       -mno-wide-bitfields
           Always treat bit-fields as int-sized.

       -m4byte-functions
       -mno-4byte-functions
           Force all functions to be aligned to a four byte boundary.

       -mcallgraph-data
       -mno-callgraph-data
           Emit callgraph information.

       -mslow-bytes
       -mno-slow-bytes
           Prefer word access when reading byte quantities.

       -mlittle-endian
       -mbig-endian
           Generate code for a little endian target.

       -m210
       -m340
           Generate code for the 210 processor.

       -mno-lsim
           Assume that run-time support has been provided and so omit the simulator library (libsim.a) from  the
           linker command line.

       -mstack-increment=size
           Set  the  maximum amount for a single stack increment operation.  Large values can increase the speed
           of programs which contain functions that need a large amount  of  stack  space,  but  they  can  also
           trigger a segmentation fault if the stack is extended too much.  The default value is 0x1000.

       MeP Options

       -mabsdiff
           Enables the "abs" instruction, which is the absolute difference between two registers.

       -mall-opts
           Enables  all  the  optional  instructions  - average, multiply, divide, bit operations, leading zero,
           absolute difference, min/max, clip, and saturation.

       -maverage
           Enables the "ave" instruction, which computes the average of two registers.

       -mbased=n
           Variables of size n bytes or smaller will be placed  in  the  ".based"  section  by  default.   Based
           variables  use  the  $tp  register  as a base register, and there is a 128 byte limit to the ".based"
           section.

       -mbitops
           Enables the bit operation instructions - bit test ("btstm"), set ("bsetm"), clear  ("bclrm"),  invert
           ("bnotm"), and test-and-set ("tas").

       -mc=name
           Selects which section constant data will be placed in.  name may be "tiny", "near", or "far".

       -mclip
           Enables the "clip" instruction.  Note that "-mclip" is not useful unless you also provide "-mminmax".

       -mconfig=name
           Selects  one  of the build-in core configurations.  Each MeP chip has one or more modules in it; each
           module has a core CPU and a variety of coprocessors, optional  instructions,  and  peripherals.   The
           "MeP-Integrator" tool, not part of GCC, provides these configurations through this option; using this
           option is the same as using all the corresponding command line options.  The default configuration is
           "default".

       -mcop
           Enables  the  coprocessor  instructions.   By  default,  this is a 32-bit coprocessor.  Note that the
           coprocessor is normally enabled via the "-mconfig=" option.

       -mcop32
           Enables the 32-bit coprocessor's instructions.

       -mcop64
           Enables the 64-bit coprocessor's instructions.

       -mivc2
           Enables IVC2 scheduling.  IVC2 is a 64-bit VLIW coprocessor.

       -mdc
           Causes constant variables to be placed in the ".near" section.

       -mdiv
           Enables the "div" and "divu" instructions.

       -meb
           Generate big-endian code.

       -mel
           Generate little-endian code.

       -mio-volatile
           Tells the compiler that any variable marked with the "io" attribute is to be considered volatile.

       -ml Causes variables to be assigned to the ".far" section by default.

       -mleadz
           Enables the "leadz" (leading zero) instruction.

       -mm Causes variables to be assigned to the ".near" section by default.

       -mminmax
           Enables the "min" and "max" instructions.

       -mmult
           Enables the multiplication and multiply-accumulate instructions.

       -mno-opts
           Disables all the optional instructions enabled by "-mall-opts".

       -mrepeat
           Enables the "repeat" and "erepeat" instructions, used for low-overhead looping.

       -ms Causes all variables to default to the ".tiny" section.  Note that there is a  65536  byte  limit  to
           this section.  Accesses to these variables use the %gp base register.

       -msatur
           Enables  the  saturation  instructions.   Note  that  the  compiler does not currently generate these
           itself, but this option is included for compatibility with other tools, like "as".

       -msdram
           Link the SDRAM-based runtime instead of the default ROM-based runtime.

       -msim
           Link the simulator runtime libraries.

       -msimnovec
           Link the simulator runtime libraries, excluding built-in support for reset and exception vectors  and
           tables.

       -mtf
           Causes all functions to default to the ".far" section.  Without this option, functions default to the
           ".near" section.

       -mtiny=n
           Variables  that are n bytes or smaller will be allocated to the ".tiny" section.  These variables use
           the $gp base register.  The default for this option is 4, but note that there's a 65536 byte limit to
           the ".tiny" section.

       MicroBlaze Options

       -msoft-float
           Use software emulation for floating point (default).

       -mhard-float
           Use hardware floating point instructions.

       -mmemcpy
           Do not optimize block moves, use "memcpy".

       -mno-clearbss
           This option is deprecated.  Use -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss instead.

       -mcpu=cpu-type
           Use features of and schedule code for given CPU.  Supported values are in the format vX.YY.Z, where X
           is a major version, YY is the minor version,  and  Z  is  compatibility  code.   Example  values  are
           v3.00.a, v4.00.b, v5.00.a, v5.00.b, v5.00.b, v6.00.a.

       -mxl-soft-mul
           Use software multiply emulation (default).

       -mxl-soft-div
           Use software emulation for divides (default).

       -mxl-barrel-shift
           Use the hardware barrel shifter.

       -mxl-pattern-compare
           Use pattern compare instructions.

       -msmall-divides
           Use table lookup optimization for small signed integer divisions.

       -mxl-stack-check
           This option is deprecated.  Use -fstack-check instead.

       -mxl-gp-opt
           Use GP relative sdata/sbss sections.

       -mxl-multiply-high
           Use multiply high instructions for high part of 32x32 multiply.

       -mxl-float-convert
           Use hardware floating point conversion instructions.

       -mxl-float-sqrt
           Use hardware floating point square root instruction.

       -mxl-mode-app-model
           Select application model app-model.  Valid models are

           executable
               normal executable (default), uses startup code crt0.o.

           xmdstub
               for  use  with  Xilinx  Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) based software intrusive debug agent called
               xmdstub. This uses startup file crt1.o and sets the start address of the program to be 0x800.

           bootstrap
               for applications that are loaded using a bootloader.  This model uses startup file  crt2.o  which
               does not contain a processor reset vector handler. This is suitable for transferring control on a
               processor reset to the bootloader rather than the application.

           novectors
               for applications that do not require any of the MicroBlaze vectors. This option may be useful for
               applications running within a monitoring application. This model uses crt3.o as a startup file.

           Option -xl-mode-app-model is a deprecated alias for -mxl-mode-app-model.

       MIPS Options

       -EB Generate big-endian code.

       -EL Generate little-endian code.  This is the default for mips*el-*-* configurations.

       -march=arch
           Generate  code  that  will run on arch, which can be the name of a generic MIPS ISA, or the name of a
           particular processor.  The ISA names are: mips1, mips2, mips3, mips4, mips32,  mips32r2,  mips64  and
           mips64r2.   The  processor  names  are:  4kc, 4km, 4kp, 4ksc, 4kec, 4kem, 4kep, 4ksd, 5kc, 5kf, 20kc,
           24kc, 24kf2_1, 24kf1_1, 24kec, 24kef2_1, 24kef1_1, 34kc, 34kf2_1, 34kf1_1,  74kc,  74kf2_1,  74kf1_1,
           74kf3_2, 1004kc, 1004kf2_1, 1004kf1_1, loongson2e, loongson2f, loongson3a, m4k, octeon, orion, r2000,
           r3000,  r3900,  r4000,  r4400,  r4600,  r4650,  r6000, r8000, rm7000, rm9000, r10000, r12000, r14000,
           r16000, sb1, sr71000, vr4100, vr4111, vr4120, vr4130, vr4300, vr5000, vr5400, vr5500  and  xlr.   The
           special  value from-abi selects the most compatible architecture for the selected ABI (that is, mips1
           for 32-bit ABIs and mips3 for 64-bit ABIs).

           Native Linux/GNU toolchains also support the value native, which selects the best architecture option
           for the host processor.  -march=native has no effect if GCC does not recognize the processor.

           In processor names, a final 000 can be abbreviated as k  (for  example,  -march=r2k).   Prefixes  are
           optional, and vr may be written r.

           Names  of the form nf2_1 refer to processors with FPUs clocked at half the rate of the core, names of
           the form nf1_1 refer to processors with FPUs clocked at the same rate as the core, and names  of  the
           form  nf3_2  refer  to  processors  with  FPUs  clocked a ratio of 3:2 with respect to the core.  For
           compatibility reasons, nf is accepted as a synonym for  nf2_1  while  nx  and  bfx  are  accepted  as
           synonyms for nf1_1.

           GCC  defines  two macros based on the value of this option.  The first is _MIPS_ARCH, which gives the
           name of target architecture, as a string.  The second has the form _MIPS_ARCH_foo, where foo  is  the
           capitalized value of _MIPS_ARCH.  For example, -march=r2000 will set _MIPS_ARCH to "r2000" and define
           the macro _MIPS_ARCH_R2000.

           Note  that  the  _MIPS_ARCH macro uses the processor names given above.  In other words, it will have
           the full prefix and will not abbreviate 000 as k.  In the case  of  from-abi,  the  macro  names  the
           resolved  architecture (either "mips1" or "mips3").  It names the default architecture when no -march
           option is given.

       -mtune=arch
           Optimize for arch.  Among other things, this option controls the way instructions are scheduled,  and
           the perceived cost of arithmetic operations.  The list of arch values is the same as for -march.

           When  this  option  is  not  used, GCC will optimize for the processor specified by -march.  By using
           -march and -mtune together, it is possible to generate code that will run on a family of  processors,
           but optimize the code for one particular member of that family.

           -mtune  defines  the  macros  _MIPS_TUNE and _MIPS_TUNE_foo, which work in the same way as the -march
           ones described above.

       -mips1
           Equivalent to -march=mips1.

       -mips2
           Equivalent to -march=mips2.

       -mips3
           Equivalent to -march=mips3.

       -mips4
           Equivalent to -march=mips4.

       -mips32
           Equivalent to -march=mips32.

       -mips32r2
           Equivalent to -march=mips32r2.

       -mips64
           Equivalent to -march=mips64.

       -mips64r2
           Equivalent to -march=mips64r2.

       -mips16
       -mno-mips16
           Generate (do not generate) MIPS16 code.  If GCC is targetting a MIPS32  or  MIPS64  architecture,  it
           will make use of the MIPS16e ASE.

           MIPS16  code  generation  can  also  be  controlled  on a per-function basis by means of "mips16" and
           "nomips16" attributes.

       -mflip-mips16
           Generate MIPS16 code on alternating functions.  This option is provided  for  regression  testing  of
           mixed MIPS16/non-MIPS16 code generation, and is not intended for ordinary use in compiling user code.

       -minterlink-mips16
       -mno-interlink-mips16
           Require (do not require) that non-MIPS16 code be link-compatible with MIPS16 code.

           For  example,  non-MIPS16  code  cannot jump directly to MIPS16 code; it must either use a call or an
           indirect jump.  -minterlink-mips16 therefore disables direct jumps unless GCC knows that  the  target
           of the jump is not MIPS16.

       -mabi=32
       -mabi=o64
       -mabi=n32
       -mabi=64
       -mabi=eabi
           Generate code for the given ABI.

           Note  that  the  EABI has a 32-bit and a 64-bit variant.  GCC normally generates 64-bit code when you
           select a 64-bit architecture, but you can use -mgp32 to get 32-bit code instead.

           For information about the O64 ABI, see <http://gcc.gnu.org/projects/mipso64-abi.html>.

           GCC supports a variant of the o32 ABI in which floating-point registers are 64 rather  than  32  bits
           wide.   You can select this combination with -mabi=32 -mfp64.  This ABI relies on the mthc1 and mfhc1
           instructions and is therefore only supported for MIPS32R2 processors.

           The register assignments for arguments and return values remain the same, but each  scalar  value  is
           passed  in  a  single  64-bit  register  rather than a pair of 32-bit registers.  For example, scalar
           floating-point values are returned in $f0 only, not a $f0/$f1 pair.  The set of call-saved  registers
           also remains the same, but all 64 bits are saved.

       -mabicalls
       -mno-abicalls
           Generate  (do  not generate) code that is suitable for SVR4-style dynamic objects.  -mabicalls is the
           default for SVR4-based systems.

       -mshared
       -mno-shared
           Generate (do not generate) code that is fully position-independent, and that can therefore be  linked
           into shared libraries.  This option only affects -mabicalls.

           All -mabicalls code has traditionally been position-independent, regardless of options like -fPIC and
           -fpic.   However,  as an extension, the GNU toolchain allows executables to use absolute accesses for
           locally-binding symbols.  It can also use shorter GP initialization  sequences  and  generate  direct
           calls to locally-defined functions.  This mode is selected by -mno-shared.

           -mno-shared  depends  on binutils 2.16 or higher and generates objects that can only be linked by the
           GNU linker.  However, the option does not affect the ABI of the final executable; it only affects the
           ABI of relocatable objects.  Using -mno-shared will  generally  make  executables  both  smaller  and
           quicker.

           -mshared is the default.

       -mplt
       -mno-plt
           Assume  (do  not assume) that the static and dynamic linkers support PLTs and copy relocations.  This
           option only affects -mno-shared -mabicalls.  For the n64 ABI,  this  option  has  no  effect  without
           -msym32.

           You  can  make  -mplt  the  default by configuring GCC with --with-mips-plt.  The default is -mno-plt
           otherwise.

       -mxgot
       -mno-xgot
           Lift (do not lift) the usual restrictions on the size of the global offset table.

           GCC normally uses a single instruction to load  values  from  the  GOT.   While  this  is  relatively
           efficient,  it  will  only work if the GOT is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger will cause the
           linker to report an error such as:

                   relocation truncated to fit: R_MIPS_GOT16 foobar

           If this happens, you should recompile your code with -mxgot.  It should then  work  with  very  large
           GOTs,  although  it  will  also be less efficient, since it will take three instructions to fetch the
           value of a global symbol.

           Note that some linkers can create multiple GOTs.  If you have such a linker, you should only need  to
           use -mxgot when a single object file accesses more than 64k's worth of GOT entries.  Very few do.

           These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position independent code.

       -mgp32
           Assume that general-purpose registers are 32 bits wide.

       -mgp64
           Assume that general-purpose registers are 64 bits wide.

       -mfp32
           Assume that floating-point registers are 32 bits wide.

       -mfp64
           Assume that floating-point registers are 64 bits wide.

       -mhard-float
           Use floating-point coprocessor instructions.

       -msoft-float
           Do  not  use  floating-point  coprocessor  instructions.  Implement floating-point calculations using
           library calls instead.

       -msingle-float
           Assume that the floating-point coprocessor only supports single-precision operations.

       -mdouble-float
           Assume that the  floating-point  coprocessor  supports  double-precision  operations.   This  is  the
           default.

       -mllsc
       -mno-llsc
           Use  (do  not use) ll, sc, and sync instructions to implement atomic memory built-in functions.  When
           neither option is specified, GCC will use the instructions if the target architecture supports them.

           -mllsc is useful if the runtime environment can emulate the instructions and -mno-llsc can be  useful
           when  compiling for nonstandard ISAs.  You can make either option the default by configuring GCC with
           --with-llsc and --without-llsc respectively.  --with-llsc is the default for some configurations; see
           the installation documentation for details.

       -mdsp
       -mno-dsp
           Use (do not use) revision 1 of the MIPS DSP ASE.
             This option defines the preprocessor macro __mips_dsp.  It also defines __mips_dsp_rev to 1.

       -mdspr2
       -mno-dspr2
           Use (do not use) revision 2 of the MIPS DSP ASE.
             This option  defines  the  preprocessor  macros  __mips_dsp  and  __mips_dspr2.   It  also  defines
           __mips_dsp_rev to 2.

       -msmartmips
       -mno-smartmips
           Use (do not use) the MIPS SmartMIPS ASE.

       -mpaired-single
       -mno-paired-single
           Use (do not use) paired-single floating-point instructions.
             This option requires hardware floating-point support to be enabled.

       -mdmx
       -mno-mdmx
           Use  (do  not  use)  MIPS  Digital  Media  Extension instructions.  This option can only be used when
           generating 64-bit code and requires hardware floating-point support to be enabled.

       -mips3d
       -mno-mips3d
           Use (do not use) the MIPS-3D ASE.  The option -mips3d implies -mpaired-single.

       -mmt
       -mno-mt
           Use (do not use) MT Multithreading instructions.

       -mlong64
           Force "long" types to be 64 bits wide.  See -mlong32 for an explanation of the default  and  the  way
           that the pointer size is determined.

       -mlong32
           Force "long", "int", and pointer types to be 32 bits wide.

           The  default  size  of  "int"s,  "long"s and pointers depends on the ABI.  All the supported ABIs use
           32-bit "int"s.  The n64 ABI uses 64-bit "long"s, as does the  64-bit  EABI;  the  others  use  32-bit
           "long"s.   Pointers are the same size as "long"s, or the same size as integer registers, whichever is
           smaller.

       -msym32
       -mno-sym32
           Assume (do not assume) that all symbols have 32-bit values, regardless of  the  selected  ABI.   This
           option  is  useful  in  combination with -mabi=64 and -mno-abicalls because it allows GCC to generate
           shorter and faster references to symbolic addresses.

       -G num
           Put definitions of externally-visible data in a small data section if that data is no bigger than num
           bytes.  GCC can then access the data more efficiently; see -mgpopt for details.

           The default -G option depends on the configuration.

       -mlocal-sdata
       -mno-local-sdata
           Extend (do not extend) the -G behavior to  local  data  too,  such  as  to  static  variables  in  C.
           -mlocal-sdata is the default for all configurations.

           If  the  linker  complains  that  an  application is using too much small data, you might want to try
           rebuilding the less performance-critical parts with -mno-local-sdata.  You might also want  to  build
           large libraries with -mno-local-sdata, so that the libraries leave more room for the main program.

       -mextern-sdata
       -mno-extern-sdata
           Assume  (do  not assume) that externally-defined data will be in a small data section if that data is
           within the -G limit.  -mextern-sdata is the default for all configurations.

           If you compile a module Mod with -mextern-sdata -G num -mgpopt, and Mod  references  a  variable  Var
           that  is no bigger than num bytes, you must make sure that Var is placed in a small data section.  If
           Var is defined by another module, you must either compile that module with a high-enough  -G  setting
           or attach a "section" attribute to Var's definition.  If Var is common, you must link the application
           with a high-enough -G setting.

           The easiest way of satisfying these restrictions is to compile and link every module with the same -G
           option.   However, you may wish to build a library that supports several different small data limits.
           You can do this by compiling the library with the highest supported -G setting and additionally using
           -mno-extern-sdata to stop the library from making assumptions about externally-defined data.

       -mgpopt
       -mno-gpopt
           Use (do not use) GP-relative accesses for symbols that are known to be in a small data  section;  see
           -G, -mlocal-sdata and -mextern-sdata.  -mgpopt is the default for all configurations.

           -mno-gpopt  is  useful  for  cases  where  the  $gp  register might not hold the value of "_gp".  For
           example, if the code is part of a library that might be used in a boot monitor,  programs  that  call
           boot  monitor  routines  will  pass  an  unknown value in $gp.  (In such situations, the boot monitor
           itself would usually be compiled with -G0.)

           -mno-gpopt implies -mno-local-sdata and -mno-extern-sdata.

       -membedded-data
       -mno-embedded-data
           Allocate variables to the read-only data section first if possible,  then  next  in  the  small  data
           section  if  possible,  otherwise  in  data.   This  gives slightly slower code than the default, but
           reduces the amount of RAM required when executing, and  thus  may  be  preferred  for  some  embedded
           systems.

       -muninit-const-in-rodata
       -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
           Put uninitialized "const" variables in the read-only data section.  This option is only meaningful in
           conjunction with -membedded-data.

       -mcode-readable=setting
           Specify  whether GCC may generate code that reads from executable sections.  There are three possible
           settings:

           -mcode-readable=yes
               Instructions may freely access executable sections.  This is the default setting.

           -mcode-readable=pcrel
               MIPS16 PC-relative load instructions can access executable sections, but other instructions  must
               not  do  so.   This option is useful on 4KSc and 4KSd processors when the code TLBs have the Read
               Inhibit bit set.  It is also useful  on  processors  that  can  be  configured  to  have  a  dual
               instruction/data  SRAM interface and that, like the M4K, automatically redirect PC-relative loads
               to the instruction RAM.

           -mcode-readable=no
               Instructions must not access executable sections.  This option can be useful on targets that  are
               configured  to  have  a  dual  instruction/data  SRAM  interface but that (unlike the M4K) do not
               automatically redirect PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.

       -msplit-addresses
       -mno-split-addresses
           Enable (disable) use of the "%hi()" and "%lo()" assembler relocation operators.  This option has been
           superseded by -mexplicit-relocs but is retained for backwards compatibility.

       -mexplicit-relocs
       -mno-explicit-relocs
           Use (do  not  use)  assembler  relocation  operators  when  dealing  with  symbolic  addresses.   The
           alternative, selected by -mno-explicit-relocs, is to use assembler macros instead.

           -mexplicit-relocs  is  the default if GCC was configured to use an assembler that supports relocation
           operators.

       -mcheck-zero-division
       -mno-check-zero-division
           Trap (do not trap) on integer division by zero.

           The default is -mcheck-zero-division.

       -mdivide-traps
       -mdivide-breaks
           MIPS systems check for division  by  zero  by  generating  either  a  conditional  trap  or  a  break
           instruction.  Using traps results in smaller code, but is only supported on MIPS II and later.  Also,
           some  versions  of  the  Linux kernel have a bug that prevents trap from generating the proper signal
           ("SIGFPE").  Use -mdivide-traps to allow conditional traps on architectures  that  support  them  and
           -mdivide-breaks to force the use of breaks.

           The  default  is  usually  -mdivide-traps,  but  this  can  be  overridden  at  configure  time using
           --with-divide=breaks.     Divide-by-zero    checks    can    be     completely     disabled     using
           -mno-check-zero-division.

       -mmemcpy
       -mno-memcpy
           Force  (do not force) the use of "memcpy()" for non-trivial block moves.  The default is -mno-memcpy,
           which allows GCC to inline most constant-sized copies.

       -mlong-calls
       -mno-long-calls
           Disable (do not disable) use of the  "jal"  instruction.   Calling  functions  using  "jal"  is  more
           efficient but requires the caller and callee to be in the same 256 megabyte segment.

           This option has no effect on abicalls code.  The default is -mno-long-calls.

       -mmad
       -mno-mad
           Enable (disable) use of the "mad", "madu" and "mul" instructions, as provided by the R4650 ISA.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Enable (disable) use of the floating point multiply-accumulate instructions, when they are available.
           The default is -mfused-madd.

           When  multiply-accumulate  instructions  are used, the intermediate product is calculated to infinite
           precision and is not subject to the FCSR Flush  to  Zero  bit.   This  may  be  undesirable  in  some
           circumstances.

       -nocpp
           Tell the MIPS assembler to not run its preprocessor over user assembler files (with a .s suffix) when
           assembling them.

       -mfix-r4000
       -mno-fix-r4000
           Work around certain R4000 CPU errata:

           -   A  double-word  or  a  variable  shift may give an incorrect result if executed immediately after
               starting an integer division.

           -   A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect  result  if  executed  while  an  integer
               multiplication is in progress.

           -   An  integer division may give an incorrect result if started in a delay slot of a taken branch or
               a jump.

       -mfix-r4400
       -mno-fix-r4400
           Work around certain R4400 CPU errata:

           -   A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect  result  if  executed  immediately  after
               starting an integer division.

       -mfix-r10000
       -mno-fix-r10000
           Work around certain R10000 errata:

           -   "ll"/"sc"  sequences  may  not behave atomically on revisions prior to 3.0.  They may deadlock on
               revisions 2.6 and earlier.

           This option can only  be  used  if  the  target  architecture  supports  branch-likely  instructions.
           -mfix-r10000 is the default when -march=r10000 is used; -mno-fix-r10000 is the default otherwise.

       -mfix-vr4120
       -mno-fix-vr4120
           Work around certain VR4120 errata:

           -   "dmultu" does not always produce the correct result.

           -   "div" and "ddiv" do not always produce the correct result if one of the operands is negative.

           The  workarounds  for  the  division errata rely on special functions in libgcc.a.  At present, these
           functions are only provided by the "mips64vr*-elf" configurations.

           Other VR4120 errata require a nop to be inserted between certain pairs of instructions.  These errata
           are handled by the assembler, not by GCC itself.

       -mfix-vr4130
           Work around the VR4130 "mflo"/"mfhi" errata.  The workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather
           than by GCC, although GCC will avoid using "mflo" and "mfhi" if the VR4130 "macc", "macchi",  "dmacc"
           and "dmacchi" instructions are available instead.

       -mfix-sb1
       -mno-fix-sb1
           Work around certain SB-1 CPU core errata.  (This flag currently works around the SB-1 revision 2 "F1"
           and "F2" floating point errata.)

       -mr10k-cache-barrier=setting
           Specify  whether  GCC  should  insert cache barriers to avoid the side-effects of speculation on R10K
           processors.

           In common with many processors, the R10K tries to predict the outcome of  a  conditional  branch  and
           speculatively  executes  instructions from the "taken" branch.  It later aborts these instructions if
           the predicted outcome was wrong.  However, on the R10K,  even  aborted  instructions  can  have  side
           effects.

           This problem only affects kernel stores and, depending on the system, kernel loads.  As an example, a
           speculatively-executed  store may load the target memory into cache and mark the cache line as dirty,
           even if the store itself is later aborted.  If a DMA operation writes to  the  same  area  of  memory
           before  the  "dirty"  line  is flushed, the cached data will overwrite the DMA-ed data.  See the R10K
           processor manual for a full description, including other potential problems.

           One workaround is to insert cache barrier instructions before  every  memory  access  that  might  be
           speculatively    executed    and    that    might    have    side    effects    even    if   aborted.
           -mr10k-cache-barrier=setting controls GCC's implementation  of  this  workaround.   It  assumes  that
           aborted accesses to any byte in the following regions will not have side effects:

           1.  the memory occupied by the current function's stack frame;

           2.  the memory occupied by an incoming stack argument;

           3.  the memory occupied by an object with a link-time-constant address.

           It  is  the  kernel's  responsibility to ensure that speculative accesses to these regions are indeed
           safe.

           If the input program contains a function declaration such as:

                   void foo (void);

           then the implementation of "foo" must allow "j foo" and "jal foo" to be executed speculatively.   GCC
           honors  this  restriction  for  functions  it compiles itself.  It expects non-GCC functions (such as
           hand-written assembly code) to do the same.

           The option has three forms:

           -mr10k-cache-barrier=load-store
               Insert a cache barrier before a load or store that might be speculatively executed and that might
               have side effects even if aborted.

           -mr10k-cache-barrier=store
               Insert a cache barrier before a store that might be speculatively executed and  that  might  have
               side effects even if aborted.

           -mr10k-cache-barrier=none
               Disable the insertion of cache barriers.  This is the default setting.

       -mflush-func=func
       -mno-flush-func
           Specifies  the  function  to  call to flush the I and D caches, or to not call any such function.  If
           called, the function must take the same arguments as the common "_flush_func()", that is, the address
           of the memory range for which the cache is being flushed, the size  of  the  memory  range,  and  the
           number  3  (to  flush  both  caches).   The default depends on the target GCC was configured for, but
           commonly is either _flush_func or __cpu_flush.

       mbranch-cost=num
           Set the cost of branches to roughly num "simple" instructions.  This cost is only a heuristic and  is
           not  guaranteed  to  produce consistent results across releases.  A zero cost redundantly selects the
           default, which is based on the -mtune setting.

       -mbranch-likely
       -mno-branch-likely
           Enable or disable use of Branch Likely instructions, regardless  of  the  default  for  the  selected
           architecture.   By  default, Branch Likely instructions may be generated if they are supported by the
           selected architecture.  An exception is for the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures and processors  which
           implement those architectures; for those, Branch Likely instructions will not be generated by default
           because the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures specifically deprecate their use.

       -mfp-exceptions
       -mno-fp-exceptions
           Specifies  whether  FP exceptions are enabled.  This affects how we schedule FP instructions for some
           processors.  The default is that FP exceptions are enabled.

           For instance, on the SB-1, if FP exceptions are disabled, and we are emitting 64-bit  code,  then  we
           can use both FP pipes.  Otherwise, we can only use one FP pipe.

       -mvr4130-align
       -mno-vr4130-align
           The VR4130 pipeline is two-way superscalar, but can only issue two instructions together if the first
           one  is  8-byte  aligned.   When this option is enabled, GCC will align pairs of instructions that it
           thinks should execute in parallel.

           This option only has an effect when optimizing for the VR4130.  It normally makes code faster, but at
           the expense of making it bigger.  It is enabled by default at optimization level -O3.

       -msynci
       -mno-synci
           Enable (disable) generation of "synci" instructions on architectures that support  it.   The  "synci"
           instructions (if enabled) will be generated when "__builtin___clear_cache()" is compiled.

           This  option  defaults  to  "-mno-synci",  but  the  default  can  be  overridden by configuring with
           "--with-synci".

           When compiling code for single processor systems, it is generally safe to use "synci".   However,  on
           many  multi-core  (SMP)  systems,  it will not invalidate the instruction caches on all cores and may
           lead to undefined behavior.

       -mrelax-pic-calls
       -mno-relax-pic-calls
           Try to turn PIC calls that are normally dispatched via register $25 into direct calls.  This is  only
           possible  if  the  linker  can  resolve the destination at link-time and if the destination is within
           range for a direct call.

           -mrelax-pic-calls is the default if GCC was configured to use an assembler and a linker that supports
           the ".reloc" assembly directive and "-mexplicit-relocs" is in effect.   With  "-mno-explicit-relocs",
           this  optimization  can  be  performed  by  the  assembler and the linker alone without help from the
           compiler.

       -mmcount-ra-address
       -mno-mcount-ra-address
           Emit (do not emit) code that allows "_mcount" to modify the calling function's return address.   When
           enabled, this option extends the usual "_mcount" interface with a new ra-address parameter, which has
           type  "intptr_t  *"  and  is passed in register $12.  "_mcount" can then modify the return address by
           doing both of the following:

           •   Returning the new address in register $31.

           •   Storing the new address in "*ra-address", if ra-address is nonnull.

           The default is -mno-mcount-ra-address.

       MMIX Options

       These options are defined for the MMIX:

       -mlibfuncs
       -mno-libfuncs
           Specify that intrinsic library functions are being compiled, passing  all  values  in  registers,  no
           matter the size.

       -mepsilon
       -mno-epsilon
           Generate  floating-point  comparison  instructions  that  compare  with  respect  to the "rE" epsilon
           register.

       -mabi=mmixware
       -mabi=gnu
           Generate code that passes function parameters and return values that (in  the  called  function)  are
           seen as registers $0 and up, as opposed to the GNU ABI which uses global registers $231 and up.

       -mzero-extend
       -mno-zero-extend
           When  reading  data  from  memory in sizes shorter than 64 bits, use (do not use) zero-extending load
           instructions by default, rather than sign-extending ones.

       -mknuthdiv
       -mno-knuthdiv
           Make the result of a division yielding a remainder have the same  sign  as  the  divisor.   With  the
           default, -mno-knuthdiv, the sign of the remainder follows the sign of the dividend.  Both methods are
           arithmetically valid, the latter being almost exclusively used.

       -mtoplevel-symbols
       -mno-toplevel-symbols
           Prepend  (do  not  prepend)  a  :  to  all  global symbols, so the assembly code can be used with the
           "PREFIX" assembly directive.

       -melf
           Generate an executable in the ELF format, rather than  the  default  mmo  format  used  by  the  mmix
           simulator.

       -mbranch-predict
       -mno-branch-predict
           Use (do not use) the probable-branch instructions, when static branch prediction indicates a probable
           branch.

       -mbase-addresses
       -mno-base-addresses
           Generate  (do  not  generate)  code  that  uses  base  addresses.  Using a base address automatically
           generates a request (handled by the assembler and the linker) for a constant to be set up in a global
           register.  The register is used for one or more base address requests within the range 0 to 255  from
           the  value  held  in  the  register.   The  generally leads to short and fast code, but the number of
           different data items that can be addressed is limited.  This means that a program that uses  lots  of
           static data may require -mno-base-addresses.

       -msingle-exit
       -mno-single-exit
           Force (do not force) generated code to have a single exit point in each function.

       MN10300 Options

       These -m options are defined for Matsushita MN10300 architectures:

       -mmult-bug
           Generate  code  to  avoid  bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300 processors.  This is the
           default.

       -mno-mult-bug
           Do not generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300 processors.

       -mam33
           Generate code which uses features specific to the AM33 processor.

       -mno-am33
           Do not generate code which uses features specific to the AM33 processor.  This is the default.

       -mam33-2
           Generate code which uses features specific to the AM33/2.0 processor.

       -mam34
           Generate code which uses features specific to the AM34 processor.

       -mtune=cpu-type
           Use the timing characteristics of the indicated CPU type when scheduling instructions.  This does not
           change the targeted processor type.  The CPU type must be one of mn10300, am33, am33-2 or am34.

       -mreturn-pointer-on-d0
           When generating a function which returns a pointer,  return  the  pointer  in  both  "a0"  and  "d0".
           Otherwise,  the  pointer  is  returned  only  in  a0,  and  attempts to call such functions without a
           prototype  would  result  in   errors.    Note   that   this   option   is   on   by   default;   use
           -mno-return-pointer-on-d0 to disable it.

       -mno-crt0
           Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.

       -mrelax
           Indicate  to  the  linker  that it should perform a relaxation optimization pass to shorten branches,
           calls and absolute memory addresses.  This option only has an effect when used on  the  command  line
           for the final link step.

           This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.

       -mliw
           Allow the compiler to generate Long Instruction Word instructions if the target is the AM33 or later.
           This is the default.  This option defines the preprocessor macro __LIW__.

       -mnoliw
           Do  not  allow  the compiler to generate Long Instruction Word instructions.  This option defines the
           preprocessor macro __NO_LIW__.

       PDP-11 Options

       These options are defined for the PDP-11:

       -mfpu
           Use hardware FPP floating point.  This is the default.  (FIS floating point on the PDP-11/40  is  not
           supported.)

       -msoft-float
           Do not use hardware floating point.

       -mac0
           Return floating-point results in ac0 (fr0 in Unix assembler syntax).

       -mno-ac0
           Return floating-point results in memory.  This is the default.

       -m40
           Generate code for a PDP-11/40.

       -m45
           Generate code for a PDP-11/45.  This is the default.

       -m10
           Generate code for a PDP-11/10.

       -mbcopy-builtin
           Use inline "movmemhi" patterns for copying memory.  This is the default.

       -mbcopy
           Do not use inline "movmemhi" patterns for copying memory.

       -mint16
       -mno-int32
           Use 16-bit "int".  This is the default.

       -mint32
       -mno-int16
           Use 32-bit "int".

       -mfloat64
       -mno-float32
           Use 64-bit "float".  This is the default.

       -mfloat32
       -mno-float64
           Use 32-bit "float".

       -mabshi
           Use "abshi2" pattern.  This is the default.

       -mno-abshi
           Do not use "abshi2" pattern.

       -mbranch-expensive
           Pretend that branches are expensive.  This is for experimenting with code generation only.

       -mbranch-cheap
           Do not pretend that branches are expensive.  This is the default.

       -munix-asm
           Use Unix assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for pdp11-*-bsd.

       -mdec-asm
           Use  DEC  assembler  syntax.   This  is  the default when configured for any PDP-11 target other than
           pdp11-*-bsd.

       picoChip Options

       These -m options are defined for picoChip implementations:

       -mae=ae_type
           Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling parameters for array  element  type
           ae_type.  Supported values for ae_type are ANY, MUL, and MAC.

           -mae=ANY  selects  a  completely generic AE type.  Code generated with this option will run on any of
           the other AE types.  The code will not be as efficient as it would be if compiled for a  specific  AE
           type, and some types of operation (e.g., multiplication) will not work properly on all types of AE.

           -mae=MUL  selects  a  MUL  AE  type.   This  is the most useful AE type for compiled code, and is the
           default.

           -mae=MAC selects a DSP-style MAC AE.  Code compiled with this option may suffer from poor performance
           of byte (char) manipulation, since the DSP AE does not provide hardware support for byte load/stores.

       -msymbol-as-address
           Enable the compiler to directly use a symbol name as an address in a load/store instruction,  without
           first  loading  it into a register.  Typically, the use of this option will generate larger programs,
           which run faster than when the option isn't used.  However, the results vary from program to program,
           so it is left as a user option, rather than being permanently enabled.

       -mno-inefficient-warnings
           Disables warnings about the generation of inefficient code.  These warnings  can  be  generated,  for
           example, when compiling code which performs byte-level memory operations on the MAC AE type.  The MAC
           AE  has  no  hardware  support  for  byte-level  memory  operations,  so all byte load/stores must be
           synthesized from word load/store operations.  This is inefficient and a  warning  will  be  generated
           indicating to the programmer that they should rewrite the code to avoid byte operations, or to target
           an  AE  type  which has the necessary hardware support.  This option enables the warning to be turned
           off.

       PowerPC Options

       These are listed under

       IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options

       These -m options are defined for the IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC:

       -mpower
       -mno-power
       -mpower2
       -mno-power2
       -mpowerpc
       -mno-powerpc
       -mpowerpc-gpopt
       -mno-powerpc-gpopt
       -mpowerpc-gfxopt
       -mno-powerpc-gfxopt
       -mpowerpc64
       -mno-powerpc64
       -mmfcrf
       -mno-mfcrf
       -mpopcntb
       -mno-popcntb
       -mpopcntd
       -mno-popcntd
       -mfprnd
       -mno-fprnd
       -mcmpb
       -mno-cmpb
       -mmfpgpr
       -mno-mfpgpr
       -mhard-dfp
       -mno-hard-dfp
           GCC supports two related instruction set architectures  for  the  RS/6000  and  PowerPC.   The  POWER
           instruction  set  are  those instructions supported by the rios chip set used in the original RS/6000
           systems and the PowerPC instruction set is the architecture of the Freescale MPC5xx,  MPC6xx,  MPC8xx
           microprocessors, and the IBM 4xx, 6xx, and follow-on microprocessors.

           Neither  architecture  is  a  subset  of  the  other.   However  there  is  a  large common subset of
           instructions supported by both.  An MQ register  is  included  in  processors  supporting  the  POWER
           architecture.

           You  use  these  options  to specify which instructions are available on the processor you are using.
           The default value of these options is determined when configuring GCC.  Specifying the -mcpu=cpu_type
           overrides the specification of these options.  We recommend you use the -mcpu=cpu_type option  rather
           than the options listed above.

           The  -mpower option allows GCC to generate instructions that are found only in the POWER architecture
           and to use the MQ register.  Specifying -mpower2 implies -power  and  also  allows  GCC  to  generate
           instructions that are present in the POWER2 architecture but not the original POWER architecture.

           The  -mpowerpc option allows GCC to generate instructions that are found only in the 32-bit subset of
           the PowerPC architecture.  Specifying -mpowerpc-gpopt implies -mpowerpc and also allows  GCC  to  use
           the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the General Purpose group, including floating-point
           square  root.   Specifying -mpowerpc-gfxopt implies -mpowerpc and also allows GCC to use the optional
           PowerPC architecture instructions in the Graphics group, including floating-point select.

           The -mmfcrf option allows GCC  to  generate  the  move  from  condition  register  field  instruction
           implemented on the POWER4 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.01 architecture.
           The  -mpopcntb option allows GCC to generate the popcount and double precision FP reciprocal estimate
           instruction implemented on the POWER5 processor and other processors that support the  PowerPC  V2.02
           architecture.   The  -mpopcntd  option allows GCC to generate the popcount instruction implemented on
           the POWER7 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.06 architecture.   The  -mfprnd
           option  allows  GCC  to  generate  the  FP  round  to integer instructions implemented on the POWER5+
           processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.03 architecture.  The -mcmpb option allows
           GCC to generate the  compare  bytes  instruction  implemented  on  the  POWER6  processor  and  other
           processors  that  support the PowerPC V2.05 architecture.  The -mmfpgpr option allows GCC to generate
           the FP move to/from general purpose register instructions implemented on the  POWER6X  processor  and
           other  processors that support the extended PowerPC V2.05 architecture.  The -mhard-dfp option allows
           GCC to generate the decimal floating point instructions implemented on some POWER processors.

           The -mpowerpc64 option allows GCC to generate the additional 64-bit instructions that  are  found  in
           the  full PowerPC64 architecture and to treat GPRs as 64-bit, doubleword quantities.  GCC defaults to
           -mno-powerpc64.

           If you specify both -mno-power and -mno-powerpc, GCC will use only the  instructions  in  the  common
           subset  of  both  architectures  plus  some  special  AIX  common-mode calls, and will not use the MQ
           register.  Specifying both -mpower and -mpowerpc permits GCC  to  use  any  instruction  from  either
           architecture and to allow use of the MQ register; specify this for the Motorola MPC601.

       -mnew-mnemonics
       -mold-mnemonics
           Select  which  mnemonics  to use in the generated assembler code.  With -mnew-mnemonics, GCC uses the
           assembler mnemonics defined for the PowerPC architecture.  With -mold-mnemonics it uses the assembler
           mnemonics defined for the POWER architecture.  Instructions defined in  only  one  architecture  have
           only one mnemonic; GCC uses that mnemonic irrespective of which of these options is specified.

           GCC  defaults  to  the  mnemonics appropriate for the architecture in use.  Specifying -mcpu=cpu_type
           sometimes overrides the value of these option.  Unless you are building a cross-compiler, you  should
           normally  not  specify  either  -mnew-mnemonics  or  -mold-mnemonics,  but  should instead accept the
           default.

       -mcpu=cpu_type
           Set architecture type, register usage, choice of mnemonics, and instruction scheduling parameters for
           machine type cpu_type.  Supported values for cpu_type are 401, 403,  405,  405fp,  440,  440fp,  464,
           464fp,  476,  476fp,  505,  601, 602, 603, 603e, 604, 604e, 620, 630, 740, 7400, 7450, 750, 801, 821,
           823, 860, 970, 8540, a2, e300c2, e300c3, e500mc, e500mc64, ec603e, G3, G4, G5, titan, power,  power2,
           power3,  power4,  power5,  power5+, power6, power6x, power7, common, powerpc, powerpc64, rios, rios1,
           rios2, rsc, and rs64.

           -mcpu=common selects a completely generic processor.  Code generated under this option  will  run  on
           any  POWER  or  PowerPC  processor.   GCC will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
           architectures, and will not use  the  MQ  register.   GCC  assumes  a  generic  processor  model  for
           scheduling purposes.

           -mcpu=power,  -mcpu=power2,  -mcpu=powerpc,  and  -mcpu=powerpc64 specify generic POWER, POWER2, pure
           32-bit  PowerPC  (i.e.,  not  MPC601),  and  64-bit  PowerPC  architecture  machine  types,  with  an
           appropriate, generic processor model assumed for scheduling purposes.

           The  other options specify a specific processor.  Code generated under those options will run best on
           that processor, and may not run at all on others.

           The -mcpu options automatically enable or disable the following options:

           -maltivec  -mfprnd  -mhard-float  -mmfcrf  -mmultiple -mnew-mnemonics  -mpopcntb  -mpopcntd   -mpower
           -mpower2   -mpowerpc64  -mpowerpc-gpopt  -mpowerpc-gfxopt  -msingle-float -mdouble-float -msimple-fpu
           -mstring  -mmulhw  -mdlmzb  -mmfpgpr -mvsx

           The particular options set for any particular CPU will vary between compiler versions,  depending  on
           what  setting  seems  to produce optimal code for that CPU; it doesn't necessarily reflect the actual
           hardware's capabilities.  If you wish to set an individual option to  a  particular  value,  you  may
           specify it after the -mcpu option, like -mcpu=970 -mno-altivec.

           On  AIX,  the  -maltivec  and  -mpowerpc64 options are not enabled or disabled by the -mcpu option at
           present because AIX does not have full support for these options.  You may still  enable  or  disable
           them individually if you're sure it'll work in your environment.

       -mtune=cpu_type
           Set  the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type cpu_type, but do not set the architecture
           type, register usage, or choice of mnemonics, as -mcpu=cpu_type would.  The same values for  cpu_type
           are  used  for  -mtune  as  for  -mcpu.   If  both  are  specified,  the  code generated will use the
           architecture, registers, and mnemonics set by -mcpu, but the scheduling parameters set by -mtune.

       -mcmodel=small
           Generate PowerPC64 code for the small model: The TOC is limited to 64k.

       -mcmodel=medium
           Generate PowerPC64 code for the medium model: The TOC and other static data may be up to a  total  of
           4G in size.

       -mcmodel=large
           Generate PowerPC64 code for the large model: The TOC may be up to 4G in size.  Other data and code is
           only limited by the 64-bit address space.

       -maltivec
       -mno-altivec
           Generate  code  that  uses  (does  not use) AltiVec instructions, and also enable the use of built-in
           functions that allow more direct access to the AltiVec instruction set.  You may  also  need  to  set
           -mabi=altivec to adjust the current ABI with AltiVec ABI enhancements.

       -mvrsave
       -mno-vrsave
           Generate VRSAVE instructions when generating AltiVec code.

       -mgen-cell-microcode
           Generate Cell microcode instructions

       -mwarn-cell-microcode
           Warning  when  a  Cell  microcode  instruction  is  going to emitted.  An example of a Cell microcode
           instruction is a variable shift.

       -msecure-plt
           Generate code that allows ld and ld.so to build executables and shared libraries with  non-exec  .plt
           and .got sections.  This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.

       -mbss-plt
           Generate  code  that uses a BSS .plt section that ld.so fills in, and requires .plt and .got sections
           that are both writable and executable.  This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.

       -misel
       -mno-isel
           This switch enables or disables the generation of ISEL instructions.

       -misel=yes/no
           This switch has been deprecated.  Use -misel and -mno-isel instead.

       -mspe
       -mno-spe
           This switch enables or disables the generation of SPE simd instructions.

       -mpaired
       -mno-paired
           This switch enables or disables the generation of PAIRED simd instructions.

       -mspe=yes/no
           This option has been deprecated.  Use -mspe and -mno-spe instead.

       -mvsx
       -mno-vsx
           Generate code that uses (does not use) vector/scalar (VSX) instructions, and also enable the  use  of
           built-in functions that allow more direct access to the VSX instruction set.

       -mfloat-gprs=yes/single/double/no
       -mfloat-gprs
           This  switch  enables  or disables the generation of floating point operations on the general purpose
           registers for architectures that support it.

           The argument yes or single enables the use of single-precision floating point operations.

           The argument double enables the use of single and double-precision floating point operations.

           The argument no disables floating point operations on the general purpose registers.

           This option is currently only available on the MPC854x.

       -m32
       -m64
           Generate code for 32-bit or 64-bit environments of Darwin and  SVR4  targets  (including  GNU/Linux).
           The  32-bit  environment  sets  int,  long and pointer to 32 bits and generates code that runs on any
           PowerPC variant.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer  to  64  bits,  and
           generates code for PowerPC64, as for -mpowerpc64.

       -mfull-toc
       -mno-fp-in-toc
       -mno-sum-in-toc
       -mminimal-toc
           Modify  generation  of  the TOC (Table Of Contents), which is created for every executable file.  The
           -mfull-toc option is selected by default.  In that case, GCC will allocate at least one TOC entry for
           each unique non-automatic variable reference in your program.  GCC  will  also  place  floating-point
           constants in the TOC.  However, only 16,384 entries are available in the TOC.

           If  you  receive  a linker error message that saying you have overflowed the available TOC space, you
           can reduce the amount of  TOC  space  used  with  the  -mno-fp-in-toc  and  -mno-sum-in-toc  options.
           -mno-fp-in-toc  prevents  GCC  from  putting  floating-point constants in the TOC and -mno-sum-in-toc
           forces GCC to generate code to calculate the sum of an address and a constant at run-time instead  of
           putting  that  sum  into  the TOC.  You may specify one or both of these options.  Each causes GCC to
           produce very slightly slower and larger code at the expense of conserving TOC space.

           If you still run out of space in the TOC even  when  you  specify  both  of  these  options,  specify
           -mminimal-toc  instead.   This option causes GCC to make only one TOC entry for every file.  When you
           specify this option, GCC will produce code that is slower and larger but which uses extremely  little
           TOC space.  You may wish to use this option only on files that contain less frequently executed code.

       -maix64
       -maix32
           Enable  64-bit  AIX  ABI  and  calling  convention:  64-bit  pointers,  64-bit  "long"  type, and the
           infrastructure needed to support them.  Specifying -maix64 implies -mpowerpc64 and  -mpowerpc,  while
           -maix32 disables the 64-bit ABI and implies -mno-powerpc64.  GCC defaults to -maix32.

       -mxl-compat
       -mno-xl-compat
           Produce  code  that conforms more closely to IBM XL compiler semantics when using AIX-compatible ABI.
           Pass floating-point arguments to prototyped functions beyond the register  save  area  (RSA)  on  the
           stack  in  addition  to  argument  FPRs.   Do not assume that most significant double in 128-bit long
           double value is properly rounded when comparing values and converting to double.  Use XL symbol names
           for long double support routines.

           The AIX calling convention was extended but not initially documented to handle an obscure K&R C  case
           of  calling  a  function  that takes the address of its arguments with fewer arguments than declared.
           IBM XL compilers access floating point arguments which do not fit in the RSA from the  stack  when  a
           subroutine  is compiled without optimization.  Because always storing floating-point arguments on the
           stack is inefficient and rarely needed, this option is not enabled by default and only  is  necessary
           when calling subroutines compiled by IBM XL compilers without optimization.

       -mpe
           Support IBM RS/6000 SP Parallel Environment (PE).  Link an application written to use message passing
           with special startup code to enable the application to run.  The system must have PE installed in the
           standard  location  (/usr/lpp/ppe.poe/), or the specs file must be overridden with the -specs= option
           to specify the appropriate directory location.  The Parallel Environment does not support threads, so
           the -mpe option and the -pthread option are incompatible.

       -malign-natural
       -malign-power
           On AIX, 32-bit Darwin, and 64-bit PowerPC GNU/Linux, the option -malign-natural  overrides  the  ABI-
           defined  alignment  of  larger  types,  such  as  floating-point doubles, on their natural size-based
           boundary.  The option -malign-power instructs GCC to follow the ABI-specified alignment  rules.   GCC
           defaults to the standard alignment defined in the ABI.

           On 64-bit Darwin, natural alignment is the default, and -malign-power is not supported.

       -msoft-float
       -mhard-float
           Generate  code  that  does  not  use (uses) the floating-point register set.  Software floating point
           emulation is provided if you use the -msoft-float option, and pass the option to GCC when linking.

       -msingle-float
       -mdouble-float
           Generate code for single or  double-precision  floating  point  operations.   -mdouble-float  implies
           -msingle-float.

       -msimple-fpu
           Do not generate sqrt and div instructions for hardware floating point unit.

       -mfpu
           Specify  type  of  floating  point  unit.   Valid  values  are  sp_lite (equivalent to -msingle-float
           -msimple-fpu),  dp_lite  (equivalent  to  -mdouble-float  -msimple-fpu),   sp_full   (equivalent   to
           -msingle-float), and dp_full (equivalent to -mdouble-float).

       -mxilinx-fpu
           Perform optimizations for floating point unit on Xilinx PPC 405/440.

       -mmultiple
       -mno-multiple
           Generate  code  that  uses  (does not use) the load multiple word instructions and the store multiple
           word instructions.  These instructions are generated by default on POWER systems, and  not  generated
           on PowerPC systems.  Do not use -mmultiple on little endian PowerPC systems, since those instructions
           do  not work when the processor is in little endian mode.  The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750 which
           permit the instructions usage in little endian mode.

       -mstring
       -mno-string
           Generate code that uses (does not use) the  load  string  instructions  and  the  store  string  word
           instructions  to  save multiple registers and do small block moves.  These instructions are generated
           by default on POWER systems, and not generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not  use  -mstring  on  little
           endian  PowerPC  systems, since those instructions do not work when the processor is in little endian
           mode.  The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750 which permit the  instructions  usage  in  little  endian
           mode.

       -mupdate
       -mno-update
           Generate  code  that uses (does not use) the load or store instructions that update the base register
           to the address of the calculated memory location.  These instructions are generated by  default.   If
           you  use  -mno-update, there is a small window between the time that the stack pointer is updated and
           the address of the previous frame is stored, which means code  that  walks  the  stack  frame  across
           interrupts or signals may get corrupted data.

       -mavoid-indexed-addresses
       -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
           Generate  code  that  tries to avoid (not avoid) the use of indexed load or store instructions. These
           instructions can incur a performance penalty on Power6 processors in certain situations, such as when
           stepping through large arrays that cross a 16M boundary.  This option  is  enabled  by  default  when
           targetting Power6 and disabled otherwise.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Generate  code  that  uses  (does  not  use) the floating point multiply and accumulate instructions.
           These instructions are generated by  default  if  hardware  floating  point  is  used.   The  machine
           dependent -mfused-madd option is now mapped to the machine independent -ffp-contract=fast option, and
           -mno-fused-madd is mapped to -ffp-contract=off.

       -mmulhw
       -mno-mulhw
           Generate code that uses (does not use) the half-word multiply and multiply-accumulate instructions on
           the  IBM  405,  440,  464  and  476  processors.   These  instructions  are generated by default when
           targetting those processors.

       -mdlmzb
       -mno-dlmzb
           Generate code that uses (does not use) the string-search dlmzb instruction on the IBM 405,  440,  464
           and 476 processors.  This instruction is generated by default when targetting those processors.

       -mno-bit-align
       -mbit-align
           On  System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) force structures and unions that contain bit-
           fields to be aligned to the base type of the bit-field.

           For example, by default a structure containing nothing but 8 "unsigned" bit-fields of length 1  would
           be  aligned  to a 4 byte boundary and have a size of 4 bytes.  By using -mno-bit-align, the structure
           would be aligned to a 1 byte boundary and be one byte in size.

       -mno-strict-align
       -mstrict-align
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that unaligned memory  references  will
           be handled by the system.

       -mrelocatable
       -mno-relocatable
           Generate code that allows (does not allow) a static executable to be relocated to a different address
           at  runtime.   A simple embedded PowerPC system loader should relocate the entire contents of ".got2"
           and 4-byte locations listed in the ".fixup" section, a table of 32-bit addresses  generated  by  this
           option.   For  this  to  work,  all  objects  linked  together must be compiled with -mrelocatable or
           -mrelocatable-lib.  -mrelocatable code aligns the stack to an 8 byte boundary.

       -mrelocatable-lib
       -mno-relocatable-lib
           Like -mrelocatable, -mrelocatable-lib generates a ".fixup" section to allow static executables to  be
           relocated   at   runtime,  but  -mrelocatable-lib  does  not  use  the  smaller  stack  alignment  of
           -mrelocatable.  Objects compiled with -mrelocatable-lib may be linked with objects compiled with  any
           combination of the -mrelocatable options.

       -mno-toc
       -mtoc
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that register 2 contains a pointer to a
           global area pointing to the addresses used in the program.

       -mlittle
       -mlittle-endian
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the processor in little endian mode.  The
           -mlittle-endian option is the same as -mlittle.

       -mbig
       -mbig-endian
           On  System  V.4  and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the processor in big endian mode.  The
           -mbig-endian option is the same as -mbig.

       -mdynamic-no-pic
           On Darwin and Mac OS X systems, compile code so that it is not relocatable,  but  that  its  external
           references  are  relocatable.   The  resulting  code  is  suitable  for  applications, but not shared
           libraries.

       -msingle-pic-base
           Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than loading it in the  prologue  for
           each function.  The run-time system is responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate
           value before execution begins.

       -mprioritize-restricted-insns=priority
           This  option  controls  the priority that is assigned to dispatch-slot restricted instructions during
           the  second  scheduling  pass.   The  argument   priority   takes   the   value   0/1/2   to   assign
           no/highest/second-highest priority to dispatch slot restricted instructions.

       -msched-costly-dep=dependence_type
           This  option  controls  which  dependences  are  considered  costly  by the target during instruction
           scheduling.  The argument dependence_type takes one of the following values:  no:  no  dependence  is
           costly,  all: all dependences are costly, true_store_to_load: a true dependence from store to load is
           costly, store_to_load: any dependence from store to load is  costly,  number:  any  dependence  which
           latency >= number is costly.

       -minsert-sched-nops=scheme
           This  option controls which nop insertion scheme will be used during the second scheduling pass.  The
           argument scheme takes one of the following values: no: Don't insert nops.  pad:  Pad  with  nops  any
           dispatch  group  which has vacant issue slots, according to the scheduler's grouping.  regroup_exact:
           Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into separate groups.  Insert exactly  as  many  nops  as
           needed  to  force  an  insn  to  a new group, according to the estimated processor grouping.  number:
           Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into separate groups.  Insert number  nops  to  force  an
           insn to a new group.

       -mcall-sysv
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using calling conventions that adheres to the
           March 1995 draft of the System V Application Binary Interface, PowerPC processor supplement.  This is
           the default unless you configured GCC using powerpc-*-eabiaix.

       -mcall-sysv-eabi
       -mcall-eabi
           Specify both -mcall-sysv and -meabi options.

       -mcall-sysv-noeabi
           Specify both -mcall-sysv and -mno-eabi options.

       -mcall-aixdesc
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the AIX operating system.

       -mcall-linux
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the Linux-based GNU system.

       -mcall-gnu
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the Hurd-based GNU system.

       -mcall-freebsd
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the FreeBSD operating system.

       -mcall-netbsd
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the NetBSD operating system.

       -mcall-openbsd
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the OpenBSD operating system.

       -maix-struct-return
           Return all structures in memory (as specified by the AIX ABI).

       -msvr4-struct-return
           Return structures smaller than 8 bytes in registers (as specified by the SVR4 ABI).

       -mabi=abi-type
           Extend  the  current  ABI  with  a  particular extension, or remove such extension.  Valid values are
           altivec, no-altivec, spe, no-spe, ibmlongdouble, ieeelongdouble.

       -mabi=spe
           Extend the current ABI with SPE ABI extensions.  This does not change the  default  ABI,  instead  it
           adds the SPE ABI extensions to the current ABI.

       -mabi=no-spe
           Disable Booke SPE ABI extensions for the current ABI.

       -mabi=ibmlongdouble
           Change  the current ABI to use IBM extended precision long double.  This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI
           option.

       -mabi=ieeelongdouble
           Change the current ABI to use IEEE extended precision long double.  This is a  PowerPC  32-bit  Linux
           ABI option.

       -mprototype
       -mno-prototype
           On  System  V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems assume that all calls to variable argument functions are
           properly prototyped.  Otherwise, the compiler must insert an instruction before every non  prototyped
           call  to  set  or  clear bit 6 of the condition code register (CR) to indicate whether floating point
           values were passed in the floating point registers in case the function takes a  variable  arguments.
           With -mprototype, only calls to prototyped variable argument functions will set or clear the bit.

       -msim
           On  embedded  PowerPC  systems,  assume  that  the  startup  module is called sim-crt0.o and that the
           standard  C  libraries  are  libsim.a  and  libc.a.   This  is  the  default  for   powerpc-*-eabisim
           configurations.

       -mmvme
           On  embedded  PowerPC  systems,  assume  that  the startup module is called crt0.o and the standard C
           libraries are libmvme.a and libc.a.

       -mads
           On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is  called  crt0.o  and  the  standard  C
           libraries are libads.a and libc.a.

       -myellowknife
           On  embedded  PowerPC  systems,  assume  that  the startup module is called crt0.o and the standard C
           libraries are libyk.a and libc.a.

       -mvxworks
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, specify that you are compiling for a VxWorks system.

       -memb
           On embedded PowerPC systems, set the PPC_EMB bit in the  ELF  flags  header  to  indicate  that  eabi
           extended relocations are used.

       -meabi
       -mno-eabi
           On  System  V.4  and  embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) adhere to the Embedded Applications Binary
           Interface (eabi) which is a set of modifications to the System V.4 specifications.  Selecting  -meabi
           means  that  the stack is aligned to an 8 byte boundary, a function "__eabi" is called to from "main"
           to set up the eabi environment, and the -msdata option can use both "r2" and "r13" to  point  to  two
           separate  small  data  areas.   Selecting  -mno-eabi  means  that  the  stack is aligned to a 16 byte
           boundary, do not call an initialization function from "main", and the -msdata option  will  only  use
           "r13" to point to a single small data area.  The -meabi option is on by default if you configured GCC
           using one of the powerpc*-*-eabi* options.

       -msdata=eabi
           On  System  V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small initialized "const" global and static data in
           the .sdata2 section, which is pointed to by register "r2".  Put small initialized non-"const"  global
           and  static  data  in  the  .sdata  section,  which  is  pointed  to  by  register  "r13".  Put small
           uninitialized global and static data in the .sbss section, which is adjacent to the  .sdata  section.
           The  -msdata=eabi option is incompatible with the -mrelocatable option.  The -msdata=eabi option also
           sets the -memb option.

       -msdata=sysv
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and static data in the  .sdata  section,
           which  is  pointed to by register "r13".  Put small uninitialized global and static data in the .sbss
           section, which is adjacent to the .sdata section.  The -msdata=sysv option is incompatible  with  the
           -mrelocatable option.

       -msdata=default
       -msdata
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, if -meabi is used, compile code the same as -msdata=eabi,
           otherwise compile code the same as -msdata=sysv.

       -msdata=data
           On  System  V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global data in the .sdata section.  Put small
           uninitialized global data in the .sbss section.  Do not use register  "r13"  to  address  small  data
           however.  This is the default behavior unless other -msdata options are used.

       -msdata=none
       -mno-sdata
           On embedded PowerPC systems, put all initialized global and static data in the .data section, and all
           uninitialized data in the .bss section.

       -mblock-move-inline-limit=num
           Inline  all  block  moves  (such  as calls to "memcpy" or structure copies) less than or equal to num
           bytes.  The minimum value for num is 32 bytes on 32-bit targets and 64 bytes on 64-bit targets.   The
           default value is target-specific.

       -G num
           On  embedded  PowerPC  systems,  put global and static items less than or equal to num bytes into the
           small data or bss sections instead of the normal data or bss section.  By default, num is 8.  The  -G
           num switch is also passed to the linker.  All modules should be compiled with the same -G num value.

       -mregnames
       -mno-regnames
           On  System  V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) emit register names in the assembly language
           output using symbolic forms.

       -mlongcall
       -mno-longcall
           By default assume that all calls are far away so that a longer more  expensive  calling  sequence  is
           required.   This  is required for calls further than 32 megabytes (33,554,432 bytes) from the current
           location.  A short call will be generated if the compiler knows the call cannot  be  that  far  away.
           This setting can be overridden by the "shortcall" function attribute, or by "#pragma longcall(0)".

           Some  linkers  are  capable  of detecting out-of-range calls and generating glue code on the fly.  On
           these systems, long calls are unnecessary and generate slower code.  As  of  this  writing,  the  AIX
           linker  can  do this, as can the GNU linker for PowerPC/64.  It is planned to add this feature to the
           GNU linker for 32-bit PowerPC systems as well.

           On Darwin/PPC systems, "#pragma longcall" will generate "jbsr callee, L42", plus  a  "branch  island"
           (glue  code).  The two target addresses represent the callee and the "branch island".  The Darwin/PPC
           linker will prefer the first address and generate a "bl callee" if  the  PPC  "bl"  instruction  will
           reach  the callee directly; otherwise, the linker will generate "bl L42" to call the "branch island".
           The "branch island" is appended to the body of the calling function;  it  computes  the  full  32-bit
           address of the callee and jumps to it.

           On  Mach-O (Darwin) systems, this option directs the compiler emit to the glue for every direct call,
           and the Darwin linker decides whether to use or discard it.

           In the future, we may cause GCC to ignore all longcall specifications when the  linker  is  known  to
           generate glue.

       -mtls-markers
       -mno-tls-markers
           Mark (do not mark) calls to "__tls_get_addr" with a relocation specifying the function argument.  The
           relocation  allows  ld  to  reliably associate function call with argument setup instructions for TLS
           optimization, which in turn allows gcc to better schedule the sequence.

       -pthread
           Adds support for multithreading with the pthreads library.  This  option  sets  flags  for  both  the
           preprocessor and linker.

       -mrecip
       -mno-recip
           This  option  will  enable  GCC  to  use  the reciprocal estimate and reciprocal square root estimate
           instructions with additional Newton-Raphson steps to increase precision instead of doing a divide  or
           square  root  and  divide  for  floating point arguments.  You should use the -ffast-math option when
           using -mrecip (or at  least  -funsafe-math-optimizations,  -finite-math-only,  -freciprocal-math  and
           -fno-trapping-math).   Note  that  while  the throughput of the sequence is generally higher than the
           throughput of the non-reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be decreased by up to
           2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994) for reciprocal square roots.

       -mrecip=opt
           This option allows to control which reciprocal estimate instructions may be used.   opt  is  a  comma
           separated  list  of  options,  that  may be preceded by a "!" to invert the option: "all": enable all
           estimate instructions, "default": enable the default instructions,  equivalent  to  -mrecip,  "none":
           disable   all   estimate  instructions,  equivalent  to  -mno-recip;  "div":  enable  the  reciprocal
           approximation instructions for both single and double precision; "divf": enable the single  precision
           reciprocal  approximation  instructions; "divd": enable the double precision reciprocal approximation
           instructions; "rsqrt": enable the reciprocal square root approximation instructions for  both  single
           and  double  precision;  "rsqrtf":  enable  the single precision reciprocal square root approximation
           instructions;  "rsqrtd":  enable  the  double  precision   reciprocal   square   root   approximation
           instructions;

           So  for  example,  -mrecip=all,!rsqrtd  would enable the all of the reciprocal estimate instructions,
           except for the "FRSQRTE",  "XSRSQRTEDP",  and  "XVRSQRTEDP"  instructions  which  handle  the  double
           precision reciprocal square root calculations.

       -mrecip-precision
       -mno-recip-precision
           Assume  (do  not assume) that the reciprocal estimate instructions provide higher precision estimates
           than is mandated by the powerpc ABI.  Selecting -mcpu=power6 or  -mcpu=power7  automatically  selects
           -mrecip-precision.   The  double  precision  square  root  estimate instructions are not generated by
           default on low precision machines, since they do not provide an estimate that converges  after  three
           steps.

       -mveclibabi=type
           Specifies  the  ABI  type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an external library.  The only type
           supported at present is "mass", which specifies to  use  IBM's  Mathematical  Acceleration  Subsystem
           (MASS)  libraries for vectorizing intrinsics using external libraries.  GCC will currently emit calls
           to "acosd2", "acosf4", "acoshd2", "acoshf4", "asind2",  "asinf4",  "asinhd2",  "asinhf4",  "atan2d2",
           "atan2f4",  "atand2", "atanf4", "atanhd2", "atanhf4", "cbrtd2", "cbrtf4", "cosd2", "cosf4", "coshd2",
           "coshf4", "erfcd2", "erfcf4", "erfd2", "erff4",  "exp2d2",  "exp2f4",  "expd2",  "expf4",  "expm1d2",
           "expm1f4",  "hypotd2", "hypotf4", "lgammad2", "lgammaf4", "log10d2", "log10f4", "log1pd2", "log1pf4",
           "log2d2", "log2f4",  "logd2",  "logf4",  "powd2",  "powf4",  "sind2",  "sinf4",  "sinhd2",  "sinhf4",
           "sqrtd2",  "sqrtf4",  "tand2", "tanf4", "tanhd2", and "tanhf4" when generating code for power7.  Both
           -ftree-vectorize and -funsafe-math-optimizations have to be enabled.  The MASS libraries will have to
           be specified at link time.

       -mfriz
       -mno-friz
           Generate (do not generate) the "friz" instruction when the -funsafe-math-optimizations option is used
           to optimize rounding a floating point value to 64-bit integer and back to floating point.  The "friz"
           instruction does not return the same value if the floating point number is too large  to  fit  in  an
           integer.

       RX Options

       These command line options are defined for RX targets:

       -m64bit-doubles
       -m32bit-doubles
           Make  the  "double" data type be 64-bits (-m64bit-doubles) or 32-bits (-m32bit-doubles) in size.  The
           default is -m32bit-doubles.  Note RX floating point hardware only works on 32-bit  values,  which  is
           why the default is -m32bit-doubles.

       -fpu
       -nofpu
           Enables  (-fpu)  or  disables (-nofpu) the use of RX floating point hardware.  The default is enabled
           for the RX600 series and disabled for the RX200 series.

           Floating point instructions will only be generated for 32-bit floating point values  however,  so  if
           the -m64bit-doubles option is in use then the FPU hardware will not be used for doubles.

           Note  If  the  -fpu option is enabled then -funsafe-math-optimizations is also enabled automatically.
           This is because the RX FPU instructions are themselves unsafe.

       -mcpu=name
           Selects the type of RX CPU to be targeted.  Currently three types are supported,  the  generic  RX600
           and RX200 series hardware and the specific RX610 CPU.  The default is RX600.

           The  only  difference  between  RX600  and  RX610  is  that  the  RX610 does not support the "MVTIPL"
           instruction.

           The RX200 series does not have a hardware floating point unit and so -nofpu  is  enabled  by  default
           when this type is selected.

       -mbig-endian-data
       -mlittle-endian-data
           Store  data  (but  not  code) in the big-endian format.  The default is -mlittle-endian-data, i.e. to
           store data in the little endian format.

       -msmall-data-limit=N
           Specifies the maximum size in bytes of global and static variables which can be placed into the small
           data area.  Using the small data area can lead to smaller and faster code, but the size  of  area  is
           limited  and  it  is  up  to the programmer to ensure that the area does not overflow.  Also when the
           small data area is used one of the RX's registers ("r13") is reserved for use pointing to this  area,
           so it is no longer available for use by the compiler.  This could result in slower and/or larger code
           if variables which once could have been held in "r13" are now pushed onto the stack.

           Note,  common variables (variables which have not been initialised) and constants are not placed into
           the small data area as they are assigned to other sections in the output executable.

           The default value is zero, which disables this feature.  Note, this feature is not enabled by default
           with higher optimization levels (-O2 etc) because of the potentially detrimental effects of reserving
           register "r13".  It is up to the programmer to experiment and discover whether  this  feature  is  of
           benefit to their program.

       -msim
       -mno-sim
           Use the simulator runtime.  The default is to use the libgloss board specific runtime.

       -mas100-syntax
       -mno-as100-syntax
           When  generating  assembler  output  use  a syntax that is compatible with Renesas's AS100 assembler.
           This syntax can also be handled by the GAS assembler but it has some restrictions so generating it is
           not the default option.

       -mmax-constant-size=N
           Specifies the maximum size, in bytes, of a  constant  that  can  be  used  as  an  operand  in  a  RX
           instruction.   Although  the RX instruction set does allow constants of up to 4 bytes in length to be
           used in instructions, a longer value equates to a longer instruction.  Thus in some circumstances  it
           can  be  beneficial  to restrict the size of constants that are used in instructions.  Constants that
           are too big are instead placed into a constant pool and referenced via register indirection.

           The value N can be between 0 and 4.  A value of 0 (the default) or 4 means that constants of any size
           are allowed.

       -mrelax
           Enable linker relaxation.  Linker relaxation is a process whereby the linker will attempt  to  reduce
           the size of a program by finding shorter versions of various instructions.  Disabled by default.

       -mint-register=N
           Specify  the number of registers to reserve for fast interrupt handler functions.  The value N can be
           between 0 and 4.  A value of 1 means that register "r13" will be reserved for the  exclusive  use  of
           fast  interrupt handlers.  A value of 2 reserves "r13" and "r12".  A value of 3 reserves "r13", "r12"
           and "r11", and a value of 4 reserves "r13" through "r10".  A  value  of  0,  the  default,  does  not
           reserve any registers.

       -msave-acc-in-interrupts
           Specifies  that  interrupt  handler functions should preserve the accumulator register.  This is only
           necessary if normal code might use the accumulator register, for example because it  performs  64-bit
           multiplications.   The  default  is  to  ignore  the accumulator as this makes the interrupt handlers
           faster.

       Note: The generic GCC command line -ffixed-reg has special significance to the RX port when used with the
       "interrupt" function attribute.  This attribute indicates a function intended to process fast interrupts.
       GCC will will ensure that it only uses the registers "r10", "r11", "r12" and/or "r13" and  only  provided
       that  the  normal  use  of  the  corresponding  registers  have  been  restricted  via the -ffixed-reg or
       -mint-register command line options.

       S/390 and zSeries Options

       These are the -m options defined for the S/390 and zSeries architecture.

       -mhard-float
       -msoft-float
           Use  (do  not  use)  the  hardware  floating-point  instructions  and  registers  for  floating-point
           operations.   When -msoft-float is specified, functions in libgcc.a will be used to perform floating-
           point operations.  When  -mhard-float  is  specified,  the  compiler  generates  IEEE  floating-point
           instructions.  This is the default.

       -mhard-dfp
       -mno-hard-dfp
           Use  (do  not  use)  the  hardware  decimal-floating-point  instructions  for  decimal-floating-point
           operations.  When -mno-hard-dfp is specified, functions in libgcc.a will be used to perform  decimal-
           floating-point  operations.   When  -mhard-dfp is specified, the compiler generates decimal-floating-
           point hardware instructions.  This is the default for -march=z9-ec or higher.

       -mlong-double-64
       -mlong-double-128
           These switches control the size of "long double" type. A size of 64bit makes the "long  double"  type
           equivalent to the "double" type. This is the default.

       -mbackchain
       -mno-backchain
           Store  (do  not store) the address of the caller's frame as backchain pointer into the callee's stack
           frame.  A backchain may be needed to allow debugging using tools that do not understand DWARF-2  call
           frame  information.   When  -mno-packed-stack  is  in  effect, the backchain pointer is stored at the
           bottom of the stack frame; when -mpacked-stack is in effect, the backchain is placed into the topmost
           word of the 96/160 byte register save area.

           In general, code compiled with -mbackchain is call-compatible with code compiled with -mmo-backchain;
           however, use of the backchain for debugging purposes usually requires that the whole binary is  built
           with  -mbackchain.   Note that the combination of -mbackchain, -mpacked-stack and -mhard-float is not
           supported.  In order to build a linux kernel use -msoft-float.

           The default is to not maintain the backchain.

       -mpacked-stack
       -mno-packed-stack
           Use (do not use) the packed stack layout.  When -mno-packed-stack is specified, the compiler uses the
           all fields of the 96/160 byte register save area only for their default purpose; unused fields  still
           take up stack space.  When -mpacked-stack is specified, register save slots are densely packed at the
           top of the register save area; unused space is reused for other purposes, allowing for more efficient
           use  of  the available stack space.  However, when -mbackchain is also in effect, the topmost word of
           the save area is always used to store the backchain, and the return address register is always  saved
           two words below the backchain.

           As  long  as  the  stack  frame  backchain  is  not used, code generated with -mpacked-stack is call-
           compatible with code generated with -mno-packed-stack.  Note that some non-FSF releases of  GCC  2.95
           for  S/390  or  zSeries  generated code that uses the stack frame backchain at run time, not just for
           debugging purposes.  Such code is not call-compatible with code compiled with -mpacked-stack.   Also,
           note that the combination of -mbackchain, -mpacked-stack and -mhard-float is not supported.  In order
           to build a linux kernel use -msoft-float.

           The default is to not use the packed stack layout.

       -msmall-exec
       -mno-small-exec
           Generate  (or  do  not generate) code using the "bras" instruction to do subroutine calls.  This only
           works reliably if the total executable size does not exceed 64k.  The default is to  use  the  "basr"
           instruction instead, which does not have this limitation.

       -m64
       -m31
           When  -m31  is  specified,  generate  code  compliant  to  the GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI.  When -m64 is
           specified, generate code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI.  This allows GCC  in  particular
           to  generate 64-bit instructions.  For the s390 targets, the default is -m31, while the s390x targets
           default to -m64.

       -mzarch
       -mesa
           When -mzarch is specified, generate code using the instructions available  on  z/Architecture.   When
           -mesa  is  specified,  generate code using the instructions available on ESA/390.  Note that -mesa is
           not possible with -m64.  When generating code compliant to the GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI,  the  default
           is -mesa.  When generating code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI, the default is -mzarch.

       -mmvcle
       -mno-mvcle
           Generate  (or  do  not  generate)  code  using  the "mvcle" instruction to perform block moves.  When
           -mno-mvcle is specified, use a "mvc" loop instead.  This is the default unless optimizing for size.

       -mdebug
       -mno-debug
           Print (or do not print) additional debug information when compiling.  The default  is  to  not  print
           debug information.

       -march=cpu-type
           Generate  code  that  will  run  on  cpu-type,  which  is the name of a system representing a certain
           processor type.  Possible values for cpu-type are g5, g6, z900, z990, z9-109, z9-ec  and  z10.   When
           generating  code  using  the  instructions  available  on z/Architecture, the default is -march=z900.
           Otherwise, the default is -march=g5.

       -mtune=cpu-type
           Tune to cpu-type everything applicable about the generated code, except for the ABI and  the  set  of
           available  instructions.   The list of cpu-type values is the same as for -march.  The default is the
           value used for -march.

       -mtpf-trace
       -mno-tpf-trace
           Generate code that adds (does not add) in TPF OS specific branches to trace routines in the operating
           system.  This option is off by default, even when compiling for the TPF OS.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Generate code that uses (does not use) the  floating  point  multiply  and  accumulate  instructions.
           These instructions are generated by default if hardware floating point is used.

       -mwarn-framesize=framesize
           Emit  a warning if the current function exceeds the given frame size.  Because this is a compile time
           check it doesn't need to be a real problem when  the  program  runs.   It  is  intended  to  identify
           functions which most probably cause a stack overflow.  It is useful to be used in an environment with
           limited stack size e.g. the linux kernel.

       -mwarn-dynamicstack
           Emit  a  warning  if the function calls alloca or uses dynamically sized arrays.  This is generally a
           bad idea with a limited stack size.

       -mstack-guard=stack-guard
       -mstack-size=stack-size
           If these options are provided the s390  back  end  emits  additional  instructions  in  the  function
           prologue  which  trigger a trap if the stack size is stack-guard bytes above the stack-size (remember
           that the stack on s390 grows downward).  If the stack-guard option is omitted the smallest power of 2
           larger than the frame size of the compiled function is chosen.  These options are intended to be used
           to help debugging stack overflow problems.  The additionally emitted code causes only little overhead
           and hence can also be used in production like systems without greater performance  degradation.   The
           given  values  have to be exact powers of 2 and stack-size has to be greater than stack-guard without
           exceeding 64k.  In order to be efficient the extra code makes the assumption that the stack starts at
           an address aligned to the value given by stack-size.  The stack-guard option  can  only  be  used  in
           conjunction with stack-size.

       Score Options

       These options are defined for Score implementations:

       -meb
           Compile code for big endian mode.  This is the default.

       -mel
           Compile code for little endian mode.

       -mnhwloop
           Disable generate bcnz instruction.

       -muls
           Enable generate unaligned load and store instruction.

       -mmac
           Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.

       -mscore5
           Specify the SCORE5 as the target architecture.

       -mscore5u
           Specify the SCORE5U of the target architecture.

       -mscore7
           Specify the SCORE7 as the target architecture. This is the default.

       -mscore7d
           Specify the SCORE7D as the target architecture.

       SH Options

       These -m options are defined for the SH implementations:

       -m1 Generate code for the SH1.

       -m2 Generate code for the SH2.

       -m2e
           Generate code for the SH2e.

       -m2a-nofpu
           Generate  code for the SH2a without FPU, or for a SH2a-FPU in such a way that the floating-point unit
           is not used.

       -m2a-single-only
           Generate code for the SH2a-FPU, in such a way that no double-precision floating point operations  are
           used.

       -m2a-single
           Generate  code  for  the  SH2a-FPU  assuming  the  floating-point unit is in single-precision mode by
           default.

       -m2a
           Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the  floating-point  unit  is  in  double-precision  mode  by
           default.

       -m3 Generate code for the SH3.

       -m3e
           Generate code for the SH3e.

       -m4-nofpu
           Generate code for the SH4 without a floating-point unit.

       -m4-single-only
           Generate code for the SH4 with a floating-point unit that only supports single-precision arithmetic.

       -m4-single
           Generate code for the SH4 assuming the floating-point unit is in single-precision mode by default.

       -m4 Generate code for the SH4.

       -m4a-nofpu
           Generate  code  for  the  SH4al-dsp,  or for a SH4a in such a way that the floating-point unit is not
           used.

       -m4a-single-only
           Generate code for the SH4a, in such a way that no  double-precision  floating  point  operations  are
           used.

       -m4a-single
           Generate code for the SH4a assuming the floating-point unit is in single-precision mode by default.

       -m4a
           Generate code for the SH4a.

       -m4al
           Same as -m4a-nofpu, except that it implicitly passes -dsp to the assembler.  GCC doesn't generate any
           DSP instructions at the moment.

       -mb Compile code for the processor in big endian mode.

       -ml Compile code for the processor in little endian mode.

       -mdalign
           Align  doubles  at  64-bit boundaries.  Note that this changes the calling conventions, and thus some
           functions from the standard C library will not work unless you recompile it first with -mdalign.

       -mrelax
           Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the linker option -relax.

       -mbigtable
           Use 32-bit offsets in "switch" tables.  The default is to use 16-bit offsets.

       -mbitops
           Enable the use of bit manipulation instructions on SH2A.

       -mfmovd
           Enable the use of the instruction "fmovd".  Check -mdalign for alignment constraints.

       -mhitachi
           Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.

       -mrenesas
           Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.

       -mno-renesas
           Comply with the calling conventions defined for GCC before the Renesas  conventions  were  available.
           This option is the default for all targets of the SH toolchain except for sh-symbianelf.

       -mnomacsave
           Mark the "MAC" register as call-clobbered, even if -mhitachi is given.

       -mieee
       -mno-ieee
           Control  the IEEE compliance of floating-point comparisons, which affects the handling of cases where
           the  result  of  a  comparison  is  unordered.   By  default  -mieee  is  implicitly   enabled.    If
           -ffinite-math-only  is  enabled  -mno-ieee  is implicitly set, which results in faster floating-point
           greater-equal and less-equal comparisons.  The implcit  settings  can  be  overridden  by  specifying
           either -mieee or -mno-ieee.

       -minline-ic_invalidate
           Inline  code  to  invalidate  instruction cache entries after setting up nested function trampolines.
           This option has no effect if -musermode is in effect and the selected code  generation  option  (e.g.
           -m4) does not allow the use of the icbi instruction.  If the selected code generation option does not
           allow  the  use  of  the  icbi  instruction,  and  -musermode is not in effect, the inlined code will
           manipulate the instruction cache address array directly with an associative  write.   This  not  only
           requires privileged mode, but it will also fail if the cache line had been mapped via the TLB and has
           become unmapped.

       -misize
           Dump instruction size and location in the assembly code.

       -mpadstruct
           This option is deprecated.  It pads structures to multiple of 4 bytes, which is incompatible with the
           SH ABI.

       -mspace
           Optimize for space instead of speed.  Implied by -Os.

       -mprefergot
           When  generating position-independent code, emit function calls using the Global Offset Table instead
           of the Procedure Linkage Table.

       -musermode
           Don't generate privileged mode only code; implies -mno-inline-ic_invalidate if the inlined code would
           not work in user mode.  This is the default when the target is "sh-*-linux*".

       -multcost=number
           Set the cost to assume for a multiply insn.

       -mdiv=strategy
           Set the division strategy to use for SHmedia code.  strategy must be one of: call,  call2,  fp,  inv,
           inv:minlat,  inv20u,  inv20l,  inv:call, inv:call2, inv:fp .  "fp" performs the operation in floating
           point.  This has a very high latency, but needs only a few instructions, so it might be a good choice
           if your code has enough easily exploitable ILP to allow the compiler to schedule the  floating  point
           instructions  together  with other instructions.  Division by zero causes a floating point exception.
           "inv" uses integer operations to calculate the inverse  of  the  divisor,  and  then  multiplies  the
           dividend  with  the  inverse.   This  strategy  allows  cse  and hoisting of the inverse calculation.
           Division by zero calculates an unspecified result, but does not trap.  "inv:minlat" is a  variant  of
           "inv"  where  if no cse / hoisting opportunities have been found, or if the entire operation has been
           hoisted to the same place, the last stages of the inverse calculation are intertwined with the  final
           multiply  to  reduce  the  overall latency, at the expense of using a few more instructions, and thus
           offering fewer scheduling opportunities with other  code.   "call"  calls  a  library  function  that
           usually  implements  the  inv:minlat  strategy.   This  gives  high  code density for m5-*media-nofpu
           compilations.  "call2" uses a different entry point of the same library function,  where  it  assumes
           that  a  pointer  to  a lookup table has already been set up, which exposes the pointer load to cse /
           code hoisting optimizations.  "inv:call", "inv:call2" and "inv:fp" all use the  "inv"  algorithm  for
           initial  code  generation,  but if the code stays unoptimized, revert to the "call", "call2", or "fp"
           strategies, respectively.  Note that the potentially-trapping side effect  of  division  by  zero  is
           carried  by  a  separate instruction, so it is possible that all the integer instructions are hoisted
           out, but the marker for the side effect stays where it is.  A recombination to  fp  operations  or  a
           call  is not possible in that case.  "inv20u" and "inv20l" are variants of the "inv:minlat" strategy.
           In the case that the inverse calculation was nor separated from the multiply, they speed up  division
           where  the  dividend  fits  into  20 bits (plus sign where applicable), by inserting a test to skip a
           number of operations in this case; this test slows down the case of larger dividends.  inv20u assumes
           the case of a such a small dividend to be unlikely, and inv20l assumes it to be likely.

       -maccumulate-outgoing-args
           Reserve space once for outgoing arguments in the function prologue  rather  than  around  each  call.
           Generally beneficial for performance and size.  Also needed for unwinding to avoid changing the stack
           frame around conditional code.

       -mdivsi3_libfunc=name
           Set  the  name of the library function used for 32 bit signed division to name.  This only affect the
           name used in the call and inv:call division strategies, and the compiler will still expect  the  same
           sets of input/output/clobbered registers as if this option was not present.

       -mfixed-range=register-range
           Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.  A fixed register is one that the
           register  allocator  can  not  use.   This is useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is
           specified as two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be specified  separated
           by a comma.

       -madjust-unroll
           Throttle  unrolling  to  avoid thrashing target registers.  This option only has an effect if the gcc
           code base supports the TARGET_ADJUST_UNROLL_MAX target hook.

       -mindexed-addressing
           Enable the use of the indexed addressing mode for SHmedia32/SHcompact.  This  is  only  safe  if  the
           hardware  and/or  OS  implement  32  bit  wrap-around semantics for the indexed addressing mode.  The
           architecture allows the implementation of processors with 64 bit MMU, which the OS could use  to  get
           32  bit  addressing,  but  since no current hardware implementation supports this or any other way to
           make  the  indexed  addressing  mode  safe  to  use   in   the   32   bit   ABI,   the   default   is
           -mno-indexed-addressing.

       -mgettrcost=number
           Set  the  cost  assumed  for  the  gettr instruction to number.  The default is 2 if -mpt-fixed is in
           effect, 100 otherwise.

       -mpt-fixed
           Assume pt* instructions won't trap.  This will generally  generate  better  scheduled  code,  but  is
           unsafe  on current hardware.  The current architecture definition says that ptabs and ptrel trap when
           the target anded with 3 is 3.  This has the unintentional effect of  making  it  unsafe  to  schedule
           ptabs  / ptrel before a branch, or hoist it out of a loop.  For example, __do_global_ctors, a part of
           libgcc that runs constructors at program startup, calls functions in a list which is delimited by -1.
           With the -mpt-fixed option, the ptabs will be done before testing against -1.  That  means  that  all
           the  constructors  will  be  run  a  bit quicker, but when the loop comes to the end of the list, the
           program crashes because ptabs loads -1 into a target register.  Since this option is unsafe  for  any
           hardware  implementing  the current architecture specification, the default is -mno-pt-fixed.  Unless
           the user specifies a specific cost with -mgettrcost, -mno-pt-fixed also implies -mgettrcost=100; this
           deters register allocation using target registers for storing ordinary integers.

       -minvalid-symbols
           Assume symbols might be invalid.  Ordinary function symbols generated by the compiler will always  be
           valid  to  load with movi/shori/ptabs or movi/shori/ptrel, but with assembler and/or linker tricks it
           is possible to generate symbols that will  cause  ptabs  /  ptrel  to  trap.   This  option  is  only
           meaningful when -mno-pt-fixed is in effect.  It will then prevent cross-basic-block cse, hoisting and
           most scheduling of symbol loads.  The default is -mno-invalid-symbols.

       Solaris 2 Options

       These -m options are supported on Solaris 2:

       -mimpure-text
           -mimpure-text, used in addition to -shared, tells the compiler to not pass -z text to the linker when
           linking  a  shared  object.   Using  this  option, you can link position-dependent code into a shared
           object.

           -mimpure-text suppresses the "relocations  remain  against  allocatable  but  non-writable  sections"
           linker  error message.  However, the necessary relocations will trigger copy-on-write, and the shared
           object is not actually shared across processes.  Instead of using -mimpure-text, you  should  compile
           all source code with -fpic or -fPIC.

       These switches are supported in addition to the above on Solaris 2:

       -threads
           Add  support  for  multithreading using the Solaris threads library.  This option sets flags for both
           the preprocessor and linker.  This option does not affect the thread safety of object  code  produced
           by the compiler or that of libraries supplied with it.

       -pthreads
           Add  support for multithreading using the POSIX threads library.  This option sets flags for both the
           preprocessor and linker.  This option does not affect the thread safety of object code  produced   by
           the compiler or that of libraries supplied with it.

       -pthread
           This is a synonym for -pthreads.

       SPARC Options

       These -m options are supported on the SPARC:

       -mno-app-regs
       -mapp-regs
           Specify  -mapp-regs  to  generate output using the global registers 2 through 4, which the SPARC SVR4
           ABI reserves for applications.  This is the default.

           To be fully SVR4 ABI compliant at the cost of some  performance  loss,  specify  -mno-app-regs.   You
           should compile libraries and system software with this option.

       -mfpu
       -mhard-float
           Generate output containing floating point instructions.  This is the default.

       -mno-fpu
       -msoft-float
           Generate  output  containing  library calls for floating point.  Warning: the requisite libraries are
           not available for all SPARC targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C  compiler  are
           used,  but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make your own arrangements to
           provide suitable library functions for cross-compilation.   The  embedded  targets  sparc-*-aout  and
           sparclite-*-* do provide software floating point support.

           -msoft-float  changes  the calling convention in the output file; therefore, it is only useful if you
           compile all of a program with this option.  In particular, you need to compile libgcc.a, the  library
           that comes with GCC, with -msoft-float in order for this to work.

       -mhard-quad-float
           Generate output containing quad-word (long double) floating point instructions.

       -msoft-quad-float
           Generate  output  containing  library  calls for quad-word (long double) floating point instructions.
           The functions called are those specified in the SPARC ABI.  This is the default.

           As of this writing, there are no SPARC implementations that have hardware support for  the  quad-word
           floating  point instructions.  They all invoke a trap handler for one of these instructions, and then
           the trap handler emulates the effect of the instruction.  Because of the trap handler overhead,  this
           is  much  slower  than  calling  the  ABI library routines.  Thus the -msoft-quad-float option is the
           default.

       -mno-unaligned-doubles
       -munaligned-doubles
           Assume that doubles have 8 byte alignment.  This is the default.

           With -munaligned-doubles, GCC assumes that doubles have 8 byte alignment only if they  are  contained
           in  another  type,  or  if  they  have  an  absolute address.  Otherwise, it assumes they have 4 byte
           alignment.  Specifying this option avoids some rare compatibility problems  with  code  generated  by
           other  compilers.   It  is  not  the default because it results in a performance loss, especially for
           floating point code.

       -mno-faster-structs
       -mfaster-structs
           With -mfaster-structs, the compiler assumes that structures  should  have  8  byte  alignment.   This
           enables the use of pairs of "ldd" and "std" instructions for copies in structure assignment, in place
           of  twice  as many "ld" and "st" pairs.  However, the use of this changed alignment directly violates
           the SPARC ABI.  Thus, it's intended only for use on targets where  the  developer  acknowledges  that
           their resulting code will not be directly in line with the rules of the ABI.

       -mcpu=cpu_type
           Set  the  instruction  set,  register  set,  and  instruction  scheduling parameters for machine type
           cpu_type.  Supported  values  for  cpu_type  are  v7,  cypress,  v8,  supersparc,  hypersparc,  leon,
           sparclite,  f930,  f934,  sparclite86x,  sparclet,  tsc701,  v9, ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara and
           niagara2.

           Default instruction scheduling parameters are used for values that select an architecture and not  an
           implementation.  These are v7, v8, sparclite, sparclet, v9.

           Here is a list of each supported architecture and their supported implementations.

                       v7:             cypress
                       v8:             supersparc, hypersparc, leon
                       sparclite:      f930, f934, sparclite86x
                       sparclet:       tsc701
                       v9:             ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2

           By  default  (unless  configured  otherwise),  GCC  generates  code  for  the V7 variant of the SPARC
           architecture.  With -mcpu=cypress, the compiler additionally optimizes it  for  the  Cypress  CY7C602
           chip,  as  used  in  the SPARCStation/SPARCServer 3xx series.  This is also appropriate for the older
           SPARCStation 1, 2, IPX etc.

           With -mcpu=v8, GCC generates code for the V8 variant of the SPARC architecture.  The only  difference
           from  V7  code  is that the compiler emits the integer multiply and integer divide instructions which
           exist in SPARC-V8 but not in SPARC-V7.  With -mcpu=supersparc, the compiler additionally optimizes it
           for the SuperSPARC chip, as used in the SPARCStation 10, 1000 and 2000 series.

           With -mcpu=sparclite, GCC generates code for the SPARClite variant of the SPARC  architecture.   This
           adds the integer multiply, integer divide step and scan ("ffs") instructions which exist in SPARClite
           but not in SPARC-V7.  With -mcpu=f930, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the Fujitsu MB86930
           chip,  which  is  the  original  SPARClite,  with no FPU.  With -mcpu=f934, the compiler additionally
           optimizes it for the Fujitsu MB86934 chip, which is the more recent SPARClite with FPU.

           With -mcpu=sparclet, GCC generates code for the SPARClet variant of  the  SPARC  architecture.   This
           adds  the  integer  multiply,  multiply/accumulate, integer divide step and scan ("ffs") instructions
           which exist in SPARClet but not in SPARC-V7.  With -mcpu=tsc701, the compiler additionally  optimizes
           it for the TEMIC SPARClet chip.

           With  -mcpu=v9,  GCC  generates  code for the V9 variant of the SPARC architecture.  This adds 64-bit
           integer and floating-point move instructions, 3 additional floating-point  condition  code  registers
           and conditional move instructions.  With -mcpu=ultrasparc, the compiler additionally optimizes it for
           the  Sun  UltraSPARC  I/II/IIi chips.  With -mcpu=ultrasparc3, the compiler additionally optimizes it
           for  the  Sun  UltraSPARC  III/III+/IIIi/IIIi+/IV/IV+  chips.   With  -mcpu=niagara,   the   compiler
           additionally   optimizes  it  for  Sun  UltraSPARC  T1  chips.   With  -mcpu=niagara2,  the  compiler
           additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T2 chips.

       -mtune=cpu_type
           Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type cpu_type, but do not set  the  instruction
           set or register set that the option -mcpu=cpu_type would.

           The  same  values  for -mcpu=cpu_type can be used for -mtune=cpu_type, but the only useful values are
           those that select a particular CPU implementation.  Those are cypress, supersparc, hypersparc,  leon,
           f930, f934, sparclite86x, tsc701, ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, and niagara2.

       -mv8plus
       -mno-v8plus
           With  -mv8plus, GCC generates code for the SPARC-V8+ ABI.  The difference from the V8 ABI is that the
           global and out registers are considered 64-bit wide.  This is enabled by default on Solaris in 32-bit
           mode for all SPARC-V9 processors.

       -mvis
       -mno-vis
           With -mvis, GCC generates code  that  takes  advantage  of  the  UltraSPARC  Visual  Instruction  Set
           extensions.  The default is -mno-vis.

       -mfix-at697f
           Enable  the  documented  workaround  for  the  single  erratum  of  the Atmel AT697F processor (which
           corresponds to erratum #13 of the AT697E processor).

       These -m options are supported in addition to the above on SPARC-V9 processors in 64-bit environments:

       -mlittle-endian
           Generate code for a processor running in  little-endian  mode.   It  is  only  available  for  a  few
           configurations and most notably not on Solaris and Linux.

       -m32
       -m64
           Generate  code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer
           to 32 bits.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.

       -mcmodel=medlow
           Generate code for the Medium/Low code model: 64-bit addresses, programs must be linked in the low  32
           bits of memory.  Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.

       -mcmodel=medmid
           Generate  code for the Medium/Middle code model: 64-bit addresses, programs must be linked in the low
           44 bits of memory, the text and data segments must be less than 2GB in size and the data segment must
           be located within 2GB of the text segment.

       -mcmodel=medany
           Generate code for the Medium/Anywhere code model: 64-bit addresses, programs may be  linked  anywhere
           in  memory,  the  text  and  data segments must be less than 2GB in size and the data segment must be
           located within 2GB of the text segment.

       -mcmodel=embmedany
           Generate code for the Medium/Anywhere code model for embedded systems: 64-bit addresses, the text and
           data segments must be less than 2GB in size, both starting anywhere in  memory  (determined  at  link
           time).   The  global  register  %g4  points to the base of the data segment.  Programs are statically
           linked and PIC is not supported.

       -mstack-bias
       -mno-stack-bias
           With -mstack-bias, GCC assumes that the stack pointer, and frame pointer if present,  are  offset  by
           -2047  which  must  be  added back when making stack frame references.  This is the default in 64-bit
           mode.  Otherwise, assume no such offset is present.

       SPU Options

       These -m options are supported on the SPU:

       -mwarn-reloc
       -merror-reloc
           The loader for SPU does not handle dynamic relocations.  By default, GCC will give an error  when  it
           generates code that requires a dynamic relocation.  -mno-error-reloc disables the error, -mwarn-reloc
           will generate a warning instead.

       -msafe-dma
       -munsafe-dma
           Instructions which initiate or test completion of DMA must not be reordered with respect to loads and
           stores  of  the  memory  which  is  being  accessed.   Users typically address this problem using the
           volatile keyword, but that can lead to inefficient code in places where the memory is  known  to  not
           change.   Rather  than  mark  the  memory  as  volatile  we treat the DMA instructions as potentially
           effecting all memory.  With -munsafe-dma users must  use  the  volatile  keyword  to  protect  memory
           accesses.

       -mbranch-hints
           By  default, GCC will generate a branch hint instruction to avoid pipeline stalls for always taken or
           probably taken branches.  A hint will not be generated closer  than  8  instructions  away  from  its
           branch.   There is little reason to disable them, except for debugging purposes, or to make an object
           a little bit smaller.

       -msmall-mem
       -mlarge-mem
           By default, GCC generates code  assuming  that  addresses  are  never  larger  than  18  bits.   With
           -mlarge-mem code is generated that assumes a full 32 bit address.

       -mstdmain
           By  default, GCC links against startup code that assumes the SPU-style main function interface (which
           has an unconventional parameter list).  With -mstdmain, GCC will link your  program  against  startup
           code that assumes a C99-style interface to "main", including a local copy of "argv" strings.

       -mfixed-range=register-range
           Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.  A fixed register is one that the
           register  allocator  can  not  use.   This is useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is
           specified as two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be specified  separated
           by a comma.

       -mea32
       -mea64
           Compile  code  assuming  that pointers to the PPU address space accessed via the "__ea" named address
           space qualifier are either 32 or 64 bits wide.  The default is 32 bits.  As this is an  ABI  changing
           option, all object code in an executable must be compiled with the same setting.

       -maddress-space-conversion
       -mno-address-space-conversion
           Allow/disallow  treating  the  "__ea"  address  space as superset of the generic address space.  This
           enables explicit type casts between "__ea" and generic pointer as well  as  implicit  conversions  of
           generic pointers to "__ea" pointers.  The default is to allow address space pointer conversions.

       -mcache-size=cache-size
           This  option  controls  the  version of libgcc that the compiler links to an executable and selects a
           software-managed cache for accessing variables in the "__ea" address space with  a  particular  cache
           size.  Possible options for cache-size are 8, 16, 32, 64 and 128.  The default cache size is 64KB.

       -matomic-updates
       -mno-atomic-updates
           This  option  controls  the  version  of  libgcc that the compiler links to an executable and selects
           whether atomic updates to the software-managed cache of PPU-side variables  are  used.   If  you  use
           atomic  updates,  changes  to  a  PPU  variable  from  SPU  code using the "__ea" named address space
           qualifier will not interfere with changes to other PPU variables residing in the same cache line from
           PPU code.  If you do not use atomic updates, such interference may occur; however, writing back cache
           lines will be more efficient.  The default behavior is to use atomic updates.

       -mdual-nops
       -mdual-nops=n
           By default, GCC will insert nops to increase dual issue when it expects it to  increase  performance.
           n can be a value from 0 to 10.  A smaller n will insert fewer nops.  10 is the default, 0 is the same
           as -mno-dual-nops.  Disabled with -Os.

       -mhint-max-nops=n
           Maximum  number  of  nops to insert for a branch hint.  A branch hint must be at least 8 instructions
           away from the branch it is effecting.  GCC will insert up to n nops to  enforce  this,  otherwise  it
           will not generate the branch hint.

       -mhint-max-distance=n
           The  encoding  of  the  branch  hint instruction limits the hint to be within 256 instructions of the
           branch it is effecting.  By default, GCC makes sure it is within 125.

       -msafe-hints
           Work around a hardware bug which causes the SPU to stall indefinitely.  By default, GCC  will  insert
           the "hbrp" instruction to make sure this stall won't happen.

       Options for System V

       These  additional  options  are available on System V Release 4 for compatibility with other compilers on
       those systems:

       -G  Create a shared object.  It is recommended that -symbolic or -shared be used instead.

       -Qy Identify the versions of each tool used by the compiler, in a ".ident"  assembler  directive  in  the
           output.

       -Qn Refrain from adding ".ident" directives to the output file (this is the default).

       -YP,dirs
           Search the directories dirs, and no others, for libraries specified with -l.

       -Ym,dir
           Look in the directory dir to find the M4 preprocessor.  The assembler uses this option.

       V850 Options

       These -m options are defined for V850 implementations:

       -mlong-calls
       -mno-long-calls
           Treat  all  calls  as  being far away (near).  If calls are assumed to be far away, the compiler will
           always load the functions address up into a register, and call indirect through the pointer.

       -mno-ep
       -mep
           Do not optimize (do optimize) basic blocks that use the same index pointer 4 or more  times  to  copy
           pointer into the "ep" register, and use the shorter "sld" and "sst" instructions.  The -mep option is
           on by default if you optimize.

       -mno-prolog-function
       -mprolog-function
           Do  not use (do use) external functions to save and restore registers at the prologue and epilogue of
           a function.  The external functions are slower, but use less code space if  more  than  one  function
           saves the same number of registers.  The -mprolog-function option is on by default if you optimize.

       -mspace
           Try  to  make  the  code  as  small  as  possible.   At  present,  this  just  turns  on the -mep and
           -mprolog-function options.

       -mtda=n
           Put static or global variables whose size is n bytes or less into the tiny data  area  that  register
           "ep"  points  to.   The  tiny  data  area  can  hold  up  to  256  bytes in total (128 bytes for byte
           references).

       -msda=n
           Put static or global variables whose size is n bytes or less into the small data area  that  register
           "gp" points to.  The small data area can hold up to 64 kilobytes.

       -mzda=n
           Put static or global variables whose size is n bytes or less into the first 32 kilobytes of memory.

       -mv850
           Specify that the target processor is the V850.

       -mbig-switch
           Generate  code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if the assembler/linker complain
           about out of range branches within a switch table.

       -mapp-regs
           This option will cause r2 and r5 to be used in the code generated by the compiler.  This  setting  is
           the default.

       -mno-app-regs
           This option will cause r2 and r5 to be treated as fixed registers.

       -mv850e2v3
           Specify  that  the target processor is the V850E2V3.  The preprocessor constants __v850e2v3__ will be
           defined if this option is used.

       -mv850e2
           Specify that the target processor is the V850E2.   The  preprocessor  constants  __v850e2__  will  be
           defined if

       -mv850e1
           Specify that the target processor is the V850E1.  The preprocessor constants __v850e1__ and __v850e__
           will be defined if

       -mv850es
           Specify that the target processor is the V850ES.  This is an alias for the -mv850e1 option.

       -mv850e
           Specify  that the target processor is the V850E.  The preprocessor constant __v850e__ will be defined
           if this option is used.

           If neither -mv850 nor -mv850e nor -mv850e1 nor -mv850e2 nor -mv850e2v3 are  defined  then  a  default
           target processor will be chosen and the relevant __v850*__ preprocessor constant will be defined.

           The  preprocessor  constants  __v850  and  __v851__ are always defined, regardless of which processor
           variant is the target.

       -mdisable-callt
           This option will suppress generation of the CALLT instruction  for  the  v850e,  v850e1,  v850e2  and
           v850e2v3  flavors of the v850 architecture.  The default is -mno-disable-callt which allows the CALLT
           instruction to be used.

       VAX Options

       These -m options are defined for the VAX:

       -munix
           Do not output certain jump instructions ("aobleq" and so on) that the  Unix  assembler  for  the  VAX
           cannot handle across long ranges.

       -mgnu
           Do output those jump instructions, on the assumption that you will assemble with the GNU assembler.

       -mg Output code for g-format floating point numbers instead of d-format.

       VxWorks Options

       The options in this section are defined for all VxWorks targets.  Options specific to the target hardware
       are listed with the other options for that target.

       -mrtp
           GCC  can generate code for both VxWorks kernels and real time processes (RTPs).  This option switches
           from the former to the latter.  It also defines the preprocessor macro "__RTP__".

       -non-static
           Link an RTP executable against shared libraries rather than static libraries.   The  options  -static
           and -shared can also be used for RTPs; -static is the default.

       -Bstatic
       -Bdynamic
           These options are passed down to the linker.  They are defined for compatibility with Diab.

       -Xbind-lazy
           Enable  lazy  binding  of function calls.  This option is equivalent to -Wl,-z,now and is defined for
           compatibility with Diab.

       -Xbind-now
           Disable lazy binding of function calls.  This option is the default and is defined for  compatibility
           with Diab.

       x86-64 Options

       These are listed under

       Xstormy16 Options

       These options are defined for Xstormy16:

       -msim
           Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.

       Xtensa Options

       These options are supported for Xtensa targets:

       -mconst16
       -mno-const16
           Enable  or  disable  use  of  "CONST16"  instructions  for  loading  constant  values.  The "CONST16"
           instruction is currently not a standard option from Tensilica.  When enabled, "CONST16"  instructions
           are  always  used  in  place of the standard "L32R" instructions.  The use of "CONST16" is enabled by
           default only if the "L32R" instruction is not available.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Enable or disable use of fused multiply/add and multiply/subtract instructions in the  floating-point
           option.   This  has  no  effect  if  the  floating-point option is not also enabled.  Disabling fused
           multiply/add and multiply/subtract instructions forces the compiler to use separate instructions  for
           the  multiply  and  add/subtract  operations.   This may be desirable in some cases where strict IEEE
           754-compliant results are required: the fused multiply add/subtract instructions  do  not  round  the
           intermediate result, thereby producing results with more bits of precision than specified by the IEEE
           standard.  Disabling fused multiply add/subtract instructions also ensures that the program output is
           not sensitive to the compiler's ability to combine multiply and add/subtract operations.

       -mserialize-volatile
       -mno-serialize-volatile
           When  this  option is enabled, GCC inserts "MEMW" instructions before "volatile" memory references to
           guarantee sequential consistency.  The default is -mserialize-volatile.  Use  -mno-serialize-volatile
           to omit the "MEMW" instructions.

       -mforce-no-pic
           For targets, like GNU/Linux, where all user-mode Xtensa code must be position-independent code (PIC),
           this option disables PIC for compiling kernel code.

       -mtext-section-literals
       -mno-text-section-literals
           Control  the  treatment  of  literal  pools.  The default is -mno-text-section-literals, which places
           literals in a separate section in the output file.  This allows the literal pool to be  placed  in  a
           data  RAM/ROM,  and  it also allows the linker to combine literal pools from separate object files to
           remove redundant literals and improve code size.   With  -mtext-section-literals,  the  literals  are
           interspersed  in  the  text  section  in order to keep them as close as possible to their references.
           This may be necessary for large assembly files.

       -mtarget-align
       -mno-target-align
           When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the  assembler  to  automatically  align  instructions  to
           reduce branch penalties at the expense of some code density.  The assembler attempts to widen density
           instructions  to align branch targets and the instructions following call instructions.  If there are
           not enough preceding safe density instructions to align a target, no widening will be performed.  The
           default is -mtarget-align.  These options do not affect the treatment  of  auto-aligned  instructions
           like  "LOOP",  which  the  assembler will always align, either by widening density instructions or by
           inserting no-op instructions.

       -mlongcalls
       -mno-longcalls
           When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to translate direct calls to indirect  calls
           unless  it  can  determine  that  the  target  of  a  direct call is in the range allowed by the call
           instruction.  This translation typically occurs  for  calls  to  functions  in  other  source  files.
           Specifically,  the  assembler  translates  a  direct  "CALL" instruction into an "L32R" followed by a
           "CALLX" instruction.  The default is -mno-longcalls.  This option should be used  in  programs  where
           the  call  target  can potentially be out of range.  This option is implemented in the assembler, not
           the compiler, so the assembly code generated by GCC will still show direct  call  instructions---look
           at  the disassembled object code to see the actual instructions.  Note that the assembler will use an
           indirect call for every cross-file call, not just those that really will be out of range.

       zSeries Options

       These are listed under

   Options for Code Generation Conventions
       These machine-independent options control the interface conventions used in code generation.

       Most of them have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of -ffoo would be -fno-foo.  In the
       table below, only one of the forms is listed---the one which is not the default.  You can figure out  the
       other form by either removing no- or adding it.

       -fbounds-check
           For  front-ends that support it, generate additional code to check that indices used to access arrays
           are within the declared range.  This is currently only supported by the Java and Fortran  front-ends,
           where this option defaults to true and false respectively.

       -ftrapv
           This option generates traps for signed overflow on addition, subtraction, multiplication operations.

       -fwrapv
           This option instructs the compiler to assume that signed arithmetic overflow of addition, subtraction
           and  multiplication  wraps  around  using  twos-complement  representation.   This  flag enables some
           optimizations and disables others.  This option is enabled by default  for  the  Java  front-end,  as
           required by the Java language specification.

       -fexceptions
           Enable  exception  handling.  Generates extra code needed to propagate exceptions.  For some targets,
           this implies GCC will generate  frame  unwind  information  for  all  functions,  which  can  produce
           significant  data  size  overhead, although it does not affect execution.  If you do not specify this
           option, GCC will enable it by default  for  languages  like  C++  which  normally  require  exception
           handling, and disable it for languages like C that do not normally require it.  However, you may need
           to  enable  this  option  when  compiling  C  code that needs to interoperate properly with exception
           handlers written in C++.  You may also wish to disable this option if you  are  compiling  older  C++
           programs that don't use exception handling.

       -fnon-call-exceptions
           Generate  code  that  allows  trapping  instructions  to  throw  exceptions.  Note that this requires
           platform-specific runtime support that does not exist everywhere.  Moreover, it only allows  trapping
           instructions to throw exceptions, i.e. memory references or floating point instructions.  It does not
           allow exceptions to be thrown from arbitrary signal handlers such as "SIGALRM".

       -funwind-tables
           Similar  to  -fexceptions,  except  that  it  will just generate any needed static data, but will not
           affect the generated code in any other way.  You will normally not enable  this  option;  instead,  a
           language processor that needs this handling would enable it on your behalf.

       -fasynchronous-unwind-tables
           Generate  unwind  table in dwarf2 format, if supported by target machine.  The table is exact at each
           instruction boundary, so it can be used  for  stack  unwinding  from  asynchronous  events  (such  as
           debugger or garbage collector).

       -fpcc-struct-return
           Return  "short"  "struct"  and  "union"  values in memory like longer ones, rather than in registers.
           This convention is less efficient, but it has the advantage of allowing intercallability between GCC-
           compiled files and files compiled with other compilers, particularly the Portable C Compiler (pcc).

           The precise convention for returning structures in memory depends on the target configuration macros.

           Short structures and unions are those whose size and alignment match that of some integer type.

           Warning: code compiled with the  -fpcc-struct-return  switch  is  not  binary  compatible  with  code
           compiled  with the -freg-struct-return switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary
           interface.

       -freg-struct-return
           Return "struct" and "union" values in registers when possible.  This  is  more  efficient  for  small
           structures than -fpcc-struct-return.

           If  you  specify  neither  -fpcc-struct-return  nor  -freg-struct-return,  GCC  defaults to whichever
           convention is standard for the  target.   If  there  is  no  standard  convention,  GCC  defaults  to
           -fpcc-struct-return,  except  on targets where GCC is the principal compiler.  In those cases, we can
           choose the standard, and we chose the more efficient register return alternative.

           Warning: code compiled with the  -freg-struct-return  switch  is  not  binary  compatible  with  code
           compiled  with the -fpcc-struct-return switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary
           interface.

       -fshort-enums
           Allocate to an "enum" type only as many bytes as it needs for the declared range of possible  values.
           Specifically, the "enum" type will be equivalent to the smallest integer type which has enough room.

           Warning: the -fshort-enums switch causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible with code
           generated without that switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.

       -fshort-double
           Use the same size for "double" as for "float".

           Warning:  the  -fshort-double  switch  causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible with
           code generated without that switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.

       -fshort-wchar
           Override the underlying type for wchar_t to be short unsigned int instead  of  the  default  for  the
           target.  This option is useful for building programs to run under WINE.

           Warning: the -fshort-wchar switch causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible with code
           generated without that switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.

       -fno-common
           In  C  code,  controls  the  placement  of  uninitialized  global  variables.   Unix C compilers have
           traditionally permitted multiple definitions of such variables  in  different  compilation  units  by
           placing  the  variables  in  a  common block.  This is the behavior specified by -fcommon, and is the
           default for GCC on most targets.  On the other hand, this behavior is not required by ISO C,  and  on
           some  targets  may carry a speed or code size penalty on variable references.  The -fno-common option
           specifies that the compiler should place uninitialized global variables in the data  section  of  the
           object  file,  rather  than  generating  them as common blocks.  This has the effect that if the same
           variable is declared (without "extern") in two different  compilations,  you  will  get  a  multiple-
           definition  error  when  you  link  them.   In  this  case,  you  must compile with -fcommon instead.
           Compiling with -fno-common is useful on targets for which it provides better performance, or  if  you
           wish  to verify that the program will work on other systems which always treat uninitialized variable
           declarations this way.

       -fno-ident
           Ignore the #ident directive.

       -finhibit-size-directive
           Don't output a ".size" assembler directive, or anything else that would cause trouble if the function
           is split in the middle, and the two halves are placed at locations far apart in memory.  This  option
           is used when compiling crtstuff.c; you should not need to use it for anything else.

       -fverbose-asm
           Put  extra  commentary  information  in  the  generated assembly code to make it more readable.  This
           option is generally only of use to those who actually  need  to  read  the  generated  assembly  code
           (perhaps while debugging the compiler itself).

           -fno-verbose-asm,  the  default,  causes  the  extra  information  to  be  omitted and is useful when
           comparing two assembler files.

       -frecord-gcc-switches
           This switch causes the command line that was used to invoke the compiler  to  be  recorded  into  the
           object  file  that  is  being created.  This switch is only implemented on some targets and the exact
           format of the recording is target and binary file format dependent, but it usually takes the form  of
           a section containing ASCII text.  This switch is related to the -fverbose-asm switch, but that switch
           only  records  information  in  the assembler output file as comments, so it never reaches the object
           file.

       -fpic
           Generate position-independent code (PIC) suitable for use in a shared library, if supported  for  the
           target  machine.  Such code accesses all constant addresses through a global offset table (GOT).  The
           dynamic loader resolves the GOT entries when the program starts (the dynamic loader is  not  part  of
           GCC;  it  is  part  of  the  operating  system).  If the GOT size for the linked executable exceeds a
           machine-specific maximum size, you get an error message from the linker indicating  that  -fpic  does
           not work; in that case, recompile with -fPIC instead.  (These maximums are 8k on the SPARC and 32k on
           the m68k and RS/6000.  The 386 has no such limit.)

           Position-independent  code  requires  special  support, and therefore works only on certain machines.
           For the 386, GCC supports PIC for System V but not for the Sun 386i.   Code  generated  for  the  IBM
           RS/6000 is always position-independent.

           When this flag is set, the macros "__pic__" and "__PIC__" are defined to 1.

       -fPIC
           If supported for the target machine, emit position-independent code, suitable for dynamic linking and
           avoiding  any  limit  on  the size of the global offset table.  This option makes a difference on the
           m68k, PowerPC and SPARC.

           Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works only on certain machines.

           When this flag is set, the macros "__pic__" and "__PIC__" are defined to 2.

       -fpie
       -fPIE
           These options are similar to -fpic and -fPIC, but generated position independent  code  can  be  only
           linked  into  executables.   Usually  these options are used when -pie GCC option will be used during
           linking.

           -fpie and -fPIE both define the macros "__pie__" and "__PIE__".  The macros  have  the  value  1  for
           -fpie and 2 for -fPIE.

       -fno-jump-tables
           Do  not  use  jump tables for switch statements even where it would be more efficient than other code
           generation strategies.  This option is of use in conjunction with -fpic or -fPIC  for  building  code
           which  forms  part  of  a  dynamic  linker and cannot reference the address of a jump table.  On some
           targets, jump tables do not require a GOT and this option is not needed.

       -ffixed-reg
           Treat the register named reg as a fixed register; generated code should never  refer  to  it  (except
           perhaps as a stack pointer, frame pointer or in some other fixed role).

           reg must be the name of a register.  The register names accepted are machine-specific and are defined
           in the "REGISTER_NAMES" macro in the machine description macro file.

           This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a three-way choice.

       -fcall-used-reg
           Treat the register named reg as an allocable register that is clobbered by function calls.  It may be
           allocated  for  temporaries or variables that do not live across a call.  Functions compiled this way
           will not save and restore the register reg.

           It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.  Use of this flag for other
           registers that have fixed pervasive roles in the machine's execution model  will  produce  disastrous
           results.

           This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a three-way choice.

       -fcall-saved-reg
           Treat  the  register named reg as an allocable register saved by functions.  It may be allocated even
           for temporaries or variables that live across a call.  Functions compiled  this  way  will  save  and
           restore the register reg if they use it.

           It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.  Use of this flag for other
           registers  that  have  fixed pervasive roles in the machine's execution model will produce disastrous
           results.

           A different sort of disaster will result from the use of this flag for a register in  which  function
           values may be returned.

           This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a three-way choice.

       -fpack-struct[=n]
           Without  a  value  specified,  pack  all  structure  members together without holes.  When a value is
           specified (which must be a small power of two), pack  structure  members  according  to  this  value,
           representing  the maximum alignment (that is, objects with default alignment requirements larger than
           this will be output potentially unaligned at the next fitting location.

           Warning: the -fpack-struct switch causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible with code
           generated without that switch.  Additionally, it makes the code suboptimal.  Use it to conform  to  a
           non-default application binary interface.

       -finstrument-functions
           Generate  instrumentation  calls for entry and exit to functions.  Just after function entry and just
           before function exit, the following profiling functions will  be  called  with  the  address  of  the
           current  function  and  its  call site.  (On some platforms, "__builtin_return_address" does not work
           beyond the current function, so the call site information may  not  be  available  to  the  profiling
           functions otherwise.)

                   void __cyg_profile_func_enter (void *this_fn,
                                                  void *call_site);
                   void __cyg_profile_func_exit  (void *this_fn,
                                                  void *call_site);

           The  first  argument  is  the  address  of  the start of the current function, which may be looked up
           exactly in the symbol table.

           This instrumentation is also done for functions expanded inline in other  functions.   The  profiling
           calls  will indicate where, conceptually, the inline function is entered and exited.  This means that
           addressable versions of such functions must be available.   If  all  your  uses  of  a  function  are
           expanded  inline,  this  may  mean an additional expansion of code size.  If you use extern inline in
           your C code, an addressable version of such functions must be provided.  (This is normally  the  case
           anyways,  but  if you get lucky and the optimizer always expands the functions inline, you might have
           gotten away without providing static copies.)

           A function may be given the attribute "no_instrument_function", in which  case  this  instrumentation
           will  not  be  done.   This can be used, for example, for the profiling functions listed above, high-
           priority interrupt routines, and any functions from which the profiling functions  cannot  safely  be
           called (perhaps signal handlers, if the profiling routines generate output or allocate memory).

       -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=file,file,...
           Set  the  list  of  functions  that  are  excluded  from  instrumentation  (see  the  description  of
           "-finstrument-functions").  If the file that contains a function definition matches with one of file,
           then that function is not instrumented.  The match is done on substrings: if the file parameter is  a
           substring of the file name, it is considered to be a match.

           For example:

                   -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=/bits/stl,include/sys

           will   exclude  any  inline  function  defined  in  files  whose  pathnames  contain  "/bits/stl"  or
           "include/sys".

           If, for some reason, you want to  include  letter  ','  in  one  of  sym,  write  ','.  For  example,
           "-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=',,tmp'" (note the single quote surrounding the option).

       -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=sym,sym,...
           This  is  similar  to  "-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list",  but  this option sets the list of
           function names to be excluded from instrumentation.  The function name to be  matched  is  its  user-
           visible  name,  such as "vector<int> blah(const vector<int> &)", not the internal mangled name (e.g.,
           "_Z4blahRSt6vectorIiSaIiEE").  The match is done on substrings: if the sym parameter is  a  substring
           of  the  function  name,  it  is considered to be a match.  For C99 and C++ extended identifiers, the
           function name must be given in UTF-8, not using universal character names.

       -fstack-check
           Generate code to verify that you do not go beyond the boundary of the stack.  You should specify this
           flag if you are running in an environment with multiple threads, but only rarely need to  specify  it
           in a single-threaded environment since stack overflow is automatically detected on nearly all systems
           if there is only one stack.

           Note  that  this  switch  does  not  actually  cause checking to be done; the operating system or the
           language runtime must do that.  The switch causes generation of code to  ensure  that  they  see  the
           stack being extended.

           You  can  additionally  specify a string parameter: "no" means no checking, "generic" means force the
           use of old-style checking, "specific" means use the best checking method and is  equivalent  to  bare
           -fstack-check.

           Old-style  checking  is  a generic mechanism that requires no specific target support in the compiler
           but comes with the following drawbacks:

           1.  Modified allocation strategy for large objects: they will  always  be  allocated  dynamically  if
               their size exceeds a fixed threshold.

           2.  Fixed  limit  on  the  size  of  the static frame of functions: when it is topped by a particular
               function, stack checking is not reliable and a warning is issued by the compiler.

           3.  Inefficiency: because of both the modified allocation strategy and  the  generic  implementation,
               the performances of the code are hampered.

           Note  that  old-style  stack checking is also the fallback method for "specific" if no target support
           has been added in the compiler.

       -fstack-limit-register=reg
       -fstack-limit-symbol=sym
       -fno-stack-limit
           Generate code to ensure that the stack does not grow beyond a certain value, either the  value  of  a
           register  or  the address of a symbol.  If the stack would grow beyond the value, a signal is raised.
           For most targets, the signal is raised before the stack overruns the boundary, so it is  possible  to
           catch the signal without taking special precautions.

           For instance, if the stack starts at absolute address 0x80000000 and grows downwards, you can use the
           flags -fstack-limit-symbol=__stack_limit and -Wl,--defsym,__stack_limit=0x7ffe0000 to enforce a stack
           limit of 128KB.  Note that this may only work with the GNU linker.

       -fsplit-stack
           Generate  code  to  automatically  split  the stack before it overflows.  The resulting program has a
           discontiguous stack which can only overflow if the program is unable to  allocate  any  more  memory.
           This  is most useful when running threaded programs, as it is no longer necessary to calculate a good
           stack size to use for each thread.  This is currently  only  implemented  for  the  i386  and  x86_64
           backends running GNU/Linux.

           When  code  compiled  with  -fsplit-stack calls code compiled without -fsplit-stack, there may not be
           much stack space available for the latter code to run.  If  compiling  all  code,  including  library
           code,  with  -fsplit-stack  is not an option, then the linker can fix up these calls so that the code
           compiled without -fsplit-stack always has a large stack.  Support for this is implemented in the gold
           linker in GNU binutils release 2.21 and later.

       -fleading-underscore
           This option and its counterpart, -fno-leading-underscore, forcibly  change  the  way  C  symbols  are
           represented in the object file.  One use is to help link with legacy assembly code.

           Warning:  the  -fleading-underscore  switch causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible
           with code generated without that switch.  Use it to  conform  to  a  non-default  application  binary
           interface.  Not all targets provide complete support for this switch.

       -ftls-model=model
           Alter   the   thread-local  storage  model  to  be  used.   The  model  argument  should  be  one  of
           "global-dynamic", "local-dynamic", "initial-exec" or "local-exec".

           The default without -fpic is "initial-exec"; with -fpic the default is "global-dynamic".

       -fvisibility=default|internal|hidden|protected
           Set the default ELF image symbol visibility to the specified option---all symbols will be marked with
           this unless overridden within the code.  Using this feature can very  substantially  improve  linking
           and  load  times  of  shared  object libraries, produce more optimized code, provide near-perfect API
           export and prevent symbol clashes.  It is strongly recommended  that  you  use  this  in  any  shared
           objects you distribute.

           Despite  the  nomenclature,  "default" always means public; i.e., available to be linked against from
           outside the shared object.  "protected" and "internal" are pretty useless in real-world usage so  the
           only  other  commonly  used  option will be "hidden".  The default if -fvisibility isn't specified is
           "default", i.e., make every symbol public---this causes the same behavior  as  previous  versions  of
           GCC.

           A  good  explanation  of  the benefits offered by ensuring ELF symbols have the correct visibility is
           given  by  "How  To  Write  Shared  Libraries"  by  Ulrich   Drepper   (which   can   be   found   at
           <http://people.redhat.com/~drepper/>)---however  a  superior solution made possible by this option to
           marking things hidden when the default is public is to  make  the  default  hidden  and  mark  things
           public.   This  is  the  norm  with  DLL's on Windows and with -fvisibility=hidden and "__attribute__
           ((visibility("default")))" instead of "__declspec(dllexport)" you get almost identical semantics with
           identical syntax.  This is a great boon to those working with cross-platform projects.

           For those adding visibility support to existing code, you may find #pragma  GCC  visibility  of  use.
           This  works  by  you  enclosing  the  declarations  you wish to set visibility for with (for example)
           #pragma GCC visibility push(hidden) and #pragma  GCC  visibility  pop.   Bear  in  mind  that  symbol
           visibility should be viewed as part of the API interface contract and thus all new code should always
           specify  visibility  when it is not the default; i.e., declarations only for use within the local DSO
           should always be marked explicitly as hidden as so to avoid PLT indirection  overheads---making  this
           abundantly  clear also aids readability and self-documentation of the code.  Note that due to ISO C++
           specification requirements, operator new and operator delete must always be of default visibility.

           Be aware that headers from outside your project, in particular system headers and  headers  from  any
           other  library  you  use, may not be expecting to be compiled with visibility other than the default.
           You may need to explicitly say  #pragma  GCC  visibility  push(default)  before  including  any  such
           headers.

           extern  declarations  are  not  affected  by  -fvisibility,  so  a lot of code can be recompiled with
           -fvisibility=hidden with no modifications.  However, this means that calls to extern  functions  with
           no  explicit  visibility  will use the PLT, so it is more effective to use __attribute ((visibility))
           and/or #pragma GCC visibility to tell the compiler which extern declarations  should  be  treated  as
           hidden.

           Note  that  -fvisibility  does  affect  C++ vague linkage entities. This means that, for instance, an
           exception class that will be thrown between DSOs must be explicitly marked with default visibility so
           that the type_info nodes will be unified between the DSOs.

           An   overview   of   these   techniques,   their   benefits   and   how   to   use   them    is    at
           <http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/Visibility>.

       -fstrict-volatile-bitfields
           This option should be used if accesses to volatile bitfields (or other structure fields, although the
           compiler  usually  honors  those types anyway) should use a single access of the width of the field's
           type, aligned to a natural alignment if possible.  For example, targets with memory-mapped peripheral
           registers might require all such accesses to be 16 bits wide; with this flag the user  could  declare
           all  peripheral  bitfields  as "unsigned short" (assuming short is 16 bits on these targets) to force
           GCC to use 16 bit accesses instead of, perhaps, a more efficient 32 bit access.

           If this option is disabled, the compiler will use the most efficient instruction.   In  the  previous
           example,  that  might  be  a  32-bit load instruction, even though that will access bytes that do not
           contain any portion of the bitfield, or memory-mapped registers unrelated to the one being updated.

           If the target requires strict alignment, and honoring the field type  would  require  violating  this
           alignment,  a  warning  is  issued.   If the field has "packed" attribute, the access is done without
           honoring the field type.  If the field doesn't have "packed" attribute, the access is  done  honoring
           the  field  type.  In both cases, GCC assumes that the user knows something about the target hardware
           that it is unaware of.

           The default value of this option is determined by the application binary  interface  for  the  target
           processor.

ENVIRONMENT

       This  section describes several environment variables that affect how GCC operates.  Some of them work by
       specifying directories or prefixes to use when searching for various kinds of files.  Some  are  used  to
       specify other aspects of the compilation environment.

       Note  that  you  can  also  specify  places  to  search  using options such as -B, -I and -L.  These take
       precedence over places specified using environment variables, which in turn take  precedence  over  those
       specified by the configuration of GCC.

       LANG
       LC_CTYPE
       LC_MESSAGES
       LC_ALL
           These  environment variables control the way that GCC uses localization information that allow GCC to
           work  with  different  national  conventions.   GCC  inspects  the  locale  categories  LC_CTYPE  and
           LC_MESSAGES  if  it  has  been  configured to do so.  These locale categories can be set to any value
           supported by your installation.  A typical value is en_GB.UTF-8 for English  in  the  United  Kingdom
           encoded in UTF-8.

           The  LC_CTYPE  environment variable specifies character classification.  GCC uses it to determine the
           character boundaries in a string; this is needed for some multibyte encodings that contain quote  and
           escape characters that would otherwise be interpreted as a string end or escape.

           The LC_MESSAGES environment variable specifies the language to use in diagnostic messages.

           If  the  LC_ALL  environment  variable  is  set,  it overrides the value of LC_CTYPE and LC_MESSAGES;
           otherwise, LC_CTYPE and LC_MESSAGES default to the value of the LANG environment variable.   If  none
           of these variables are set, GCC defaults to traditional C English behavior.

       TMPDIR
           If TMPDIR is set, it specifies the directory to use for temporary files.  GCC uses temporary files to
           hold  the  output  of  one  stage  of compilation which is to be used as input to the next stage: for
           example, the output of the preprocessor, which is the input to the compiler proper.

       GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
           If GCC_EXEC_PREFIX is set, it specifies a prefix to use in the names of the subprograms  executed  by
           the  compiler.  No slash is added when this prefix is combined with the name of a subprogram, but you
           can specify a prefix that ends with a slash if you wish.

           If GCC_EXEC_PREFIX is not set, GCC will attempt to figure out an appropriate prefix to use  based  on
           the pathname it was invoked with.

           If  GCC  cannot  find the subprogram using the specified prefix, it tries looking in the usual places
           for the subprogram.

           The default value of GCC_EXEC_PREFIX is prefix/lib/gcc/ where prefix is the prefix to  the  installed
           compiler. In many cases prefix is the value of "prefix" when you ran the configure script.

           Other prefixes specified with -B take precedence over this prefix.

           This prefix is also used for finding files such as crt0.o that are used for linking.

           In  addition,  the  prefix  is used in an unusual way in finding the directories to search for header
           files.  For each of the standard directories whose name normally begins with /usr/local/lib/gcc (more
           precisely, with the value of GCC_INCLUDE_DIR), GCC tries replacing that beginning with the  specified
           prefix  to  produce an alternate directory name.  Thus, with -Bfoo/, GCC will search foo/bar where it
           would normally search /usr/local/lib/bar.   These  alternate  directories  are  searched  first;  the
           standard  directories  come  next. If a standard directory begins with the configured prefix then the
           value of prefix is replaced by GCC_EXEC_PREFIX when looking for header files.

       COMPILER_PATH
           The value of COMPILER_PATH is a colon-separated list of directories, much like PATH.  GCC  tries  the
           directories  thus  specified  when  searching for subprograms, if it can't find the subprograms using
           GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.

       LIBRARY_PATH
           The value of LIBRARY_PATH is a colon-separated list of directories, much like PATH.  When  configured
           as  a  native  compiler,  GCC  tries the directories thus specified when searching for special linker
           files, if it can't find them using GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.  Linking using GCC also  uses  these  directories
           when  searching  for  ordinary  libraries  for  the -l option (but directories specified with -L come
           first).

       LANG
           This variable is used to pass locale information to the compiler.  One way in which this  information
           is  used  is  to  determine the character set to be used when character literals, string literals and
           comments are parsed in C and C++.  When the compiler is configured to allow multibyte characters, the
           following values for LANG are recognized:

           C-JIS
               Recognize JIS characters.

           C-SJIS
               Recognize SJIS characters.

           C-EUCJP
               Recognize EUCJP characters.

           If LANG is not defined, or if it has some other value, then the compiler will use mblen and mbtowc as
           defined by the default locale to recognize and translate multibyte characters.

       Some additional environments variables affect the behavior of the preprocessor.

       CPATH
       C_INCLUDE_PATH
       CPLUS_INCLUDE_PATH
       OBJC_INCLUDE_PATH
           Each variable's value is a list of directories separated by a special character, much like  PATH,  in
           which  to  look  for  header files.  The special character, "PATH_SEPARATOR", is target-dependent and
           determined at GCC build time.  For Microsoft Windows-based targets it is a semicolon, and for  almost
           all other targets it is a colon.

           CPATH  specifies  a  list  of directories to be searched as if specified with -I, but after any paths
           given with -I options on the command line.  This environment variable is  used  regardless  of  which
           language is being preprocessed.

           The  remaining environment variables apply only when preprocessing the particular language indicated.
           Each specifies a list of directories to be searched as if specified  with  -isystem,  but  after  any
           paths given with -isystem options on the command line.

           In  all  these  variables,  an  empty  element  instructs  the compiler to search its current working
           directory.  Empty elements can appear at the beginning or end of a path.  For instance, if the  value
           of CPATH is ":/special/include", that has the same effect as -I. -I/special/include.

       DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT
           If  this  variable  is set, its value specifies how to output dependencies for Make based on the non-
           system header files processed by the compiler.  System header files are  ignored  in  the  dependency
           output.

           The value of DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT can be just a file name, in which case the Make rules are written to
           that  file,  guessing the target name from the source file name.  Or the value can have the form file
           target, in which case the rules are written to file file using target as the target name.

           In other words, this environment variable is equivalent to combining the options -MM and -MF, with an
           optional -MT switch too.

       SUNPRO_DEPENDENCIES
           This variable is the same as DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT (see above), except that system header files are not
           ignored, so it implies -M rather than -MM.  However,  the  dependence  on  the  main  input  file  is
           omitted.

BUGS

       For instructions on reporting bugs, see <file:///usr/share/doc/gcc-4.6/README.Bugs>.

FOOTNOTES

       1.  On  some  systems,  gcc  -shared needs to build supplementary stub code for constructors to work.  On
           multi-libbed systems, gcc -shared must select the correct support libraries to link against.  Failing
           to supply the correct flags may lead to subtle defects.  Supplying them in cases where they  are  not
           necessary is innocuous.

SEE ALSO

       gpl(7),  gfdl(7),  fsf-funding(7),  cpp(1), gcov(1), as(1), ld(1), gdb(1), adb(1), dbx(1), sdb(1) and the
       Info entries for gcc, cpp, as, ld, binutils and gdb.

AUTHOR

       See the Info entry for gcc, or <http://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Contributors.html>, for contributors to
       GCC.

COPYRIGHT

       Copyright (c) 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,  2003,  2004,
       2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.

       Permission  is  granted  to  copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free
       Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software  Foundation;  with
       the  Invariant  Sections  being "GNU General Public License" and "Funding Free Software", the Front-Cover
       texts being (a) (see below), and with the Back-Cover Texts being (b) (see below).  A copy of the  license
       is included in the gfdl(7) man page.

       (a) The FSF's Front-Cover Text is:

            A GNU Manual

       (b) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is:

            You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU
            software.  Copies published by the Free Software Foundation raise
            funds for GNU development.

gcc-4.6                                            2013-04-12                                             GCC(1)